RESOURCE AMERICA INC
S-3, 1998-03-05
INVESTMENT ADVICE
Previous: SYMMETRICOM INC, S-8, 1998-03-05
Next: REVERE PAUL VARIABLE ANNUITY CONTRACT ACCMULATION FUND, N-30D, 1998-03-05



<PAGE>

                                                         Registration No. 333-

                      SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION

                                   FORM S-3
            REGISTRATION STATEMENT UNDER THE SECURITIES ACT OF 1933

                            RESOURCE AMERICA, INC.
- ------------------------------------------------------------------------------
            (Exact name of registrant as specified in its charter)

                                   DELAWARE
- ------------------------------------------------------------------------------
        (State or other jurisdiction of incorporation or organization)

                                  72-0654145
- ------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                     (I.R.S. Employer Identification No.)

     1521 Locust Street, Philadelphia, Pennsylvania 19102 (215-546-5005)
- ------------------------------------------------------------------------------
             (Address, including zip code, and telephone number,
      including area code, of registrant's principal executive offices)

             Steven J. Kessler, 1521 Locust Street, Philadelphia,
                      Pennsylvania 19102 (215-546-5005)
- ------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                     (Name, address, including zip code,
       and telephone number, including area code, of agent for service)

                                  Copies to:
J. Baur Whittlesey, Esq.                       Dave Muchnikoff, P.C.
Ledgewood Law Firm, P.C.                       Silver, Freedman & Taff, L.L.P.
1521 Locust Street                             1100 New York Avenue, N.W.
Philadelphia, PA 19102                         Washington, D.C. 20005-3934
(215) 735-0663                                 (202) 682-0354

         Approximate date of commencement of proposed sale to the public: As
soon as practicable after the registration statement becomes effective.

If the only securities being registered on this Form are being offered
pursuant to dividend or interest reinvestment plans, please check the
following box [ ].

If any of the securities being registered on this Form are to be offered on a
delayed or continuous basis pursuant to Rule 415 under the Securities Act of
1933, other than securities offered only in connection with dividend or
interest reinvestment plans, check the following box [ ].

If this Form is filed to register additional securities for an offering
pursuant to Rule 462(b) under the Securities Act, please check the following
box and list the Securities Act registration statement number of the earlier
effective registration statement for the same offering [ ].



<PAGE>



If this Form is a post-effective amendment filed pursuant to Rule 462(c) under
the Securities Act, check the following box and list the Securities Act
registration statement number of the earlier effective registration statement
for the same offering [].

If delivery of the prospectus is expected to be made pursuant to Rule 434,
please check the following box [ ].

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>

                                          CALCULATION OF REGISTRATION FEE
- -----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
    Title of each class                                       Proposed                 Proposed maximum
    of securities to be           Amount to be            maximum offering            aggregate offering               Amount of
        registered                 registered             price per unit(1)                  price                 registration fee
- -----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
<S>                                 <C>                   <C>                         <C>                          <C>     
Common Stock                        1,725,000                $47.125                     $81,290,625                 $23,980.73
- -----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
</TABLE>

(1)      Estimated solely for purposes of calculating the registration fee in
         accordance with Rule 457(c) under the Securities Act of 1933 based
         upon the average of the high and low prices reported on the Nasdaq
         Stock Market on March 3, 1998.

The registrant hereby amends this registration statement on such date or dates
as may be necessary to delay its effective date until the registrant shall
file a further amendment which specifically states that this registration
statement shall thereafter become effective in accordance with Section 8(a) of
the Securities Act of 1933 or until the registration statement shall become
effective on such date as the Securities and Exchange Commission, acting
pursuant to said Section 8(a), may determine.

                                       2

<PAGE>
Information contained herein is subject to completion or amendment. A
registration statement relating to these securities has been filed with the
Securities and Exchange Commission. These securities may not be sold nor may
offers to buy be accepted prior to the time the registration statement becomes
effective. This Prospectus shall not constitute an offer to sell or the
solicitation of an offer to buy nor shall there be any sale of these
securities in any State in which such offer, solicitation or sale would be
unlawful prior to registration or qualification under the securities laws of
any such State.

                  SUBJECT TO COMPLETION, DATED MARCH 5, 1998

PROSPECTUS

                                    [LOGO]

                            RESOURCE AMERICA, INC.

                       1,500,000 Shares of Common Stock

         Resource America, Inc. (the "Company") is hereby offering (the
"Offering") for sale 1,500,000 shares of its common stock, $.01 par value per
share (the "Common Stock").

         The Common Stock is quoted on the Nasdaq National Market System
("Nasdaq") under the symbol "REXI." The last sales price of the Common Stock
on March 3, 1998, as reported on Nasdaq, was $47.00 per share. See "Price
Range of Common Stock and Dividend Policy."

The Common Stock offered hereby involves a high degree of risk. See "Risk
Factors" beginning on page 12 hereof for a discussion of certain factors that
should be considered carefully by prospective purchasers.

                                  ---------

 THESE SECURITIES HAVE NOT BEEN APPROVED OR DISAPPROVED BY THE SECURITIES AND
      EXCHANGE COMMISSION OR ANY STATE SECURITIES COMMISSION NOR HAS THE
     SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION OR ANY STATE SECURITIES COMMISSION
         PASSED UPON THE ACCURACY OR ADEQUACY OF THIS PROSPECTUS. ANY
             REPRESENTATION TO THE CONTRARY IS A CRIMINAL OFFENSE.


                                       1

<PAGE>

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>


============================================================================================================================
                                                 Price to                   Underwriting          Proceeds to
                                                  Public                     Discount(1)           Company(2)
- ----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
<S>                                                  <C>                      <C>                   <C>             
Per Share.............................               $                            $                          $
Total(3)..............................              $                            $                          $
============================================================================================================================
</TABLE>

(1)      The Company has agreed to indemnify the Underwriters against certain
         liabilities, including liabilities under the Securities Act of 1933,
         as amended. See "Underwriting."
(2)      Before deducting expenses of the offering, estimated to be
         $_____________.
(3)      The Company has granted the several Underwriters a 30-day option to
         purchase up to 225,000 additional shares of Common Stock to cover
         over-allotments. If all such shares of Common Stock are purchased,
         the total Price to Public, Underwriting Discount and Proceeds to
         Company will be $__________, $__________ and $__________,
         respectively. See "Underwriting."

         The shares of Common Stock are offered by the Underwriters, subject
to receipt and acceptance by the Underwriters, approval of certain legal
matters by counsel for the Underwriters and certain other conditions. The
Underwriters reserve the right to withdraw, cancel or modify such offers and
to reject orders in whole or in part. It is expected that delivery of the
shares of Common Stock will be made in New York, New York on or about
_____________, 1998.



FRIEDMAN, BILLINGS, RAMSEY & CO., INC.
                        BANCAMERICA ROBERTSON STEPHENS
                                                  JANNEY MONTGOMERY SCOTT INC.


             The date of this Prospectus is ______________, 1998.

                                       2

<PAGE>
                             AVAILABLE INFORMATION

         The Company is subject to the informational requirements of the
Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended (the "Exchange Act"), and,
accordingly, files reports, proxy statements and other information with the
Securities and Exchange Commission (the "Commission"). Such reports, proxy
statements and other information filed with the Commission are available for
inspection and copying at the public reference facilities maintained by the
Commission at Room 1024, Judiciary Plaza, 450 Fifth Street, N.W. Washington,
D.C. 20549, and at the Commission's Regional Offices located at Citicorp
Center, 500 West Madison Street, Suite 1400, Chicago, Illinois 60661 and at
Seven World Trade Center, New York, New York 10048. Copies of such documents
may also be obtained from the Public Reference Section of the Commission at
Judiciary Plaza, 450 Fifth Street, N.W., Washington, D.C. 20549, at prescribed
rates. In addition, copies of such documents may be obtained through the
Commission's Internet address at http://www.sec.gov. The Common Stock is
authorized for quotation on Nasdaq and, accordingly, such materials and other
information can also be inspected at the offices of the National Association
of Securities Dealers, Inc., 1735 K Street, N.W., Washington, D.C. 20006.

                            ADDITIONAL INFORMATION

         The Company has filed with the Commission a Registration Statement on
Form S-3 (No. 333- ) (together with any amendments thereto, the "Registration
Statement"), under the Securities Act of 1933, as amended (the "Securities
Act"), with respect to the securities offered hereby. This Prospectus, which
constitutes a part of the Registration Statement, omits certain information
contained in the Registration Statement as permitted by the rules and
regulations of the Commission. For further information with respect to the
Company and the securities offered hereby, reference is made to the
Registration Statement and the exhibits and financial statements, notes and
schedules filed as part thereof or incorporated by reference therein, which
may be inspected at the public reference facilities of the Commission at the
addresses set forth above. Statements made in this Prospectus concerning the
contents of any documents referred to herein are not necessarily complete, and
in each instance are qualified in all respects by reference to the copy of
such document filed as an exhibit to the Registration Statement or
incorporated by reference therein.

         This Prospectus contains certain forward-looking statements which
involve substantial risks and uncertainties. These forward-looking statements
can generally be identified as such because the context of the statement
includes words such as the Company "believes," "anticipates," "expects,"
"estimates," "intends," or other words of similar intent. Similarly,
statements that describe the Company's future plans, objectives and goals are
also forward-looking statements. The Company's actual results, performance or
achievements could differ materially from those expressed or implied in these
forward-looking statements as a result of certain factors, including those set
forth in "Risk Factors" and elsewhere in this Prospectus.


                                       3

<PAGE>



         CERTAIN PERSONS PARTICIPATING IN THIS OFFERING MAY ENGAGE IN
TRANSACTIONS THAT STABILIZE, MAINTAIN, OR OTHERWISE AFFECT THE PRICE OF THE
COMMON STOCK, INCLUDING OVER-ALLOTMENT, STABILIZING TRANSACTIONS, SYNDICATE
SHORT COVERING TRANSACTIONS AND THE IMPOSITION OF PENALTY BIDS. FOR A
DESCRIPTION OF THESE ACTIVITIES. SEE "UNDERWRITING."

         IN CONNECTION WITH THIS OFFERING, CERTAIN UNDERWRITERS AND SELLING
GROUP MEMBERS MAY ENGAGE IN PASSIVE MARKET MAKING TRANSACTIONS IN THE COMMON
STOCK ON THE NASDAQ NATIONAL MARKET IN ACCORDANCE WITH RULE 103 OF REGULATION
M. SEE "UNDERWRITING."

                INCORPORATION OF CERTAIN DOCUMENTS BY REFERENCE

         The following documents, previously filed with the Commission (File
No. 0-4408) pursuant to Section 13 of the Exchange Act, are incorporated by
reference herein and made a part hereof: (i) the Company's Annual Report on
Form 10-K for the year ended September 30, 1997; (ii) the Company's Quarterly
Report on Form 10-Q for the quarter ended December 31, 1997; (iii) the
Company's Current Reports on Form 8-K dated December 17, 1997 and January 14,
1998; and (iv) the description of the Company's Common Stock contained in Form
8-A, including any amendment or report filed for the purpose of updating such
description.

         All documents filed by the Company with the Commission pursuant to
Section 13(a), 13(c), 14 or 15(d) of the Exchange Act after the date hereof
and prior to the termination of this offering shall be deemed to be
incorporated by reference in this Prospectus and to be a part hereof from the
date of filing of such documents. Any statement contained in a document
incorporated or deemed to be incorporated by reference herein shall be deemed
to be modified or superseded for purposes of this Prospectus to the extent
that a statement contained herein or in any other subsequently filed document
which also is or is deemed to be incorporated by reference herein modifies or
supersedes such statement. Any such statement so modified or superseded shall
not be deemed, except as so modified or superseded, to constitute a part of
this Prospectus. All information appearing in this Prospectus should be read
in conjunction with, and is qualified in its entirety by, the information and
financial statements (including notes thereto) appearing in the documents
incorporated herein by reference, except to the extent set forth in the
immediately preceding statement.

         The Company will provide without charge, to each person to whom this
Prospectus is delivered, upon written or oral request of such person, a copy
of any and all of the documents referred to above which have been or may be
incorporated in this Prospectus by reference (other than exhibits not
specifically incorporated by reference therein). Written or oral requests for
such copies should be directed to: Secretary, Resource America, Inc., 1521
Locust Street, Philadelphia, Pennsylvania 19102 (215) 546-5005.

                                       4

<PAGE>
                              PROSPECTUS SUMMARY

                                  The Company

General

         The Company operates a specialty finance business focused on real
estate finance and equipment leasing. For approximately 25 years prior to
1991, the Company was principally involved in the energy industry and it
continues to conduct energy industry operations, including natural gas and oil
production. Since 1991, the Company's business strategy has focused on
locating and developing niche finance businesses in which the Company can
realize attractive returns by targeting well-defined financial services
markets and by developing specialized skills to service those markets on a
cost-effective basis. To date, the Company has developed two main businesses:
real estate finance and equipment leasing. Within its real estate finance
business, the Company has developed a commercial mortgage loan acquisition and
resolution business and a residential mortgage lending business. The Company
has also sponsored a real estate investment trust and currently owns 15% of
the trust's common shares of beneficial interest. Within its equipment leasing
business, the Company focuses primarily on small ticket equipment lease
financing, although it also manages five publicly-owned equipment leasing
partnerships and has a lease finance placement and advisory business.

Real Estate Finance

         The Company's commercial mortgage loan acquisition and resolution
business involves the purchase, at a discount, of troubled commercial real
estate mortgage loans, and the restructuring and refinancing of those loans.
These loans are generally acquired from private market sellers, primarily
financial institutions, for net investments generally ranging from $1 million
to $15 million. Loans acquired by the Company typically involve legal and
other disputes among the lender, the borrower and/or other parties in
interest, and generally are secured by properties which are unable to produce
sufficient cash flow to fully service the loans in accordance with the
original lender's loan terms. Since fiscal 1991 (when it entered this
business), and through December 31, 1997, the Company's commercial mortgage
loan portfolio has grown to 43 loans with aggregate outstanding loan balances
of $318.3 million. These loans were acquired at an investment cost of $184.9
million (including subsequent advances, which had been anticipated by the
Company at the time of acquisition and were included in its analysis of loan
costs and yields and senior lien interests to which the properties were
subject at the time of acquisition). During the fiscal years ended September
30, 1997, 1996 and 1995, the Company's yield on its net investment in
commercial mortgage loans (including gains on sale of senior lien interests
in, and gains, if any, resulting from refinancings of commercial mortgage
loans) equalled 35%, 36% and 35%, respectively, while its gross profit
(revenues from loan activities minus costs attributable thereto, including
interest and provision for possible losses, and less depreciation and
amortization, without allocation of corporate overhead) from its commercial
mortgage loan

                                       5

<PAGE>



activities for the same periods were $16.5 million, $6.3 million and $5.3
million, respectively. The yield on net investment in commercial mortgage
loans for the quarter ended December 31, 1997 was 30%, while gross profit for
that period was $7.3 million.

         The Company seeks to reduce the amount of its own capital invested in
commercial mortgage loans after their acquisition, and to enhance its returns,
through sale at a profit of senior lien interests in its loans (typically on a
recourse basis) or through borrower refinancing of the properties underlying
its loans. At December 31, 1997, senior lenders held outstanding obligations
of $93.2 million. For the quarter ended December 31, 1997, the ratio of
operating cash flow (based upon (i) with respect to loans acquired prior to
October 1, 1997, cash flows for the quarter ended December 31, 1997,
and (ii) with respect to loans acquired on or after October 1, 1997, cash flow
estimates, historical information or information on cash flows for periods other
than for the quarter ended December 31, 1997) to the required debt service on 
senior lien interests averaged 2.46 to 1. See "Business - Real Estate Finance -
Commercial Mortgage Loan Acquisition and Resolution: Loan Status." The excess
of operating cash flow over required debt service on senior lien obligations
is, pursuant to agreements with most borrowers, generally retained by the
Company as debt service on the outstanding balance of the Company's loans.

         The Company's residential mortgage lending business provides first
and second mortgage loans on one-to-four family residences to borrowers who
typically do not conform to guidelines established by the Federal National
Mortgage Association ("Fannie Mae") because of past credit impairment or other
reasons. Through its subsidiaries, Fidelity Mortgage Funding, Inc. ("FMF")
which commenced lending operations in October 1997 and Tri-Star Financial
Services, Inc. ("Tri-Star") which was acquired in November 1997, the Company
is licensed as a residential mortgage lender in 23 states and is currently
originating loans in 11 states (Connecticut, Delaware, Indiana, Kentucky,
Maryland, Mississippi, New Jersey, North Carolina, Ohio, Pennsylvania and
Virginia). The Company concentrates on mid-size residential mortgage loans
with a targeted average loan of approximately $50,000. The Company markets its
services directly to consumers and anticipates establishing "private label"
lending programs (that is, programs where the Company will process, fund and
service loans originated by an institution, under the institution's name) for
institutions which, because of a lack of expertise in the area or for other
reasons, do not otherwise originate non-conforming loans. The Company pursues
a strategy of selling its residential mortgage loan portfolio on a regular
basis. The Company is currently an approved loan seller to 16 investors.

         The Company sponsored Resource Asset Investment Trust ("RAIT"), a
real estate investment trust which is publicly traded on the American Stock
Exchange. The Company sold 10 loans and senior lien interests in two other
loans to RAIT in January 1998. The aggregate price paid by RAIT for the loans
and the senior lien interests was $20.1 million (including $2.0 million
attributable to senior lien interests acquired by the Company in anticipation
of sale of the loans to RAIT and thereafter sold to RAIT, at cost). The
Company realized a gain on this sale of $3.0 million. The Company anticipates
selling further loans to

                                       6

<PAGE>



RAIT. See "Business - Real Estate Finance - Sponsorship of Real Estate
Investment Trust" and "Management - Certain Relationships and Related Party
Transactions."

Equipment Leasing

         The Company's equipment leasing business commenced in September 1995
with the acquisition of an equipment leasing subsidiary of a regional
insurance company. Through this acquisition, the Company manages five
publicly-held equipment leasing partnerships involving $49.8 million (original
equipment cost) in leased assets at December 31, 1997. More importantly,
through this acquisition the Company acquired an infrastructure of operating
systems, computer hardware and proprietary software (generally referred to as
a "platform"), as well as personnel, which the Company utilized in fiscal 1996
as a basis for the development of an equipment leasing business for its own
account. As part of its development of this business, in early 1996 the
Company hired a team of four experienced leasing executives, including the
former chief executive officer of the U.S. leasing subsidiary of Tokai Bank, a
major Japanese banking institution. The Company's operational strategy for
equipment leasing is to focus on leases with equipment costs of between $5,000
to $100,000 ("small ticket" leasing), with a targeted average transaction of
approximately $10,000 per lease. The Company markets its equipment leasing
products through vendor programs with equipment manufacturers, distributors
and other vendors such as Minolta Corporation and Lucent Technologies, Inc.
The Company believes that the small ticket leasing market within the dealer
distribution channels is under-served by equipment lessors, banks and other
financial institutions, affording the Company a market opportunity with
significant growth potential. During the first quarter of fiscal 1998, the
Company received 3,608 lease applications involving equipment with an
aggregate cost of $47.8 million, approved 1,907 applications involving equipment
with an aggregate cost of $18.6 million, and entered into 1,551 transactions
involving equipment with an aggregate cost of $16.0 million. During fiscal
1997, the Company received 8,344 lease applications involving equipment with
an aggregate cost of $113.4 million, approved 5,054 applications involving
equipment with an aggregate cost of $67.2 million, and entered into 3,214
transactions involving equipment with an aggregate cost of $34.6 million.

         The Company pursues a strategy of selling equipment leases originated
by it in bulk on a servicing retained basis. See "Business - Equipment Leasing
- - Strategy: Focus on Lease Sales." During the first quarter of fiscal 1998 and
during fiscal 1997, the Company sold equipment leases with an aggregate book
value of approximately $14.4 million and $30.2 million, respectively, to third
parties. The Company's income from retained servicing was not material during
either the first fiscal quarter of 1998 or fiscal 1997.

Energy

         The Company produces natural gas and, to a lesser extent, oil from
locations principally in Ohio, Pennsylvania and New York. At December 31,
1997, the Company had a net investment of $12.4 million in its energy
operations, including interests in 1,264

                                       7

<PAGE>



individual wells owned directly by the Company or through 64 partnerships and
joint ventures managed by the Company. While the Company has focused its
business development efforts on its specialty finance operations over the past
several years, its energy operations historically have provided a steady
source of cash flow and tax benefits. From time to time, the Company receives
indications of interest in the acquisition of its energy operations, and
continually pursues the increase of its reserve base through selective
acquisition of producing properties and other assets. Within the past nine
months, the Company has acquired the assets of two small energy companies.

                                 The Offering
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
<S>                                                                <C>

Common Stock offered to the public.............................    1,500,000 shares(1)

Common Stock to be outstanding after
 the Offering..................................................    6,248,537 shares(1)(2)

Use of Proceeds................................................    The net proceeds from the sale of
                                                                   Common Stock by the Company will
                                                                   be used primarily for the acquisition of
                                                                   additional commercial real estate
                                                                   mortgage loans and, to a lesser extent,
                                                                   for the expansion of equipment leasing
                                                                   operations, the acquisition of selected
                                                                   energy properties and assets and for
                                                                   other general corporate purposes.

Nasdaq Stock Market symbol.....................................    REXI
</TABLE>
- -------------
(1)      Assumes that the Underwriters' over-allotment option to purchase up
         to 225,000 shares of Common Stock is not exercised.
(2)      Does not give effect to employee stock options to purchase up to
         262,431 shares of Common Stock outstanding at February 13, 1998.


                                                         8

<PAGE>
                      Summary Consolidated Financial Data

                  The financial data set forth below should be read in
conjunction with, and is qualified in its entirety by, the Consolidated
Financial Statements of the Company, including the notes thereto, and
"Management's Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of
Operations" included elsewhere herein.
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>

                                              As of and for
                                            the Quarter Ended                              As of and for the
                                               December 31,                              Year Ended September 30,
                                          -----------------------    --------------------------------------------------------------
                                             1997          1996         1997          1996         1995        1994           1993
                                           ---------    ---------    ---------    ---------    ---------    ---------    ---------
                                                              (in thousands, except ratios and per share data)

<S>                                        <C>          <C>          <C>          <C>          <C>          <C>          <C>      
Statement of Operations Data:
Revenues:
 Real estate finance -
  Interest(1) ..........................   $   4,668    $   1,427    $   9,001    $   2,853    $   3,422    $   1,401    $     606
  Fees .................................       1,775        1,407        2,556          675          963           25         --
  Gains on refinancings and
   sales of senior lien interests ......       2,949          385        7,587        3,643        1,729        1,096         --
                                           ---------    ---------    ---------    ---------    ---------    ---------    ---------
     Total .............................       9,392        3,219       19,144        7,171        6,114        2,522          606
 Equipment leasing .....................       3,172        1,202        7,162        4,466         --           --           --
 Energy production .....................       1,232          950        3,936        3,421        3,452        3,442        3,409
 Energy services .......................         583          389        1,672        1,736        1,879        2,080        2,445
 Interest ..............................         698           84          930          197          149          136          106
                                           ---------    ---------    ---------    ---------    ---------    ---------    ---------
     Total revenues ....................      15,077        5,844       32,844       16,991       11,594        8,180        6,566
Costs and expenses:
 Real estate finance ...................       1,523          163        1,069          852          801          248          114
 Equipment leasing .....................       1,325          883        3,822        2,339         --           --           --
 Energy exploration and production .....         574          412        1,823        1,582        1,733        2,004        1,735
 Energy services .......................         309          224          909          869        1,026        1,131        1,106
 General and administrative ............         927          592        2,851        1,756        2,265        1,901        1,841
 Provision for possible losses .........         318           10          653            7         --           --           --
 Interest ..............................       3,870          409        5,273          872        1,091          310           41
 Other .................................          (3)         (88)        (101)          (7)          (1)          30         (383)
                                           ---------    ---------    ---------    ---------    ---------    ---------    ---------
     Total costs and expenses ..........       8,843        2,605       16,299        8,270        6,915        5,624        4,454
Income before income taxes,
 depreciation, depletion and
 amortization ..........................       6,234        3,239       16,545        8,721        4,679        2,556        2,112
Depreciation, depletion and amortization         508          379        1,614        1,368        1,335        1,347        1,478
Income before income taxes .............       5,726        2,860       14,931        7,353        3,344        1,209          634
Net income .............................       3,951        2,285       10,951        5,147        2,714        1,309          590

Segment Profitability (Loss):(2)
Real estate finance ....................   $   7,467    $   2,865    $  16,546    $   6,281    $   5,276    $   2,237    $     455
Equipment leasing ......................       1,430          214        2,457        1,916         --           --           --
Energy exploration, production and
  services .............................         518          372        1,699        1,646        1,317        1,114        1,720
Corporate (excluding taxes)(3) .........      (3,692)        (679)      (5,845)      (2,497)      (3,248)      (2,105)      (1,393)

Balance Sheet and Other Data:
Assets:
 Current assets ........................   $  34,343    $   8,721    $  72,269    $   6,106    $   3,924    $   3,985    $   2,150
 Net investment in real estate loans ...     128,884       49,693       88,816       21,798       17,991       10,386        7,329
 Net investment in leasing assets ......      13,214        5,388        8,152          729         --           --           --
 Net investment in energy property and
  equipment ............................      12,379       11,036       11,400       11,265       11,964       12,786       13,542
 Net other assets ......................      19,099        5,573       14,482        4,061        3,671        7,639        2,210
                                           ---------    ---------    ---------    ---------    ---------    ---------    ---------
     Total assets ......................     207,919       80,411      195,119       43,959       37,550       34,796       25,231
</TABLE>

                                                         9

<PAGE>
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>

                                              As of and for
                                            the Quarter Ended                              As of and for the
                                               December 31,                              Year Ended September 30,
                                          -----------------------    --------------------------------------------------------------
                                             1997          1996         1997          1996         1995        1994           1993
                                           ---------    ---------    ---------    ---------    ---------    ---------    ---------
                                                                (in thousands, except ratios and per share data)

<S>                                        <C>          <C>          <C>          <C>          <C>            <C>          <C>      
Liabilities:                                                                                                 
 Current liabilities ......................   $ 16,690    $  2,449    $ 10,841    $  1,664      $  1,329      $  1,355    $    723
 Long-term debt less current                                                                                 
  maturities(4) ...........................    118,116      22,496     118,786       8,966         8,523         8,627         813
 Deferred income taxes and long-term                                                                         
  liabilities .............................      2,656       2,589         663       2,206         1,147           674         834
                                               -------    --------    --------    --------      --------      --------    --------
     Total liabilities ....................    137,462      27,534     130,290      12,836        10,999        10,656       2,370
Stockholders' equity(5) ...................     70,457      52,877      64,829      31,123        26,551        24,140      22,861
Stockholders' equity per common share(6)(7)      14.86       14.89       13.79       16.43         14.21         12.52       11.59
Assets under management:                                                                                     
 Real estate(8) ...........................    330,128     139,608     233,666     100,520        52,955        26,328      13,303
 Leasing(9) ...............................    114,876      83,503     105,940      79,649       103,439          --          --
 Energy(10) ...............................     38,867      32,145      37,809      32,147        33,688        36,067      38,500
                                               -------    --------    --------    --------      --------      --------    --------
     Total assets under management ........    483,871     255,256     377,415     212,316       190,082        62,395      51,803
                                                                                                             
Selected Ratios:                                                                                             
Operating ratios -                                                                                           
 Return on equity(11) .....................         23%         22%         23%         18%           11%            6%          3%
 Yield on net real estate investment(12) ..         30%         36%         35%         36%           35%           31%         12%
Balance sheet ratios:                                                                                        
 Real estate loan to value(13) ............         82%         80%         82%         86%           78%           79%         82%
 Earnings to fixed charges(14) ............       2.48        8.00        3.83        9.44          4.07          4.89       16.45
Common Share Information:                                                                                    
Net income per common share (basic)(15) ...   $    .83    $    .91    $   3.15    $   2.72      $   1.43      $    .66    $    .30
Weighted average number of common                                                                            
  shares outstanding (basic) ..............      4,733       2,507       3,478       1,890         1,904         1,970       1,975
Net income per common share (diluted)(16) .   $    .81    $    .66    $   2.51    $   1.88      $   1.23      $    .64    $    .30
Weighted average number of common                                                                            
  shares (diluted) ........................      4,906       3,476       4,358       2,757         2,235         2,076       1,990
Cash dividends per common share ...........   $    .10    $    .10    $    .40    $    .38      $    .09      $   --      $   --
                                                                                                             
</TABLE>
- ---------
(1)      Interest income includes accreted discounts of $1.7 million and       
         $793,000 for the quarters ended December 31, 1997 and 1996,           
         respectively, and $4.1 million, $954,000, $1.2 million, $602,000, and 
         $256,000 for the fiscal years ended September 30, 1997, 1996, 1995,   
         1994 and 1993, respectively.
(2)      Represents segment revenues minus segment costs less depreciation,
         depletion and amortization attributable to the segment, but without
         allocation of corporate overhead.
(3)      Includes interest expense, interest income on cash not invested in
         operations, general and administrative expenses, and depreciation and
         amortization not allocated to operations of other segments. Interest
         expense was $3.9 million and $409,000 for the quarters ended December
         31, 1997 and 1996, respectively, and $5.3 million, $872,000, $1.1
         million, $310,000 and $41,000 for the years ended September 30, 1997,
         1996, 1995, 1994 and 1993, respectively.
(4)      In July 1997, the Company completed a private offering of 12% senior
         notes and received net proceeds (after placement and offering
         expenses) of $110.6 million.
(5)      In December 1996, the Company completed a public offering of shares
         of Common Stock and received net proceeds (after underwriting and
         offering expenses) of $19.5 million.


                                      10

<PAGE>



(6)      Based on shares of Common Stock outstanding of 4.7 million and 3.6
         million at December 31, 1997 and 1996, respectively, and 4.7 million,
         1.9 million, 1.9 million, 1.9 million, and 2.0 million at September
         30, 1997, 1996, 1995, 1994, 1993, respectively.
(7)      Giving effect to the issuance of 1.5 million shares in this Offering
         at an assumed price of $47.00 (the closing price of the Common Stock
         on Nasdaq on March 3, 1998), and after deduction of underwriting
         discounts and estimated offering expenses, stockholders' equity per
         common share would have been $21.83 on December 31, 1997.
(8)      Represents the stated, or face, amount of outstanding loans plus
         accrued interest and penalties.
(9)      Represents the aggregate of (i) the original cost of equipment under
         lease and cash held by equipment leasing limited partnerships managed
         by the Company, and (ii) gross lease receivables under leases held in
         the Company's portfolio or serviced by the Company for third parties.
(10)     Represents the original cost of assets held by the Company and energy
         partnerships and joint ventures managed by the Company.
(11)     Calculated as net income divided by average stockholders' equity. (12)
         Calculated as gross real estate finance revenues (including gains on
         refinancings and
         sales of senior lien interests in commercial mortgage loans) divided
         by the average book cost of real estate finance assets.
(13)     Calculated as the aggregate book value of loans with respect to any
         property (including all loans with liens senior to or of the same
         seniority with the loan interest held by the Company) divided by the
         appraised value of the property.
(14)     Calculated by dividing income from continuing operations before
         income taxes, extraordinary gains and cumulative effect of a change
         in accounting principle plus fixed charges by fixed charges. Fixed
         charges represent total interest expense, including amortization of
         debt expense and discount relating to indebtedness.
(15)     Calculated as net income divided by the weighted average Common Stock
         outstanding during the period, in accordance with Statement of
         Financial Accounting Standards ("SFAS") No. 128.
(16)     Calculated as net income divided by the weighted average number of
         shares of Common Stock outstanding during the period and dilutive
         potential Common Stock in accordance with SFAS No. 128. Dilutive
         potential shares of Common Stock include shares issuable under the
         terms of various stock option and warrant agreements (including,
         during fiscal 1994 through fiscal 1997, warrants exercised during
         fiscal 1997) net of the number of such shares that could have been
         reacquired (at the weighted average price of the Common Stock during
         the period) with the proceeds received from the exercise of the
         options and warrants.


                                      11

<PAGE>
                                 RISK FACTORS

         In addition to the other information contained or incorporated by
reference in this Prospectus, the following factors should be considered
carefully in evaluating an investment in the Common Stock. The cautionary
statements set forth below and elsewhere in this Prospectus, or which are
incorporated by reference herein, should be read as accompanying
forward-looking statements included or incorporated by reference herein. The
risks described in the statements set forth below could cause the Company's
results to differ materially from those expressed in or indicated by such
forward-looking statements.

General

         Ability to Generate Funding for Growth. The success of the Company's
future operations will depend largely upon the continued availability of
outside funds for its real estate finance and equipment leasing operations.
Funding for the Company's operations has been derived from a number of
different sources, including internally generated funds, borrowings, and the
sale of its notes and Common Stock. See "Business - Sources of Funds." The
future availability of third-party financing for each of the Company's
specialty finance businesses will depend on a number of factors over which the
Company has limited or no control, including general conditions in the credit
markets, the size, pricing and liquidity of the markets for the types of
mortgage loans or equipment leases in the Company's portfolio and the
financial performance of the Company's loans and equipment leases. There can
be no assurance that the Company will be able to generate funding on
satisfactory terms and in acceptable amounts and thus sustain its growth.
Moreover, any failure to renew or obtain adequate funding under a credit or
financing facility or other borrowing could have a material adverse effect on
the Company's results of operations and financial condition. To the extent the
Company is not successful in maintaining or replacing existing financing, and,
in particular, replacing or refinancing the $115.0 million principal amount of
its 12% Senior Notes (the "Senior Notes") when they become due in August 2004,
the Company would have to curtail its activities (and, with respect to the
Senior Notes, possibly sell assets in order to repay the Senior Notes), which
would have a material adverse effect on the Company's results of operations
and financial condition.

         Certain Financing Limitations Imposed by Senior Notes. The Indenture
pursuant to which the Senior Notes were issued permits the Company to incur
both secured and unsecured debt in the future, subject to specific
limitations. Such limitations include (i) a prohibition against incurring
debt, of equal seniority with or junior to the Senior Notes, which has a
maturity prior to that of the Senior Notes, and (ii) a prohibition from
incurring further debt where the ratio of debt (excluding debt used to acquire
mortgage loans, equipment leases or other assets, obligations to repurchase
assets sold, guarantees of either of the foregoing and certain other
obligations) to the Company's consolidated net worth would exceed 2.0 to 1.0.
For a description of certain other limitations imposed by the Indenture, see
"Business - Sources of Funds." Such limitations may restrict the ability of the
Company to obtain financing in the future.

                                      12

<PAGE>

         Ability to Generate Growth Opportunities. The success of the
Company's finance operations will also depend on its continued ability to
generate attractive opportunities for acquiring commercial mortgage loans at a
discount and originating and reselling equipment leases and residential
mortgage loans. In each area, the Company will rely primarily upon the
knowledge, experience and industry contacts of its senior management to
generate appropriate opportunities. See "Management." There can be no
assurance that the Company will generate opportunities satisfactory to it
sufficient to sustain growth or that, in its commercial mortgage loan
acquisition and resolution activities, the Company will be able to acquire
loans in the same manner, on similar terms or at similar levels of discount as
its current portfolio loans. The availability of loans for acquisition on
terms acceptable to the Company, and the ability of the Company to originate
satisfactory equipment leases and residential mortgage loans, will depend upon
a number of factors over which the Company has no control, including economic
conditions, interest rates and the market for and value of properties securing
loans which the Company may seek to acquire. The Company may also be affected
by competition from other acquirors of troubled loans and by the willingness
of financial institutions and other entities to dispose of troubled or
under-performing loans in their portfolios.

         The Company's growth strategy with respect to both equipment leasing
and residential mortgage lending involves expanding these businesses through
increased penetration into existing markets and expansion into new markets
while maintaining satisfactory premiums on sale, interest rate spreads and
underwriting criteria. Implementation of this strategy will depend in large
part on the Company's ability to (i) expand its network of manufacturers,
distributors and other vendors to join with the Company in vendor programs for
equipment leasing and, with respect to residential mortgage lending,
establishing direct-sourced origination activities in markets with a
sufficient concentration of borrowers meeting the Company's underwriting
criteria, (ii) hire, train and retain skilled employees, and (iii) continue to
expand in the face of increasing competition from other lessors and mortgage
lenders. There can be no assurance that the Company will be able to implement
these growth strategies, or that such strategies will be effective.

         Risks Related to Management of Growth. The Company has recently
undergone a period of significant growth, and further expansion may
significantly strain the Company's management, financial and other resources.
There can be no assurance that the Company will manage its growth effectively
or that the Company will be able to attract and retain the personnel necessary
to meet its business objectives. If the Company is unable to manage its growth
effectively, the Company's business, operating results and financial condition
could be materially adversely affected.

         Interest Rate Risks. As an entity engaged in real estate finance and
equipment leasing, the Company will be subject to risks relating to changes in
interest rates. In general, in a period of rising interest rates, the resale
value of loans or leases with fixed interests rates will decrease. Changing
interest rate environments will also affect the Company's rate of return on
its investments. In commercial mortgage loan acquisition and resolution, a
rising interest rate environment will increase the Company's cost of funds,
such as the interest rates payable

                                      13

<PAGE>



on new senior lien interests sold by the Company or new borrower refinancings,
while not necessarily resulting in an increase in interest paid to or accrued
by the Company, thus reducing the Company's return on its funds invested.
Interest rate changes will also affect the Company's return on commercial
mortgage loan originations. In particular, during a period of declining rates,
the amounts becoming available to the Company for investment due to repayment
of its commercial mortgage loans, sales of senior lien interests, borrower
refinancing or (particularly with its residential mortgage loans) prepayments
may be invested at lower rates than the Company had been able to obtain in
prior investments, or than the rates on the repaid loans. In addition, in
residential mortgage lending and equipment leasing, the return expected, and
the rates charged, by the Company are based on interest rates prevailing in
the market at the time of loan origination or lease approval. Until the
Company's residential loans or leases are sold, they are funded from the
Company's credit facilities or from working capital. Should the Company be
unable to sell residential loans or leases with fixed rates within a
reasonable period of time after funding, the Company's operating margins could
be adversely affected by increases in interest rates. Further, increases in
interest rates could cause a reduction in demand for the Company's residential
mortgage and lease funding.

         Economic Slowdown May Adversely Affect Volume of Residential Mortgage
Loans and Equipment Leases. Periods of economic slowdown may reduce the demand
for residential mortgage loans as people elect not to purchase new homes due
to economic uncertainty and also may adversely affect the financial condition
of potential borrowers so that they do not meet the Company's underwriting
criteria. In addition, economic slowdowns may cause a decline in real estate
values. Any material decline in real estate values will reduce the ability of
borrowers to use home equity to support borrowings by negatively affecting
loan-to-value ratios of the home equity collateral. Similarly, small
businesses may defer the leasing of new equipment or may suffer a decline in
profitability which would inhibit their ability to obtain lease financing. To
the extent that the loan-to-value ratios of prospective borrowers' home equity
collateral (for residential mortgage loans) or the debt service ratios (for
equipment leasing) do not meet the Company's underwriting criteria, the volume
of loans and leases originated by the Company could decline which could have a
material adverse effect on the Company's operations and financial condition.

         Credit Risks. Loans and equipment leases are subject to the risk of
default in payment by borrowers and lessees. Defaults by borrowers and lessees
could adversely affect the Company's financial position. Upon a default, the
Company will attempt to recover outstanding loan or lease balances through
foreclosure, repossession of equipment or similar procedures. With respect to
any particular loan or equipment lease, instituting any of these procedures
could adversely impact the Company's yield on such loan or lease. There can be
no assurance that, in the event of default, the amount realizable from the
property securing a defaulted loan or the equipment subject to a defaulted
lease will be sufficient to recover amounts invested by or owed to the
Company. See "Risk Factors - Real Estate Finance Considerations - Lien
Priority" and "- Equipment Leasing Considerations - Residuals."


                                      14

<PAGE>



         The commercial mortgage loans acquired in the Company's commercial
mortgage loan acquisition and resolution operations typically do not provide
for recourse against the borrowers and, accordingly, in seeking to collect
amounts owed on a loan, the Company must rely solely on the value of the
property underlying the loan to satisfy the obligation. This value will be
affected by numerous factors beyond the Company's control, including general
or local economic conditions, neighborhood real property values, interest
rates, operating expenses (such as real estate taxes and insurance costs),
occupancy rates and the presence of competitive properties. In addition, most
of the Company's loans require a substantial lump sum payment at maturity. The
ability of a borrower to pay a lump sum, and thus the ability of the Company
to collect promptly all amounts due upon maturity, may be dependent on the
borrower's ability to obtain suitable refinancing or otherwise raise a
substantial amount of cash which, in turn, will depend upon factors (such as
those referred to previously) over which the Company has no control. To the
extent that the Company sells a senior lien position in a loan, or the loan is
refinanced, the Company will typically retain a subordinated interest in the
loan, which may be unsecured. See "Risk Factors - Real Estate Finance
Considerations - Lien Priority." Such retained interests are relatively
illiquid investments and are subject to materially increased risks of
collection upon default.

         The Company focuses its marketing efforts in residential mortgage
lending on borrowers who may be unable to obtain mortgage financing from
conventional mortgage sources. Loans made to such borrowers may entail a
higher risk of delinquency and higher losses than loans made to borrowers who
qualify to utilize conventional mortgage sources. Delinquencies, foreclosures
and losses generally increase during economic slowdowns or recessions.
Further, any material decline in real estate values increases the
loan-to-value ratios of loans previously made by the Company, thereby
weakening collateral coverages and increasing the possibility of a loss in the
event of a borrower default. Any sustained period of increased delinquencies,
foreclosures or losses after the loans are sold could adversely affect the
pricing of the Company's future residential loan sales and the ability of the
Company to sell its residential loans in the future.

         The Company specializes in acquiring and originating equipment leases
involving equipment with a purchase price of less than $100,000, generally
involving small and mid-size commercial businesses located throughout the
United States. Small business leases may entail a greater risk of
non-performance and higher delinquencies and losses than leases entered into
with larger lessees because small businesses generally have lesser financial
resources with which to meet lease obligations and may be more susceptible to
changes in economic conditions. Although the Company seeks to mitigate this
risk through the use of its Small Business Credit Scoring System, its asset
tracking systems and its loan servicing and collection procedures, there can
be no assurance that the Company will not be subject to higher risks of
default than firms leasing to larger entities. Moreover, because of the
Company's short operating history in leasing, only limited performance data is
available with respect to leases funded by the Company. Thus, historical
delinquency and loss statistics are not necessarily indicative of future
performance. The failure of the Company's lessees to comply with the terms of
their leases will result in the inability of such leases to qualify to

                                      15

<PAGE>



serve as collateral under the Company's warehouse facilities or to be sold to
investors, which may materially adversely affect the Company's liquidity.
Additionally, delinquencies and defaults experienced in excess of levels
estimated by management in determining the Company's allowance for credit
losses could have a material adverse effect on the Company's ability to obtain
financing and effect lease sales or other transactions which may, in turn,
have a material adverse effect on the Company's financial condition and result
of operations.

         Dependence on Lease and Residential Loan Sales. Gains on sales of
residential loans and equipment leases generated by the Company represent a
material and growing source of the Company's revenues and net income,
aggregating $3.2 million or 21% of the Company's revenues for the three months
ended December 31, 1997. The gain on sale of leases sold represented
approximately 56% of revenues from leasing operations for the quarter ended
December 31, 1997 and approximately 52% of the Company's revenues from leasing
operations in fiscal 1997. The gain on sale of residential mortgage loans
represented 84% of the Company's revenues from residential mortgage loan
operations for the quarter ended December 31, 1997 (the quarter in which such
operations commenced). Furthermore, the Company will rely in significant part
on proceeds from residential loan and equipment lease sales to generate cash
for further investments and for repayment of borrowings used by the Company to
originate residential loans and equipment leases. The Company sells virtually
all of its residential loan and equipment leases in the secondary market to a
limited number of institutional purchasers. Several factors affect the
Company's ability to complete such lease and residential mortgage sales,
including the credit quality of the Company's lease and mortgage originations,
compliance of the Company's originations with eligibility requirements
established by buyers, and, to the extent that such buyers engage in
securitization transactions or other structured finance techniques in order to
fund their purchases, conditions in the asset-backed securities markets. There
can be no assurance that such purchasers will continue to purchase loans or
equipment leases or that the purchase terms will be similar to those obtained
by the Company to date. To the extent that the Company cannot successfully
replace such purchasers or negotiate favorable terms for such purchases, the
Company's results of operations and financial condition could be materially
adversely affected. See "Risk Factors - Real Estate Finance Considerations -
Note Received in Sale of Certain Residential Loans" and "- Equipment Leasing
Considerations - Sale of Equipment Leases." For a discussion of the Company's
revenue recognition and accounting policies pertaining to its equipment
leasing operations, see "Business - Equipment Leasing - Revenue Recognition
and Lease Accounting."

         Risks Related to Representations and Warranties in Residential Loan
and Equipment Lease Sales. The Company engages in bulk residential loan and
equipment lease sales pursuant to agreements that typically require the
Company to repurchase or substitute loans or equipment leases in the event of
a breach of a representation or warranty made to the purchaser, any
misrepresentation during the mortgage loan origination process or, in some
cases, upon any fraud or first payment default on an equipment lease or
mortgage loan. Any claims asserted against the Company in the future by one of
its lease or loan purchasers may

                                      16

<PAGE>



result in liabilities or legal expenses that could have a material adverse
effect on the Company's results of operations and financial condition.

         Fluctuations in Periodic Results. The Company may experience
significant fluctuations in quarterly or other periodic operating results due
to a number of factors, including variations in the volume of commercial
mortgage loans purchased and in the volume of residential mortgage loans and
equipment leases originated by the Company, fees obtained in connection with
the Company's commercial loan activities, timing of sales of senior lien
interests or borrower refinancings of commercial loans, loan prepayments,
differences between the Company's cost of funds and average yield on its
residential mortgage loans and leases prior to sale, default rates on loans or
leases originated by the Company, variations in prices obtainable, or demand
for, natural gas and oil, the degree to which the Company encounters
competition in its markets and general economic conditions. In addition, both
the residential ending and equipment leasing businesses are relatively young
and still evolving and, accordingly, involve greater uncertainties and risk of
loss. As a result, results for any one quarter or period should not be relied
upon as being indicative of performance in future quarters or periods. See
"Management's Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of
Operations."

         Competition. In each of its business operations, the Company is
subject to intense competition from numerous competitors, many of whom possess
far greater financial, marketing, operational and other resources than the
Company and who may have lower costs of funds than the Company. In this
regard, the Company will also have to compete for the capital necessary to
fund both its real estate finance and equipment leasing operations based
largely upon the performance of its portfolio loans and equipment leases.

         Although the commercial mortgage loan acquisition and resolution
business is generally competitive in virtually all of its aspects, the
Company's focus on the acquisition of troubled commercial real estate loans
subject to complex and/or contentious situations is a niche in which the
Company believes there are relatively few, specialized investors. In the
overall market for the acquisition of real estate obligations, however, there
are a substantial number of competitors (including investment partnerships,
financial institutions, investment companies, public and private mortgage
funds and other entities). Many of the Company's competitors possess greater
financial and other resources than the Company. As a result, there can be no
assurance that the Company will be able to effect acquisitions of discounted
loans in the same manner and on the same terms as in the past or that there
will not be significant variations in the profitability of the Company's
commercial mortgage loan acquisition and resolution business.

         As an originator of residential mortgage loans and equipment leases,
the Company faces intense competition, primarily from mortgage banking
companies, commercial banks, credit unions, thrift institutions and finance
companies and from equipment manufacturers that finance the sale or lease of
their products themselves. Furthermore, the current level of gains realized by
the Company and its competitors on the sale of non-conforming residential

                                      17

<PAGE>



mortgage loans is attracting and may continue to attract additional
competitors into the non-conforming mortgage loan market. In the future, the
Company may also face competition from, among others, governmental-sponsored
entities who may enter the non-conforming mortgage market.

         Increased competition in the residential mortgage loan and equipment
leasing markets could have the possible effects of (i) lowering gains that may
be realized on the Company's residential mortgage loan and equipment lease
sales, (ii) reducing the volume of the Company's loan and equipment lease
originations and sales, (iii) increasing the demand for the Company's
experienced personnel and the potential that such personnel will be recruited
by the Company's competitors, and (iv) lowering the industry standard for
underwriting guidelines (for example, by providing for less stringent debt
service coverage or loan-to-value ratios) as competitors attempt to increase
or maintain market share in the face of increased competition. See "Risk
Factors - Risk of Economic Slowdown May Adversely Affect Volume of Residential
Mortgage Loans and Equipment Leases" and "- Credit Risks."

         As the Company expands into new geographic or industry markets, it
may face competition from residential mortgage lenders or equipment lessors
with established positions in these markets. There can be no assurance that
the Company will be able to successfully compete with such established lenders
or lessors. Further, there can be no assurance that the Company will be able
to continue to compete successfully in the markets it serves. Inability to
compete successfully would have a material adverse effect on the Company's
results of operations and financial condition.

         Changing Nature of Risks. The nature of the risks associated with the
Company's operations have changed and are likely to continue to change over
time due to a corporate strategy which emphasizes the entry into and exit from
business lines based on market, economic or competitive conditions. As a
result, there can be no assurance that the risks associated with an investment
in the Company described in this Prospectus will not materially change in the
future or that there will not be additional risks associated with the
Company's future operations not described herein.

Real Estate Finance Considerations

         Troubled Status of Acquired Commercial Loans and Underlying
Properties. The Company seeks to acquire commercial real estate mortgage loans
at a discount from both the unpaid principal and interest amounts of the loans
and the appraised value of the underlying properties. As a consequence, the
Company will frequently be involved with loans that are secured by properties
that, while income producing, are unable to generate sufficient revenues to
pay the full amount of debt service under the original loan terms and that are
frequently the subject of contentious and often complex disputes among various
parties regarding application of cash flow from the underlying properties,
loan terms, lease terms or similar matters. Although prior to acquisition of a
loan the Company will generally negotiate with the borrower or other parties
in interest and, where appropriate, make financial accommodations

                                      18

<PAGE>



to take into account the operating conditions of an underlying property,
resolve outstanding disputes and ensure the Company's control of the cash flow
from the underlying property, there can be no assurance that the problems
which existed prior to the Company's acquisition of the loan will not recur or
that other problems may not arise. As a result, these loans may be subject to
a higher risk of default and consequent loss to the Company than conventional
loans. See "Risk Factors - General - Credit Risks."

         Lien Priority. Although in its commercial mortgage loan acquisition
and resolution operations the Company normally acquires first mortgage loans,
it is not limited as to the lien priority of a loan which it may acquire. Ten
of the Company's mortgage loans were acquired as junior lien obligations.
Moreover, a lender refinancing a loan in the Company's portfolio will
typically require, as a condition to its refinancing (the proceeds of which
generally are paid to the Company), that the Company's remaining interest in
the loan be subordinated to such lender's interest or that the Company release
its mortgage lien. The Company currently holds 30 junior lien loans or
subordinated senior lien interests, seven of which (at an aggregate book value
of $7.7 million, constituting approximately 6.6%, of the book value of the
Company's loan portfolio) are not formally secured by recorded mortgages
(although they are protected by judgment liens, unrecorded deeds in lieu of
foreclosure, borrowers' covenants not to further encumber the property without
the Company's consent, and/or similar devices). In addition, in certain
circumstances, mortgage loans, including first mortgage loans, may be subject
to mechanics', materialmens' or government liens which may be prior in right
of payment to liens held by the Company. Subordinate or junior lien loans
carry a greater credit risk, including a substantially greater risk of
non-payment of interest or principal, than senior lien financing. Where, as
part of a financing structure, the Company has an unsecured position, the risk
of loss may be materially increased. A decline in the real estate market where
the property underlying the loan is located could adversely affect the value
of the property such that the aggregate outstanding balances of senior liens
and the Company's loan may exceed the value of the underlying property.

         In the event of a default on a senior mortgage, the Company may make
payments, if it has the right to do so, in order to prevent foreclosure on the
senior mortgage, thereby increasing its investment cost without necessarily
improving its lien position. In the event of a foreclosure, the Company will
only be entitled to share in the net proceeds after the payment of all senior
lienors, including senior mortgagees, and holders of mechanics', materialmens'
and government liens. It is therefore possible that the total amount which may
be recovered by the Company upon a foreclosure may be less than the
outstanding balance of the loan or the Company's investment in the loan, with
a resultant loss to the Company. It is also possible that, in some cases, a
"due on sale" clause included in a senior mortgage, which accelerates the
amount due under the senior mortgage in case of the sale of the property, may
apply to the sale of the property upon foreclosure of a junior loan, and may
accordingly increase the risks to the Company in the event of a default by the
borrower on the junior loan.

         Disposition of Acquired Commercial Mortgage Loan Interests. In its
commercial mortgage loan acquisition and resolution operations, after the
Company has acquired a loan,

                                      19

<PAGE>



the Company will typically sell a senior lien position in the loan, or assist
the borrower in obtaining third-party refinancing, while retaining a junior
lien position in the loan. Although the sale of a senior lien position or a
refinancing often results in the return of an amount representing a major
portion of (or sometimes exceeding) the amount of Company's investment in the
loan, in most such sales or refinancings a reduced portion of the Company's
investment in the loan remains unrecovered. Based upon its analysis of the
properties underlying the loans, the Company believes that it will recover
amounts substantially in excess of the Company's remaining invested capital;
however, there can be no assurance that, upon termination of the loan, the
borrower will be able to repay the loan or that, if the borrower is not able
to do so, the Company will be able to dispose of its remaining loan interest
for an amount equal to or in excess of its remaining investment or that the
property underlying the loan can be disposed of for an amount equal to or in
excess of the interests of senior lienors and the Company's remaining
investment.

         Potential Replacement, Repurchase or Repayment of Senior Lien
Positions. Senior lien positions aggregating $12.0 million at December 31,
1997 in seven of the commercial mortgage loans in the Company's portfolio have
been sold to an institutional investor. See "Business - Commercial Loan
Acquisition and Resolution: Loan Status." Pursuant to the terms of these
sales, if the borrower under any such loan defaults in the payment of debt
service, the Company is required to replace the defaulted obligation with a
performing one. Since the Company has sold (or intends to sell) senior
positions in, or refinanced, most of its current portfolio of loans, if the
Company were required to replace a defaulted loan with a performing loan, it
may not be able to do so without acquiring additional commercial mortgage
loans. If the Company could not fulfill its obligation, the institutional
investor would have various legal remedies, including foreclosure on and sale
of the underlying property (see "Risk Factors - General - Credit Risks") or
requiring the Company to repay its interest. There can be no assurance that
borrowers on one or more of such loans will not default or that, in such
event, the Company would be able to acquire additional commercial real estate
mortgage loans to substitute for the defaulted obligations or, if a
replacement loan is not so acquired and substituted, that the investor would
not seek repayment from the Company. Moreover, generally, interest only is
paid on each senior lien obligation until maturity, at which time the entire
principal amount of the senior lien obligation becomes due. Maturity dates of
the senior lien obligations range from December 1999 to June 2001. If the
borrower is unable to pay or refinance any senior lien obligation when it
becomes due, the institutional investor may foreclose on the underlying
property, or require the Company to repay its interest.

         The Company is also required to repurchase from other institutional
investors two senior loans in the event that the senior loans are not repaid,
in accordance with their terms, by June 27, and September 29, 2002 for a
repurchase price equal to the unpaid principal balance of the respective loans
plus accrued interest at the time of repurchase by the Company ($1.6 million
and $7.3 million, respectively, at maturity, assuming all debt service
payments have been made). There can be no assurance that borrowers on one or
more of such loans will not default and the Company required to repurchase the
loan, or that the

                                      20

<PAGE>



borrowers will be able to repay or refinance the senior lien interests when
they become due. See "Business - Real Estate Finance - Loan Status."

         Lack of Geographic Diversification Exposes the Company's Investments
to Higher Risk of Loss Due to Regional Economic Factors. The Company does not
expect to set specific limitations on the aggregate percentage of its
portfolio relating to properties located in any one area (whether by state,
zip code or other geographic measure). Any lack of geographic diversification
that may occur could result in the Company's investment portfolio being more
sensitive to, and the Company being less able to respond to, adverse economic
developments of a primarily regional nature, which may result in reduced rates
of return, or higher rates of default, on the Company's mortgage loans than
might be incurred with a more geographically diverse investment portfolio. At
December 31, 1997, 19 of the 43 loans in the Company's commercial mortgage
loan portfolio, aggregating $45.9 million (39%) of the book value of the
Company's commercial loan portfolio) relate to properties located in the
Philadelphia, Pennsylvania metropolitan area.

         Commercial Mortgage Loan Loss Reserves. The Company records its
investment in its commercial mortgage loan portfolio at cost, which is
significantly discounted from the face value of, and accrued interest and
penalties on, the loans. The cost basis in the loans is reviewed periodically
to determine whether it is greater than the sum of the projected cash flows
and appraised values of the underlying properties. If the cost basis is found
to be greater, the Company provides an appropriate allowance through a charge
to operations. The Company did not establish any reserves with respect to its
portfolio loans for fiscal years 1994, 1995 and 1996. At December 31, 1997,
the Company's allowance for possible losses was $452,000 (0.4% of the book
value of its commercial mortgage loan portfolio at that date), of which
$52,000 was recorded in the quarter ended December 31, 1997. There can be no
assurance that future provisions for loan losses will not be materially
greater than the provision recorded at December 31, 1997 which could have a
material adverse effect on the Company's results of operations.

         Compliance of Residential Mortgage Loan Operations with Applicable
Law. The Company's residential mortgage loan origination business is subject
to federal and state laws relating to truth in lending, equal credit
opportunity, settlement procedures, mortgage disclosure, debt collection
practices and similar matters. Failure to comply with these federal or state
laws can lead to loss of approved status, demands for indemnification or
mortgage loan repurchases, certain rights of rescission for borrowers, class
action lawsuits and administrative enforcement actions. Although the Company
believes that it has systems and procedures to facilitate compliance with
these requirements and believes that it is in compliance in all material
respects with applicable local, state and federal laws, rules and regulations,
in the future more restrictive laws, rules and regulations or the judicial
interpretation of existing laws, rules and regulations could make compliance
more difficult or expensive.


                                      21

<PAGE>



         Residential Mortgage Lending Is a New Business Line. The Company's
residential mortgage loan business commenced lending operations in the first
quarter of fiscal 1998. As a result, the Company has had only a limited amount
of experience upon which an evaluation of its prospects in the business can be
based. Such prospects must be assessed in light of the risks, expenses and
difficulties frequently encountered in the establishment of a new business
which may materially adversely affect the Company's ability to develop the
business, and the Company's investment in it.

         Note Received in Sale of Certain Residential Loans. Although the
Company's policy is to sell residential mortgage loans for cash, with
servicing-released, in the first quarter of fiscal 1998 the Company sold with
servicing-retained a pool of residential mortgage loans acquired and
originated by it to an unrelated special purpose financing entity for a note
with a face value of $8.3 million (and a book value of $8.1 million). The
Company recognized a gain of $1.2 million on the sale. The note was partially
prepaid, in the amount of $6.2 million, in the second quarter of fiscal 1998
through third-party financing arranged by the special purpose financing
entity. The third party financing was unconditionally guaranteed by the
Company. The balance of the note ($2.1 million) is due on or before December
31, 2027. The special purpose financing entity has no material assets other
than the loan pool sold to it. In addition, the Company has subcontracted the
servicing of the pool to Jefferson Bank. See "Management - Certain
Relationships and Related Party Transactions - Relationship with Jefferson
Bank." Loans included in this pool are either secured by property located in
Louisiana or have loan to value ratios in excess of 100%. Although the Company
believes Jefferson Bank has the expertise to service these loans, Jefferson
Bank does not typically service residential loans with loan to value ratios in
excess of 100%. Accordingly, to the extent that defaults under the loans in
the pool are greater than anticipated by the Company, or if loan prepayments
are substantially in excess of those anticipated by the Company, the Company
may not receive full payment on the remaining balance of the note or, with
respect to defaulted loans, may possibly be required to reacquire these loans.
This would result in a charge to the Company's earnings in the amount of any
unrecovered remaining balance of the note which could materially adversely
affect the Company's results of operations. Moreover, if the number of
defaults is sufficiently large, the Company may be required to repay some
portion or all of the third party financing pursuant to its guaranty. Any such
repayment could have a material adverse effect on the Company's results of
operations and financial condition. See "Risk Factors - General - Credit
Risks."

         Elimination of Deductibility of Mortgage Interest Could Adversely
Affect Results of Operations. Members of Congress and government officials
have from time to time suggested the elimination of the mortgage interest
deduction for federal income tax purposes, either entirely or in part, based
on borrower income, type of loan or principal amount. Because many of the
Company's residential mortgage loans may be sought by borrowers for the
purpose of consolidating consumer debt or financing other consumer needs, the
competitive advantages of tax deductible interest, when compared with
alternative sources of financing, could be eliminated or seriously impaired by
such government action. Accordingly, the

                                      22

<PAGE>



reduction or elimination of these tax benefits could have a material adverse
effect on the demand for the kind of residential loans offered by the Company.

         Environmental Liabilities. In the event of a default on a portfolio
loan, the Company may acquire the underlying property through foreclosure.
There is a risk that hazardous substances, wastes, contaminants or pollutants
would be discovered on the foreclosed property after acquisition by the
Company. In such event, the Company might be required to remove such
substances at its sole cost and expense. There can be no assurance that the
cost of such removal would not substantially exceed the value of the affected
property or the loan secured by the property, that the Company would have
adequate remedies against the prior owner or other responsible parties or that
the Company would not find it difficult or impossible to sell the affected
property either prior to or following any such removal.

Equipment Leasing Considerations

         Limited Equipment Leasing Operating History. The Company acquired its
equipment leasing operations in September 1995 and, in 1996, the Company
expanded these leasing operations to include small ticket equipment leasing
for its own account. Although the leasing business acquired by the Company has
been in operation since 1986, and the executives primarily responsible for
developing the Company's proprietary leasing program have had lengthy
experience in the equipment leasing industry, the Company has only a limited
amount of direct experience upon which an evaluation of its prospects in the
equipment leasing business can be based. Such prospects must be considered in
light of the expenses and difficulties frequently encountered by an acquiror
in integrating a newly-acquired business with its other operations, and in
expanding the scope of the newly-acquired business.

         Demand for Company's Equipment Leasing Services. The demand for the
equipment leasing services provided by the Company is subject to numerous
factors beyond the control of the Company, including general economic
conditions, fluctuations in interest rate levels and fluctuations in demand
for the types of equipment as to which the Company provides equipment leases.
In addition, the demand for the Company's equipment lease services will be
materially affected by the ability of the Company to market its services to
manufacturers, regional distributors and other vendors.

         Dependence on Vendors. The Company currently relies upon
relationships it has established with certain manufacturers and regional
distributors in order to gain access to end-users who will enter into
equipment leases. To date, the Company has established vendor programs with
nine manufacturers or distributors and is an authorized lessor for the dealer
distribution channels of two other manufacturers. Two manufacturers, Minolta
Corporation and Lucent Technologies, accounted for 21% and 8%, respectively
(by cost) of the equipment leased by the Company since inception of leasing
operations through December 31, 1997 (and 18% and 8%, respectively, of
equipment leased by the Company during the quarter ended December 31, 1997).
See "Business - Equipment Leasing - Focus on Vendor Programs." In

                                      23

<PAGE>



the event that these vendors significantly reduce the number of leases placed
with the Company, and the Company cannot replace the lost lease volume, such
reduction could have a material adverse effect on the Company's financial
condition and results of operations.

         Financing for Equipment Leasing Operations. The Company anticipates
that it may be required to provide credit enhancement for debt obligations
incurred under any warehouse or permanent financing utilized in its equipment
leasing operations. See "Risk Factors - General - Ability to Generate Funding
for Growth." These credit enhancements may include cash deposits, funding of
subordinated tranches of securitizations, the pledge of additional equipment
leases which are funded by the Company's capital, and/or (as is the case with
the Company's existing credit facility) a guaranty by the Company and
restrictive covenants concerning maintenance by the Company of minimum capital
levels or debt to equity ratios. Any such requirements may reduce the
Company's liquidity and require it to obtain additional capital. The Indenture
pursuant to which the Senior Notes were issued contains certain restrictions
which may limit the Company's ability to provide credit enhancement. See "Risk
Factors - General - Ability to Generate Funding for Growth."

         The Company anticipates that warehouse financing (as is the case with
the Company's existing credit facility) will bear interest at variable rates
while its permanent funding will typically be at fixed rates set at the time
the financing is provided. Accordingly, the Company will be subject to
interest rate risk to the extent interest rates increase between the time a
lease is funded by warehouse facilities and the time of permanent funding.
Increases in interest rates during this period could narrow or eliminate the
spread between the effective interest rates on the Company's equipment leases
and the rates on the Company's funding, or result in a negative spread.

         Sale of Equipment Leases. The Company has sold its entire interest in
originated equipment leases and the related equipment to unaffiliated special
purpose financing entities (each, an "Intermediate Purchaser") for cash and
promissory notes. See "Business - Equipment Leasing - Revenue Recognition and
Lease Accounting." At December 31, 1997, the Company held $9.0 million of such
notes and had recognized gains on lease sales related to such notes of $5.5
million. The Intermediate Purchaser resells the leases to a financial
institution which provides the cash portion of the purchase price payable to
the Company. The Company typically will provide credit enhancement in
connection with a refinancing or resale, generally in the form of a guarantee
of the refinancing and/or a commitment to replace defaulted leases in excess
of permitted limits. The Intermediate Purchasers have no material assets other
than the leases and equipment purchased from the Company. If lease defaults
are greater than anticipated by the Company, the ability of an Intermediate
Purchaser to repay its notes to the Company may be adversely affected. The
ability of the Intermediate Purchaser to repay the notes could also be
adversely effected if the realization of residuals is less than anticipated by
the Company. See "Risk Factors - Equipment Leasing Considerations - Residuals."
Accordingly, lease defaults that are greater than anticipated and residual
earnings that are less than anticipated could result in a charge to the
Company's earnings in the amount of the notes not recoverable by the Company.
Moreover, if the number of lease defaults is

                                      24

<PAGE>



sufficiently large, the Company may be required, under the terms of any credit
enhancement provided by it, to repay some portion or all of the financing
arranged by the Intermediate Purchaser or to replace defaulted leases with
performing leases. See "Risk Factors - Equipment Leasing Considerations -
Potential Replacement of Leases." Any such repayment or replacement could have
a material adverse effect on the Company's results of operations and financial
condition.

         While the existing forward lease sale commitment among the Company,
an Intermediate Purchaser and certain institutional purchasers (see "Business
- - Sources of Funds - Forward Sale Commitment") does not require the Company to
provide credit enhancement, if lease defaults are greater than anticipated,
not only will the ability of the Intermediate Purchaser to repay its note be
adversely affected, the institutional purchasers may terminate the commitment.
To preserve the ability of the Intermediate Purchaser to pay its note, and/or
to prevent termination of the commitment, the Company may determine to replace
defaulted leases. Any such replacement could result in a charge to the
Company's earnings.

         Residuals. "Residuals" are proceeds received upon the sale or
re-leasing of equipment upon lease termination or from the extension of lease
terms beyond their original expiration dates. To the date of this Prospectus,
as part of its equipment lease sales the Company has sold its entire interest
in the leased equipment, including residuals, to Intermediate Purchasers in
exchange for cash and promissory notes. The promissory notes will typically
include all of the Company's gain on the sale and a portion of its capital
investment. Payment of the notes will, to a material extent, depend upon
residuals realized. The Company may be required to establish an allowance for
possible losses against the notes if residuals are less than anticipated at
the time of sale. If the Company is required to establish an allowance, it
would result in a charge to earnings; any such charge could materially
adversely affect the Company's results of operations. See "Business -
Equipment Leasing - Revenue Recognition and Lease Accounting." In the future,
the Company anticipates that it may retain residuals for its own account in
which case the gain on sale of leases would be materially reduced as the
recognition of revenues, if any, from residuals would be recorded subsequently
upon lease termination. Realization of residuals are subject to a number of
factors including the ability or willingness of a lessee to continue to lease
or to acquire the equipment, unusual wear and tear on or use of the equipment,
equipment obsolescence, excessive supply of similar equipment, reductions in
manufacturers' prices for similar equipment and similar matters which could
materially adversely affect the amount of residuals obtainable. To the extent
that the Company retains residuals, a decline in their value could adversely
affect the Company's operating results and financial condition.

         Potential Replacement of Leases. Under the terms of certain of its
lease sales, the Company may be required to replace a lease if the lessee
defaults in its obligations under the lease. If the Company were required to
replace a lease, the pool of leases otherwise available for sale by the
Company would be reduced. In addition, the Company would have to repossess the
leased equipment in order to attempt to recover the lease balance. There can
be no assurance that the amount realizable from equipment subject to a
defaulted lease will be

                                      25

<PAGE>



sufficient to recover amounts invested by the Company. See "Risk Factors -
General - Credit Risks."

Energy Industry Considerations

         Volatility of Oil and Gas Prices. Historically, the markets for
natural gas and oil have been volatile and are likely to continue to be
volatile in the future. Prices for natural gas and oil are subject to wide
fluctuation in response to relatively minor changes in the supply of and
demand for natural gas and oil, market uncertainty and other factors over
which the Company has no control. These factors include the extent of domestic
production and importation of foreign natural gas and/or oil, political
instability in oil and gas producing countries and regions, the ability of
members of the Organization of Petroleum Exporting Countries to agree upon
price and production levels for oil, the effect of federal regulation on the
sale of natural gas and/or oil in interstate commerce, and other governmental
regulation of the production and transportation of natural gas and/or oil.
Certain other factors outside the Company's control, such as operational and
transportation difficulties of pipeline or oil purchasing companies, may also
limit sales. In addition, the price level of natural gas obtainable by the
Company depends upon the needs of the purchasers to which the producer has
access. Depending on the purchasers' needs, the price obtainable for natural
gas produced by the Company, or the amount of natural gas which the Company is
able to sell, the revenues of the Company from its energy operations may be
materially adversely affected.

         Possible Decline in Production. Production of oil and gas from a
particular well generally declines over time until it is no longer economical
to produce from the well, at which time the well is plugged and abandoned. The
Company's wells have been drilled at various times from 1966 to the present.
The Company's wells generally have productive lives of 15 to 20 years and have
been subject to normal production declines. To date, these declines have been
offset largely by the acquisition of additional wells and, to a materially
lesser extent, drilling of wells. The Company cannot predict whether the
Company will acquire further energy assets or drill further wells, or as to
the timing or cost thereof.

         Operating Hazards and Uninsured Risks. The oil and natural gas
business involves certain operating hazards such as well blowouts, craterings,
explosions, uncontrollable flows of oil, natural gas or well fluids, fires,
formations with abnormal pressures, pipeline ruptures or spills, pollution,
releases of toxic gas and other environmental hazards and risks, any of which
could result in substantial losses to the Company. In addition, the Company
may be liable for environmental damage caused by previous owners of property
purchased or leased by the Company. As a result, substantial liabilities to
third parties or governmental entities may be incurred, the payment of which
could materially adversely affect the Company's results of operations or
financial condition. In accordance with customary industry practices, the
Company maintains insurance against some, but not all, of such risks and
losses. The Company may elect to self-insure if it believes that the cost of
insurance, although available, is excessive relative to the risks presented.
The occurrence of an event that is not covered, or not fully covered, by
insurance could have a material adverse effect on the Company's

                                      26

<PAGE>



business, financial condition and results of operations. In addition,
pollution and environmental risks generally are not fully insurable.

         Carrying Value of Energy Properties May Be Subject to Reduction. The
Company annually reviews the carrying value of its oil and natural gas
properties under the full cost accounting rules of the Commission. Under these
rules, capitalized costs of proved oil and natural gas properties may not
exceed the present value of estimated future net revenues from proved
reserves, discounted at 10%. Application of the "ceiling" test generally
requires pricing future revenue at the unescalated prices in effect as of the
end of each fiscal year and requires a write-down for accounting purposes if
the ceiling is exceeded, even if prices were depressed for only a short period
of time. The Company may be required to write-down the carrying value of its
oil and natural gas properties when oil and natural gas prices are depressed
or unusually volatile. If a write-down is required, it could result in a
material charge to earnings, but would not impact cash flow from operating
activities. Once incurred, a write-down of oil and natural gas properties is
not reversible at a later date.

         Uncertainty of Estimates of Oil and Natural Gas Reserves. The
estimates of the Company's proved oil and natural gas reserves and the
estimated future net revenues therefrom referred to immediately above are
based upon reserve reports that rely upon various assumptions, including
assumptions required by the Commission as to oil and natural gas prices,
drilling and operating expenses, capital expenditures, taxes and availability
of funds. The process of estimating oil and natural gas reserves is complex,
requiring significant decisions and assumptions in the evaluation of available
geological, geophysical, engineering and economic data for each reservoir. As
a result, such estimates are inherently imprecise. Actual future production,
oil and natural gas prices, revenues, taxes, development expenditures,
operating expenses and quantities of recoverable oil and natural gas reserves
may vary substantially from those estimated by the Company or contained in the
reserve reports. Any significant variance in these assumptions could
materially affect the estimated quantity of the Company's reserves. The
Company's properties also may be susceptible to hydrocarbon drainage from
production by other operators on adjacent properties. In addition, the
Company's proved reserves may be subject to downward or upward revision based
upon production history, results of future exploration and development,
prevailing oil and natural gas prices, mechanical difficulties, governmental
regulation and other factors, many of which are beyond the Company's control.

         Governmental Regulation and Environmental Matters. Oil and gas
operations are subject to various federal, state and local government
regulations that may be changed from time to time in response to economic or
political conditions. Matters subject to regulation include discharge permits
for drilling operations, drilling bonds, reports concerning operations, the
spacing of wells, unitization and pooling of properties and taxation. From
time to time, regulatory agencies have imposed price controls and limitations
on production by restricting the rate of flow of oil and gas wells below
actual production capacity in order to conserve supplies of oil and gas. In
addition, the development, production, handling, storage, transportation and
disposal of oil and gas, by-products thereof and other substances and

                                      27

<PAGE>



material produced or used in connection with oil and gas operations are
subject to complex regulation under federal, state and local laws and
regulations primarily relating to protection of human health and the
environment. The Company is also subject to changing and extensive tax laws,
the effects of which cannot be predicted. The Company believes that it is in
compliance with applicable regulations, although there can be no assurance
that this is or will remain the case. The implementation of new, or the
modification of existing, laws or regulations could have a material adverse
effect on the Company. No assurance can be given that existing environmental
laws or regulations, as currently interpreted or reinterpreted in the future,
or future laws or regulations will not materially adversely affect the
Company's financial condition and results of operations.

Restrictions on Payment of Dividends

         Under the terms of the Senior Notes, the Company may not pay
dividends or make other distributions on the Common Stock in excess of 25% of
aggregated consolidated net income (offset by 100% of any deficit) on a
cumulative basis. See "Business - Sources of Funds - Senior Notes."
Accordingly, the Company's ability in the future to pay (or increase the
amount of) cash dividends on its Common Stock may be restricted, depending
upon the amount of its future income.

Importance of Key Employees

         The Company's future success will depend upon the continued services
of the Company's senior management and, with respect to its leasing
operations, the Chairman and Chief Executive Officer of its leasing
subsidiary. The unexpected loss of the services of any of these management
personnel could have a material adverse effect upon the Company. See
"Management." The Company does not maintain key man life insurance on, nor
(except for employment agreements with Edward E. Cohen, the Chairman, Chief
Executive Officer and President of the Company, Abraham Bernstein, the
Chairman and Chief Executive Officer of its small ticket leasing subsidiary,
and Daniel G. Cohen, the Chairman and Chief Executive Officer of the Company's
residential mortgage lending business and an Executive Vice President of the
Company) does it have employment agreements with, any of its senior
management.

Shares Eligible for Future Sale

         Upon consummation of this Offering, the Company will have 6,248,537
shares of Common Stock outstanding (assuming the Underwriters do not exercise
their over-allotment option). Following this Offering, sales of substantial
amounts of the Common Stock in the public market pursuant to Rule 144 or
otherwise, or the availability of such shares for sale, could adversely affect
the prevailing market prices for the Common Stock and impair the Company's
ability to raise additional capital through the sale of equity securities
should it desire to do so. See "Shares Eligible for Future Sale."


                                      28

<PAGE>



Forward Looking Statements

         This Prospectus, and the information incorporated by reference
herein, may include certain statements and estimates provided by the Company
with respect to the Company's anticipated operations. Such statements and
estimates reflect various assumptions made by the Company about circumstances
and events, many of which have not yet taken place, as well as reflecting a
substantial degree of judgment by management as to the scope and presentation
of such information. There can be no assurance that any of such statements or
estimates of anticipated operations will prove to be correct, and no
representations and warranties are made as to the accuracy of such statements
or estimates. Actual results may vary and such variations may be material.


                PRICE RANGE OF COMMON STOCK AND DIVIDEND POLICY

         The following table sets forth the high and low sale prices of the
Common Stock, as reported by Nasdaq, on a quarterly basis for the Company's
last two full fiscal years and for fiscal 1998 through March 3, 1998:

                                                             High        Low
                                                             ----        ---

         Fiscal 1998
         -----------

         Second Quarter (through March 3, 1998)........     $49.50      $43.50
         First Quarter ................................      56.50       42.75

         Fiscal 1997
         -----------

         Fourth Quarter................................      51.50       25.00
         Third Quarter.................................      26.25       19.00
         Second Quarter................................      26.50       17.75
         First Quarter.................................      19.00       12.25

         Fiscal 1996
         -----------

         Fourth Quarter................................      17.50       12.00
         Third Quarter.................................      21.19       12.83
         Second Quarter ...............................      16.23        7.43
         First Quarter.................................       8.63        6.58

         As of March 3, 1998, there were 4,748,537 shares of Common Stock
outstanding held by 784 holders of record.


                                      29

<PAGE>



         The Company has paid regular quarterly cash dividends on its Common
Stock of $.10 per share commencing with the third quarter of fiscal 1996. The
Company paid dividends of $.094 and $.089 per share during the second and
first fiscal quarters of 1996, respectively.

         The Company declared and paid 6% stock dividends in January 1996 and
April 1996, and effected a five-for-two stock split in the form of a 150%
stock dividend in May 1996. The Company anticipates effecting a three-for-one
stock split in the form of a 200% stock dividend in fiscal 1998, subject to
the approval of its stockholders to an increase in authorized Common Stock
necessary to effect the dividend. See "Description of Capital Stock - General."

         Under the terms of the Senior Notes, the payment of cash dividends on
the Common Stock is restricted unless certain financial tests are met. See "
Business - Sources of Funds - Senior Notes."


                                      30

<PAGE>



                                CAPITALIZATION

         The following table sets forth the consolidated capitalization of the
Company as of December 31, 1997, and as adjusted as of that date to give
effect to the sale of 1,500,000 shares of Common Stock by the Company in this
Offering at an assumed price of $47.00 per share (the closing price of the
Common Stock on Nasdaq on March 3, 1998) and after deducting underwriters'
discounts and estimated offering expenses. The following data should be read
in conjunction with the consolidated financial statements and notes thereto of
the Company which are included elsewhere herein. See also "Selected
Consolidated Financial Data" and "Management's Discussion and Analysis of
Financial Condition and Results of Operations."
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>

                                                                                As of December 31, 1997
                                                                              ----------------------------
                                                                              Actual           As Adjusted
                                                                              ------           -----------
                                                                                    (in thousands)

<S>                                                                            <C>                  <C>     
    Current portion of long-term debt                                          $  5,100             $  5,100
    Long-term debt:
         Other debt...........................................                    3,116                3,116
         Senior Notes.........................................                  115,000              115,000
                                                                               --------             --------
           Total long-term debt...............................                 $123,216             $123,216
                                                                               ========             ========

    Stockholders' equity
         Preferred Stock, $1.00 par value, 1,000,000
             shares authorized, none issued..................               $     -                $    -
         Common Stock, $.01 par value, 8,000,000
             shares authorized, 4,742,919 shares
             issued; 6,242,919 shares issued, as adjusted(1)                         55                   70
         Additional paid-in capital...........................                   59,343              125,150
         Retained earnings....................................                   25,486               25,486
         Less treasury stock, at cost(1)......................                  (14,074)             (14,074)
         Less loan receivable from Employee Stock
            Ownership Plan....................................                     (353)                (353)
                                                                              ---------             --------
         Total stockholders' equity...........................                   70,457              136,279
                                                                              ---------             --------
    Total capitalization......................................                 $193,673             $259,495
                                                                               ========             ========
</TABLE>
- ---------
(1)      The number of issued shares of Common Stock excludes 717,682 shares
         held by the Company as treasury stock and excludes 5,618 shares
         issued pursuant to exercise of options subsequent to December 31,
         1997.

                                      31

<PAGE>



                     SELECTED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL DATA

         The financial data set forth below should be read in conjunction
with, and is qualified in its entirety by, the Consolidated Financial
Statements of the Company, including the notes thereto, and "Management's
Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations"
included elsewhere herein.
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>

                                              As of and for
                                            the Quarter Ended                              As of and for the
                                               December 31,                              Year Ended September 30,
                                          -----------------------    --------------------------------------------------------------
                                             1997          1996         1997          1996         1995        1994           1993
                                           ---------    ---------    ---------    ---------    ---------    ---------    ---------
                                                              (in thousands, except ratios and per share data)

<S>                                        <C>          <C>          <C>          <C>          <C>            <C>          <C>      

Statement of Operations Data:
Revenues:
 Real estate finance -
  Interest(1) ..........................   $   4,668    $   1,427    $   9,001    $   2,853    $   3,422    $   1,401    $     606
  Fees .................................       1,775        1,407        2,556          675          963           25         --
  Gains on refinancings and
   sales of senior lien interests ......       2,949          385        7,587        3,643        1,729        1,096         --
                                           ---------    ---------    ---------    ---------    ---------    ---------    ---------
     Total .............................       9,392        3,219       19,144        7,171        6,114        2,522          606
 Equipment leasing .....................       3,172        1,202        7,162        4,466         --           --           --
 Energy production .....................       1,232          950        3,936        3,421        3,452        3,442        3,409
 Energy services .......................         583          389        1,672        1,736        1,879        2,080        2,445
 Interest ..............................         698           84          930          197          149          136          106
                                           ---------    ---------    ---------    ---------    ---------    ---------    ---------
     Total revenues ....................      15,077        5,844       32,844       16,991       11,594        8,180        6,566
Costs and expenses:
 Real estate finance ...................       1,523          163        1,069          852          801          248          114
 Equipment leasing .....................       1,325          883        3,822        2,339         --           --           --
 Energy exploration and production .....         574          412        1,823        1,582        1,733        2,004        1,735
 Energy services .......................         309          224          909          869        1,026        1,131        1,106
 General and administrative ............         927          592        2,851        1,756        2,265        1,901        1,841
 Provision for possible losses .........         318           10          653            7         --           --           --
 Interest ..............................       3,870          409        5,273          872        1,091          310           41
 Other .................................          (3)         (88)        (101)          (7)          (1)          30         (383)
                                           ---------    ---------    ---------    ---------    ---------    ---------    ---------
     Total costs and expenses ..........       8,843        2,605       16,299        8,270        6,915        5,624        4,454
Income before income taxes,
 depreciation, depletion and
 amortization ..........................       6,234        3,239       16,545        8,721        4,679        2,556        2,112
Depreciation, depletion and amortization         508          379        1,614        1,368        1,335        1,347        1,478
Income before income taxes .............       5,726        2,860       14,931        7,353        3,344        1,209          634
Net income .............................       3,951        2,285       10,951        5,147        2,714        1,309          590

Segment Profitability (Loss):(2)
Real estate finance ....................   $   7,467    $   2,865    $  16,546    $   6,281    $   5,276    $   2,237    $     455
Equipment leasing ......................       1,430          214        2,457        1,916         --           --           --
Energy exploration, production and
  services .............................         518          372        1,699        1,646        1,317        1,114        1,720
Corporate (excluding taxes)(3) .........      (3,692)        (679)      (5,845)      (2,497)      (3,248)      (2,105)      (1,393)

Balance Sheet and Other Data:
Assets:
 Current assets ........................   $  34,343    $   8,721    $  72,269    $   6,106    $   3,924    $   3,985    $   2,150
 Net investment in real estate loans ...     128,884       49,693       88,816       21,798       17,991       10,386        7,329
 Net investment in leasing assets ......      13,214        5,388        8,152          729         --           --           --
 Net investment in energy property and
  equipment ............................      12,379       11,036       11,400       11,265       11,964       12,786       13,542
 Net other assets ......................      19,099        5,573       14,482        4,061        3,671        7,639        2,210
                                           ---------    ---------    ---------    ---------    ---------    ---------    ---------
     Total assets ......................     207,919       80,411      195,119       43,959       37,550       34,796       25,231
</TABLE>

                                      32

<PAGE>
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>

                                              As of and for
                                            the Quarter Ended                              As of and for the
                                               December 31,                              Year Ended September 30,
                                          -----------------------    --------------------------------------------------------------
                                             1997          1996         1997          1996         1995        1994           1993
                                           ---------    ---------    ---------    ---------    ---------    ---------    ---------
                                                                 (in thousands, except ratios and per share data)

<S>                                        <C>          <C>          <C>          <C>          <C>            <C>          <C>      
Liabilities:
 Current liabilities ......................   $ 16,690    $  2,449    $ 10,841    $  1,664    $  1,329    $  1,355    $    723
 Long-term debt less current
  maturities(4) ...........................    118,116      22,496     118,786       8,966       8,523       8,627         813
 Deferred income taxes and long-term
  liabilities .............................      2,656       2,589         663       2,206       1,147         674         834
                                              --------    --------    --------    --------    --------    --------    --------
     Total liabilities ....................    137,462      27,534     130,290      12,836      10,999      10,656       2,370
Stockholders' equity(5) ...................     70,457      52,877      64,829      31,123      26,551      24,140      22,861
Stockholders' equity per common share(6)(7)      14.86       14.89       13.79       16.43       14.21       12.52       11.59
Assets under management:
 Real estate(8) ...........................    330,128     139,608     233,666     100,520      52,955      26,328      13,303
 Leasing(9) ...............................    114,876      83,503     105,940      79,649     103,439        --          --
 Energy(10) ...............................     38,867      32,145      37,809      32,147      33,688      36,067      38,500
                                              --------    --------    --------    --------    --------    --------    --------
     Total assets under management ........    483,871     255,256     377,415     212,316     190,082      62,395      51,803

Selected Ratios:
Operating ratios -
 Return on equity(11) .....................         23%         22%         23%         18%         11%          6%          3%
 Yield on net real estate investment(12) ..         30%         36%         35%         36%         35%         31%         12%
Balance sheet ratios:
 Real estate loan to value(13) ............         82%         80%         82%         86%         78%         79%         82%
 Earnings to fixed charges(14) ............       2.48        8.00        3.83        9.44        4.07        4.89       16.45
Common Share Information:
Net income per common share (basic)(15) ...   $    .83    $    .91    $   3.15    $   2.72    $   1.43    $    .66    $    .30
Weighted average number of common
  shares outstanding (basic) ..............      4,733       2,507       3,478       1,890       1,904       1,970       1,975
Net income per common share (diluted)(16) .   $    .81    $    .66    $   2.51    $   1.88    $   1.23    $    .64    $    .30
Weighted average number of common
  shares (diluted) ........................      4,906       3,476       4,358       2,757       2,235       2,076       1,990
Cash dividends per common share ...........   $    .10    $    .10    $    .40    $    .38    $    .09    $   --      $   --
</TABLE>
- ---------
(1)      Interest income includes accreted discounts of $1.7 million and
         $793,000 for the quarters ended December 31, 1997 and 1996,
         respectively, and $4.1 million, $954,000, $1.2 million, $602,000, and
         $256,000 for the fiscal years ended September 30, 1997, 1996, 1995,
         1994 and 1993, respectively.
(2)      Represents segment revenues minus segment costs less depreciation,
         depletion and amortization attributable to the segment, but without
         allocation of corporate overhead.
(3)      Includes interest expense, interest income on cash not invested in
         operations, general and administrative expenses, and depreciation and
         amortization not allocated to operations of other segments. Interest
         expense was $3.9 million and $409,000 for the quarters ended December
         31, 1997 and 1996, respectively, and $5.3 million, $872,000, $1.1
         million, $310,000 and $41,000 for the years ended September 30, 1997,
         1996, 1995, 1994 and 1993, respectively.
(4)      In July 1997, the Company completed a private offering of Senior
         Notes and received net proceeds (after placement and offering
         expenses) of $110.6 million.
(5)      In December 1996, the Company completed a public offering of shares
         of Common Stock and received net proceeds (after underwriting and
         offering expenses) of $19.5 million.


                                      33

<PAGE>



(6)      Based on shares of Common Stock outstanding of 4.7 million and 3.6
         million at December 31, 1997 and 1996, respectively, and 4.7 million,
         1.9 million, 1.9 million, 1.9 million, and 2.0 million at September
         30, 1997, 1996, 1995, 1994, 1993, respectively.
(7)      Giving effect to the issuance of 1.5 million shares in this Offering
         at an assumed price of $47.00 (the closing price of the Common Stock
         on Nasdaq on March 3, 1998), and after deduction of underwriting
         discounts and estimated offering expenses, stockholders' equity per
         common share would have been $21.83 on December 31, 1997.
(8)      Represents the stated, or face, amount of outstanding loans plus
         accrued interest and penalties.
(9)      Represents the aggregate of (i) the original cost of equipment under
         lease and cash held by equipment leasing limited partnerships managed
         by the Company, and (ii) gross lease receivables as of the end of the
         period under leases held in the Company's portfolio or serviced by
         the Company for third parties.
(10)     Represents the original cost of assets held by the Company and energy
         partnerships and joint ventures managed by the Company.
(11)     Calculated as net income divided by average stockholders' equity. 
(12)     Calculated as gross real estate finance revenues (including gains on
         refinancings and sales of senior lien interests in commercial
         mortgage loans) divided by the average book cost of real estate
         finance assets.
(13)     Calculated as the aggregate book value of loans with respect to any
         property (including all loans with liens senior to or of the same
         seniority with the loan interest held by the Company) divided by the
         appraised value of the property.
(14)     Calculated by dividing income from continuing operations before
         income taxes, extraordinary gains and cumulative effect of a change
         in accounting principle plus fixed charges by fixed charges. Fixed
         charges represent total interest expense, including amortization of
         debt expense and discount relating to indebtedness.
(15)     Calculated as net income divided by the weighted average Common Stock
         outstanding during the period, in accordance with SFAS No. 128.
(16)     Calculated as net income divided by the weighted average number of
         shares of Common Stock outstanding during the period and dilutive
         potential Common Stock, in accordance with SFAS No. 128. Dilutive 
         potential shares of Common Stock include shares issuable under the
         terms of various stock option and warrant agreements (including,
         during fiscal 1994 through fiscal 1997, warrants exercised during
         fiscal 1997) net of the number of such shares that could have been
         reacquired (at the weighted average price of the Common Stock during
         the period) with the proceeds received from the exercise of the
         options and warrants.


                                      34

<PAGE>



                                USE OF PROCEEDS

                  The net proceeds to be received by the Company from the sale
of the Common Stock offered hereby, after deducting the underwriting discount
and estimated offering expenses, are estimated (based on the closing price of
the Common Stock on _______________, 1998 as reported on Nasdaq) to be
$__________ ($_____________, assuming the Underwriters exercise their
over-allotment option). The Company intends to use the net proceeds primarily
for the acquisition of additional commercial real estate mortgage loans and,
to a lesser extent, the expansion of equipment leasing operations, the
acquisition of selected energy properties and assets and for other general
corporate purposes.

                    MANAGEMENT'S DISCUSSION AND ANALYSIS OF
                 FINANCIAL CONDITION AND RESULTS OF OPERATIONS

General

         The Company's operating results and financial condition reflect an
acceleration of the Company's shift in focus to specialty finance businesses
following substantial increases in working capital due to the sale, in
December 1996, of 1.7 million shares of Common Stock (from which it received
net proceeds of $19.5 million) and the issuance, in July 1997, of $115 million
of Senior Notes (from which it received net proceeds of $110.6 million). These
capital market transactions were primarily responsible for increasing the
Company's capitalization (stockholders' equity plus long-term debt) to $193.7
million as of December 31, 1997.

         Overview of First Quarter of Fiscal 1998. The Company's gross
revenues were $15.1 million in the first quarter of fiscal 1998, an increase
of $9.2 million (158%) from $5.8 million in the first quarter of fiscal 1997.
As of December 31, 1997, total assets were $207.9 million, an increase of
$12.8 million (7%) from $195.1 million at September 30, 1997. Of the increases
in total revenues during the first quarter of fiscal 1998, the revenues from
the Company's real estate finance business increased to $9.4 million, an
increase of $6.2 million (192%) from $3.2 million in the first quarter of
fiscal 1997. Equipment leasing revenues were $3.2 million in the first quarter
of fiscal 1998, an increase of $2.0 million (164%) from $1.2 million in the
first quarter of fiscal 1997. Energy revenues were $1.8 million in the first
quarter of fiscal 1998, an increase of $476,000 (36%) from $1.3 million in the
first quarter of fiscal 1997. Real estate finance (commercial and residential
mortgage loans) and equipment leasing revenues were 83% and 76% of total
revenues in the first quarter of fiscal 1998 and 1997, respectively. Energy
revenues were 12% and 23% of total revenues in the first quarter of fiscal
1998 and 1997, respectively. Real estate finance and equipment leasing assets
were 75% and 73% of total assets at December 31, 1997 and 1996, respectively.
Energy assets were 8% and 16% of total assets at December 31, 1997 and 1996,
respectively.

         Overview of Fiscal 1997. The Company's gross revenues were $32.8
million in fiscal 1997, an increase of $15.8 million (93%) from $17.0 million
in fiscal 1996, as compared to

                                      35

<PAGE>



an increase in fiscal 1996 of $5.4 million (47%) from $11.6 million in fiscal
1995. As of September 30, 1997, total assets were $195.1 million, an increase
of $151.1 million (343%), from $44.0 million at September 30, 1996, as
compared to an increase of $6.4 million (17%) from $37.6 million at September
30, 1995. Of the increases in total revenue during that period, the revenues
from the Company's commercial mortgage loan acquisition and resolution
business increased to $19.1 million, an increase of $12.0 million (167%) from
$7.2 million in fiscal 1996, as compared to an increase of $1.1 million (17%)
in fiscal 1996 from $6.1 million in fiscal 1995. In addition, leasing revenues
were $7.2 million in fiscal 1997, an increase of $2.7 million (60%) from $4.5
million in fiscal 1996, the year in which leasing operations commenced. Energy
revenues remained relatively constant at $5.6 million, $5.2 million and $5.3
million in fiscal 1997, 1996 and 1995, respectively. Real estate finance and
equipment leasing revenues were 80%, 68% and 53% of total revenues in fiscal
1997, 1996 and 1995, respectively. Energy revenues were 17%, 30% and 46% of
total revenues in fiscal 1997, 1996 and 1995, respectively. Real estate
finance and equipment leasing assets were 53%, 57% and 51% of total assets at
September 30, 1997, 1996, and 1995, respectively. Energy assets were 8%, 29%
and 37% of total assets at September 30, 1997, 1996 and 1995, respectively.

Results of Operations:  Real Estate Finance

         The following table sets forth certain information relating to the
revenue recognized and expenses incurred in the Company's real estate finance
operations during the periods indicated:
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>

                                              Quarter Ended                             Year Ended
                                               December 31,                            September 30,
                                             ----------------               ------------------------
                                             1997           1996            1997          1996            1995
                                             ----           ----            ----          ----            ----
                                                                        (in thousands)
<S>                                          <C>             <C>              <C>          <C>           <C>    
Revenues:
Commercial mortgage loan acquisition and resolution:
         Interest.....................       $2,722          $  634           $ 4,877      $ 1,899       $ 2,246
         Accreted discount............        1,666             793             4,124          954         1,176
         Fees.........................        1,775           1,407             2,556          675           963
         Gains on refinancings
           and sale of senior
           lien interests.............        1,528             385             7,587        3,643         1,729
                                             ------          ------           -------      -------       -------
                                              7,691           3,219            19,144        7,171         6,114
                                              -----          ------           -------      -------       -------

Residential mortgage lending:
         Gain on sale of residential
           mortgage loans.............        1,421            --               --            --            --
         Interest.....................          280            --               --            --            --
                                             ------          ------            ------       ------        ----
                                              1,701            --                --           --            --
                                             ------          ------            ------       ------        ----

                                             $9,392          $3,219           $19,144       $7,171        $6,114
                                             ======          ======           =======       ======        ======

</TABLE>

                                      36

<PAGE>
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>

                                              Quarter Ended                             Year Ended
                                               December 31,                            September 30,
                                             -------------------               ------------------------
                                             1997           1996            1997          1996            1995
                                             ----           ----            ----          ----            ----
                                                                        (in thousands)
<S>                                          <C>             <C>              <C>          <C>           <C>    
Expenses:

Commercial mortgage loan acquisition
 and resolution:......................       $  380          $  163            $1,069       $  852        $  801
Residential mortgage lending..........        1,143            --                --           --            --
                                             ------           -----             -----        -----         ---

                                             $1,523            $163            $1,069       $  852        $  801
                                             ======            ====            ======       ======        ======

</TABLE>
Quarter Ended December 31, 1997 Compared to Quarter Ended December 31, 1996

         During the first quarter of fiscal 1998, the Company purchased or
originated four commercial mortgage loans for a total cost of $63.5 million
(including $35.3 million of costs with respect to one loan which were reduced
immediately upon loan acquisition by first mortgage financing arranged by the
Company), as compared to the purchase of four loans for a total cost of $27.9
million in the first quarter of fiscal 1997. The average net investment in the
four loans (excluding the $35.3 million financing referred to in the preceding
sentence) purchased during the first quarter of fiscal 1998 was $7.0 million
and ranged from a high of $14.5 million to a low of $1.5 million whereas in
the first quarter of fiscal 1997, the average net investment in the four loans
was $7.0 million and ranged from a high of $19.2 million to a low of $508,000.
In addition, during the first quarter of fiscal 1998 the Company originated a
construction loan with respect to a hotel property in Savannah, Georgia, in
the amount of $3.6 million, of which $339,000 was drawn down during the
quarter. The Company also increased its investment in certain existing loans
by an aggregate of $2.0 million and $1.0 million in the first quarters of
fiscal 1998 and 1997, respectively, for the purpose of paying for property
improvement costs, unpaid taxes and similar items relating to properties
underlying portfolio loans. The increased investments had been anticipated by
the Company at the time the loans were acquired and were included in its
analysis of loan costs and yields. The average balance of the Company's
investments in commercial mortgage loans was $102.9 million and $35.7 million
for the first quarters of fiscal 1998 and fiscal 1997, respectively.

         The Company purchased certain commercial mortgage loans in the fourth
quarter of fiscal 1997 and the first quarter of fiscal 1998 which have not yet
been refinanced or in which senior lien interests have not yet been sold.
Refinancings and senior lien interests generally bear lower rates of interest
and are included within the balance of the obligation owed to the Company,
thereby typically increasing the Company's yield on its funds remaining
invested. As a consequence of the increase in loans which have not yet been
refinanced or in which senior lien interests have not yet been sold, the
Company's yield on its average loan balances decreased in the first quarter of
fiscal 1998 to 30% from 36% in the first quarter of fiscal 1997.


                                      37

<PAGE>



         Revenues from commercial mortgage loan acquisition and resolution
operations increased to $7.7 million in the first quarter of fiscal 1998 from
$3.2 million in the first quarter of fiscal 1997, an increase of 139%. The
increase in the first quarter of fiscal 1998 was attributable to (i) an
increase of $3.0 million (207%) in interest income (including accretion of
discount) resulting from an increase in the average amount of loans
outstanding during that period as compared to the same period in the prior
fiscal year; (ii) gains recognized on the refinancing or sale of senior lien
interests in loans held by the Company which increased to $1.5 million in the
first quarter of fiscal 1998 from $385,000 in the first quarter of fiscal
1997, an increase of $1.1 million (297%), as a result of an increased number
of loans refinanced or in which senior lien interests were sold (six in the
first quarter of 1998, resulting in gross proceeds of $5.3 million, as
compared to three in the first quarter of fiscal 1997, resulting in gross
proceeds of $2.2 million); and (iii) an increase in fee income to $1.8 million
in the first quarter of fiscal 1998 from $1.4 million in first quarter of
fiscal 1997, an increase of $368,000 (26%). Of these fees, $830,000 were for
financial advisory and consultation services related to the organization and
capitalization of RAIT. The Company also received a $900,000 fee for services
to a borrower whose loan the Company later acquired. Gains on sale of senior
lien interests in loans and the amount (if any) of fees received vary from
transaction to transaction and there may be significant variations in the
Company's gain on sale and fee income from period to period.

         Costs and expenses of the Company's commercial mortgage loan
acquisition and resolution operations increased $217,000 (133%) in the first
quarter of fiscal 1998 compared to the first quarter of fiscal 1997. The
increase was primarily a result of higher personnel costs associated with the
expansion of this operation.

         As a consequence of the foregoing, the Company's gross profit from
commercial mortgage loan acquisition and resolution operations increased to
$7.3 million in the first quarter of fiscal 1998 from $3.1 million in the
first quarter of fiscal 1997 (139%).

         On October 1, 1997, the Company's residential mortgage lending
business commenced operations. On November 5, 1997 the Company acquired
Tri-Star, an originator of residential mortgage loans, for $3.5 million of
which $2.5 million was paid through the issuance of Common Stock and the
remainder in cash. During the first quarter of fiscal 1998 the Company
originated 263 residential mortgage loans (including residential loans
originated by Tri-Star subsequent to its acquisition) for a cost of $11.8
million and acquired, from an unaffiliated third party, a portfolio of 37
loans for a cost of $2.7 million. The Company may opportunistically purchase
residential mortgage loans although its focus is on loan originations.

         The Company sold residential mortgage loans, including the purchased
loans referred to above, with a book value of $11.0 million during the first
quarter of fiscal 1998 in several different transactions, receiving (in the
aggregate) cash of $4.3 million and a note (from an unaffiliated third party)
with a book value of $8.1 million, of which $6.2 million was paid in the
second quarter of fiscal 1998. The remaining balance of the note is due in
2027. The

                                      38

<PAGE>



sales resulted in an aggregate gain of $1.4 million. See "Risk Factors - Real
Estate Considerations - Note Received in Sale of Certain Residential Loans."

         Costs and expenses associated with residential mortgage lending
operations were $1.1 million, reflecting the commencement of operations during
the quarter.

Year Ended September 30, 1997 Compared to Year Ended September 30, 1996

         During fiscal 1997, the Company purchased or originated 18 commercial
real estate loans, for a total cost of $71.7 million, as compared to the
purchase of nine commercial real estate loans for a total of $15.1 million in
fiscal 1996. The average net investment in the 18 loans was $4.0 million (with
individual investments ranging from a high of $19.2 million to a low of
$400,000) during fiscal 1997, as compared to an average net investment of $1.7
million in nine loans (with individual investments ranging from a high of $3.8
million to a low of $100,000) during fiscal 1996. In addition, the Company
increased its investment in certain existing loans by an aggregate of $1.9
million in fiscal 1997, and an aggregate of $2.6 million in fiscal 1996 for
purposes of paying for property improvement costs, unpaid taxes and similar
items relating to properties underlying portfolio loans. The increased
investments had been anticipated by the Company at the time the loans were
acquired and were included in its analysis of loan costs and yields.

         Revenues from commercial mortgage loan acquisition and resolution
operations increased to $19.1 million in fiscal 1997 from $7.2 million in
fiscal 1996, an increase of 167%. The increase in fiscal 1997 was attributable
to (i) an increase of $6.1 million (215%) in interest income (including
accretion of discount) resulting from an increase in the average amount of
loans outstanding during fiscal 1997 as compared to fiscal 1996; (ii) gains
recognized on the refinancing of loans and sale of senior lien interests in
loans held by the Company which increased to $7.6 million in fiscal 1997 from
$3.6 million in fiscal 1996, an increase of $4.0 million (108%); and (iii) an
increase in fee income to $2.6 million in fiscal 1997 from $675,000 in fiscal
1996, an increase of $1.9 million (279%) as a result of an increase in the
number of transactions in which fee income was earned. The Company sold senior
lien interests in or refinanced nine loans during fiscal 1997 and eight loans
during fiscal 1996, realizing proceeds of $16.5 million and $18.0 million,
respectively.

         Costs and expenses of the Company's real estate finance operations
increased 25% in fiscal 1997 compared to fiscal 1996. The increase was
primarily a result of higher personnel costs associated with the expansion of
the Company's commercial mortgage lending operations.

         As a consequence of the foregoing, the Company's gross profit from
commercial mortgage loan acquisition and resolution operations increased to
$16.5 million in fiscal 1997 from $6.3 million in fiscal 1996 (163%).

Year Ended September 30, 1996 Compared to Year Ended September 30, 1995

                                      39

<PAGE>




         Revenues from commercial mortgage loan acquisition and resolution
operations increased to $7.2 million in fiscal 1996 from $6.1 million in
fiscal 1995. This increase was attributable to increases of 111% in gains
recognized on the refinancing of loans and sale of senior lien interests in
loans held by the Company. Fees decreased 30% in fiscal 1996 as compared to
fiscal 1995 due to a reduction in the number of refinancings of, and sales of
senior lien interests in, certain of the Company's portfolio loans occurring
during fiscal 1996 as compared to fiscal 1995. The Company sold senior lien
interests in or refinanced eight and eleven commercial mortgage loans during
fiscal years 1996 and 1995, respectively, realizing proceeds of $18.0 million
and $10.2 million, respectively.

         During fiscal 1996, the Company purchased or originated nine
commercial mortgage loans, for a total cost of $15.1 million, as compared to
seven loans for a total of $13.6 million in fiscal 1995. In addition, the
Company increased its investment in certain existing loans by $2.6 million in
fiscal 1996 and $1.3 million in fiscal 1995 for purposes of paying for
property improvement costs, unpaid taxes and similar items relating to
properties underlying portfolio loans. The increased investments had been
anticipated by the Company at the time the loans were acquired and were
included in its analysis of loan costs and yields. In addition, in fiscal 1996
the Company increased its investment in loans by $535,000 in connection with
its repurchase of certain senior lien interests to facilitate borrower
refinancings and received a note for $317,000 (thus increasing its investment
in loans) in connection with granting its consent to the sale (subject to the
Company's existing mortgage loan) of another property by a borrower. Real
estate costs and expenses increased 6% in fiscal 1996 as compared to fiscal
1995. The increase was primarily a result of higher personnel costs associated
with the expansion of these operations. It should be noted that certain
reclassifications have been made to the consolidated financial statements for
fiscal years 1996 and 1995 to conform to the fiscal 1997 presentation.

         As a consequence of the foregoing, the Company's gross profit from
commercial mortgage loan acquisition and resolution operations increased to
$6.3 million for fiscal 1996 from $5.3 million for fiscal 1995 (19%).


                                      40

<PAGE>



Results of Operations:  Equipment Leasing

         The following table sets forth certain information relating to the
revenue recognized and expenses incurred in the Company's equipment leasing
operations during the periods indicated:
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>

                                                           Quarter Ended                Year Ended
                                                            December 31,               September 30,
                                                         --------------------       --------------------
                                                          1997          1996         1997           1996
                                                         ------         -----       ------         ------
                                                                          (in thousands)
<S>                                                      <C>           <C>          <C>            <C> 
Revenues:
         Small ticket leasing -
            Gain on sale of leases.................      $1,788        $  313       $3,711         $ --
            Interest and fees......................         601            76        1,081              7
         Partnership management....................         531           513        1,713          3,809
         Lease finance placement and
           advisory services.......................         252           300          657            650
                                                         ------         -----       ------         ------
                                                         $3,172        $1,202       $7,162         $4,466
                                                         ======        ======       ======         ======



                                                           Quarter Ended                 Year Ended
                                                            December 31,                September 30,
                                                        ---------------------       --------------------
                                                          1997          1996         1997           1996
                                                         ------         -----       ------         ------
                                                                          (in thousands)
Expenses:
         Small ticket leasing......................      $  797          $353       $2,051         $  425
         Partnership management....................         338           372        1,243          1,471
         Lease finance placement and
           advisory services.......................         190           158          528            443
                                                          -----          ----       ------         ------
                                                         $1,325          $883       $3,822         $2,339
                                                         ======        ======       ======         ======
</TABLE>



                                      41

<PAGE>



Quarter Ended December 31, 1997 Compared to Quarter Ended December 31, 1996

         During the first quarter of fiscal 1998 the Company experienced
continued growth in its leasing business, originating 1,551 leases having a
cost of $16.0 million, as compared to 307 leases having a cost of $4.4 million
during the first quarter of fiscal 1997. In the first quarter of fiscal 1998,
the Company sold leases with a book value of approximately $14.4 million to an
Intermediate Purchaser in return for cash of $12.3 million and a note with a
face value of $3.9 million, as compared to the first quarter of fiscal 1997,
where the Company sold leases with a book value of $3.0 million to an
Intermediate Purchaser in exchange for a note with a face value of $3.3
million. Revenues from equipment leasing increased to $3.2 million in the
first quarter of fiscal 1998 from $1.2 million in the first quarter of fiscal
1997, an increase of $2.0 million (164%). The increase in revenues in the
first quarter of fiscal 1998 was attributable to (i) an increase in the gain
on sale of leases of $1.5 million (471%) resulting from the increased number
of leases originated by the Company and, thus, available for sale; and (ii) an
increase in interest and fee income of $525,000 (691%) resulting from the
increased volume of lease transactions. For a discussion of the Company's
revenue recognition and accounting policies pertaining to its equipment
leasing operations, see "Business - Equipment Leasing - Revenue Recognition
and Lease Accounting."

         Equipment leasing costs and expenses increased $442,000 (50%) in the
first quarter of fiscal 1998 as compared to the first quarter of fiscal 1997.
This increase was primarily a result of higher operating costs associated with
the increase in lease originations.

Year Ended September 30, 1997 Compared to Year Ended September 30, 1996

         In fiscal 1997, the Company received 8,344 lease proposals involving
equipment with an aggregate cost of $113.4 million, approved 5,054 of such
proposals involving equipment with an aggregate cost of $67.2 million, and
entered into 3,214 transactions and acquired equipment for lease with a cost
of $34.6 million. During fiscal 1997, the Company sold leases with a book
value of approximately $30.2 million to Intermediate Purchasers in return for
cash of $20.6 million and notes with face values of $13.3 million, resulting
in gains on sale of $3.7 million. During fiscal 1997, the Company collected
$8.5 million in principal payments on the notes.

         Small ticket leasing expenses increased as a result of the start-up
of small ticket leasing activities in June 1996. Partnership management
expenses decreased as a result of the liquidation of one partnership. Lease
placement and advisory expenses increased as a result of an increase in
commissions paid.

         The decrease in partnership management revenue in fiscal 1997 as
compared to the prior year period was the result of the liquidation, in
accordance with the terms of its partnership agreement, of one leasing
partnership in the first quarter of fiscal 1996. Partnership management
revenue in fiscal 1996 includes the settlement of the Company's general
partner share of revenues from prior fiscal periods. The Company currently
acts as

                                      42

<PAGE>



general partner for five limited partnerships which held a total of $49.8
million (original equipment cost) in leased assets at December 31, 1997.

Results of Operations:  Energy

Quarter Ended December 31, 1997 Compared to Quarter Ended December 31, 1996

         During the first quarter of fiscal 1998 oil and gas production
revenues increased 30%, compared to the same period of the previous fiscal
year. A comparison of the Company's revenues, daily production volumes, and
average sales prices follows:

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
 
                                                                                 Quarter Ended December 31,
                                                                                ---------------------------
                                                                                 1997                1996    
                                                                                ------              -------
                                                                                              
<S>                                                                               <C>                  <C> 
         Revenues (in thousands)                                                              
         Gas ..........................................................           $1,017               $755
         Oil ..........................................................              201                185
                                                                                              
         Production Volumes                                                                   
         Gas (thousands of cubic feet ("mcf")/day).....................            4,198              3,309
         Oil (barrels ("bbls")/day)....................................              124                 91
                                                                                              
         Average Sales Price                                                                  
         Gas (per mcf).................................................           $ 2.63             $ 2.48
         Oil (per bbl).................................................            17.52              22.19
                                                                                            
</TABLE>
         Natural gas revenues increased 35% in the quarter ended December 31,
1997, compared to the same period of the prior fiscal year, due to a 27%
increase in production volumes. Additionally, the average sales price per mcf
increased 6% in the quarter ended December 31, 1997.

         Oil revenues increased 8% in the quarter ended December 31, 1997,
compared to the same period of fiscal 1997, due to a 37% increase in
production volumes which was partially offset by a 21% decrease in the average
sales price per barrel as compared to the quarter ended December 31, 1996.
Both gas and oil volumes were favorably impacted by two acquisitions of
producing properties located in Ohio and New York. These acquisitions
accounted for an increase of 32% and 15% in gas and oil volumes, respectively,
as compared to the first quarter of fiscal 1997. The Company spent $1.8
million to acquire interests in 431 wells during the twelve months ended
December 31, 1997.


                                      43

<PAGE>



         A comparison of the Company's production costs as a percentage of oil
and gas sales, and the production cost per equivalent unit for oil and gas,
for the quarters ended December 31, 1997 and 1996 is as follows:

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
 
                                                                              Quarter Ended December 31,
                                                                              --------------------------
                                                                                 1997              1996
                                                                               ---------        --------

<S>                                                                               <C>                <C> 
         Production Costs
         As a percent of sales.........................................            42%               38%
         Gas (per mcf).................................................          $1.14             $1.03
         Oil (per bbl).................................................          $6.79             $6.19
</TABLE>

         Production costs increased 42% ($153,000) in the quarter ended
December 31, 1997 from the quarter ended December 31, 1996 as a result of the
acquisition of the working interests mentioned above.

         Amortization of oil and gas property costs as a percentage of oil and
gas revenues was 15% in the quarter ended December 31, 1997 compared to 19% in
the quarter ended December 31, 1996. The variance from year to year was
directly attributable to changes in the Company's oil and gas reserve
quantities, product prices and fluctuations in the depletable cost basis of
oil and gas properties. See Note 2 to the Consolidated Financial Statements.

Year Ended September 30, 1997 Compared to Year Ended September 30, 1996 and Year
Ended September 30, 1995

         Oil and gas revenues from production sales increased 16% in fiscal
1997 as compared to fiscal 1996, which remained essentially constant from
fiscal 1995.


                                      44

<PAGE>



         A comparison of the Company's revenues, daily production volumes, and
average sales prices for the periods indicated is as follows:
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>

                                                                    Year Ended September 30,
                                                           ---------------------------------------
                                                              1997            1996          1995
                                                           ---------        ---------     --------

<S>                                                         <C>               <C>          <C>    
         Sales (in thousands)
           Gas(1)................................           $ 3,178           $ 2,722      $ 2,762
           Oil....................................          $   705           $   627      $   610
         Production volumes
           Gas (mcf/day)(1).......................            3,364             3,184        3,283
           Oil (bbls/day).........................               98                93          100
         Average sales prices
           Gas (per mcf)..........................          $  2.59           $  2.34      $  2.31
           Oil (per bbl)..........................          $ 19.68           $ 18.53      $ 16.74
</TABLE>
- ---------
(1) Excludes sales of residual gas and sales to landowners.

         Natural gas revenues from production sales increased 17% in fiscal
1997 from fiscal 1996 due to a 6% increase in production volumes and an 11%
increase in the average price per mcf of natural gas. In fiscal 1996, natural
gas revenues decreased 1% from fiscal 1995 as a result of a 3% decrease in
production volumes partially offset by a 1% increase in the average price per
mcf of natural gas. Oil revenues increased by 12% in fiscal 1997 from fiscal
1996 due to a 6% increase in the average price per barrel and a 5% increase in
production volumes. Primarily as a result of these changes, the Company's
operating profit from energy production (energy production revenues less
energy production and exploration costs) increased to $2.1 million in fiscal
1997 from $1.8 million in fiscal 1996 and $1.7 million in fiscal 1995.

         The Company continues to experience normally declining production
from its properties located in New York State. This decline was offset by the
acquisition of additional well interests in Ohio in June 1997. The Company
participated in the drilling of three successful exploratory wells and two
successful developmental wells during fiscal 1996. The impact on revenues from
these wells was realized in the Company's financial statements commencing with
fiscal 1997. In fiscal 1995, the Company participated in the drilling of three
successful exploratory wells and recompleted one successful development well.
The impact on revenues from these wells was realized in the Company's
financial statements commencing with fiscal 1996.



                                      45

<PAGE>



         A comparison of the Company's production costs as a percentage of oil
and gas sales, and the production cost per equivalent unit for oil and gas for
the fiscal years 1997, 1996 and 1995, is as follows:

                                                Year Ended September 30,
                                          -----------------------------------
                                          1997           1996            1995
                                          ----           ----            ----
         Production Costs
          As a percent of sales........      42%             42%           44%
          Gas (mcf)....................    $1.13           $1.04         $1.06
          Oil (bbl)....................    $6.80           $6.23         $6.36

         Production costs increased $215,000 (15%) in fiscal 1997 from fiscal
1996 as a result of an increase in the number of wells requiring cleanout and
workover operations. These operations are conducted on an as-needed basis and,
accordingly, costs incurred by the Company may vary from year to year.
Production costs also increased in fiscal 1997 as the result of the
acquisition of interests in 288 wells in Ohio. Production costs decreased
$81,000 (5%) in fiscal 1996 from fiscal 1995, a result of a decrease in the
number of wells requiring cleanout and workover operations.

         Exploration costs increased $26,000 (16%) in fiscal 1997 and
decreased $69,000 (30%) in fiscal 1996 from the previous fiscal periods. The
fiscal 1997 increase was the result of an increase in delay rentals paid on
lease acreage held by the Company. During fiscal 1997, the Company
participated in one successful exploratory well and had lease value
impairments totalling $6,000. The 1996 decrease resulted from a decrease in
delay rentals and impairment of lease costs which resulted from a termination
of certain leases in New York State in fiscal 1995 and reduced costs relating
to dry holes. During fiscal 1996 the Company participated in one exploratory
dry hole and had lease impairments totaling $50,000. During fiscal 1995, the
Company's participation in two exploratory dry holes and lease impairments and
delay rentals totaled $145,000.

         Amortization of oil and gas property costs as a percentage of oil and
gas revenues was 18% in fiscal 1997, 23% in fiscal 1996 and 27% in fiscal
1995. The variance from year to year was directly attributable to changes in
the Company's oil and gas reserve quantities, product prices and fluctuations
in the depletable cost basis of oil and gas properties. See Note 2 to the
Consolidated Financial Statements.


                                      46

<PAGE>



Results of Operations: Other Income (Expense)

Quarter Ended December 31, 1997 Compared to Quarter Ended December 31, 1996

         Interest income increased 786% ($613,000) in the quarter ended
December 31, 1997 as compared to the quarter ended December 31, 1996 as a
result of the substantial increase in the Company's uncommitted cash balances
($69.3 million at the beginning of the first quarter of fiscal 1998 as
compared to $4.2 million at the beginning of the first quarter of fiscal
1997), and the temporary investment of such balances. The Company deployed
$41.2 million of its cash balances during the first quarter of fiscal 1998
primarily in its real estate finance and equipment leasing operations,
reducing its cash balance to $28.1 million at the end of the first quarter of
fiscal 1998.

         General and administrative expense increased 57% ($335,000) in the
quarter ended December 31, 1997, as compared to the quarter ended December 31,
1996, primarily as a result of the payment of compensation and benefits to
executive officers and occupancy costs.

         Interest expense increased to $3.9 million in the first quarter of
fiscal 1998 from $409,000 in the first quarter of fiscal 1997, an increase of
$3.5 million (846%) reflecting the increase in borrowings to fund the growth
of the Company's real estate finance and equipment leasing operations. In July
1997, the Company issued $115.0 million of Senior Notes.

         The effective tax rate increased to 31% in the quarter ended December
31, 1997 from 20% in the quarter ended December 31, 1996 based upon the
Company's anticipated earnings and stability in the amount of the Company's
depletion, tax credits and tax exempt interest.

Year Ended September 30, 1997 Compared to Year Ended September 30, 1996 and Year
Ended September 30, 1995

         General and administrative expense increased by $1.1 million (62%)
for fiscal 1997 as compared to fiscal 1996 primarily as a result of costs
associated with the Company's residential mortgage loan business, higher legal
and professional fees and the payment of incentive and retirement compensation
to executive officers. General and administrative expense decreased $509,000
(22%) for the year ended September 30, 1996 as compared to the same period in
fiscal 1995 primarily as a result of a decrease in executive compensation due
to the death of a senior officer in July 1995 and the reclassification of
wages which were previously in general and administrative expense to real
estate finance expense.

         Interest expense increased to $5.3 million in fiscal 1997 from
$872,000 in fiscal 1996, an increase of $4.4 million (505%), reflecting
increased borrowing to fund the growth of the Company's real estate finance
and small ticket leasing operations. In July 1997, the Company issued $115
million of the Senior Notes and in December 1996, the Company incurred
purchase money financing of $13.4 million to fund the acquisition of a series
of mortgage loans on a property located in Philadelphia, Pennsylvania (see
Note 6 to Consolidated

                                      47

<PAGE>



Financial Statements). The purchase money financing was repaid in July 1997.
Interest expense decreased $219,000 during fiscal 1996 as a result of a
decrease in average debt outstanding during the period due to loan repayments.

         The effective tax rate decreased to 27% in fiscal 1997 from 30% in
fiscal 1996 which increased from 19% in fiscal 1995. The fiscal 1997 decrease
resulted from the purchase of commercial mortgage loans which generate tax
exempt interest as well as the investment in several low-income housing
partnerships and the low income housing tax credits associated with such
investments. The increase from fiscal 1995 to fiscal 1996 was the result of a
continuing decrease in the generation of depletion (for tax purposes) and tax
credits in relation to net income.

Liquidity and Capital Resources

         The Company's primary liquidity needs are for continued expansion of
its real estate finance and small ticket leasing subsidiaries, activities that
are the core of the Company's growth strategy. The Company will add to its
commercial mortgage loan acquisition and resolution loan portfolio as
economically attractive opportunities become available and will also continue
to originate residential loans. In addition, it expects substantial ongoing
growth in its small ticket leasing activities. In energy, the Company is
seeking to increase its reserve base through selective acquisition of
producing properties and other assets and further development of its mineral
interests. The Company from time to time may also consider acquisitions of
energy industry companies.

         Thus far, the Company has been able to finance each of these
activities through a variety of sources, including internally generated funds,
borrowings, the sales of its notes and Common Stock. See "Business - Sources
of Funds." The Company expects to finance future activities in a similar
manner.

Quarter Ended December 31, 1997 Compared to Quarter Ended December 31, 1996

         Sources and (uses) of cash for the quarters ended December 31, 1997
and 1996 were as follows:

                                                     Quarter Ended December 31,
                                                     --------------------------
                                                        1997              1996
                                                     ----------        --------
                                                           (in thousands)

         Provided by (used in) operations.........      $(2,643)       $ 2,840
         (Used in) investing activities...........      (41,431)       (32,559)
         Provided by financing activities.........        2,881         32,886
                                                       --------        -------
                                                       $(41,193)       $ 3,167
                                                       ========        =======


                                      48

<PAGE>



         The Company had $28.1 million in cash and cash equivalents on hand at
December 31, 1997, as compared to $69.3 million at September 30, 1997. The
Company's ratio of current assets to current liabilities was 2.1 to 1 at
December 31, 1997 and 6.7 to 1 at September 30, 1997. Working capital at
December 31, 1997 was $17.7 million as compared to $61.4 million at September
30, 1997. The Company's ratio of earnings to fixed charges was 2.5 to 1 in the
quarter ended December 31, 1997 as compared to 8.0 to 1 in the quarter ended
December 31, 1996.

         Cash used in operating activities in the first quarter of fiscal 1998
increased $5.5 million as compared to the first quarter of fiscal 1997
primarily as a result of an increase in accounts receivable including fees
earned and advances made to RAIT and the sale of a senior lien interest for an
interest bearing note.

         The Company's cash used in investing activities increased $8.9
million in the first quarter of fiscal 1998 as compared to the first quarter
of fiscal 1997. This increase resulted primarily from an increase in the
amount of cash used to fund real estate finance and small ticket leasing
activities. In commercial mortgage loan acquisition and resolution, the
Company invested $63.5 million and $27.9 million in the acquisition or
origination of five and four loans in the first quarters of fiscal years 1998
and 1997, respectively. In addition, the Company advanced funds on existing
commercial mortgage loans of $2.0 million and $1.0 million, respectively, in
the same periods. Proceeds received upon refinancings or sales of senior lien
interests amounted to $39.6 million and $2.2 million in the first quarters of
fiscal years 1998 and 1997, respectively. These proceeds reflect the sale of
senior lien interests in or refinancing of six and three loans, respectively,
for which gains were recognized on five and one loans, respectively.

         The Company invested $14.5 million in 300 residential mortgage loans
during the quarter ended December 31, 1997. The Company sold 234 of these
loans for $12.6 million, of which $4.3 million was in cash and $8.3 million
was by a promissory note (with a book value of $8.1 million) of which $6.2
million was paid in the second quarter of fiscal 1998 with the balance of $2.1
million being payable in 2027. See "Risk Factors - Real Finance Considerations
- - Note Received in Sale of Certain Residential Loans."

         In small ticket leasing, cost of equipment acquired for lease
represents the equipment cost and initial direct costs associated with leasing
operations. Proceeds received upon the sale of equipment lease receivables
totaled $12.3 million in the quarter ended December 31, 1997.

         The increase in other assets of $974,000 during the quarter ended
December 31, 1997 principally represents a note of $765,000 from the purchaser
of a loan from the Company.

         The Company's cash flow provided by financing activities decreased
$30.0 million during the first quarter of fiscal 1998 as compared to the first
quarter of fiscal 1997. In the first quarter of fiscal 1998, the Company's
residential mortgage loan business borrowed $6.7

                                      49

<PAGE>



million under its warehouse line and repaid $2.2 million. In the first quarter
of fiscal 1997, the Company completed a public offering of shares of its
common stock, receiving net proceeds of $19.5 million, and borrowed $14.1
million (including $13.4 million of purchase money financing) to finance its
commercial mortgage loan and acquisition operations.

Year Ended September 30, 1997 Compared to Year Ended September 30, 1996

         The Company raised net proceeds of $19.5 million from its equity
offering and $110.6 million from its offering of Senior Notes during fiscal
1997. These activities, coupled with the Company's increased profitability,
resulted in the Company having $69.3 million in cash and cash equivalents on
hand at September 30, 1997, as compared to $4.2 million at September 30, 1996.
The Company's ratio of current assets to current liabilities was 6.7 to 1.0 at
September 30, 1997 and 3.7 to 1.0 at September 30, 1996. The Company's ratio
of earnings to fixed charges was 3.8 to 1.0 at September 30, 1997 and 9.4 to
1.0 at September 30, 1996. Working capital at September 30, 1997 was $61.4
million as compared to $4.4 million at September 30, 1996, as the Company had
not fully deployed the proceeds from the Senior Notes offering.

         Cash provided by operating activities increased $1.1 million, or 38%,
during fiscal 1997, as compared to fiscal 1996. The fiscal 1997 increase was
primarily the result of an increase in operating income in the commercial
mortgage loan acquisition and resolution and equipment leasing businesses.

         The Company's cash used in investing activities increased $62.1
million in fiscal 1997 as compared to fiscal 1996. The increase resulted
primarily from increases in the amount of cash used to fund commercial
mortgage loan acquisition and resolution activities. The Company invested
$71.7 million and $15.1 million in the acquisition of 18 and nine loans in
fiscal years 1997 and 1996, respectively. In addition, the Company advanced
funds on existing loans of $1.9 million and $2.6 million in fiscal years 1997
and 1996, respectively.

         Proceeds received from the sale of senior lien interests or borrower
refinancings amounted to $16.5 million and $18.5 million in fiscal years 1997
and 1996, respectively. Cash used for capital expenditures increased $694,000,
or 63%, during fiscal year 1997 over fiscal 1996. The 1997 increase includes
$507,000 in capital expenditures relating to the Company's residential
mortgage loan business. During fiscal 1997, the Company invested $1.2 million
in 288 wells, operating rights and pipelines located in Ohio. The cost of
equipment acquired for lease was $34.6 million in fiscal 1997 as compared to
$731,000 in fiscal 1996, an increase of $33.9 million, as a result of the full
year's activity for the small ticket leasing business in fiscal 1997 as
compared to two months activity in fiscal 1996.

         The Company's cash flow provided by financing activities increased
$124.4 million during fiscal 1997, as compared to fiscal 1996 as a result of
the additional borrowings discussed above.


                                      50

<PAGE>



Year Ended September 30, 1996 Compared to Year Ended September 30, 1995

         The Company had $4.2 million in cash and cash equivalents on hand at
September 30, 1996, as compared to $2.5 million at September 30, 1995. The
Company's ratio of current assets to current liabilities was 3.7 to 1.0 at
September 30, 1996 and 3.0 to 1.0 at September 30, 1995. Working capital at
September 30, 1996 was $4.4 million as compared to $2.6 million at September
30, 1995.

         Cash provided by operating activities increased $1.4 million, or 88%
during fiscal 1996, as compared to fiscal 1995. This increase was primarily
the result of an increase in operating income in the commercial mortgage loan
acquisition and resolution and equipment leasing businesses.

         The Company's cash used in investing activities decreased $5.1
million or 83% during fiscal 1996, as compared to fiscal 1995. The change
resulted primarily from changes in the amount of cash used to fund commercial
mortgage loan acquisition and resolution activities. The Company invested
$15.1 million and $13.6 million in the acquisition of nine and seven loans in
fiscal years 1996 and 1995, respectively. In addition, the Company advanced
funds on existing loans of $2.6 million and $1.3 million in fiscal years 1996
and 1995, respectively, and in fiscal 1996 increased its investment in certain
existing loans by $852,000.

         Proceeds received upon refinancings or the sale of senior lien
interests amounted to $18.5 million and $10.2 million in fiscal years 1996 and
1995, respectively. Cash used for capital expenditures increased $280,000, or
34% during fiscal year 1996 over the previous period. This increase includes
$506,000 in capital expenditures relating to the start-up of small ticket
leasing operations. Cost of equipment acquired for lease represents the
equipment cost and initial direct costs associated with the start up of small
ticket leasing operations. The Company commenced leasing operations for its
own account in June 1996 and began to write leases in August 1996.

         Cash flow provided by financing activities decreased $4.6 million
during fiscal 1996, as compared to fiscal 1995. During fiscal 1995, the
Company (i) sold a $2.0 million senior lien interest, (ii) borrowed $2.5
million and (iii) was able to release for corporate investment purposes $4.9
million of restricted cash as a result of the purchase of loans for the
Company's portfolio.

Dividends

         In the quarter ended December 31, 1997 and fiscal years 1997, 1996
and 1995, $470,000, $1.4 million, $757,000 and $161,000 were paid in
dividends, respectively. The Company has paid regular dividends since August
1995.

         The determination of the amount of future cash dividends, if any, to
be declared and paid is in the sole discretion of the Company's Board of
Directors and will depend on the

                                      51

<PAGE>



various factors affecting the Company's financial condition and other matters
the Board of Directors deems relevant.

Inflation and Changes in Prices

         Inflation affects the Company's operating expenses and increases in
those expenses may not be recoverable by increases in finance rates chargeable
by the Company. Inflation also affects interests rates and movements in rates
may adversely affect the Company's profitability.

         The Company's revenues and the value of its oil and gas properties
have been and will continue to be affected by changes in oil and gas prices.
Oil and gas prices are subject to fluctuations which the Company is unable to
control or accurately predict.

Computer Systems and Year 2000 Issue

         The "year 2000 issue" is the result of computer programs being
written using two digits, rather than four digits, to identify the year in a
date field. Any computer programs using such a system, and which have date
sensitive software, will not be able to distinguish between the year 2000 and
the year 1900. This could result in miscalculations or an inability to process
transactions, send invoices or engage in similar normal business activities.

         Based upon a recent assessment by the Company, the Company has in
place year 2000 capable systems for its equipment leasing and residential
mortgage loan operations. For its commercial mortgage loan acquisition and
resolution operations, the Company will be required to purchase year 2000
capable computer software, but believes that its requirements can be met by
commercially available software. The Company has determined that it will be
required to modify and, possibly, replace material portions of the software
relating to its energy operations, and has commenced the remediation process.
With respect to both its commercial mortgage loan acquisition and resolution
operations and its energy operations, the Company anticipates that remediation
will be completed on or before March 31, 1999 and that the aggregate cost of
such remediation will not be material to the Company.

         The Company has made inquiries concerning the year 2000 issue to its
significant suppliers of services and, with respect to its energy operations,
to the two largest purchasers of its products. Based thereon, the Company
believes that it will not be materially adversely impacted by year 2000 issues
pertaining to such entities. However, there can be no assurance that the
systems of third parties will be year 2000 compatible in a timely fashion, or
that failure to achieve compatibility by such entities will not have a
material adverse effect on the Company.



                                      52

<PAGE>


Environmental Regulation

         A continued trend to greater environmental and safety awareness and
increasing environmental regulation has resulted in higher operating costs for
the oil and gas industry and the Company. The Company monitors environmental
and safety laws and believes it is in compliance with such laws and applicable
regulations thereunder. To date, compliance with environmental laws and
regulations has not had a material impact on the Company's capital
expenditures, earnings or competitive position. The Company believes, however,
that environmental and safety costs will increase in the future. There can be
no assurance that compliance with such laws will not, in the future,
materially impact the Company.


                                      53

<PAGE>



                                   BUSINESS

General

         The Company operates a specialty finance business focused on real
estate finance and equipment leasing. The Company was organized as a Delaware
corporation in 1966. For approximately 25 years prior to 1991, the Company was
principally involved in the energy industry and it continues to conduct energy
industry operations, including natural gas and oil production. Since 1991, the
Company's business strategy has focused on locating and developing niche
finance businesses in which the Company can realize attractive returns by
targeting well-defined financial services markets and by developing
specialized skills to service those markets on a cost-effective basis. To
date, the Company has developed two main businesses: real estate finance and
equipment leasing. Within its real estate finance business, the Company has
developed a commercial mortgage loan acquisition and resolution business and a
residential mortgage lending business. The Company has also sponsored RAIT, a
real estate investment trust, and currently owns 15% of RAIT's common shares
of beneficial interest. Within its equipment leasing business, the Company
focuses primarily on small ticket equipment lease financing, although it also
manages five publicly-owned equipment leasing partnerships and has a lease
finance placement and advisory business.

Real Estate Finance

Commercial Mortgage Loan Acquisition and Resolution Strategy

         Identification and Acquisition of Troubled Commercial Mortgage Loans.
The Company believes that the success to date of its commercial mortgage loan
acquisition and resolution business has been due in large part to its ability
to identify and acquire troubled commercial mortgage loans which, due to
operational difficulties at the underlying properties, legal or factual
disputes, or other problems, are unable fully to meet debt service
requirements under the original loan terms and can be acquired at a discount
from the unpaid principal and interest amounts of the loan and the estimated
value of the underlying property. A principal part of this strategy is the
Company's focus on acquiring commercial mortgage loans held by large private
sector financial institutions and other entities at net investments generally
ranging from $1 million to $15 million. Due to the comparatively small size of
these loans relative to a large institution's total portfolio, the lender is
often not able, or willing, to devote the managerial and other resources
necessary to resolve the problems to which the loans are subject, and thus is
sometimes willing to dispose of these loans at prices favorable to the
Company. The Company, which offers to acquire a loan quickly and for immediate
cash, provides a convenient way for an institution to dispose of these loans
and to eliminate future work-out costs. The Company believes that the trend of
consolidation in the banking industry, and the implementation of risk-based
capital rules in the insurance industry, may cause an increase in the amount
of smaller loans available for sale and provide the Company significant
opportunities for growth.


                                      54

<PAGE>



         Efficient Resolution of Loans. The Company believes that a further
aspect of its success to date has been its ability to resolve problems
surrounding loans it has identified for acquisition. The principal element of
this strategy is the cost-effective use of management and third-party
resources to negotiate and resolve disputes concerning a troubled loan or the
property securing it, and to identify and resolve any existing operational or
other problems at the property. To implement this strategy, the Company has
taken advantage of the background and expertise of its management and has
identified third-party subcontractors (such as property managers and legal
counsel) familiar with the types of problems to which smaller commercial
properties may be subject and who have, in the past, provided effective
services to the Company.

         Refinancing or Sale of Senior Lien Interests in Portfolio Loans. The
Company seeks to reduce its invested capital and enhance its returns through
sale, at a profit, of senior lien interests in its loans or through
refinancing of the properties underlying its loans by borrowers. In so doing,
the Company has in the past obtained, and in the future anticipates obtaining,
a return of a substantial portion of its invested capital (and in some cases
has obtained returns of amounts in excess of its invested capital), which it
will typically seek to reinvest in further loans, while maintaining a
significant continuing position in the original loan. See "Business - Real
Estate Finance - Commercial Mortgage Loan Acquisition and Resolution - Sale of
Senior Lien Interests and Refinancings." In addition, the Company has sold and
anticipates further sales of whole loans and senior lien interests to RAIT
(see "Business - Real Estate Finance - Sponsorship of Real Estate Investment
Trust"). The Company's strategic plan contemplates continued growth in its
commercial mortgage loan portfolio, in part through the liquidity provided by
such sales or refinancings.

         Disposition of Loans. In the event a borrower does not repay a loan
when due, the Company will seek to foreclose upon and sell the underlying
property or otherwise liquidate the loan. In appropriate cases and for
appropriate consideration, the Company may agree to forbear from the exercise
of remedies available to it. See "Business - Real Estate Finance Commercial
Mortgage Loan Acquisition and Resolution - Forbearance Agreements" and
"Commercial Mortgage Loan Acquisition and Dissolution - Loan Status."

Market for Commercial Mortgage Loan Acquisition and Resolution Services

         Discounted loans acquired by the Company are, at the time of
acquisition, secured by commercial properties (generally multi-family housing,
office buildings, hotels or single-user retail properties) which, while income
producing, are unable fully to meet debt service requirements of the original
loan terms. The loans are usually acquired from banks, insurance companies,
investment banks, mortgage banks or other similar financial organizations.

         The market for commercial mortgage loan acquisition and resolution
services of the type provided by the Company is, the Company believes,
relatively new. A major impetus to the creation of this market had been the
sale of packages of under-performing and non-performing loans by government
agencies, in particular the Resolution Trust Corporation

                                      55

<PAGE>



("RTC") and Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation ("FDIC"). While the need for
loan acquisition and resolution services by governmental agencies has declined
in recent years (the RTC terminated its loan pool packaging and sales
operations on December 31, 1995, and any RTC assets remaining to be sold at
that time were transferred to the FDIC for sale), the Company believes that a
permanent market for these services is emerging in the private sector as
financial institutions and other entities realize that outside specialists may
be able to resolve troubled loans more cost-efficiently than their internal
staff. Moreover, the sale of loans provides selling institutions with a means
of disposing of under-performing assets, thereby obtaining liquidity and
improving their balance sheets. The trend has been reinforced, management
believes, by consolidation within the banking industry, the implementation of
risk-based capital rules within the insurance industry, and by the
standardization of financing criteria by real estate conduits and other
"securitization" outlets.

Acquisition and Administration Procedures for Commercial Mortgage Loan
Acquisition and Resolution Operations

         Prior to acquiring any commercial mortgage loan, the Company conducts
an acquisition review. This review includes an evaluation of the adequacy of
the loan documentation (for example, the existence and adequacy of notes,
mortgages, collateral assignments of rents and leases, and title policies
ensuring first or other lien positions) and other available information (such
as credit and collateral files). The value of the property securing the loan
is estimated by the Company based upon a recent independent appraisal obtained
by the borrower or seller of the loan, an independent appraisal obtained by
the Company, or upon valuation information obtained by the Company and
thereafter confirmed by an independent appraisal. One or more members of the
Company's management makes an on-site inspection of the property and, where
appropriate, the Company will require further inspections by engineers,
architects or property management consultants. The Company may also retain
environmental consultants to review potential environmental issues. The
Company obtains and reviews available rental, expense, maintenance and other
operational information regarding the property, prepares cash flow and debt
service analyses and reviews all pertinent information relating to any legal
or other disputes to which the property is subject. The amount of the
Company's offer to purchase any such loan is based upon the foregoing
evaluations and analyses.

         The Company generally will not acquire a loan unless (i) current net
cash flow from the property securing the loan is sufficient to yield a cash
return on the Company's investment of not less than 10% per annum; (ii) the
ratio of the Company's initial investment to the appraised value of the
property underlying the loan (generally utilizing an appraisal dated within
one year of acquisition) is less than 80%; (iii) there is the possibility of
either prompt refinancing of the loan by the borrower after acquisition, or
sale by the Company of a senior lien interest, that will result in an enhanced
yield to the Company on its (reduced) funds still outstanding (see "Business -
Real Estate Finance - Commercial Mortgage Loan Acquisition and Resolution:
Sale of Senior Lien Interests and Refinancings"); and (iv) there is the
possibility of a substantial increase in the value of the property underlying
the loan over its

                                      56

<PAGE>



appraised value, increasing the potential amount of the loan discount
recoverable by the Company at loan termination. On occasion, the Company will
acquire a loan that does not meet one or more of the criteria specified above
if, in the Company's judgment, other factors make the loan an appropriate
investment opportunity. The Company currently has in its portfolio 11 loans in
which the ratio of the cost of investment to the appraised value of the
underlying property (both at the time of acquisition and at the date of the
most recent appraisal) exceeds 80%. The Company has a policy that appraisals
of properties underlying loans be updated no less often than every three
years. Also, the Company has acquired loans outside of its targeted net
investment cost range of $1 million to $15 million and, as opportunities
arise, may do so in the future. Five of the Company's portfolio loans were
acquired at a lesser investment cost, while one loan was acquired at a greater
investment cost ($19.2 million). In addition, the Company purchased a loan for
$43.0 million which, as part of the acquisition, was refinanced in the amount
of $35.3 million, reducing the Company's net investment to $7.7 million. The
Company is not limited by regulation or contractual obligation as to the types
of properties that secure the loans it may seek to acquire or the nature or
priority of any lien or other encumbrance it may accept with respect to a
property. The Company also does not have restrictions regarding whether, after
sale of a senior lien interest or a refinancing, its interest in a particular
loan must continue to be secured (although the Company will typically retain a
subordinated lien position), the amount it may invest in any one loan, or the
ratio of initial investment cost-to-appraised value of the underlying
property.

         As part of the acquisition process, the Company typically resolves
disputes relating to the loans or the underlying properties. Through
negotiations with the borrower and, as appropriate or necessary, with other
creditors or parties in interest, the Company seeks to arrive at arrangements
that reflect more closely the current operating conditions of the property and
the present strategic position of the various interested parties. Where
appropriate, the Company will offer concessions to assure that the Company's
future control of the property's cash flow is free from dispute. These
arrangements are normally reflected in an agreement (a "Forbearance
Agreement") pursuant to which foreclosure or other action on the mortgage is
deferred so long as the arrangements reflected in the Forbearance Agreement
are met. The Company also seeks to resolve operational problems of the
properties by appointment of a property manager acceptable to it (see
"Business - Real Estate Finance - Commercial Mortgage Loan Acquisition and
Resolution: Forbearance Agreements") and may advance funds for purposes of
paying property improvement costs, unpaid taxes and similar items. Prior to
loan acquisition, the Company includes in its pre-acquisition analysis of loan
costs and yields an estimate of such advances. See "Management's Discussion
and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations - Results of
Operations - Commercial Mortgage Loan Acquisition and Resolution."

          Upon acquisition of a loan, the Company typically requires that all
revenues from the property underlying the loan be paid into an operating
account on which the Company or its managing agent is the sole signatory. All
expenditures with respect to a property (including debt service, taxes,
operational expenses and maintenance costs) are paid from the Company's

                                      57

<PAGE>



account and are reviewed and approved by a senior officer of the Company prior
to payment. The Company further requires that its approval be obtained before
any material contract or commercial lease with respect to the property is
executed. To assist it in monitoring the loan, the Company requires that the
borrower prepare a budget for the property not less than 60 days prior to the
beginning of a year, which must be reviewed and approved by the Company, and
submit both a monthly cash flow statement and a monthly occupancy report. The
Company analyzes these reports in comparison with each other and with account
activity in the operating account.

         The Company may alter the foregoing procedures in appropriate
circumstances. Where a borrower has refinanced a loan held by the Company (or
where the Company has acquired a loan subject to existing senior debt), the
Company may agree that the revenues be paid to an account controlled by the
senior lienor, with the excess over amounts payable to the senior lienor being
paid directly to the Company. Where the property is being managed by
Brandywine Construction & Management, Inc. ("BCMI"), a property manager
affiliated with the Company (see "Business - Real Estate Finance - Commercial
Mortgage Loan Acquisition and Resolution: Forbearance Agreements"and
"Management - Certain Relationships and Related Party Transactions"), the
Company may direct that property revenues be paid to BCMI, as the Company's
managing agent. As of December 31, 1997, revenues are being paid to BCMI with
respect to two loans (loans 25 and 30). Where the Company believes that
operating problems with respect to an underlying property have been
substantially resolved, the Company may permit the borrower to retain revenues
and pay property expenses directly. The Company currently permits borrowers
with respect to four loans (loans 24, 27, 37 and 41) to do so. (Loan number
designations correspond to the designations set forth in the table included as
part of "Business - Real Estate Finance - Commercial Mortgage Loan Acquisition
and Resolution - Loan Status.")

Commercial Mortgage Loan Acquisition and Resolution: Sale of Senior Lien
Interests and Refinancings

         In evaluating a potential commercial mortgage loan, the Company
places significant emphasis on the likelihood of its being able to sell a
senior lien interest on favorable terms after the acquisition and/or the
borrower's likely ability, with or without the Company's assistance, to secure
favorable refinancing. When a loan is refinanced, or a senior lien interest
sold, the Company will obtain net sale or refinance proceeds in an amount
representing a major portion of (and sometimes exceeding) the amount of its
investment in the loan. After sale of a senior lien interest or refinancing,
the Company will typically retain an interest in the loan, which is usually
subordinated to the interest of the senior lienholder or refinance lender.

         Where a senior lien interest is sold, the outstanding balance of the
Company's loan at the time of sale remains outstanding, including as a part of
that balance the amount of the senior lien interest. Thus, the Company's
remaining interest effectively "wraps around" the senior lien interest.
Typically, the interest rate on the senior lien interest is less than the

                                      58

<PAGE>



stated rate on the Company's loan. Senior lien interests with an aggregate
balance of $12 million at December 31, 1997, relating to seven of the
Company's loans, obligate the Company, in the event of a default on a loan, to
replace such loan with a performing loan. These senior lien interests become
due upon the expiration of their respective Forbearance Agreements (one in
1999, three in 2000, two in 2001 and one in 2016). Two other senior lien
interests obligate the Company, upon their respective maturities (all in
fiscal 2002) to repurchase the senior lien interest (if not theretofore paid
off) at a price equal to the outstanding balance of the senior lien interest
plus accrued interest ($1.6 million and $7.3 million, respectively, assuming
all debt service payments have been made). See "Business - Real Estate Finance
- - Commercial Mortgage Loan Acquisition and Resolution: Loan Status."

         Where a refinancing is effectuated, the Company reduces the amount
outstanding on its loan by the amount of net refinancing proceeds received by
it and either converts the outstanding balance of the original note (both
principal and accrued interest, as well as accrued penalties) into the stated
principal amount of an amended note on the same terms as the original note, or
retains the original loan obligation as paid down by the amount of refinance
proceeds received by the Company. As with senior lien interests, the interest
rate on the refinancing is typically less than the interest rate on the
Company's retained interest.

         After sale of a senior lien interest or a refinancing, the Company's
retained interest will usually be secured by a subordinate lien on the
property. In certain situations, however, (including seven loans aggregating
$7.7 million and constituting 6.6%, by book value, of the Company's loans),
the Company's retained interest may not be formally secured by a mortgage
because of conditions imposed by the senior lender, although it may be
protected by a judgment lien, an unrecorded deed-in-lieu of foreclosure, the
borrower's covenant not to further encumber the property without the Company's
consent, and/or a similar device.

Commercial Mortgage Loan Acquisition and Resolution: Forbearance Agreements

         Substantially all of the commercial mortgage loans acquired by the
Company are subject to Forbearance Agreements with borrowers pursuant to which
the holder of the loan (the Company, upon loan acquisition) (i) agrees,
subject to receipt of specified minimum monthly payments, to defer the
exercise of existing rights to proceed on the defaulted loan (including the
right to foreclose), (ii) receives the rents from the underlying property
(either directly or through a managing agent approved by the Company, subject
to certain exceptions; see "Business - Real Estate Finance - Acquisition and
Administration Procedures for Commercial Loan Acquisition and Resolution
Operations") and (iii) requires the borrower to retain a property management
firm acceptable to the holder. The Forbearance Agreements also provide that
any cash flow from the property (after payment of Company-approved expenses
and debt service on senior lien interests) above the minimum payments will be
retained by the Company and applied to accrued but unpaid debt service on the
loan. As a result of provision (iii), BCMI has assumed responsibility for
supervisory and, in many cases, day to day management of the underlying
properties with respect to substantially all of the loans the Company
currently owns. In ten instances, the President of BCMI (or an entity

                                      59

<PAGE>



affiliated with him) has also acted as the general partner or trustee of the
borrower; an entity affiliated with him is also the general partner of the
sole limited partner of an eleventh borrower. See "Management - Certain
Relationships and Related Party Transactions - Relationship with BCMI." The
minimum payments required under a Forbearance Agreement (generally related to
anticipated cash flow from the property after operating expenses) are normally
materially less than the debt service payments called for by the original
terms of the loan. The difference between the minimum required payments under
the Forbearance Agreement and the payments called for by the original loan
terms continues to accrue, but (except for amounts recognized as an accretion
of discount; see "Business - Real Estate Finance - Commercial Mortgage Loan
Acquisition and Resolution: Accounting for Discounted Loans") are not
recognized as revenue to the Company until actually paid.

         At the end of the term of a Forbearance Agreement, the borrower is
required to pay the loan in full. The borrower's ability to do so, however,
will be dependent upon a number of factors, including prevailing conditions at
the underlying property, the state of real estate and financial markets
(generally and as regards the particular property), and general economic
conditions. In the event the borrower does not or cannot do so, the Company
anticipates that it will seek to sell the property underlying the loan or
otherwise liquidate the loan. Alternatively, the Company anticipates that it
might, in appropriate cases, and for appropriate additional consideration,
agree to further forbearance.

         An existing Forbearance Agreement remains in effect without
modification when the Company sells a senior lien interest in a loan. In such
instance, the purchaser's interest in the loan is subject to the terms of the
Forbearance Agreement. However, when a borrower refinances a loan, the
Forbearance Agreement is amended to (i) reflect the pay down of the loan
balance, (ii) acknowledge the existence of the refinancing and (iii) provide
for the continued effectiveness of all provisions of the Forbearance Agreement
for a term specified except that where specific provisions of the Forbearance
Agreement are inconsistent with the terms of the refinancing, the terms of the
refinancing have priority. In some refinancings, the refinance lender may
require that the borrower issue an amended note (a "retained interest note")
to reflect the reduction of the borrower's indebtedness to the Company and,
where applicable, any other revised terms.

Commercial Mortgage Loan Acquisition and Resolution: Loan Status

         At December 31, 1997, the Company's loan portfolio consisted of 43
loans of which 33 loans were acquired as first mortgage liens and 10 loans
were acquired as junior lien obligations. The Company's strategy has been to
acquire loans in anticipation of selling a senior lien interest in the loan or
in anticipation of the borrower's refinancing of the loan. The Company has
sold senior lien interests in 14 loans in its portfolio (including senior
interests in six loans initially acquired by the Company as junior lien loans)
and borrowers with respect to 12 of the Company's loans obtained refinancing.
After such sales and refinancings, the Company holds subordinated interests in
30 loans of which seven interests, constituting approximately 6.6% of the book
value of the Company's loan portfolio, are not

                                      60

<PAGE>



collateralized by recorded mortgages (see "Business - Real Estate Finance -
Commercial Mortgage Loan Acquisition and Resolution: Sale of Senior Lien
Interests and Refinancings").

         During the second quarter of fiscal 1998, the Company sold 10 of its
loans, and senior lien interests in two loans, to RAIT as indicated by Note
(9) to the following table. For certain information regarding this sale see
"Business - Real Estate Finance - Sponsorship of Real Estate Investment
Trust."

                                      61

<PAGE>
         The following table sets forth certain information relating to the
Company's investments in commercial mortgage loans as of December 31, 1997.
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                           Loan           Outstanding
 Loan        Type of                                                                     Acquired           Loan          
Number       Property            Location          Seller/Originator                   (Fiscal Year)     Receivable(1)    
- ------       --------            --------          -----------------                   -------------     -------------    
<S>         <C>               <C>                 <C>                                   <C>          <C>                  
 001        Multifamily       Pennsylvania        Alpha Petroleum Pension Fund             1991         $  8,537,276      
 002(9)     Multifamily       Pennsylvania        CoreStates Bank(10)                      1992            1,579,496      
 003        Multifamily       New Jersey          RAM Enterprises/Glenn Industries         1993            2,737,559      
                                                    Pension Plan
 004(9)     Multifamily       Pennsylvania        St. Paul Federal Bank for Savings(12)    1993            1,486,601      
 005        Office            Pennsylvania        Shawmut Bank(10)                         1993            6,408,289      
 006(9)     Office/Retail     Virginia            Nationsbank(10)                          1993            5,804,115      
 007        Single User       Minnesota           Prudential Insurance, Alpha              1993            5,050,886      
             (Retail)                               Petroleum Pension Fund
 008(9)     Multifamily       Pennsylvania        Nomura/Cargill/Eastdil Realty(14)        1994            5,394,281      
 009(9)     Multifamily       Pennsylvania        Mellon Bank(10)                          1995            1,640,973      
 010(9)     Multifamily       Pennsylvania        RIVA Financial                           1994            1,600,713      
 011        Office            Washington, D.C.    First Union Bank(10)                     1995            1,427,447      
 012(9)     Multifamily       Pennsylvania        CoreStates Bank(10)(12)                  1995            3,037,884      
 013        Single User       California          California Federal Bank, FSB             1994            2,969,853      
             (Commercial)
 014        Office            Washington, D.C.    Nomura/Cargill/Eastdil Realty(14)        1995           14,977,664      
 015        Condo/            North Carolina      First Bank/South Trust Bank(15)          1995/1997       3,553,137      
             Multifamily
 016        Single User       California          Mass Mutual/Alpha Petroleum              1995/1996       6,992,873      
             (Retail)                              Pension Fund
 017        Single User       West Virginia       Triester Investments(10)(16)             1996            1,453,966      
             (Retail)
 018        Single User       California          Emigrant Savings Bank/Walter             1996            2,835,687      
             (Retail)                               R. Samuels and Jay Furman(19)
 019(9)     Multifamily       Pennsylvania        Summit Bancorp(10)                       1996            4,675,262      
 020        Office            New Jersey          Cargill/Eastdil Realty(13)               1996            7,114,661      
 021        Multifamily       Pennsylvania        Bruin Holdings/Berkeley Federal          1996/1997       9,260,609      
                                                   Savings Bank
 022        Multifamily       Pennsylvania        FirsTrust FSB                            1996            4,655,151      
 023(9)     Multifamily       Pennsylvania        Jefferson Bank                           1996              718,848 (24) 
 024        Multifamily       Pennsylvania        U.S. Dept. of Housing & Urban
                                                    Development                            1996            3,427,028      
</TABLE>
                               RESTUBBED TABLE
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                         Appraised Value
 Loan        Type of                                                                       of Property         Cost of
Number       Property            Location          Seller/Originator                      Securing Loan(2)   Investment(3)
- ------       --------            --------          -----------------                     -----------------   -------------
<S>         <C>               <C>                 <C>                                  <C>                <C>        
 001        Multifamily       Pennsylvania        Alpha Petroleum Pension Fund            $  5,300,000       $ 4,704,540
 002(9)     Multifamily       Pennsylvania        CoreStates Bank(10)                          900,000           547,813
 003        Multifamily       New Jersey          RAM Enterprises/Glenn Industries           1,350,000         1,325,081
                                                    Pension Plan
 004(9)     Multifamily       Pennsylvania        St. Paul Federal Bank for Savings(12)      1,200,000           862,356
 005        Office            Pennsylvania        Shawmut Bank(10)                           1,700,000         1,229,417
 006(9)     Office/Retail     Virginia            Nationsbank(10)                            2,800,000         2,391,040
 007        Single User       Minnesota           Prudential Insurance, Alpha                2,515,000         1,354,382
             (Retail)                               Petroleum Pension Fund
 008(9)     Multifamily       Pennsylvania        Nomura/Cargill/Eastdil Realty(14)          3,200,000         1,614,174
 009(9)     Multifamily       Pennsylvania        Mellon Bank(10)                            2,700,000         1,393,031
 010(9)     Multifamily       Pennsylvania        RIVA Financial                               800,000           457,356
 011        Office            Washington, D.C.    First Union Bank(10)                       2,000,000         1,180,030
 012(9)     Multifamily       Pennsylvania        CoreStates Bank(10)(12)                    2,200,000         1,296,565
 013        Single User       California          California Federal Bank, FSB               2,400,000         1,694,799
             (Commercial)
 014        Office            Washington, D.C.    Nomura/Cargill/Eastdil Realty(14)         12,250,000        10,571,763
 015        Condo/            North Carolina      First Bank/South Trust Bank(15)            3,702,000         2,787,774
             Multifamily
 016        Single User       California          Mass Mutual/Alpha Petroleum                3,000,000         2,114,520
             (Retail)                              Pension Fund
 017        Single User       West Virginia       Triester Investments(10)(16)               1,900,000           895,113
             (Retail)
 018        Single User       California          Emigrant Savings Bank/Walter               4,555,000         2,227,199
             (Retail)                               R. Samuels and Jay Furman(19)
 019(9)     Multifamily       Pennsylvania        Summit Bancorp(10)                         5,725,000         3,758,685
 020        Office            New Jersey          Cargill/Eastdil Realty(13)                 4,600,000         3,225,589
 021        Multifamily       Pennsylvania        Bruin Holdings/Berkeley Federal            4,222,000         2,454,437
                                                   Savings Bank
 022        Multifamily       Pennsylvania        FirsTrust FSB                              4,110,000         4,016,498
 023(9)     Multifamily       Pennsylvania        Jefferson Bank                               600,000           480,643
 024        Multifamily       Pennsylvania        U.S. Dept. of Housing & Urban
                                                    Development                              3,250,000         2,740,093
</TABLE>
                                      62
<PAGE>
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                           Loan          Outstanding      
 Loan        Type of                                                                     Acquired           Loan          
Number       Property            Location          Seller/Originator                   (Fiscal Year)     Receivable(1)    
- ------       --------            --------          -----------------                   -------------     -------------    

<S>         <C>               <C>                 <C>                                    <C>          <C>                 
 025        Hotel/Commercial  Georgia             Bankers Trust Co.                        1997         $  5,975,639      
 026        Office            Pennsylvania        FirsTrust FSB/The Metropolitan Fund      1997            8,498,640      
 027(9)     Office            Pennsylvania        Lehman Brothers Holdings, Inc.           1997           53,183,775      
 028        Condo/            North Carolina      First Bank/SouthTrust Bank(27)           1997            1,703,755      
             Multifamily
 029        Commercial/       Pennsylvania        Castine Associates, L.P.(28)             1997            7,127,386      
             Retail
 030        Hotel             Nebraska            CNA Insurance                            1997            7,274,234      
 031        Multifamily       Connecticut         John Hancock Mutual Life                 1997           10,024,031      
                                                   Insurance Company
 032        Multifamily       New Jersey          John Hancock Mutual Life                 1997           12,260,126      
                                                   Insurance Company
 033        Single User       Virginia            Brambilla, Ltd.                          1997            4,015,686      
             (Retail)
 034        Multifamily       Pennsylvania        Resource America, Inc.(29)               1997              398,697      
 035        Office            Pennsylvania        Jefferson Bank                           1997            2,331,275      
 036        Office            North Carolina      Union Labor Life Insurance Co.           1997            4,514,732      
 037        Multifamily       Florida             Howe, Soloman & Hall                     1997            6,998,319      
                                                   Financial, Inc.
 038(9)     Office/Retail     Pennsylvania        Resource Asset Investment Trust(30)      1997            8,351,314      
 039        Hotel             Georgia             Resource America, Inc.(29)               1998              342,691  (31)
 040        Retail            Virginia            Lehman Brothers Holdings                 1998           45,005,722      
 041        Multifamily       Connecticut         J.E. Roberts Companies                   1998           26,695,085      
 042        Multifamily       Pennsylvania        Fannie Mae(33)                           1998            4,290,337      
 043        Multifamily       Pennsylvania        Downingtown National Bank/D, Ltd.        1998            1,957,557  (34)
                                                                                                        ------------      
                                                  Balance as of December 31, 1997                       $318,289,260      
                                                                                                        ============      
</TABLE>
                               RESTUBBED TABLE

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                         Appraised Value
 Loan        Type of                                                                       of Property         Cost of
Number       Property            Location          Seller/Originator                      Securing Loan(2)   Investment(3)
- ------       --------            --------          -----------------                     -----------------   -------------

<S>         <C>               <C>                 <C>                                   <C>                <C>        
 025        Hotel/Commercial  Georgia             Bankers Trust Co.                       $  8,500,000       $ 5,877,874
 026        Office            Pennsylvania        FirsTrust FSB/The Metropolitan Fund        5,000,000         2,484,966
 027(9)     Office            Pennsylvania        Lehman Brothers Holdings, Inc.            34,000,000        19,243,749
 028        Condo/            North Carolina      First Bank/SouthTrust Bank(27)             1,773,000         1,028,143
             Multifamily
 029        Commercial/       Pennsylvania        Castine Associates, L.P.(28)               4,025,000         2,986,618
             Retail
 030        Hotel             Nebraska            CNA Insurance                              4,000,000         3,673,462
 031        Multifamily       Connecticut         John Hancock Mutual Life                   7,500,000         4,760,894
                                                   Insurance Company
 032        Multifamily       New Jersey          John Hancock Mutual Life                  12,425,000         7,374,894
                                                   Insurance Company
 033        Single User       Virginia            Brambilla, Ltd.                            2,650,000         2,003,684
             (Retail)
 034        Multifamily       Pennsylvania        Resource America, Inc.(29)                   450,000           400,000
 035        Office            Pennsylvania        Jefferson Bank                             2,550,000         1,591,662
 036        Office            North Carolina      Union Labor Life Insurance Co.             4,150,000         3,053,846
 037        Multifamily       Florida             Howe, Soloman & Hall                       3,500,000         2,772,641
                                                   Financial, Inc.
 038(9)     Office/Retail     Pennsylvania        Resource Asset Investment Trust(30)       10,600,000         8,580,000
 039        Hotel             Georgia             Resource America, Inc.(29)                 4,100,000           338,633
 040        Retail            Virginia            Lehman Brothers Holdings                  47,000,000        43,154,886
 041        Multifamily       Connecticut         J.E. Roberts Companies                    18,500,000  (32)  14,546,344
 042        Multifamily       Pennsylvania        Fannie Mae(33)                             5,000,000  (32)   4,234,556
 043        Multifamily       Pennsylvania        Downingtown National Bank/D, Ltd.          2,275,000         1,518,188
                                                                                          ------------      ------------
                                                  Balance as of December 31, 1997         $254,977,000      $184,947,938
                                                                                          ============      ============
</TABLE>



                                      63

<PAGE>
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                    Proceeds from                                             Company's Net       Maturity of Loan/
            Ratio of Cost       Refinancing or                                                 Interest In         Expiration of
 Loan     of Investment to      Sale of Senior             Net           Book Value         Outstanding Loan         Forbearance
Number    Appraised Value       Lien Interests        Investment(4)    of Investment(5)        Receivables(6)        Agreement(7)
- ------    ---------------       --------------        -------------    ----------------        --------------       ----------------

<S>               <C>           <C>                  <C>                 <C>                  <C>                     <C>      
 001              89%           $ 2,570,000 (8)      $  2,134,540        $ 2,580,970          $ 5,967,276             12/31/02
 002              61%                     0 (11)          547,813            785,295            1,579,496             10/31/98
 003              98%               627,000               698,081            731,656            2,103,068             01/01/03

 004              72%                     0 (11)          862,356          1,134,958            1,486,601             10/31/98
 005              72%               940,000 (13)          289,417            784,776            5,568,289             02/07/01
 006              85%               840,000             1,551,040          1,670,669            4,928,075             07/31/98
 007              54%             2,099,000              (744,618)           567,169            2,919,116             12/31/14

 008              50%               934,300               679,874          1,270,541            4,296,133             07/31/98
 009              52%               654,600               738,431            564,876              755,711             11/01/99
 010              57%                     0 (11)          457,356            734,073            1,600,713             09/02/99
 011              59%               660,000 (13)          520,030            685,655              742,447             09/30/99
 012              59%             1,079,000               217,565            747,650            1,781,319             12/02/99
 013              71%             1,975,000 (13)         (280,201)           325,972              969,853             05/01/01

 014              86%             6,487,000             4,084,763          5,472,297            8,299,802             11/30/98
 015              75%             2,558,000 (8)           229,774          3,553,137            1,218,418             08/25/00

 016              70%             2,375,000 (13)         (260,480)           481,117            4,592,873             12/31/00

 017              47%             1,000,000 (17)(18)     (104,887)           465,347              453,966             12/31/16

 018              49%             1,969,000 (13)          258,199            833,952              866,687             12/01/00

 019              66%             3,020,000               738,685            992,855            1,496,823             12/29/00
 020              70%             2,562,000               663,589          1,878,059            4,715,532             02/07/01
 021              58%             2,760,000 (20)         (305,563)         1,034,292            6,500,609                     (21)

 022              98%             2,636,000 (22)(23)    1,380,498            995,483            1,992,593             10/31/98
 023              80%               450,000 (25)           30,643            128,642              271,107             03/28/01
 024              84%             2,318,750               421,343            814,710              933,181             11/01/22
</TABLE>

                                      64

<PAGE>

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>


                                                    (Continued)

                                Proceeds from                                                Company's Net        Maturity of Loan/
            Ratio of Cost       Refinancing or                                                  Interest In        Expiration of
 Loan     of Investment to      Sale of Senior             Net           Book Value         Outstanding Loan        Forbearance
Number    Appraised Value       Lien Interests        Investment(4)    of Investment(5)        Receivables(6)       Agreement(7)
- ------    ---------------       --------------        -------------    ----------------        --------------       ---------------

<S>               <C>          <C>                    <C>                <C>                  <C>                     <C>   
 025              69%          $          0           $ 5,877,874        $ 6,102,863          $ 5,975,639             12/31/15
 026              50%             2,240,000 (26)          244,966          2,372,008            6,257,369             09/30/03
 027              57%             7,920,000 (22)       11,323,749         17,253,179           45,209,204             01/01/02
 028              58%                     0             1,028,143          1,703,755            1,703,755             03/31/02
 029              74%             1,000,000 (17)        1,986,618          2,312,861            6,127,386             07/01/02

 030              92%                     0             3,673,462          3,740,136            7,274,234             09/30/02
 031              63%                     0             4,760,894          4,951,443           10,024,031             09/01/05

 032              59%                     0             7,374,894          7,464,646           12,260,126             09/01/05

 033              76%             1,383,705 (8)           619,979            633,604            2,653,184             02/01/21

 034              89%                     0               400,000            398,422              398,697             10/01/02

 035              62%             1,000,000 (17)          591,662            928,445            1,331,275             09/25/02
 036              74%                     0             3,053,846          3,110,677            4,514,732             12/31/11
 037              79%             2,096,000 (11)(13)      676,641          1,162,202            4,902,319             07/01/00
 038              81%                     0             8,580,000          8,351,314            8,351,314             12/31/02
 039               8%                     0               338,633            201,155              342,691             11/30/02
 040              92%            35,250,000 (8)         7,904,886          8,081,017            9,806,748             12/01/02
 041              79%                     0            14,546,344         14,426,655           26,695,085             06/30/03
 042              85%                     0             4,234,556          4,262,517            4,290,337             12/31/02
 043              67%             1,000,000 (35)          518,188            803,012              957,557             12/17/02
                                -----------           -----------        -----------        -------------
Balance as of December
 31, 1997                       $92,404,355           $92,543,583       $117,494,062         $225,115,371
                                ===========           ===========       ============         ============
</TABLE>


                                      65

<PAGE>

(1)    Consists of the stated or face value of the obligation plus accrued
       interest and the amount of the senior lien interest at December 31,
       1997.
(2)    The Company generally obtains appraisals on each of its properties at
       least once every three years. Accordingly, appraisal dates range from
       1994 to 1997.
(3)    Consists of the original cost of the investment to the Company
       (including acquisition costs and the amount of any senior lien interest
       to which the property remained subject) plus subsequent advances, but
       excludes the proceeds to the Company from the sale of senior lien
       interests or borrower refinancings.
(4)    Represents the unrecovered costs of the Company's calculated
       investment, calculated as the cash investment made in acquiring the
       loan plus subsequent advances less cash received from sale of a senior
       lien interest in or borrower refinancing of the loan. Negative amounts
       represent the receipt by the Company of proceeds from the sale of
       senior lien interests or borrower refinancings in excess of the
       Company's investment.
(5)    Represents the cost of the investment carried on the books of the
       Company after accretion of discount and allocation of gains from the
       sale of a senior lien interest in, or borrower refinancing of the loan
       but excludes an allowance for possible losses of $452,000. For a
       discussion of accretion on discount and allocation of gains, see
       "- Commercial Mortgage Loan Acquisition and Resolution: Accounting for
       Discounted Loans."
(6)    Consists of the amount set forth in the column "Outstanding Loan
       Receivable" less senior lien interests at December 31, 1997 (excluding
       one senior lien interest of $2,334,719 which is included in the cost of
       investment carried on the books of the Company relating to loan 15).
(7)    With respect to loans 6, 7, 8, 14, 25, 27, 30, 31, 32, 34, 35, 38 and
       39, the date given is for the maturity of the Company's interest in the
       loan. For loan 43, the date given is the expiration date of the
       Forbearance Agreement with respect to the loan in the original
       principal amount of $404,026 (see note (34) below). For the remaining
       loans, the date given is the expiration date of the related Forbearance
       Agreement.
(8)    Represents the amount of the senior lien in place on date of
       acquisition, except that, with respect to loan 40, it represents the
       amount of a senior lien interest sold contemporaneously with the
       Company's investment.
(9)    Loans 2, 4, 6, 8, 9, 10, 12, 19, 23, and one of the four loans (in the
       amount of $900,000) comprising loan 38 were sold to RAIT on January 23,
       1998 (see note (30) below). In addition, senior lien interests in loans
       27 and 38 were sold to RAIT on January 23, 1998. See "- Sponsorship of
       Real Estate Investment Trust."
(10)   Successor by merger to the Seller.
(11)   In December 1997, senior lien interests in loans 2, 4 and 10 were
       transferred to loan 37. (12) Seller was a wholly-owned subsidiary of
       this institution. (13) Senior lien interest sold subject to the right
       of the holder (Citation Insurance Company, a subsidiary of Physicians
       Insurance Company of Ohio), upon default, to require the Company to
       substitute a performing loan.
(14)   Seller was a partnership of these entities.
(15)   Original lending institutions. In March 1997, as a result of agreements
       among the borrower, the Company and a third party, Concord Investment,
       L.P. ("Concord"), the

                                      66

<PAGE>



       borrower's partnership interests were transferred to the Company which
       resold them to Concord for a mortgage note (which wrapped around
       certain senior indebtedness) and cash.
(16)   The loan acquired consists of a series of notes becoming due yearly
       through December 31, 2016. The notes are being paid in accordance with
       their terms and, accordingly, a Forbearance Agreement was not required.
(17)   Senior lien interest sold to Peoples Thrift Savings Bank. (18) Original
       senior lien interest repaid by the Company in December 1997. (19) Amounts
       advanced by the Company were used in part to directly repay the loan of
       Emigrant Savings Bank; the balance was applied to purchase a note held by
       Messrs. Samuels and Furman.
(20)   Senior lien interest sold to People's Thrift Savings Bank in 17 
       individual condominium units in a single building.
(21)   The loan acquired consists of 31 separate mortgage loans on 49
       individual condominium units in a single building. Nine of such loans
       are due July 1, 2016, eighteen are due January 1, 2015, one is due
       October 1, 2007, one is due March 1, 2001 and two are due October 9,
       2001.
(22)   Two senior lien interests were sold to Commerce Bank, N.A.
       ("Commerce"), Philadelphia, Pennsylvania. The Company has the
       obligation to repurchase these senior lien interests, at Commerce's
       option, on or after June 27, 2002 (loan 22) and September 29, 2002
       (loan 27), if the senior lien interest is not repaid in accordance with
       its terms by the borrower.
(23)   Junior lien interest sold to Crafts House Apartments Partners, L.P., a
       limited partnership in which officers and directors of the Company
       beneficially own a 21.3% interest.
(24)   Includes a note for $14,948 which is payable to the Company on demand.
(25)   Senior lien interest sold to Crusader Bank. The senior lien interest was
       paid off in connection with the acquisition of this loan by RAIT.
(26)   Senior lien interest sold to CRC-Axewood Partners, L.P., a limited
       partnership in which officers and directors of the Company beneficially
       own an 18.3% interest.
(27)   Original lending institutions. In connection with the transactions
       referred to in Note (14), Concord acquired other condominium units in
       the same building. These units secured a loan in the original principal
       amount of $910,000 held by the Company. As part of that acquisition,
       the Company made an additional mortgage loan to Concord of $797,675.
(28)   From 1993 to October 1997, an officer of the Company served as the
       General Partner. 
(29)   Loan originated by the Company. 
(30)   Consists of three related loans to one borrower secured by two
       properties. A fourth related loan, in the amount of $100,000, was
       repaid in the first quarter of fiscal 1998. The loans were originated
       by RAIT and funded by the Company pending closing of RAIT's public
       offering. Upon completion of that offering in the second quarter of
       fiscal 1998, the Company sold one of the loans (in the principal amount
       of $900,000) and $4.9 million of senior lien interests in the two
       remaining loans to RAIT, at cost. See note (9) above).
(31)   Construction loan with a maximum borrowing of $3,625,000.

                                      67

<PAGE>



(32)   Company's estimate of the value of the property, pending completion of
       appraisal. 
(33)   Original lending institution.
(34)   Consists of two related loans to one borrower secured by a single
       property in the original principal amounts of $1,600,000, due in
       October 2006, and $404,026 which is subject to a Forbearance Agreement
       expiring in December 2002.
(35)   Senior lien interest sold to Washsquare Properties Partners, L.P., a
       limited partnership in which officers and directors of the Company
       beneficially own a 17.8% limited partnership interest.


                                      68

<PAGE>

       The following table sets forth certain information with respect to
monthly cash flow from the properties underlying the Company's commercial
mortgage loans, monthly debt service payable to senior lienholders and
refinance lenders, monthly payments with respect to the Company's retained
interest and the ratio of cash flow from the properties to debt service
payable on senior lien interests. It should be noted that monthly cash flow
for loans 39 through 43 is based upon estimates or historical information
different than the average cash flow for the three months ended December 31,
1997 utilized for all other loans.
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                     Monthly                  Monthly               Debt Service
                      Monthly Cash               Debt Service on             Payment to            Coverage Ratio
 Loan                  Flow from                   Senior Lien              the Company's          on Senior Lien
Number               Property(1)(2)               Interests(3)                Interest                Interests
- ------               --------------               ------------                --------                ---------
<S>                    <C>                            <C>                       <C>                    <C> 
001                    $   41,717                     $ 26,425                  $ 15,292               1.58
002                         6,168                        4,875                     1,293               1.27
003                         6,874                        6,058                       816               1.13
004                        10,949                        7,280                     3,669               1.50
005                        14,643                        6,825                     7,818               2.15
006                        28,504                        8,021                    20,483               3.55
007                        20,400                       20,400                         0               1.00
008                        30,290                       10,670                    19,620               2.84
009                        26,012                        7,359                    18,653               3.53
010                         6,953                        4,875                     2,078               1.43
011                        11,179                        5,566                     5,613               2.01
012                        17,536                       10,317                     7,219               1.70
013                        20,011                       15,833                     4,178               1.26
014                        88,168                       58,551                    29,617               1.51
015 & 028 (4)              27,492                       26,113                     1,379               1.05
016                        23,917                       19,500                     4,417               1.23
017                        10,690                        9,190                     1,500               1.16
018                        25,529   (5)                 15,998                     9,531               1.60
019                        49,346                       25,300                    24,046               1.95
020                        39,742                       19,527                    20,215               2.04
021                        23,783                       16,331                     7,452               1.46
022                        26,767                       24,365                     2,402               1.10
023                         5,108                        3,932                     1,176               1.30
024                         6,435                            0                     6,435               N/A
025                        48,838                            0                    48,838               N/A
026                        37,357                       10,800                    26,557               3.46
027                       160,158                       74,570                    85,588   (6)         2.15
029                        26,510                        8,333  (7)               18,177               3.18
030                        60,194                            0                    60,194               N/A
031                        41,667                            0                    41,667               N/A
032                       102,831                            0                   102,831               N/A
</TABLE>

                                      69

<PAGE>
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                     Monthly                  Monthly               Debt Service
                      Monthly Cash               Debt Service on             Payment to            Coverage Ratio
 Loan                  Flow from                   Senior Lien              the Company's          on Senior Lien
Number               Property(1)(2)               Interests(3)                Interest                Interests
- ------               --------------               ------------                --------                ---------
<S>                    <C>                            <C>                       <C>                    <C> 
033                        21,940                       14,985                     6,955               1.46
034                         5,112                            0                     5,112               N/A
035                        27,954                        8,333  (7)               19,621               3.35
036                        23,950                            0                    23,950               N/A
037                        25,000                            0                    25,000               N/A
038                        69,013                            0                    69,013   (8)         N/A
                       ----------                     --------                  --------      
                       $1,218,737   (9)               $470,332  (9)             $748,405   (9)         2.59
                       ----------                     --------                  --------      

039                   $     3,814   (10)            $        0               $     3,814                N/A
040                       375,000   (11)               249,497                   125,503               1.50
041                       154,699   (12)                     0                   154,699                N/A
042                        34,080   (12)                     0                    34,080                N/A
043                        16,418   (12)                12,854                     3,564               1.28
                      -----------                     --------               -----------
                       $  584,011                     $262,351                $  321,660               2.23
                       ----------                     --------                ----------
Total (loans
1 through 43)          $1,802,748                     $732,683                $1,070,065               2.46
                       ==========                     ========                ==========
</TABLE>
- ---------
(1)      "Cash Flow" as used in this table is that amount equal to the
         operating revenues from property operations less operating expenses,
         including real estate and other taxes pertaining to the property and
         its operations, and before depreciation, amortization and capital
         expenditures.
(2)      Except as set forth in notes (4), (10), (11), and (12) monthly cash
         flow from each of the properties has been calculated as the average
         monthly amount during the three month period ended December 31, 1997.
(3)      Monthly debt service consists of required payments of principal,
         interest and other regularly recurring charges payable to the holder
         of the refinanced loan or senior lien interest.
(4)      Loans 15 and 28 represent different condominium units in the same
         property and are, accordingly combined for cash flow purposes.
(5)      Includes one-twelfth of an annual payment of $110,000 received in 
         December of each year.
(6)      A senior lien interest of $4.9 million in loan 27 was sold to RAIT.
         (See note (9) to the previous table). As a result of this sale, the
         cash flow to the Company will decrease by $44,755 per month.
(7)      Includes additional debt service of $2,083 per month attributable to 
         a senior lien interest sold in December 1997.
(8)      Loan 38 consisted of four related loans of which one was repaid in
         the first quarter of fiscal 1998. (See notes (9) and (30) to the
         previous table). One loan in the amount of $900,000 was sold to RAIT.
         In addition RAIT acquired senior lien interests in two of the
         remaining loans in the amount of $4.9 million. As a result of these
         sales the cash flow to the Company will decrease by $48,180 per
         month.

                                      70

<PAGE>



(9)      Excludes amounts attributable to loans 39 through 43, which are
         referred to in the table below.

(10)     Monthly cash flow currently consists of interest only since loan 39
         is a construction loan.

(11)     Based upon average cash flow for the three months ended January 31,
         1998.

(12)     Estimate based on an historical analysis of the property's cash flow
         prior to the Company's purchase of the loan.

         All of the Company's portfolio loans are currently performing in
accordance with their respective repayment terms under Forbearance Agreements
or retained interest notes.

Commercial Mortgage Loan Acquisition and Resolution: Accounting for Discounted
Loans

         The difference between the Company's cost basis in a loan and the sum
of projected cash flows from, and the appraised value of, the underlying
property (up to the amount of the loan) is accreted into interest income over
the estimated life of the loan using a method which approximates the level
yield method. The projected cash flows from the property are reviewed on a
quarterly basis and changes to the projected amounts reduce or increase the
amounts accreted into interest income over the remaining life of the loan on a
method approximating the level yield method.

         The Company records the investments in its commercial mortgage loan
portfolio at cost, which is significantly discounted from the face value of,
and accrued interest and penalties on, the notes. This discount to face value
and accrued interest and penalties (as adjusted to give effect to refinancings
and sales of senior lien interests) totaled $110.4 million, $86.3 million,
$40.0 million and $16.1 million at December 31, 1997, and September 30, 1997,
1996 and 1995, respectively. The cost basis in the various loans is
periodically reviewed to determine that it is not greater than the sum of the
projected cash flows and the appraised value of the underlying properties. If
the cost basis were found to be greater, the Company would provide, through a
charge to operations, an appropriate allowance. For the quarter ended December
31, 1997, the Company recorded a provision for possible losses of $52,000. For
the year ended September 30, 1997, the Company recorded a provision for
possible losses of $400,000 to reflect the increase in size of its commercial
mortgage loan portfolio. For the years ended September 30, 1996 and 1995, no
such provision was required.

         Gains on the sale of a senior lien interest in a loan (or gains, if
any, from the refinancing of a loan) are allocated between the portion of the
loan sold or refinanced and the portion retained based upon the fair value of
those respective portions on the date of such sale or refinancing. Any gain
recognized on a sale of a senior lien interest or a refinancing is brought
into income on the date of such sale or refinancing.



                                      71

<PAGE>


Residential Mortgage Loans

         The Company's residential mortgage lending business provides first
and second mortgage loans on one-to-four family residences to borrowers who
typically do not conform to guidelines established by Fannie Mae because of
past credit impairment or other reasons. Through its subsidiaries, FMF and
Tri-Star (which was acquired in November 1997 and which, following regulatory
approvals regarding transfer of mortgage lending licenses, the Company
anticipates merging into FMF), the Company is licensed as a residential
mortgage lender in 23 states and is currently originating loans in 11 states
(Connecticut, Delaware, Indiana, Kentucky, Maryland, Mississippi, New Jersey,
North Carolina, Ohio, Pennsylvania and Virginia). The Company began its
residential mortgage lending business during fiscal 1997 and commenced
originating loans in the first quarter of fiscal 1998.

         The Company's operational strategy is to concentrate on mid-size
residential mortgage loans with a targeted average loan of approximately
$50,000. Currently, the average loan size is approximately $45,000. Depending
upon the credit qualification of a borrower, the Company may originate loans
for its portfolio with a loan-to-value ratio of up to 60% (for the least
qualified borrowers) to 90% (for the most qualified borrowers). In addition,
the Company originates "125 Loans" (that is, loans with a cumulative
loan-to-value ratio of up to 125%) provided that such loans are approved for
acquisition by third-party purchasers prior to funding. Approximately 12% of
the Company's residential mortgage loans for the quarter ended December 31,
1997 conform to Fannie Mae guidelines although the Company does not seek to
originate these loans and does not expect to establish goals with respect to
the aggregate percentage of conforming loans in its portfolio.

         The Company typically originates residential mortgage loans directly
with consumers rather than acquiring such loans in bulk from other
originators. The Company primarily originates its loans through
retail/consumer direct channels (principally direct mail) under the trade name
USDirect Mortgage. Potential customers are identified using statistical models
predicting consumer need and capacity for a mortgage loan. The Company also
anticipates entering into "private label" arrangements with financial
institutions and other entities to originate loans by providing loan
underwriting, processing and other services to these institutions, under their
names, for their non-conforming borrowers.

         The Company reduces the time and costs related to underwriting,
processing and funding residential mortgage loans, and attempts to increase
the consistency of its loan underwriting, through an automated underwriting
and processing system which incorporates a proprietary credit evaluation
system developed from industry data and parameters established by FMF's
management. The Company (through FMF) has arranged two warehouse lines of
credit, with an aggregate credit amount of $35 million, to fund its lending
operations. See "Business - Sources of Funds."

         The Company (through FMF) is approved as a loan seller to 16
investors. The Company's policy is to sell its loans for cash. During the
first quarter of fiscal 1998 however, the Company engaged in a sale of a pool
of loans for a note. See "Risk Factors - Real Estate Finance Considerations -
Note Received in Sale of Certain Residential Loans."

                                      72

<PAGE>



The Company's policy is generally to sell loans on a servicing-released basis,
however, with respect to the sale of $6.8 million of originated and acquired
loans, the sale was on a servicing-retained basis. The Company has
subcontracted the servicing of these loans to Jefferson Bank. See "Risk
Factors - Real Estate Finance Considerations - Note Received in Sale of
Certain Residential Loans" and "Management - Certain Relationships and Related
Party Transactions - Jefferson Bank." As FMF and Tri-Star develop their
operations and increase staffing, they may retain servicing for their own
account and may retain certain loans for their portfolios.

Sponsorship of Real Estate Investment Trust

         The Company is the sponsor of RAIT, a publicly-held real estate
investment trust whose common shares of beneficial interest are listed on the
American Stock Exchange. RAIT's primary business is to acquire or originate
commercial mortgage loans in situations that, generally, do not conform to the
underwriting standards of institutional lenders or sources that provide
financing through securitization. Although RAIT may acquire commercial
mortgage loans at a discount, it seeks to acquire such loans where the workout
process has been initiated and where, unlike the commercial mortgage loans
acquired by the Company, there is no need for RAIT's active intervention. RAIT
commenced operations on January 14, 1998.

         As sponsor of RAIT, the Company acquired 15% of RAIT's common shares
of beneficial interest upon completion of the offering of such shares, at a
cost of approximately $7.0 million. So long as the Company owns 5% or more of
RAIT's common shares, the Company will have the right to nominate one person
to RAIT's board of trustees (the "Board of Trustees"). The Company sold 10 of
its mortgage loans and senior lien interests in two other loans (representing
a net investment by the Company at December 31, 1997 of $17.1 million,
including $2.0 million of senior lien interests acquired by the Company in
connection with the sale) to RAIT, as part of RAIT's initial investments, for
$20.1 million. The Company may sell further loans to RAIT, to a maximum of 30%
of RAIT's investments (on a cost basis), excluding the initial investments.
Betsy Z. Cohen, spouse of the Company's Chairman and Chief Executive Officer,
Edward E. Cohen, and mother of Daniel G. Cohen, the Chairman and Chief
Executive Officer of FMF and an Executive Vice President and director of the
Company, is the Chairman and Chief Executive Officer of RAIT. Jonathan Z.
Cohen, the son of Mr. and Mrs. Cohen and the Secretary and a director of
Resource Energy, Inc., a wholly-owned subsidiary of the Company through which
its energy operations are conducted ("Resource Energy"), is the Company's
nominee to the Board of Trustees.

         To limit conflicts between RAIT and the Company, it has been agreed
that, for two years following the completion of the RAIT offering, (i) the
Company will not sponsor another real estate investment trust with investment
objectives and policies which are the same as, or substantially similar to,
those of RAIT; (ii) if the Company originates a proposal to provide wraparound
or other junior lien or subordinated financing (as opposed to acquiring
existing financing) with respect to multifamily, office or other commercial
properties to a

                                      73

<PAGE>



borrower (other than to a borrower with an existing loan from the Company),
the Company must first offer the opportunity to RAIT; and (iii) if the Company
desires to sell any loan it has acquired that conforms to RAIT's investment
objectives and policies with respect to acquired loans, it must first offer to
sell it to RAIT. The Company anticipates that complying with these
restrictions will not materially affect the Company's operations for the
foreseeable future. The Company has also agreed that if, after the expiration
of the two year period, the Company sponsors a real estate investment trust
with investment objectives similar to those of RAIT, the Company's
representative on the Board of Trustees (should the Company have a
representative on the Board at that time) will recuse himself or herself from
considering or voting upon matters relating to financings which may be deemed
to be within the lending guidelines of both RAIT and the real estate
investment trust then being sponsored by the Company.


Equipment Leasing

General

         The Company's equipment leasing business commenced in September 1995
with the acquisition of an equipment leasing subsidiary of a regional
insurance company. Through this acquisition, the Company assumed the
management of five publicly-held equipment leasing partnerships involving
$49.8 million (original equipment cost) in leased assets at December 31, 1997.
More importantly, through this acquisition the Company acquired an
infrastructure of operating systems, computer hardware and proprietary
software (generally referred to as a "platform"), as well as personnel, which
the Company utilized in fiscal 1996 as a basis for the development of an
equipment leasing business for its own account. As part of its development of
this business, in early 1996 the Company hired a team of four experienced
leasing executives, including the former chief executive officer of the U.S.
leasing subsidiary of Tokai Bank, a major Japanese banking institution.

         The Company conducts its leasing operations through three corporate
divisions: Fidelity Leasing, Inc. ("FLI"), which conducts the Company's small
ticket leasing operations; F.L. Partnership Management, Inc. ("FLPM"), which
manages five public leasing partnerships; and FL Financial Services, Inc.
("FLFS"), which provides lease finance placement and advisory services. The
Company's primary focus in its equipment leasing operations is on the
development of FLI, which commenced small ticket leasing operations in August
1996. FLPM's operations will be reduced over the next several years as
partnership assets are sold and cash is distributed back to the investors.
FLPM does not anticipate forming new limited partnerships in the future. FLFS
will continue to operate its lease finance placement and advisory business
which, while profitable, is not expected to constitute a material source of
revenues for the Company.


                                      74

<PAGE>



Strategy

         Focus on Small Ticket Leasing. The Company focuses on leasing
equipment costing between $5,000 and $100,000 ("small ticket" leasing). By so
doing, the Company takes advantage not only of the background and expertise of
its leasing management team, but also of the servicing platform the Company
has acquired and developed, which has the capacity to monitor the large
amounts of equipment and related assets involved in a small ticket leasing
operation. In addition, small ticket items represent a substantial portion of
the equipment sought by small businesses thereby affording the Company a niche
market with significant growth potential (see "Business - Equipment Leasing -
Strategy: Focus on Leasing to Small Businesses"). Moreover, the small size of
a typical transaction relative to the Company's total lease portfolio reduces
the Company's credit risk exposure from any particular transaction.

         Focus on Vendor Programs. The significant majority of equipment
leased to end-user customers by the Company will be purchased from
manufacturers or regional distributors with whom the Company is establishing
vendor programs. In so doing, the Company utilizes the manufacturer's or
distributor's sales organization to gain access to the manufacturer's end-user
base without incurring the costs of establishing independent customer
relationships. The Company is actively pursuing the establishment of multiple
vendor programs in an effort to reduce its reliance on any one vendor and,
thus, to reduce the risk of tying the success of the Company's leasing
operations to the continuation of a relationship with one (or a small group)
of vendors. The Company has currently established programs with ten
manufacturers or distributors. Two of such manufacturers (Minolta Corporation
and Lucent Technologies) accounted for 21% and 8%, respectively, of the
equipment (by cost) leased by the Company from the beginning of operations
through December 31, 1997 (18% and 8%, respectively, for the quarter ended
December 31, 1997.

         Focus on Leasing to Small Businesses. The Company focuses its
marketing programs and resources on lease programs for small business
end-users (generally those with 500 or fewer employees). The Company has
acquired and developed credit evaluation and scoring systems (based upon
credit evaluation services provided by Dun & Bradstreet) which it believes
significantly increases its ability to evaluate the credit risk in dealing
with small business end-users (see "Business - Equipment Leasing - Small
Ticket Leasing"). The Company also believes that small business end-users,
while sensitive to the size of a monthly lease payment, are less sensitive
than large end-users to the interest rate structure of a lease, allowing the
Company to increase its yield by lengthening lease terms to lower monthly
rent. The Company currently offers lease terms from one to five years to meet
the needs of its end-users and will consider other lease terms in appropriate
circumstances.

         Focus on Full-Payout Leases. The Company seeks to reduce the
financial risk associated with the lease transactions it originates through
the use of full-payout leases. A "full-payout lease" is a lease under which
the non-cancelable rental payments due during the initial lease term are at
least sufficient to recover the purchase price of the equipment under the
lease, related acquisition fees and, typically, a minimum return on the
Company's invested

                                      75

<PAGE>



capital. To the extent possible, the Company seeks to substantially increase
this return through amounts received upon remarketing the equipment or through
continued leasing of the equipment after expiration of the initial lease term.

         Focus on Providing Service. The Company provides service and support
to its small business customers and vendors by seeking to minimize the time
required to respond to customer applications for lease financing and by
providing sales training programs to its vendors and their sales staff (which
it customizes to their particular needs) regarding the use of lease financing
for marketing purposes to increase a vendor's equipment sales and market
share. The Company has acquired and developed proprietary management systems
to assist it in providing lease quotes and application decisions to its
customers, generally within 4 hours after receipt of a request.

         Focus on Lease Sales. The Company sells virtually all of its leases.
In fiscal 1997, the Company effected four sales in which it sold discrete
pools of leases and the equipment underlying the leases (including the
residual interest) to Intermediate Purchasers which then sold interests in the
leases to an institutional buyer. In the first quarter of fiscal 1998, the
Company entered into an arrangement with an Intermediate Purchaser and a group
of institutional buyers to periodically sell leases originated by the Company,
to a maximum of $50.0 million of leases. The Company has sold $14.4 million of
leases under this arrangement. See "Business - Sources of Funds - Forward Sale
Commitment." To date, the Company has retained the servicing rights on the
leases it sells. The Company anticipates that in the future it will enter into
sale arrangements similar to that concluded in the first quarter of fiscal
1998; however, the Company may retain the residual interest in the equipment
in the future. Selling the leases allows the Company to recover a significant
amount of its investment in the leased equipment, freeing capital for further
leasing activity. See "Risk Factors - Equipment Leasing Considerations - Sale
of Leases."

Small Ticket Leasing

         The Company offers full-payout leases with options, exercisable by
the lessee at the end of the lease term, either to purchase the equipment at
fair market value, to purchase the equipment for a fixed price negotiated at
the time the lease is signed, or to continue as a lessee on a month-to-month
basis. The Company's leases have a provision which requires the lessee to make
all lease payments under all circumstances. The leases are also net leases,
requiring the lessee to pay (in addition to rent) any other expenses
associated with the use of equipment, such as maintenance, casualty and
liability insurance, sales or use taxes and personal property taxes. The
Company offers lease terms from one to five years and will consider other
lease terms in appropriate circumstances.

         The equipment that the Company presently purchases for lease includes
document processing and storage equipment, telecommunications systems,
computer equipment, small manufacturing machines and office furniture. The
table below sets forth the distribution of equipment purchased by the Company,
by principal product type and percentage of dollar

                                      76

<PAGE>



volume of equipment purchased, during the quarters ended December 31, 1997 and
1996 and fiscal years 1997 and 1996.

                       Equipment Volume by Product Type
                  (% by dollar volume of equipment purchased)

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                              Quarter Ended                 Year Ended
                                                               December 31,                September 30,
                                                            ------------------         ---------------------
                                                            1997         1996           1997           1996
                                                            ----         ----           ----           ----
<S>                                                          <C>          <C>             <C>            <C>
         Document processing and storage..............       48%          68%             49%            73%
         Telecommunications...........................       38%          19%             37%            21%
         Computer systems.............................       10%          10%              8%             6%
         Other........................................        4%           3%              6%            -
                                                            ----         ----            ----          ---
                                                            100%         100%            100%           100%
                                                            ====         ====            ====           ====
</TABLE>

         The Company has developed a credit evaluation system, known as the
"Small Business Credit Scoring System," which is intended to respond to the
inability of small businesses to supply standardized financial information for
credit analysis (for example, audited financial statements). The system
operates by assigning point amounts, or "scores," to various factors (such as
business longevity, type of business, payment history, bank account balances
and credit ratings) deemed relevant by the Company in determining whether an
end-user is a creditworthy lessee. The scoring system declines approval of
end-users with low scores, approves end-users with high scores and refers
mid-range scores to credit analysts for further consideration and decision.
Information is obtained from the end-user, from reports by standard credit
reporting firms and from reports provided by consumer credit bureaus. The
credit scoring system is also based upon industry data and the past experience
of the Company and will be reviewed and modified as required in response to
actual portfolio performance. Financial statements may be required for larger
transactions (in the $30,000 to $100,000 range) as a complement to the scoring
system.

         The Company oversees its leasing program through lease administration
and management systems which control invoicing, collection, sales and property
taxes and financial and other reporting to management (including reports
regarding regular payments, payment shortages, advance payments, security
deposits, insurance payments and late or finance charges). The Company has
supplemented the system with an internal audit department (which evaluates the
safeguarding of assets, reliability of financial information and compliance
with the Company's credit policies) and a collection department.

         The Company is marketing its leasing services primarily through the
establishment of vendor programs. See "Business - Equipment Leasing -
Strategy: Focus on Vendor Programs." The Company has currently entered into
vendor program relationships with eight vendors: Minolta Corporation (copiers),
Celsis Incorporated (microbial testing systems),

                                      77

<PAGE>



American Marbacom Communications (Teleco) (telephone systems), CSi (test
equipment), Telrad Communications (telephone systems), ATI Communications
(telephone systems), the National Association of College Stores (affinity
program) and Millipore Corp. (test equipment). In addition, Lucent
Technologies (telecommunications equipment) and Softmart (computer software)
have designated the Company as an authorized lessor for their dealer
distribution channels. Under a typical vendor program, the Company will work
with the vendor and the lessee to structure the lease, finance the lease,
purchase the related equipment and administer the lease, including providing
all billing and collection services (except for private-label leasing,
referred to below). At the end of the initial lease term, the Company and the
vendor will typically coordinate the re-marketing of the equipment. The
Company seeks to establish vendor relationships by (i) obtaining
manufacturers' endorsements of the Company's finance programs, (ii) offering
inventory financing credit lines to a manufacturer's vendors, (iii) developing
customized sales training programs to offer to vendors and (iv) assisting the
manufacturers and their vendors in establishing a sales package including the
lease financing provided by the Company.

         The Company also competes by establishing private-label leasing
programs with its vendors. Private-label leasing involves the lease by a
vendor of its own equipment on a lease form bearing the vendor's name as
lessor (but otherwise identical to the Company's lease form), the sale of the
lease and equipment to the Company, and the provision of basic administrative
services by the vendor (such as billing and collecting rent). The Company will
provide assistance, particularized rental payment structures and other
customized lease terms, remarketing, customized invoicing and management
information reports. The Company also seeks to develop programs marketing
directly to end-user groups, primarily through small business affinity groups
or associations, participations in trade shows and conventions, and media
advertising.

         Although there can be no assurance, it is anticipated that in the
future the Company may retain the residual interest in leases sold by it and
derive a significant portion of its leasing profits from residuals. Currently,
repayment of notes received by the Company from Intermediate Purchasers of the
Company's equipment leases depends, to a significant extent, on realization of
residuals. See "Risk Factors - Equipment Leasing Considerations - Residuals"
and "- Sale of Leases," see also "Business - Equipment Leasing - Revenue
Recognition and Lease Accounting." The Company anticipates that residuals will
principally involve the original end-users; however, equipment not sold or
re-leased to end-users will be disposed of in the secondary market. While
residual realization is generally higher with original end-users than in the
secondary market, the secondary market (essentially, networks of distributors
and dealers in various equipment categories) is well developed in the product
categories the Company currently pursues and transactions in these product
categories have historically resulted in residual recoveries, on average,
equal to the book value of the equipment. Equipment reacquired by the Company
prior to lease termination (through lease default or otherwise) will be sold
in the secondary market.


                                      78

<PAGE>



Revenue Recognition and Lease Accounting

         General. The manner in which lease finance transactions are
characterized and reported for accounting purposes has a major impact upon the
Company's reported revenue, net earnings and the resulting financial measures.
Lease accounting methods significant to the Company's leasing operations are
discussed below.

         Direct Financing Leases. The Company classifies its lease
transactions, as required by the Statement of Financial Accounting Standards
No. 13, Accounting for Leases ("FASB No. 13") as direct financing leases (as
distinguished from sales-type or operating leases). Direct financing leases
transfer substantially all benefits and risks of equipment ownership to the
customer. A lease is a direct financing lease if the creditworthiness of the
customer and the collectibility of lease payments are reasonably certain and
it meets one of the following criteria: (i) the lease transfers ownership of
the equipment to the customer by the end of the lease term; (ii) the lease
contains a bargain purchase option; (iii) the lease term at inception is at
least 75% of the estimated economic life of the leased equipment; or (iv) the
present value of the minimum lease payments is at least 90% of the fair market
value of the leased equipment at inception of the lease. The Company's net
investment in direct financing leases consists of the sum of the total future
minimum lease payments receivable and the estimated unguaranteed residual
value of leased equipment, less unearned income. Unearned lease income, which
is recognized as revenue over the term of the lease by the effective interest
method, represents the excess of the total future minimum lease payments plus
the estimated unguaranteed residual value expected to be realized at the end
of the lease term over the cost of the related equipment. Initial direct costs
incurred in consummating a lease are capitalized as part of the investment in
direct finance leases and amortized over the lease term as a reduction in the
yield.

         Residual Values. Unguaranteed residual value represents the estimated
amount to be received at lease termination from lease extensions or
disposition of the leased equipment financed under direct financing leases.
The estimates are based upon available industry data and senior management's
prior experience with respect to comparable equipment. The residual values are
recorded as investment in direct financing leases, on a net present value
basis. The estimated residual values will vary, both in amount and as a
percentage of the original equipment cost depending upon several factors
including the equipment type, market conditions and the term of the lease.
Amounts to be realized at lease termination depend on the fair market value of
the related equipment and may vary from the recorded estimate. Residual values
are reviewed periodically to determine if the equipment's fair market value is
below its recorded value. Any required changes are recorded in accordance with
FASB No. 13. In accordance with generally accepted accounting principles,
residual values can only be adjusted downward.

         Sales of Leases. The Company sells a large percentage of the leases
it originates (including residual values) through indirect securitization
transactions and other structured finance techniques. In a securitization
transaction, the Company sells and transfers a pool of

                                      79

<PAGE>



leases to a bankruptcy remote Intermediate Purchaser unaffiliated with the
Company. Typically, the Intermediate Purchaser will have no material assets
apart from the leases sold to it. The Intermediate Purchaser in turn
simultaneously sells and transfers its interest in the leases (excluding the
residual value) to a financial institution in return for cash equal to a
percentage of the aggregate present value of the finance lease receivables
being sold. The consideration paid to the Company for the lease receivables
and the residuals sold to the Intermediate Purchaser consists of the cash
advanced by the financial institution and an interest bearing note from the
Intermediate Purchaser.

         Gains on the sale of leasing portfolios are recorded at the date of
sale in the amount by which the sales price exceeds the book value of the
underlying leases. Subsequent to a sale, the Company has no remaining interest
in the pool of leases or equipment except (i) a security interest is retained
in the pool when a note is received as part of the sale proceeds and (ii)
under certain circumstances, the Company is obligated to replace
non-performing leases in the pool. See "Risk Factors - Equipment Leasing
Considerations - Sale of Leases" and "- Potential Replacement of Leases" and
"- Residuals."

         To the extent that the Company determines to retain residuals for its
own account, the Company's gain on sale from any pool of leases so sold may be
materially reduced, although the Company's revenues in subsequent years from
realization of residuals may be increased. For a discussion of certain risks
relating to realization of residuals, see "Risk Factors Equipment Leasing
Considerations - Residuals."

         During the fiscal year ended September 30, 1997, the Company sold
leases on a servicing retained basis, with a book value of approximately $30.2
million to Intermediate Purchasers in return for cash of $20.6 million and
notes with a total face value of $13.3 million resulting in a gain of $3.7
million. During the year ended September 30, 1997, $8.5 million of principal
payments were made on these notes. In the first quarter of fiscal 1998 the
Company sold leases with a book value of approximately $14.4 million to an
Intermediate Purchaser in return for cash of $12.3 million and a note with a
face value of $3.9 million.

         The Company accounts for the sale and servicing of lease equipment in
accordance with SFAS No. 125, "Accounting for Transfers and Servicing of
Financial Assets and Extinguishments of Liabilities." See Note 2, Notes to
Consolidated Financial Statements.

Partnership Management

         The Company acts as the general partner and manager of five public
limited partnerships formed between 1986 and 1990 with total assets at
December 31, 1997 of $36.1 million, including $18.5 million (book value) of
equipment with an original cost of $49.8 million. The partnerships primarily
lease computers and related peripheral equipment to investment grade, middle
market, and capital intensive companies. The principal stated objective of
each of the limited partnerships is to generate leasing revenues for
distribution to the investors in the partnerships.

                                      80

<PAGE>




         For its services as general partner, the Company receives management
fees, an interest in partnership cash distributions and a reimbursement of
specified expenses related to administration of the partnerships (including
costs of non-executive personnel, legal, accounting and third-party contractor
fees and costs, and costs of equipment used in a partnership's behalf).
Management fees range from 3% to 6% of gross rents except that, if leases are
full payout leases, management fees range from 1% to 3% of gross rents. In
four of the partnerships, management fees are subordinated to the receipt by
limited partners of a cumulative annual cash distribution of 11% (two
partnerships) or 12% (two partnerships) of the limited partners' aggregate
investment. The Company's interest, as general partner, in cash distributions
from the partnerships is 3.5% (one partnership) and 1% (four partnerships).

Lease Finance Placement and Advisory Business

         The Company also operates a lease finance placement and advisory
business which focuses on two related types of leasing transactions: the
origination of leases by others and the identification of third-party lease
funding sources. Lease transactions generated by the division are typically
full payout leases. The Company generally receives between 1% and 4% of the
equipment cost at the time the transaction is closed for its services in
arranging a transaction. In some of the transactions it generates, the Company
also enters into a remarketing agreement that entitles it to fees upon
residual sale. Lease finance placement and advisory services generated
revenues of $252,000 and $300,000 during the quarters ended December 31, 1997
and 1996, respectively, and $657,000 and $650,000 during fiscal years 1997 and
1996, respectively.

Energy Operations

General

         The Company produces natural gas and, to a lesser extent, oil from
locations principally in Ohio, Pennsylvania and New York. At December 31,
1997, the Company had (either directly or through partnerships and joint
ventures managed by it) interests in 1,264 wells (including royalty or
overriding interests with respect to 182 wells), of which the Company operates
908 wells, 590 miles of natural gas pipelines and 91,000 acres (net) of
mineral rights. Natural gas produced from wells operated by the Company is
collected in gas gathering pipeline systems owned by partnerships managed by
the Company (and in which the Company also has an interest) and by systems
directly owned by the Company, and is sold to a number of customers, such as
gas brokers and local utilities, under a variety of contractual arrangements.
Oil produced from wells operated by the Company is sold at the well site to
regional oil refining companies at the prevailing spot price for Appalachian
crude oil. From time to time, the Company receives indications of interest in
the acquisition of its energy operations, and continually pursues the increase
of its reserve base through selective acquisition of producing properties and
other assets. Within the past nine months, the Company has acquired the assets
of two small energy companies. For further information, see Note 11 to
Consolidated Financial Statements.

                                      81

<PAGE>




Well Operations

         The following table sets forth information as of December 31, 1997
regarding productive oil and gas wells in which the Company has a working
interest:

                                                    Number of Productive Wells
                                                     ------------------------
                                                     Gross(1)         Net(1)
                                                     --------         ------

                  Oil Wells......................        161              62
                  Gas Wells......................        921             612
                                                       -----             ---
                                                       1,082             674
                                                       =====             ===

- -------------
(1)      Includes the Company's equity interest in wells owned by 64
         partnerships and joint ventures. Does not include royalty or
         overriding interests with respect to 182 wells held by the Company.

         The following table sets forth net quantities of oil and natural gas
produced, average sales prices, and average production (lifting) costs per
equivalent unit of production, for the periods indicated, including the
Company's equity interests in the production of 64 partnerships and joint
ventures, for the periods indicated.
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>

                                                                                                  
                                                                                                   Average  
                                                                                                   Lifting  
                                       Production                 Average Sales Price              Cost per 
                               -------------------------         ------------------------         Equivalent
         Fiscal Period(1)      Oil(bbls)        Gas(mcf)         per bbl          per mcf           mcf(2)
         ----------------      ---------        --------         -------          -------         ----------

            <S>                 <C>              <C>            <C>               <C>            <C>  
            1998                  11,450           386,171        $17.52            $2.63          $1.14
            1997                  35,811         1,227,887        $19.68            $2.59          $1.13
            1996                  33,862         1,165,477        $18.53            $2.34          $1.04
            1995                  36,420         1,198,245        $16.74            $2.31          $1.06
</TABLE>

- ---------
(1) All periods are fiscal years, except that 1998 is for the first fiscal
    quarter ended December 31, 1997.
(2) Oil production is converted to mcf equivalents at the rate of six mcf per
    barrel.

         Neither the Company nor the partnerships and joint ventures it
manages are obligated to provide any fixed quantities of oil or gas in the
future under existing contracts.


                                      82

<PAGE>



Exploration and Development

         The following table sets forth information with respect to the number
of wells completed in Ohio and New York (the only areas in which Company
drilling activities occurred) at any time during the first quarter of fiscal
year 1998 and fiscal years 1997, 1996, and 1995, regardless of when drilling
was initiated.
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>

                                     Exploratory Wells                              Development Wells
                           --------------------------------------         -------------------------------------
                               Productive               Dry                 Productive                Dry
             Fiscal        ----------------       ---------------         ---------------        --------------
             Period(1)     Gross       Net        Gross       Net         Gross      Net         Gross     Net
             ---------     -----       ---        -----       ---         -----      ---         -----     ---
             <S>            <C>         <C>        <C>        <C>          <C>       <C>          <C>     <C> 
             1998           --          --         --         --            --        --          --       --
             1997           1.0         .50        --         --            --        --          --       --
             1996           3.0         .52        1.0        .29          2.0      1.50          --       --
             1995           3.0         .36        2.0        .36          1.0       .87          2.0     1.75
</TABLE>                                                   
- ---------
(1) All periods are fiscal years, except that 1998 is for the first fiscal
    quarter ended December 31, 1997.

         All drilling has been on acreage held by the Company. The Company
does not own its own drilling equipment; rather, it acts as a general
contractor for well operations and subcontracts drilling and certain other
work to third parties.

Oil and Gas Reserve Information

         An evaluation of the Company's estimated proved developed oil and gas
reserves as of September 30, 1997, was verified by E.E. Templeton &
Associates, Inc., an independent petroleum engineering firm. Such study
showed, subject to the qualifications and reservations therein set forth,
reserves of 15.2 million mcf of gas and 358,000 barrels of oil. See Note 13 to
the Consolidated Financial Statements.


                                      83

<PAGE>



         The following table sets forth information with respect to the
Company's developed and undeveloped oil and gas acreage as of December 31,
1997. The information in this table includes the Company's equity interest in
acreage owned by 64 partnerships and joint ventures.
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>

                                                        Developed Acreage              Undeveloped Acreage
                                                      ----------------------      ----------------------------
                                                      Gross             Net          Gross               Net
                                                      -----           ------        -------             ------
<S>                                                   <C>              <C>           <C>                <C>   
         Arkansas...........................           2,560              403            -                 -
         Kansas.............................             160               20            -                 -
         Louisiana..........................           1,819              206            -                 -
         Mississippi........................              40                3            -                 -
         New York...........................          30,065           21,025        14,498             13,457
         Ohio...............................          61,224           36,652        18,489             17,450
         Oklahoma...........................           4,243              635            -                 -
         Pennsylvania.......................           2,271            1,679            -                 -
         Texas..............................           4,520              209            -                 -
                                                     -------           ------        ------             ----
                                                     106,902           60,832        32,987             30,907
                                                     =======           ======        ======             ======
</TABLE>

         The terms of the oil and gas leases held by the Company's for its own
account and by its managed partnerships vary, depending upon the location of
the leased premises and the minimum remaining terms of undeveloped leases,
from less than one year to five years. Rentals of approximately $27,600 in
fiscal 1997 and $16,400 for the quarter ended December 31, 1997 were paid to
maintain leases on such acreage in force.

         The Company believes that the partnership, joint venture and Company
properties have satisfactory title. The developed oil and gas properties are
subject to customary royalty interests generally contracted for in connection
with the acquisition of the properties, burdens incident to operating
agreements, current taxes and easements and restrictions (collectively,
"Burdens"). Presently, the partnerships, joint ventures and the Company are
current with respect to all such Burdens.

         At December 31, 1997, the Company had no individual interests in any
oil and gas property that accounted for more than 10% of the Company's proved
developed oil and gas reserves, including the Company's interest in reserves
owned by 64 partnerships and joint ventures.

Pipeline Operation

         The Company operates, on behalf of three limited partnerships of
which it is both a general and limited partner (in which it owns 13%, 46% and
22% interests), and for its own account, various gas gathering pipeline
systems totaling approximately 590 miles in length. The pipeline systems are
located in Ohio, New York and Pennsylvania.

                                      84

<PAGE>




Well Services

         The Company provides a variety of well services to wells of which it
is the operator and to wells operated by independent third party operators.
These services include well operations, petroleum engineering, well
maintenance and well workover and are provided at rates in conformity with
general industry standards.

Sources and Availability of Raw Materials

         The Company contracts for drilling rigs and purchases tubular goods
necessary for the drilling and completion of wells from a substantial number
of drillers and suppliers, none of which supplies a significant portion of the
Company's annual needs. During fiscal 1997, and 1996, the Company faced no
shortage of such goods and services. The duration of the current supply and
demand situation cannot be predicted with any degree of certainty due to
numerous factors affecting the oil and gas industry, including selling prices,
demand for oil and gas, and governmental regulations.

Major Customers

         The Company's natural gas and oil is sold to various purchasers. In
fiscal 1998 through January 31, 1998, gas and oil sales to three purchasers
accounted for 36%, 14% and 11%, respectively, of the Company's total
production revenues. For the years ended September 30, 1997 and 1996, gas
sales to two purchasers accounted for 29% and 12%, and 29% and 13%,
respectively, of the Company's total production revenues. Gas sales to one
purchaser individually accounted for approximately 15% of total revenues from
energy production for fiscal 1995.

Competition

         The oil and gas business is intensely competitive in all of its
aspects. The oil and gas industry also competes with other industries in
supplying the energy and fuel requirements of industrial, commercial and
individual customers. Domestic oil and gas sales are also subject to
competition from foreign sources. Moreover, competition is intense for the
acquisition of leases considered favorable for the development of oil and gas
in commercial quantities. The Company's competitors include other independent
oil and gas companies, individual proprietors and partnerships. Many of these
entities possess greater financial resources than the Company. While it is
impossible for the Company to accurately determine its comparative industry
position with respect to its provision of products and services, the Company
does not consider its oil and gas operations to be a significant factor in the
industry.


                                      85

<PAGE>



Markets

         The availability of a ready market for oil and gas produced by the
Company, and the price obtained therefor, will depend upon numerous factors
beyond the Company's control including the extent of domestic production,
import of foreign natural gas and/or oil, political instability in oil and gas
producing countries and regions, market demands, the effect of federal
regulation on the sale of natural gas and/or oil in interstate commerce, other
governmental regulation of the production and transportation of natural gas
and/or oil and the proximity, availability and capacity of pipelines and other
required facilities. Currently, the supply of both crude oil and natural gas
is more than sufficient to meet projected demand in the United States. These
conditions have had, and may continue to have, a negative impact on the
Company through depressed prices for its oil and gas reserves.

Governmental Regulation

         The exploration, production and sale of oil and natural gas are
subject to numerous state and federal laws and regulations. Compliance with
the laws and regulations affecting the oil and gas industry generally
increases the Company's costs of doing business in, and the profitability of
its energy operations. Inasmuch as such regulations are frequently changing,
the Company is unable to predict the future cost or impact of complying with
such regulations. The Company is not aware of any pending or threatened matter
involving a claim that it has violated environmental regulations which would
have a material effect on its operations or financial position.

Sources of Funds

         Historically, the Company has relied upon internally generated funds
to finance its growth. During fiscal 1997, the Company augmented its
internally generated funds by a $5.0 million credit facility (increased to
$20.0 million in the first quarter of fiscal 1998) for its residential
mortgage lending operations and a $5.0 million credit facility for oil and gas
asset acquisitions and completed two capital markets transactions: a public
offering of its Common Stock resulting in $19.5 million in net proceeds to the
Company, and a private placement of $115.0 million of the Senior Notes due
2004 to a small group of institutional investors, resulting in $110.6 million
of net proceeds to the Company. In addition, during fiscal 1997 the Company
entered into an initial $20.0 million credit facility for its equipment
leasing operations. In the first quarter of fiscal 1998, the Company entered
into a $50.0 million forward sales commitment and an additional $15.0 million
warehouse credit facility for its residential mortgage lending operations. See
Note 6 to Consolidated Financial Statements.

         Senior Notes. The Senior Notes are unsecured general obligations of
the Company, payable interest only until maturity on August 1, 2004. The
Senior Notes are not subject to mandatory redemption except upon a change in
control of the Company, as defined in the indenture (the "Indenture") pursuant
to which the Senior Notes were issued, when the Noteholders have the right to
require the Company to redeem the Senior Notes at 101% of

                                      86

<PAGE>



principal amount plus accrued interest. No sinking fund has been established
for the Senior Notes. At the Company's option, the Senior Notes may be
redeemed in whole or in part on or after August 1, 2002 at a price of 106% of
principal amount (through July 31, 2003) and 103% of principal amount (through
July 31, 2004), plus accrued interest to the date of redemption. The Indenture
contains covenants that, among other things, (i) require the Company to
maintain certain levels of net worth (generally, an amount equal to $50
million plus a cumulative 25% of the Company's consolidated net income) and
liquid assets (generally, an amount equal to 100% of required interest
payments for the next succeeding interest payment date); and (ii) limit the
ability of the Company and its subsidiaries to (a) incur indebtedness (not
including secured indebtedness used to acquire or refinance the acquisition of
loans, equipment leases or other assets), (b) pay dividends or make other
distributions in excess of 25% of aggregate consolidated net income (offset by
100% of any deficit) on a cumulative basis, (c) engage in certain transactions
with affiliates, (d) dispose of certain subsidiaries, (e) create liens and
guarantees with respect to pari passu or junior indebtedness and (f) enter
into any arrangement that would impose restrictions on the ability of
subsidiaries to make dividend and other payments to the Company. The Indenture
also restricts the Company's ability to merge, consolidate or sell all or
substantially all of its assets and prohibits the Company from incurring
additional indebtedness if the Company's "leverage ratio" exceeds 2.0 to 1.0.
As defined by the Indenture, the leverage ratio is the ratio of all
indebtedness (excluding debt used to acquire assets, obligations of the
Company to repurchase loans or other financial assets sold by the Company,
guarantees of either of the foregoing, non-recourse debt and certain
securities issued by securitization entities, as defined in the Indenture), to
the consolidated net worth of the Company. The Indenture also prohibits the
Company from incurring pari passu or junior indebtedness with a maturity date
prior to that of the Senior Notes.

         Lease Financing Credit Facility. FLI maintains a $20.0 million
revolving credit facility with term loan availability with CoreStates Bank and
First Union Bank for its equipment leasing operations. The facility has, in
addition to customary covenants, the following principal terms: (i) revolving
credit lines bear interest at adjusted LIBOR rate plus 175 basis points, while
term loans bear interest at adjusted LIBOR plus 225 basis points; (ii) the
loans are secured by a first lien on the equipment leases being financed (and
on the underlying equipment), a guaranty by the Company and a pledge of the
capital stock of FLI and Resource Leasing, Inc. (the direct parent of FLI and
a wholly-owned subsidiary of the Company); (iii) revolving credit loans may be
converted to term loans (with terms of 18, 24 or 36 months), provided that
term loans must be in increments of $2.0 million and no more than five term
loans may be outstanding at any time; (iv) adjustable rate term loans may, at
the option of FLI, be converted into fixed rate term loans at then quoted
rates; (v) FLI will be required to maintain a debt (excluding non-recourse
debt) to "worth" ratio of 4.5 to 1.0, a minimum tangible net worth equal to
$5.0 million plus 75% of FLI's net income, and specified ratios of cash flow
to the sum of debt service plus 25% of outstanding obligations under the
revolving line of credit plus mandatory principal payments; and (vi) the
Company will be required to maintain minimum stockholders' equity of $40.0
million. The facility expires on May 29, 1998 but may be renewed annually by
the lenders. The Company is

                                      87

<PAGE>



currently negotiating with the lenders for a renewal of the facility and
believes that the facility will be renewed on similar terms. There can,
however, be no assurance that the facility will be renewed or that the renewal
terms will be similar to the existing terms. See "Risk Factors - General -
Ability to Generate Funding for Growth." During fiscal 1997, the maximum
borrowing by the Company under this facility was $7.1 million, all of which
was repaid prior to fiscal year end. There were no borrowings under this line
during the quarter ended December 31, 1997.

         Residential Mortgage Loan Credit Facilities. FMF maintains a $20.0
million credit facility with CoreStates Bank, bearing interest at either (i)
the CoreStates prime rate, (ii) the federal funds rate plus 250 basis points,
or (iii) an adjusted LIBOR plus 150 basis points, with the rate to be elected
by FMF, and with the right in FMF to elect different rate formulas for
separate draws under the credit facility. The credit facility will be secured
by a first lien interest in the loans being financed by facility draws. Under
the facility, FMF is required to maintain a minimum tangible net worth of $1.0
million, and a debt to tangible net worth ratio of 5.0 to 1.0 (where debt
includes the unused portion of any financing commitment but excludes
subordinated debt). The facility expires on September 22, 1998 unless renewed
by the parties. There were no borrowings outstanding under this facility at
December 31, 1997.

         FMF has also established a $15.0 million warehouse credit facility
with Morgan Stanley Mortgage Capital, Inc., bearing interest at LIBOR or, if
unavailable, the interbank eurodollars market rate plus 90 basis points. The
facility is secured by a first lien interest in the loans being financed by
facility draws. Under the credit facility, FMF is required to maintain
tangible net worth (capital and subordinated debt minus advances to affiliates
and intangible assets representing start up costs in excess of $1.0 million),
and a ratio of total indebtedness to tangible net worth of 10.0 to 1.0. The
facility expires on October 16, 1998. There were $4.4 million of borrowings
outstanding under this facility at December 31, 1997.

         Forward Sale Commitment. In December 1997, the Company, through FLI,
entered into an arrangement (the "Commitment") with SW Leasing Portfolio IV,
Inc. ("SW"), as the Intermediate Purchaser, and First Union National Bank
("First Union") and Variable Funding Capital Corporation ("VFCC"), as the
ultimate investors, pursuant to which (1) SW will purchase equipment leases
(meeting specific eligibility requirements) and the underlying equipment from
FLI for a purchase price equal to the sum of the present value of scheduled
payments (the "Discounted Contract Balance") as of the date of sale and the
residual value of the equipment (the "Residual Value"), (2) First Union and
VFCC will purchase, for a price equal to the product of .88 multiplied by the
aggregate Discounted Contract Balances on the date of sale, up to $50.0
million of equipment leases from SW from time to time on or before December
17, 1998 and (3) FLI acts as servicing agent for the equipment leases
purchased by First Union and VFCC from SW. SW uses the cash received by it
from First Union and VFCC to pay a portion of the purchase price of the leases
and pays the balance with a promissory note in an original principal amount
equal to the aggregate Residual Value and the non-advanced portion of the
aggregate Discounted Contract Balances. Lease collections in excess of fees
associated with the leases and a return to First Union and VFCC (equivalent to

                                      88

<PAGE>



LIBOR, the First Union prime rate, or the federal funds rate plus 1%,
depending on the circumstances) may be reinvested in eligible leases (unless
the capital limit (the product of the aggregate Discounted Contract Balances
multiplied by .88) has been exceeded, in which event the amount of such excess
must be paid to First Union and VFCC) or paid to SW in order to pay down the
promissory note to FLI. Under the Commitment, FLI is obligated to provide a
substitute equipment lease to First Union and VFCC in the event a lease is
terminated or prepaid in full prior to its scheduled expiration date and the
prepayment amount is less than the Discounted Contract Balance on the date of
prepayment plus any outstanding servicer advances. In addition, SW and FLI are
obligated to accept re-transfer of, or provide a substitute lease for, any
lease which does not meet the eligibility requirements. The Commitment is
subject to early termination under certain circumstances, including (i) if the
ratio of the average Discounted Contract Balances (for each of the previous
three months) for all leases delinquent in payments by 60 days or more to the
aggregate Discounted Contract Balances (for each of the previous three months)
for all non-delinquent leases exceeds 3% or (ii) if the ratio of the aggregate
Discounted Contract Balances (for each of the preceding six months) for all
defaulted leases (i.e., leases which the Company has determined are not
collectible or subject to repossession or which are delinquent in payments by
120 days or more) to the aggregate Discounted Contract Balances (for each of
the preceding six months) for all non-defaulted leases exceeds 2.75%. In the
first quarter of fiscal 1998, the Company sold to SW equipment leases with an
aggregate book value of $14.4 million in return for cash of $12.3 million and
a promissory note for $3.9 million.

         Oil and Gas Credit Facility. In October 1997, the Company obtained a
$5.0 million credit facility from KeyBank for purposes of acquiring oil and
gas assets. The credit facility permits draws based on a percentage of
reserves of oil and gas properties pledged as security for the facility. Draws
under the facility bear interest at KeyBank's prime rate plus 25 basis points.
The facility requires the Company to maintain a tangible net worth in excess
of $31.0 million, a 2.0 to 1.0 ratio of current assets to current liabilities,
a 1.5 to 1.0 ratio of cash flow to maturities of long-term debt coming due
within the calculation period and a ratio of adjusted debt to tangible net
worth of not more than 2.0 to 1.0. The facility terminates on June 30, 1999.
There were no borrowings under this line during the quarter ended December 31,
1997.

Employees

         As of December 31, 1997, the Company employed 226 persons, including
8 in general corporate, 112 in real estate finance, 80 in equipment leasing
and 26 in energy.

Properties

         The Company's executive office is located in Philadelphia, and is
leased under an agreement providing for rents of $65,000 per year through May
2000. The Company's small ticket equipment leasing and residential mortgage
loan headquarters are located in Ambler, Pennsylvania, and are leased by the
Company under agreements providing for rents of

                                      89

<PAGE>



$355,000 per year (including space leased beginning July 1, 1997). The
agreements terminate on June 30, 1998 and June 30, 2007. The Company leases
space for management operations with respect to its five public leasing
partnerships in Philadelphia for $87,825 per year. That lease expires on
January 24, 2003. The Company owns a 9,600 square foot office building and
related land in Akron, Ohio, housing its energy and accounting operations. The
Company also maintains two energy field offices in Ohio and New York and an
equipment lease brokerage office in California at an aggregate rent of $46,000
per year. Aggregate rent for all of the Company's offices was $238,600 for
fiscal 1997.

Legal Proceedings

         The Company is party to various routine legal proceedings arising out
of the ordinary course of its business. Management believes that none of these
actions, individually or in the aggregate, will have a material adverse effect
on the financial condition or operations of the Company.


                                      90

<PAGE>



                                  MANAGEMENT

Directors and Executive Officers

         The following sets forth certain information regarding the directors
and executive officers of the Company:
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>

Name                                     Age        Position with the Company
- ----                                     ---        -------------------------

<S>                                      <C>        <C>                                                     
Edward E. Cohen(1)...................     59        Chairman of the Board of Directors, President,
                                                    Chief Executive Officer and Director
Daniel G. Cohen(2)...................     28        Executive Vice President and  Director
Scott F. Schaeffer(1)................     35        Executive Vice President and Director
Steven J. Kessler....................     54        Senior Vice President and Chief Financial Officer
Freddie M. Kotek.....................     42        Senior Vice President
Michael L. Staines(2)................     48        Senior Vice President, Secretary and Director
Nancy J. McGurk......................     42        Vice President-Finance and Treasurer
Carlos C. Campbell(1)................     59        Director
Andrew M. Lubin(3)...................     50        Director
Alan D. Schreiber, M.D.(3)...........     55        Director
John S. White(2).....................     56        Director
</TABLE>
- ---------
(1)  Term as director expires in 1999.
(2)  Term as director expires in 2000.
(3)  Term as director expires in 1998.

         Edward E. Cohen has been Chairman of the Board of Directors of the
Company since 1990, its Chief Executive Officer and a director since 1988 and
its President since 1995. He is Chairman of the Board of Directors and a
director of BCMI, a real estate construction and management company. See
"Management - Certain Relationships and Related Party Transactions." Since
1981, Mr. Cohen has been Chairman of the Executive Committee and a director of
JeffBanks, Inc. (a bank holding company with total assets of approximately
$1.2 billion). From 1991 to 1996, Mr. Cohen was affiliated with Ledgewood Law
Firm, P.C., most recently in an of counsel capacity. See "Legal Matters." From
1969 through 1989, Mr. Cohen was Chairman of the Board or Chairman of the
Executive Committee of State National Bank of Maryland (now First Union Bank
of Maryland) and/or its holding company.
Mr. Cohen is the father of Daniel G. Cohen.

         Daniel G. Cohen has been an Executive Vice President and Director of
the Company since July, 1997. Prior thereto, since 1995, Mr. Cohen had been a
Senior Vice President of the Company. Mr. Cohen is also Chairman, Chief
Executive Officer and a director of FMF, the residential mortgage loan
origination subsidiary of the Company. Prior to joining the Company in
November 1995, Mr. Cohen was principally engaged in graduate studies.
Mr. Cohen is the son of Edward E. Cohen.

                                      91

<PAGE>

         Scott F. Schaeffer has been an Executive Vice President and Director
of the Company since July, 1997. Prior thereto, Mr. Schaeffer had been, since
1995, a Senior Vice President of the Company. Mr. Schaeffer has been President
of Resource Properties, Inc. (a wholly owned subsidiary of the Company) since
1992.

         Steven J. Kessler has been Senior Vice President and Chief Financial
Officer of the Company since August 1997. Prior thereto, Mr. Kessler was Vice
President (Finance and Acquisitions) at Kravco Company (a national shopping
center developer and operator) from March 1994 until joining the Company. From
1983 through March of 1994, he was Chief Financial Officer and Chief Operating
Officer at Strouse Greenberg & Co., Inc., a regional full service real estate
company, and Vice President (Finance) and Chief Accounting Officer at its
successor, The Rubin Organization. Prior thereto, he was a partner at the
international accounting and consulting firm of Touche Ross & Co. (now
Deloitte & Touche LLP), Philadelphia, Pennsylvania.

         Freddie M. Kotek has been a Senior Vice President of the Company
since 1995 and an Executive Vice President of Resource Properties, Inc. (a
wholly owned subsidiary of the Company) since 1993. Prior thereto, he was a
First Vice President of Royal Alliance Associates (an investment banking and
brokerage firm) from 1991 to 1993, and a Senior Vice President and Chief
Financial Officer of Paine Webber Properties (a real estate investment firm)
from 1990 to 1991.

         Michael L. Staines has been Senior Vice President, Secretary and a
director of the Company since 1989 and President and a director of Resource
Energy since its organization in 1993.

         Nancy J. McGurk has been Vice President-Finance of the Company since
1992 and Treasurer and Chief Accounting Officer of the Company since 1984.

         Carlos C. Campbell has been a director of the Company since 1990. He
is President of C.C. Campbell and Company (a management consulting firm), Vice
Chairman of the Board of Directors of Computer Dynamics, Inc. (a computer
services corporation) and a director of Sensys, Inc. (a
telecommunication/asset management corporation).

         Andrew M. Lubin has been a director of the Company since 1994. He has
been President of Delaware Financial Group, Inc. (a private investment firm)
since 1984.

         Alan D. Schreiber, M.D. has been a director of the Company since
1994. Dr. Schreiber has been a Professor of Medicine and Assistant Dean for
Research and Research Training at the University of Pennsylvania School of
Medicine since 1973 and Chairman of the Scientific Advisory Board of Inkine
Pharmaceutical Co., Inc. since 1997. From 1993 to 1997, Dr. Schreiber was
Chief Scientific Officer of CorBec Pharmaceuticals, Inc., a Company he
founded.


                                      92

<PAGE>



         John S. White has been a director of the Company since 1993. He has
been Chairman of the Board and Chief Executive Officer of DCC Securities
Corporation (a securities brokerage firm) since 1990.

Other Significant Employees

         The following sets forth certain information regarding other
significant employees of the Company:

         Abraham Bernstein, age 64, is the Chairman, Chief Executive Officer
and President of the small ticket equipment leasing subsidiary of the Company.
From 1982 to 1993, he was the President and Chief Executive Officer of Tokai
Financial Services, Inc., the equipment leasing subsidiary of Tokai Bank of
Japan. From 1993 to 1995, the contractual period during which Mr. Bernstein's
restrictive covenant with Tokai was in effect, Mr. Bernstein was a Managing
Director of the Rittenhouse Consulting Group (a financial consulting company).

         Crit DeMent, age 44, is the Executive Vice President of FLI. Prior
thereto, from 1983 through 1996 he was Vice President-Marketing and Leasing
Associate-Senior Account Representative for Tokai Financial Services, Inc.

         Joseph T. Ellis, Jr., age 36, is the Director of Vendor Services for
FLI. Prior thereto, from 1985 through February 1996, he held various marketing
and sales positions with Tokai Financial Services, Inc., most recently as the
Director of Program Management and Strategic Market Development.

         Frank V. Pellegrini, age 50, has been the Chairman, Chief Executive
Officer and President of Tri-Star since 1993. Prior to that, he was Senior
Vice President of Home American Financial Services, Inc. (now known as Upland
Mortgage Corporation), a residential mortgage lender.

         Kathy B. Schauer, age 46, has served since February 1997 as the
President, Chief Operating Officer and a director of FMF. Immediately prior to
joining FMF, Ms. Schauer served as Director of Business and Product
Development at Standard & Poors Rating Services (where she was involved in the
development and implementation of credit scoring and pricing models for the
residential mortgage market), and, prior thereto, served in executive
capacities with Smith Barney, Meridian Bancorp and J.P. Morgan. From 1985 to
1993, Ms. Schauer was a Vice President (Mortgage Products Group) of CS First
Boston.

         Bruce R. Schmidt, age 40, is Senior Vice President of FMF. From 1993
until March 1997, Mr. Schmidt was Director of Marketing for Advanta Corp., a
national consumer home equity lender. Prior thereto, from 1988 to 1993, he was
Vice President, Marketing, for Nutri/System, Inc., a national weight loss
program company.


                                      93

<PAGE>



         Jeffrey C. Simmons, age 39, has been Executive Vice President and a
director of Resource Energy since 1997. From 1994 to 1997 he was Vice
President-Exploration of the Company and from 1988 to 1994 he was Director of
Well Services of the Company.

Certain Relationships and Related Party Transactions

         In the ordinary course of its business operations, the Company has
ongoing relationships with several related entities, primarily a property
management firm, a bank and RAIT. As particular opportunities have arisen, the
Company has purchased commercial mortgage loans from, or involving borrowers
which are, affiliated with officers of the Company. In three instances
(excluding sales to RAIT) the Company has sold senior or junior lien interests
in commercial loans to purchasers affiliated with officers of the Company. At
December 31, 1997, loans held with respect to related borrowers or acquired
from related lenders constitute 7% ($8.2 million), by book value, of the
Company's commercial loan portfolio, while the senior lien interests sold to
related purchasers constituted 6% ($5.9 million) of all senior lien interests
with respect to the Company's commercial loan portfolio. Transactions with
affiliates must be approved by the Company's Board of Directors, including a
majority of the disinterested directors. In addition, acquisitions of
commercial mortgage loans must be approved by the Investment Committee of the
Board of Directors (which consists of two disinterested directors). The
Company believes that the terms of its transactions with related parties are
no less favorable than those available from unrelated third parties. A more
detailed description of these relationships and transactions is set forth
below.

         Relationship with BCMI. The Company holds commercial mortgage loans
of borrowers whose underlying properties are managed by BCMI, a firm of which
Edward E. Cohen is Chairman of the Board of Directors and a minority
stockholder (approximately 8%). The Company has advanced funds to certain of
these borrowers for improvements on their properties, which have been
performed by BCMI. The President of BCMI (or an entity affiliated with him)
has also acted as the general partner or trustee of ten of the borrowers; an
entity affiliated with him is the general partner of the sole limited partner
of an eleventh borrower. BCMI has agreed to subordinate its management fees to
receipt by the Company of minimum required debt service payments under the
obligations held by the Company.

         Relationship with Jefferson Bank. The Company maintains normal
banking and borrowing relationships with Jefferson Bank, a subsidiary of
JeffBanks, Inc. The Company, through FMF, subcontracts any residential
mortgage loan servicing duties to Jefferson Bank. See "Business - Real Estate
Finance - Residential Mortgage Loans." Edward E. Cohen and his spouse are
officers and directors of JeffBanks, Inc. (and his spouse is Chairman and
Chief Executive Officer of Jefferson Bank and JeffBanks, Inc.), and are
principal stockholders thereof. Daniel G. Cohen is a director of Jefferson
Bank. The Company anticipates that it may effect borrowings in the future from
Jefferson Bank. Jefferson Bank is also a tenant at two properties which secure
loans held by the Company and, at one of such properties, subleases space to
RAIT.


                                      94

<PAGE>



         Relationship with RAIT. The Company sponsored the formation and
public offering of common shares of beneficial interest of RAIT. See "Business
- - Real Estate Finance - Sponsorship of Real Estate Investment Trust." RAIT
raised $49.3 million (including the Company's investment) in the offering
which was completed in January 1998. The Company acquired 15% of RAIT's
outstanding shares for an investment of approximately $7.0 million. Edward E.
Cohen's spouse, Betsy Z. Cohen, is Chairman and Chief Executive Officer of
RAIT. The Company has the right to nominate one person for election to the
Board of Trustees until such time as its ownership of RAIT's outstanding
common shares is less than 5%. One of the current trustees, Jonathan Z. Cohen,
is serving as the Company's nominee. Jonathan Z. Cohen is the son of Edward E.
Cohen (Chairman, Chief Executive Officer and President of the Company), the
brother of Daniel G. Cohen (Executive Vice President and director of the
Company and Chairman and Chief Executive Officer of FMF), and is the Secretary
and a director of Resource Energy. The Company had advanced funds to RAIT for
legal, accounting and filing fees and expenses, salaries of RAIT's executive
officers, rent and other organizational expenses and for the expenses incurred
by the Company in sponsoring RAIT including an allocation of compensation of
Company employees. These advances were without interest and were repaid from
the proceeds of RAIT offering.

         In connection with RAIT's offering, the Company, through its
subsidiaries, sold ten loans and senior lien interests in two additional loans
to RAIT (the "Initial Investments") at an aggregate purchase price of $20.1
million (including $2.0 million attributable to senior lien interests acquired
by the Company in connection with the sales to RAIT). Two of the Initial
Investments were originated for RAIT; one was sold to RAIT at cost and RAIT
purchased a senior lien interest in the other at cost. The Company realized a
gain on the sale of the Initial Investments of $3.0 million. The Company
anticipates that, subject to certain limitations, it will sell additional
investments to RAIT.

         Relationships with Certain Borrowers. The Company has from time to
time purchased loans in which affiliates of the Company are affiliates of the
borrowers, as discussed in the following paragraphs. (Loan numbers are as set
forth in the table of loans in "Business - Real Estate Finance - Commercial
Mortgage Loan Acquisition and Resolution: Loan Status.")

         In August 1997, the Company, through a subsidiary, acquired a loan
(loan 35) with a face amount of $2.3 million from Jefferson Bank at a cost of
$1.6 million. The loan is secured by a property owned by a partnership in
which Mr. Schaeffer, the Company's executive vice president and a director, is
the general partner and Edward E. Cohen, together with his spouse, are limited
partners. The Company leases its headquarters space at such property. The
lease provides for rents of $65,000 per year through May 2000. Ledgewood Law
Firm, P.C., a law firm which provides legal services to the Company, and BCMI
are also tenants at such property.

         In June 1997, the Company acquired a loan (loan 29) with a face
amount of $7.0 million from a partnership in which Mr. Schaeffer and Edward E.
Cohen, together with his

                                      95

<PAGE>



wife, are limited partners. Mr. Schaeffer was previously the general partner
of such partnership. The Company acquired such loan at a cost of $3.0 million.

         In December 1994, the Company acquired a loan (loan 13) with a face
amount of $3.0 million from California Federal Bank, FSB at a cost of $1.7
million. The loan is secured by a property owned by a borrower whose general
partner is the President of BCMI. Edward E. Cohen, together with his wife, is
a limited partner in such partnership. The borrower refinanced the Company's
loan in September 1995, applying $2.0 million of the proceeds to the repayment
of the Company's loan. As a result, the Company obtained a gain on its
investment of $300,000, while maintaining a continuing interest in the loan of
approximately $1.0 million.

         In August 1994, the Company acquired from third parties a loan (loan
8), in the original principal amount of $ 3.4 million (and with a
then-outstanding balance of $4.4 million), for an investment of $1.6 million.
The borrower is a limited partnership of which Mr. Lubin, a director of the
Company, is currently the general partner. Mr. Lubin assumed such position
after the Company's acquisition of the loan. Previously, the general partner
had been the President of BCMI. The borrower subsequently refinanced the loan
with another third party and repaid the Company $934,000, leaving the Company
with a net investment of $419,000. This loan was sold to RAIT in January 1998.

         Relationships with Certain Lienholders. The Company has sold two
senior lien interests and one junior lien interest in its commercial loans to
entities in which officers of the Company have minority interests as discussed
in the following paragraphs.

         In December 1997, the Company purchased from third parties, for an
aggregate of $1.51 million, two loans (loan 43) in the aggregate original
principal amount of $2.0 million and with an aggregate outstanding balance at
the time of purchase of $1.96 million. The loans are secured by an apartment
building. The Company sold to a limited partnership in which Edward E. Cohen
and Scott F. Schaeffer beneficially own a 17.8% interest a senior lien
interest in one of the loans for $1.0 million, reducing the Company's net
investment to $518,000 and leaving the Company with a retained interest in
outstanding loan receivables of $1.0 million (at a book value of $803,000).

         From November 1996 to June 1997 the Company acquired from third
parties loans (loan 26) relating to one property in the aggregate original
principal amount of $5.8 million (and with aggregate outstanding balances at
the respective times of purchase of $6.9 million) for an investment of $2.5
million. The Company sold a senior lien interest in the loan for $2.2 million
reducing the Company's net investment to $245,000 and leaving the Company with
a retained interest in outstanding loan receivables of $6.3 million (at a book
value of $2.4 million). The purchaser was a limited partnership in which
Edward E. Cohen and Scott F. Schaeffer beneficially own an 18.3% limited
partnership interest.


                                      96

<PAGE>



         In June 1996, for an investment of $2.4 million the Company acquired
from third parties a loan (loan 22), in the original principal amount of $3.3
million (and with a then-outstanding balance of $3.3 million). The Company
sold a junior lien interest in the loan for $875,000, leaving the Company with
a net investment of $1.5 million, to a limited partnership in which Messrs.
Edward E. Cohen and Scott F. Schaeffer beneficially own a 21.3% limited
partnership interest.

         Relationship with Financing Institution. The Company has in the past
obtained material amounts of financing from Physicians Insurance Company of
Ohio ("PICO") by the sale to PICO, in May 1994, of an $8 million principal
amount 9.5% senior note and by the sale to PICO, in fiscal years 1995 and
1996, of $12 million of senior lien interests in seven of the Company's
portfolio loans, together with warrants to purchase 983,150 shares of Common
Stock. In July 1997, the Company repaid the senior note in full and PICO
exercised, and subsequently sold, the common shares underlying the warrants to
institutional investors in private transactions pursuant to which the Company
granted certain registration rights. See "Shares Eligible for Future Sale."
Following such transactions, John R. Hart, an executive officer and director
of PICO who had become a director of the Company in connection with the PICO
financings, resigned from the Board of Directors of the Company.


                                      97

<PAGE>



                         SECURITY OWNERSHIP OF CERTAIN
                       BENEFICIAL OWNERS AND MANAGEMENT

         The following table sets forth the number and percentage of shares of
Common Stock owned, as of March 3, 1998, by (a) each person who, to the
knowledge of the Company, is the beneficial owner of 5% or more of the
outstanding shares of Common Stock, (b) each of the Company's present
directors, (c) each of the Company's executive officers, and (d) all of the
Company's present executive officers and directors as a group. This
information is reported in accordance with the beneficial ownership rules of
the Securities and Exchange Commission under which a person is deemed to be
the beneficial owner of a security if that person has or shares voting power
or investment power with respect to such security or has the right to acquire
such ownership within 60 days. Shares of Common Stock issuable pursuant to
options or warrants are deemed to be outstanding for purposes of computing the
percentage of the person or group holding such options or warrants but are not
deemed to be outstanding for purposes of computing the percentage of any other
person. See note (2) below, for information concerning outstanding options.
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>

                                                                         Common Stock
                                                     -------------------------------------------------
                                                     Amount and Nature of                   Percent of
         Beneficial Owner                            Beneficial Ownership                      Class
         ----------------                            --------------------                      -----
         <S>                                         <C>                              <C>
         Directors(1)
         Carlos C. Campbell                                    160                                *
         Daniel G. Cohen                                     6,180  (2)                           *
         Edward E. Cohen                                   426,250  (2)(3)(4)(6)              8.89%
         Andrew M. Lubin                                       280                                *
         Scott F. Schaeffer                                100,183  (2)(3)(4)(5)              2.11%
         Alan D. Schreiber, M.D.                             5,370                                *
         Michael L. Staines                                 44,390  (2)(3)(4)                     *
         John S. White                                           0                                *

         Executive Officers(1)

         Steven J. Kessler                                       0                                *
         Freddie M. Kotek                                   26,355  (2)(3)(4)                     *
         Nancy J. McGurk                                    24,900  (2)(3)(4)                     *

         All present officers                              579,335  (2)(3)(4)(5)(6)          11.97%
         and directors as a group
         (11 persons)
</TABLE>


                                      98

<PAGE>
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>

                                                                         Common Stock
                                                     -------------------------------------------------
                                                     Amount and Nature of                   Percent of
         Beneficial Owner                            Beneficial Ownership                      Class
         ----------------                            --------------------                      -----
         <S>                                         <C>                              <C>
         Other owners of 5% or
         More of Outstanding Shares(7)

         Friedman, Billings, Ramsey Investment
            Management, Inc.                               314,005                            6.61%
         Keefe Managers, Inc.                              450,000                            9.48%
         Kramer Spellman L.P.                              536,800                           11.30%
         Wellington Management
            Company, LLP.                                  548,500                           11.55%
</TABLE>
- ---------
* Less than 1%

(1)      The address for each director and executive officer is 1521 Locust
         Street, Fourth Floor, Philadelphia, Pennsylvania 19102.
(2)      Includes shares allocated under the Resource America, Inc. Employee
         Savings Plan (the Company's 401(k) plan) in the amounts of: Mr. E.
         Cohen - 2,792 shares; Mr. Kotek - 1,522 shares; Ms. McGurk - 4,704
         shares; Mr. Schaeffer - 688 shares; Mr. Staines - 558 shares; and Mr.
         D. Cohen - 562 shares, as to which each has voting power.
(3)      Includes shares issuable on exercise of options granted in 1993 and
         1995 under the 1989 Key Employee Stock Option Plan in the amounts of:
         Mr. E. Cohen - 47,753 shares; Mr. Schaeffer - 5,618 shares; Mr.
         Staines - 22,472 shares; Mr. Kotek - 9,832 shares; and Ms.
         McGurk - 5,618 shares.
(4)      Includes shares allocated under the 1989 Employee Stock Ownership
         Plan in the amounts of: Mr. E. Cohen - 20,089 shares; Mr. Staines -
         13,624 shares; Mr. Schaeffer - 7,047 shares; Mr. Kotek - 5,170
         shares; and Ms. McGurk - 8,960 shares, as to which each has voting
         power.
(5)      Includes 60,815 shares held by a limited partnership, of which Mr.
         Schaeffer is the general partner and in which he has a 10% interest.
(6)      Includes Mr. Cohen's proportionate interest (aggregating 54,733
         shares) in shares held by a limited partnership in which Mr. Cohen is
         the limited partner.
(7)      Includes shares held by entities managed by the named persons. The
         address for Friedman, Billings, Ramsey Investment Management, Inc.,
         an affiliate of Friedman, Billings, Ramsey & Co., Inc., is 1001 19th
         Street North, 18th Floor, Arlington, Virginia 22209; the address for
         Keefe Managers, Inc. is 375 Park Avenue, Suite 3108, New York, New
         York 10152; the address for Kramer Spellman L.P. is 2050 Center
         Avenue, Suite 300, Fort Lee, New Jersey 07024; and the address for
         Wellington Management Company, LLP. is 75 State Street, Boston,
         Massachusetts 02109.

                                      99

<PAGE>



                         DESCRIPTION OF CAPITAL STOCK

General

         The Company is authorized to issue 50,000,000 shares of capital
stock, consisting of 49,000,000 shares of Common Stock, par value $.01 per
share, and 1,000,000 shares of preferred stock, par value $1.00 per share
("Preferred Stock"). As of March 3, 1998, there were 4,748,537 shares of
Common Stock outstanding and no shares of Preferred Stock outstanding.

Common Stock

         Holders of Common Stock are entitled to dividends when, as and if
declared by the Company's Board of Directors and in such amounts as the Board
of Directors may deem advisable. See "Price Range of Common Stock and Dividend
Policy." In the event of any liquidation, dissolution or winding up of the
Company, whether voluntary or involuntary, holders of Common Stock are
entitled, after payment or provision for payment of the debts or other
liabilities of the Company, and subject to the prior rights of holders of any
Preferred Stock which may then be outstanding, to share ratably in the
remaining assets of the Company. Shares of Common Stock do not possess
preemptive rights. Holders of Common Stock are entitled to one vote for each
share held of record on each matter submitted to a vote at a meeting of
stockholders. For a description of certain provisions of the Company's
Certificate of Incorporation and Delaware law which affect the voting rights
of stockholders of the Company and provide for a classified board of
directors, see "Description of Capital Stock - Anti-Takeover Provisions of
Delaware Law" and " - Classes of Directors."

Preferred Stock

         Preferred Stock may be issued from time to time in one or more series
and the Board of Directors, without further approval of the stockholders, is
authorized to fix the dividend rights and terms, conversion rights, voting
rights, redemption rights and terms, liquidation preferences, sinking funds
and any other rights, preferences, privileges and restrictions applicable to
each such series of Preferred Stock. The issuance of Preferred Stock, while
providing flexibility in connection with possible acquisitions and other
corporate purposes, could, among other things, adversely affect the voting
power of the holders of Common Stock and, under certain circumstances, make it
more difficult for a third party to gain control of the Company. The Company
has no current plan to issue any Preferred Stock.

Anti-Takeover Provisions of Delaware Law

         The Company is a Delaware corporation and consequently is subject to
certain anti-takeover provisions of the Delaware General Corporation Law (the
"Delaware Law"). Under the business combination provision contained in Section
203 of the Delaware Law ("Section 203"), a Delaware corporation may not engage
in any business combination with any interested stockholder for a period of
three years following the date such stockholder became an interested

                                      100

<PAGE>



stockholder, unless (i) prior to such date the board of directors of the
corporation approved either the business combination or the transaction which
resulted in the stockholder becoming an interested stockholder, or (ii) upon
completion of the transaction which resulted in the stockholder becoming an
interested stockholder, the interested stockholder owned at least 85% of the
voting stock of the corporation outstanding at the time the transaction
commenced (excluding, for purposes of determining the number of shares
outstanding, (a) shares owned by persons who are directors and also officers
and (b) employee stock plans, in certain instances), or (iii) on or subsequent
to such date the business combination is approved by the board of directors
and authorized at an annual or special meeting of stockholders by at least
two-thirds of the outstanding voting stock that is not owned by the interested
stockholder. Section 203 defines an interested stockholder of a corporation to
be any person (other than the corporation and any direct or indirect
majority-owned subsidiary of the corporation) who (i) owns, directly or
indirectly, 15% or more of the outstanding voting stock of the corporation or
(ii) is an affiliate or associate of the corporation and was the owner of 15%
or more of the outstanding voting stock of the corporation at any time within
the three-year period immediately prior to the date on which it is sought to
be determined whether such person (and the affiliates and the associates of
such person) is an interested stockholder. Section 203 defines business
combinations to include certain mergers, consolidations, asset sales,
transfers and other transactions resulting in a financial benefit to the
interested stockholder.

         The restrictions imposed by Section 203 will not apply to a
corporation if (i) the corporation's original certificate of incorporation
contains a provision expressly electing not to be governed by Section 203 or
(ii) the corporation, by the action of stockholders holding a majority of
outstanding voting stock, adopts an amendment to its certificate of
incorporation or by-laws expressly electing not to be governed by Section 203
(such amendment will not be effective until 12 months after adoption and shall
not apply to any business combination between such corporation and any person
who became an interested stockholder of such corporation on or prior to such
adoption). The Company has not opted out of Section 203. Section 203 could
under certain circumstances make it more difficult for a third party to gain
control of the Company, deny stockholders the receipt of a premium on their
Common Stock and have a depressive effect on the market price of the Common
Stock.

Classes of Directors

         The Board of Directors is currently classified into three classes.
One class of directors is elected each year and the members of such class hold
office for a three-year term or until each of their successors is duly elected
and qualified. The classification of directors will have the effect of making
it more difficult for a third party to change the composition of the Board of
Directors without the support of the incumbent Board. At least two annual
stockholder meetings, instead of one, will be required to effect a change in
the control of the Board, unless stockholders remove directors for cause.


                                      101

<PAGE>



Transfer Agent and Registrar

         The transfer agent and registrar for the Common Stock is American
Stock Transfer & Trust Company.

                                      102

<PAGE>
                        SHARES ELIGIBLE FOR FUTURE SALE

         The Company's Certificate of Incorporation authorizes the issuance of
9,000,000 shares of capital stock, consisting of 8,000,000 shares of Common
Stock and 1,000,000 shares of Preferred Stock. Upon completion of this
offering, there will be outstanding 6,248,537 shares of Common Stock (assuming
no exercise of the Underwriters' over-allotment option).

         The 1,500,000 shares of Common Stock to be sold in this offering
(1,725,000 shares if the Underwriters' over-allotment option is exercised in
full) will be available to the public without restriction or further
registration under the Securities Act, except for shares purchased by
affiliates of the Company (in general, any person who has a control
relationship with the Company), which shares will be subject to the resale
limitations of Rule 144 promulgated under the Securities Act ("Rule 144"). The
Company, its executive officers and directors, and entities affiliated with
Friedman, Billings, Ramsey & Co., Inc. ("FBR") have agreed to not offer, sell
or contract to sell or otherwise dispose of Common Stock without the prior
consent of FBR or, in the case of sale by affiliates of FBR, the Company, for
a period of 120 days following the conclusion of the Offering. See
"Underwriting".

         In general, under Rule 144 as currently in effect, any person (or
persons whose shares are aggregated) who has beneficially owned shares for at
least one year is entitled to sell, within any three month period, a number of
shares which does not exceed the greater of 1% of the then outstanding shares
of the Common Stock or the average weekly trading volume of the Common Stock
during the four calendar weeks preceding the date on which notice of the sale
is filed with the Commission. Sales under Rule 144 may also be subject to
certain manner of sale provisions, notice requirements and the availability of
current public information about the Company. Any person (or persons whose
shares are aggregated) who is not deemed to have been an affiliate of the
Company at any time during the three months preceding a sale, and who has
beneficially owned shares within the definition of "restricted securities"
under Rule 144 for at least two years, is entitled to sell such shares under
Rule 144(k) without regard to the volume limitation, manner of sale
provisions, public information requirements or notice requirements.

         In February 1998, pursuant to a contractual obligation, the Company
filed a registration statement on Form S-3 with the Commission in order to
register the resale of an aggregate of 983,150 shares of Common Stock by
certain selling stockholders. Upon effectiveness of such registration
statement, all of the shares included in the registration statement will be
permitted to be sold to the public without restriction, at the discretion of
the selling stockholders. The Company has agreed to maintain the effectiveness
of the registration statement for two years.

         There are currently outstanding options held by officers and
directors to purchase 262,431 shares of Common Stock.

         The Company has reserved an additional 207,795 shares of Common Stock
for future option grants.


                                      103

<PAGE>



         No prediction can be made as to the effect, if any, that future sales
of shares of Common Stock or availability of such shares for future sale will
have on the market price of the Common Stock prevailing from time to time.
Sales of substantial amounts of Common Stock (including shares issued upon the
exercise of outstanding options), or the perception that such sales could
occur, could adversely affect prevailing market prices for the Common Stock.





                                      104

<PAGE>
                                 UNDERWRITING

         Subject to the terms and conditions of the Underwriting Agreement,
the Underwriters named below (the "Underwriters"), through Friedman, Billings,
Ramsey & Co., Inc., BancAmerica Robertson Stephens and Janney Montgomery Scott
Inc., as their representatives (the "Representatives"), have severally agreed
to purchase from the Company the following respective number of shares of
Common Stock at the offering price less the underwriting discounts and
commissions set forth on the cover page of this Prospectus:

         Underwriter                                           Number of Shares
         -----------                                           ----------------

         Friedman, Billings, Ramsey & Co., Inc.........
         BancAmerica Robertson Stephens................
         Janney Montgomery Scott Inc...................
                                                                ---------
            Total......................................         1,500,000
                                                                =========

         The Underwriting Agreement provides that the obligations of the
Underwriters are subject to certain conditions precedent and that the
Underwriters will purchase all of the shares offered hereby (other than those
covered by the over-allotment option described below), if any of such shares
are purchased.

         The Company has been advised by the Underwriters that the
Underwriters propose to offer the shares of Common Stock to the public at the
offering price set forth on the cover page of this Prospectus and to certain
dealers at such price less a concession not in excess of $________ per share.
The Underwriters may allow, and such dealers may reallow, a concession not in
excess of $_______ per share to certain other dealers. After the initial
offering, the offering price and other selling terms may be changed by the
Representatives.

         The Company has granted to the Underwriters an option, exercisable
not later than 30 days after the date of this Prospectus, to purchase up to
225,000 additional shares of Common Stock at the initial offering price less
the underwriting discounts and commissions set forth on the cover page of this
Prospectus. To the extent that the Underwriters exercise such option, each of
the Underwriters will have a firm commitment to purchase approximately the
same percentage thereof that the number of shares of Common Stock to be
purchased by it shown in the above table bears to 1,500,000, and the Company
will be obligated, pursuant to the option, to sell such shares to the
Underwriters. The Underwriters may exercise such option only to cover
over-allotments made in connection with the sale of Common Stock offered
hereby. If purchased, the Underwriters will offer such additional shares on
the same terms as those on which the 1,500,000 shares are being offered.

         The Company, its executive officers and directors, and entities
affiliated with FBR have agreed not to offer, sell or contract to sell or
otherwise dispose of any shares of Common Stock

                                      105

<PAGE>



without the prior consent of FBR or, in the case of sale by affiliates of FBR,
the Company, for a period of 120 days following the conclusion of the Offering.

         The Company has agreed to indemnify the Underwriters against certain
liabilities including liabilities under the Securities Act.

         In connection with this offering, the Underwriters may engage in
transactions that stabilize, maintain or otherwise affect the market price of
the Common Stock. Such transactions may include stabilization transactions
pursuant to which the Representatives may bid for or purchase Common Stock for
the purpose of stabilizing its market price. The Underwriters also may create
a short position for the account of the Underwriters by selling more Common
Stock in connection with this offering than they are committed to purchase
from the Company and in such case the Representatives may purchase Common
Stock in the open market following completion of this offering to cover all or
a portion of such short position. The Underwriters may also cover all or a
portion of such short position by exercising the Underwriters' over-allotment
option referred to above. In addition, the Representatives, on behalf of the
Underwriters, may impose "penalty bids" under contractual arrangements with
the Underwriters whereby they may reclaim from an Underwriter (or dealer
participating in this offering), for the account of other Underwriters, the
selling concession with respect to Common Stock that is distributed in this
offering but subsequently purchased for the account of the Underwriters in the
open market. Any of the transactions described in this paragraph may result in
the maintenance of the price of the Common Stock at a level above that which
might otherwise prevail in the open market. The imposition of a penalty bid
might also affect the price of the Common Stock to the extent that it could
discourage resales of the security. Neither the Company nor any of the
Underwriters makes any representation or prediction as to the direction or
magnitude of any effect that the transactions described above may have on the
price of the Common Stock. In addition, neither the Company nor any of the
Underwriters makes any representation that the Underwriters will engage in
such transactions or that such transactions, once commenced, will not be
discontinued without notice.

         The Underwriters and dealers may engage in passive market making
transactions in the Common Stock in accordance with Rule 103 of Regulation M
promulgated by the Commission. In general, a passive market maker may not bid
for or purchase shares of Common Stock at a price that exceeds the highest
independent bid. In addition, the net daily purchases made by any passive
market maker generally may not exceed 30% of its average daily trading volume
in the Common Stock during a specified two-month prior period, or 200 shares,
whichever is greater. A passive market maker must identify passive market
making bids as such on the Nasdaq electronic inter-dealer reporting system.
Passive market making may stabilize or maintain the market price of the Common
Stock above independent market levels. Underwriters and dealers are not
required to engage in passive market making and may end passive market making
activities at any time.


                                      106

<PAGE>



         The Representatives have informed the Company that the Underwriters
do not intend to confirm sales of the Common Stock offered hereby to any
accounts over which they exercise discretionary authority.

         Entities associated with Friedman, Billings, Ramsey & Co., Inc. are
the beneficial owners of 314,005 shares of the Common Stock, representing 6.7%
of all Common Stock issued and outstanding. Friedman, Billings, Ramsey & Co.,
Inc. currently makes a market in the Common Stock and the Senior Notes.

                                 LEGAL MATTERS

         The legality of the Common Stock offered hereby is being passed upon
by Ledgewood Law Firm, P.C., Philadelphia, Pennsylvania. Certain legal matters
will be passed upon for the Underwriters by Silver, Freedman & Taff, L.L.P.,
Washington, D.C.

                             INDEPENDENT AUDITORS

         The consolidated financial statements and schedules of the Company
and its subsidiaries as of September 30, 1997 and 1996 and for each of the
three year periods ended September 30, 1997 included in this Prospectus have
been so included in reliance upon the reports of Grant Thornton LLP,
independent certified public accountants, upon the authority of such firm as
experts in accounting and auditing.



                                      107

<PAGE>



Report of Independent Certified Public Accountants

Stockholders and Board of Directors 
RESOURCE AMERICA, INC.

         We have audited the accompanying consolidated balance sheets of
Resource America, Inc. and subsidiaries as of September 30, 1997 and 1996, and
the related consolidated statements of income, changes in stockholders'
equity, and cash flows for each of the three years in the period ended
September 30, 1997. These financial statements are the responsibility of the
Company's management. Our responsibility is to express an opinion on these
financial statements based on our audits.

         We conducted our audits in accordance with generally accepted
auditing standards. Those standards require that we plan and perform the audit
to obtain reasonable assurance about whether the financial statements are free
of material misstatement. An audit includes examining, on a test basis,
evidence supporting the amounts and disclosures in the financial statements.
An audit also includes assessing the accounting principles used and
significant estimates made by management, as well as evaluating the overall
financial statement presentation. We believe that our audits provide a
reasonable basis for our opinion.

         In our opinion, the financial statements referred to above present
fairly, in all material respects, the consolidated financial position of
Resource America, Inc. and subsidiaries as of September 30, 1997 and 1996, and
the consolidated results of their operations and cash flows for each of the
three years in the period ended September 30, 1997, in conformity with
generally accepted accounting principles.


Grant Thornton LLP


Cleveland, Ohio 
November 6, 1997, except for 
Earnings Per Share disclosures 
in Footnote 2 to the financial 
statements for which the date is 
February 19, 1998


                                      F-1

<PAGE>
                            RESOURCE AMERICA, INC.
                          CONSOLIDATED BALANCE SHEETS
                                (in thousands)
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>

                                                                                              September 30,
                                                                         December 31,     ----------------------
                                                                            1997           1997           1996
                                                                         ------------     --------       -------
                                                                         (Unaudited)
<S>                                                                        <C>            <C>            <C>    
ASSETS
Current Assets
  Cash and cash equivalents........................................        $ 28,086       $ 69,279       $ 4,154
  Accounts and notes receivable....................................           5,309          2,414         1,479
  Prepaid expenses and other current assets........................             948            576           473
                                                                           --------       --------       -------
         Total current assets......................................          34,343         72,269         6,106

Investments in Real Estate Loans (less allowance for
  possible losses of $468, $400, and $0)...........................         128,884         88,816        21,798

Notes Secured by Equipment Leases..................................           9,008          4,761           -

Net Investment in Direct Financing Leases (less allowance for
  possible losses of $492, $248 and $7)............................           4,206          3,391           729

Property and Equipment
  Oil and gas properties and equipment (successful efforts)........          25,967         24,939        24,035
  Gas gathering and transmission facilities........................           1,609          1,606         1,536
  Other  ..........................................................           3,652          2,874         1,666
                                                                           --------      ---------      --------
                                                                             31,228         29,419        27,237

  Less accumulated depreciation, depletion, and amortization.......         (16,073)       (15,793)      (14,857)
                                                                           --------      ----------     --------
                                                                             15,155         13,626        12,380
Other Assets (less accumulated amortization of $1,307, $1,014
   and $885).......................................................          16,323         12,256         2,946
                                                                           --------      ---------      --------
                                                                           $207,919       $195,119       $43,959
                                                                           ========       ========       =======
LIABILITIES AND STOCKHOLDERS' EQUITY
Current Liabilities
  Current maturities of long-term debt.............................        $  5,100       $    708       $   105
  Accounts payable.................................................           1,754          1,339           585
  Accrued interest.................................................           6,180          2,734           253
  Accrued liabilities..............................................           2,884          1,967           344
  Estimated income taxes...........................................             772          4,093           377
                                                                           --------      ---------      --------
         Total current liabilities.................................          16,690         10,841         1,664

Long-Term Debt, less current maturities............................         118,116        118,786         8,966
Other Long-Term Liabilities........................................           1,830            663          --
Deferred Income Taxes..............................................             826            --          2,206
Commitments and Contingencies......................................             --             --            --

Stockholders' Equity
  Preferred Stock, $1.00 par value; 1,000,000 authorized shares....             --             --            --
  Common Stock, $.01 par value; 8,000,000 authorized shares........              55             54            20
  Additional paid-in capital.......................................          59,343         56,787        21,761
  Retained earnings................................................          25,486         22,005        12,458
</TABLE>

                                      F-2

<PAGE>
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>

                                                                                              September 30,
                                                                         December 31,     ----------------------
                                                                            1997           1997           1996
                                                                         ------------     --------       -------
                                                                         (Unaudited)
<S>                                                                        <C>            <C>            <C>    
  Less treasury stock, at cost.....................................         (14,074)       (13,664)       (2,699)
  Less loan receivable from Employee Stock Ownership Plan ("ESOP")             (353)          (353)         (417)
                                                                           --------       --------      --------
         Total stockholders' equity................................          70,457         64,829        31,123
                                                                            -------       --------      --------
                                                                           $207,919       $195,119       $43,959
                                                                           ========       ========       =======
</TABLE>

         See accompanying notes to consolidated financial statements.

                                      F-3

<PAGE>
                            RESOURCE AMERICA, INC.
                       CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF INCOME
                     (in thousands, except per share data)
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>


                                                                  Quarter Ended
                                                                   December 31,        Years Ended September 30,
                                                                 ----------------     ----------------------------
                                                                  1997      1996      1997        1996       1995
                                                                 -------  --------   --------- --------- ---------
                                                                   (Unaudited)
<S>                                                              <C>       <C>         <C>       <C>       <C>    
REVENUES
Real Estate Finance........................................      $ 9,392   $ 3,219     $19,144   $ 7,171   $ 6,114
Equipment Leasing..........................................        3,172     1,202       7,162     4,466      --
Energy: Production.........................................        1,232       950       3,936     3,421     3,452
         Services..........................................          583       389       1,672     1,736     1,879
Interest on Corporate Investments..........................          698        84         930       197       149
                                                                 -------  --------   --------- --------- ---------
                                                                  15,077     5,844      32,844    16,991    11,594

COSTS AND EXPENSES
Real Estate Finance........................................        1,523       163       1,069       852       801
Equipment Leasing..........................................        1,325       883       3,822     2,339       --
Energy: Exploration and Production.........................          574       412       1,823     1,582     1,733
          Services.........................................          309       224         909       869     1,026
General and Administrative.................................          927       592       2,851     1,756     2,265
Depreciation, Depletion and Amortization...................          508       379       1,614     1,368     1,335
Interest ..................................................        3,870       409       5,273       872     1,091
Provision for Possible Losses.............                           318        10         653         7      --
Other - Net................................................         --        --           (27)     --          (2)
                                                                --------  --------    --------  -------- ---------
                                                                   9,354     3,072      17,987     9,645     8,249
                                                                 -------   -------     -------   -------   -------
         Income from Operations............................        5,723     2,772      14,857     7,346     3,345
                                                                 -------   -------     -------   -------   -------

OTHER INCOME (EXPENSE)
Gain (Loss) on Sale of Property............................            3        88          74         7        (1)
                                                                 -------   -------     -------  -------- ---------

Income Before Income Taxes.................................        5,726     2,860      14,931     7,353     3,344

Provision for Income Taxes.................................        1,775       575       3,980     2,206       630
                                                                 -------   -------     -------   -------   -------
Net Income.................................................      $ 3,951   $ 2,285     $10,951   $ 5,147   $ 2,714
                                                                 =======   =======     =======   =======   =======

Net Income Per Common Share - Basic........................    $     .83 $     .91   $    3.15 $    2.72 $    1.43
                                                               --------- ---------   --------- --------- ---------
Weighted Average Common Shares Outstanding.................        4,733     2,507       3,478     1,890     1,904
                                                                   =====     =====       =====     =====     =====

Net Income Per Common Share - Diluted......................    $     .81 $     .66   $    2.51 $    1.88 $    1.23
                                                               --------- ---------   --------- --------- ---------
Weighted Average Common Shares.............................        4,906     3,476       4,358     2,757     2,235
                                                                 =======     =====       =====     =====     =====
</TABLE>

         See accompanying notes to consolidated financial statements.

                                      F-4

<PAGE>
                            RESOURCE AMERICA, INC.
          CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF CHANGES IN STOCKHOLDERS' EQUITY
                 YEARS ENDED SEPTEMBER 30, 1997, 1996 AND 1995
                         (Dollar amounts in thousands)

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                  
                                    Common Stock      Additional                  Treasury Stock        ESOP              Total     
                                    ------------       Paid-In     Retained     -------------------     Loan          Stockholders'
                                   Shares   Amount      Capital    Earnings      Shares     Amount      Receivable       Equity
                                   ------   ------      -------    --------      ------     ------      ----------       ------

<S>                                 <C>       <C>     <C>           <C>         <C>         <C>             <C>         <C>    
Balance, October 1, 1994            817,912   $ 8     $ 19,136      $ 7,979     (131,402)   $ (2,437)       $(546)      $24,140
Treasury shares acquired                                                         (21,298)       (284)                      (284)
Cash dividends ($.09 per share)                                   (161)                                      (161)
Warrants issued                                             78                                                               78
Repayment of ESOP loan                                                                                         64            64
Net income                                                            2,714                                               2,714
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Balance, September 30, 1995         817,912   $ 8     $ 19,214      $10,532     (152,700)    $(2,721)       $(482)      $26,551
Treasury shares issued                                     (24)                    1,889          39                         15
6% stock dividends                   82,688     1        2,453       (2,453)                                                  1
5 for 2 stock split effected
 in the form of a 150%
 stock dividend                   1,136,609    11                       (11)
Issuance of common stock             10,000                 77                                                               77
Treasury shares acquired                                             (1,637)         (17)                     (17)
Cash dividends ($.38 per share)                                   (757)                                      (757)
Warrants issued                                             41                                                               41
Repayment of ESOP loan                                                                            65           65
Net income                                                            5,147                                               5,147
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Balance, September 30, 1996       2,047,209   $20      $21,761      $12,458     (152,448)    $(2,699)       $(417)      $31,123
Treasury shares issued                                     (34)                   23,023         483                        449
Issuance of common stock          3,363,436    34       35,060                                                           35,094
Treasury shares acquired                                           (579,623)     (11,448)                 (11,448)
Cash dividends ($.40 per share)                                   (1,404)                                  (1,404)
Repayment of ESOP loan                                                                            64           64
Net income                                                        10,951                                   10,951
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Balance, September 30, 1997       5,410,645   $54      $56,787      $22,005     (709,048)   $(13,664)       $(353)      $64,829

(Unaudited)
Treasury shares issued                                      34                     1,366          30                         64
Issuance of common stock             49,956     1        2,522                                                            2,523
Treasury shares acquired                                                         (10,000)       (440)                      (440)
Cash dividends ($.10 per share)                                        (470)                                               (470)
Net Income                                                            3,951                                               3,951
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Balance, December 31, 1997        5,460,601   $55     $59,,343      $25,486     (717,682)   $(14,074)       $(353)      $70,457
                                  =========   ===     ========      =======     ========    ========        =====       =======


</TABLE>

          See accompanying notes to consolidated financial statements

                                      F-5

<PAGE>
                            RESOURCE AMERICA, INC.
                     CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF CASH FLOWS
                                (in thousands)
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>

                                                                           Quarter Ended
                                                                            December 31,       Years Ended September 30,
                                                                            ------------       -------------------------
                                                                           1997      1996      1997       1996        1995
                                                                           ----      ----      ----       ----        ----
                                                                             (Unaudited)
<S>                                                                       <C>       <C>       <C>         <C>       <C>    
CASH FLOWS FROM OPERATING ACTIVITIES:
Net income        ..................................................      $ 3,951   $ 2,285   $ 10,951    $ 5,147   $ 2,714
Adjustments to reconcile net income to net cash
 provided by operating activities:
   Depreciation and amortization....................................          508       379      1,614      1,368     1,335
   Amortization of discount on senior note and deferred
     finance costs...............................................208           24       657         75         74
   Provision for possible losses....................................          318        10        653          7       --
   Deferred income taxes............................................          826       382     (2,206)     1,059       473
   Accretion of discount...........................................        (1,666)     (793)    (4,124)      (954)   (1,176)
   Gain on asset dispositions ......................................       (4,740)     (785)   (11,375)    (3,650)   (1,727)
   Property impairments and abandonments............................          --        --          38         71        56
Change in operating assets and liabilities:
   Net of effects from purchase of subsidiaries.....................
   (Increase) decrease in accounts receivable.......................       (3,086)      316       (935)      (175)       81
   (Increase) decrease in prepaid expenses
     and other current assets.......................................         (372)      236       (103)      (310)       88
   Increase (decrease) in accounts payable.........................           367       377        754       (137)     (291)
   Increase (decrease) in accrued income taxes.....................           --        --       3,716        377      (100)
   Increase in other liabilities....................................        1,043       409      4,451         81        51
                                                                          -------    ------    -------     ------   -------
Net cash provided by (used in) operating activities................        (2,643)    2,840      4,091      2,959     1,578

CASH FLOWS FROM INVESTING ACTIVITIES:
Acquisition of business, less cash acquired.........................         (997)      --      (1,226)      --        (877)
Cost of equipment acquired for lease................................      (15,972)   (4,411)   (34,567)      (731)      --
Capital expenditures................................................       (1,811)     (130)    (1,791)    (1,097)     (817)
Principal payments on notes receivable..............................         --         --       8,514        --        --
Proceeds from sale or refinancings of assets........................       56,305     2,323     37,713     18,577    10,348
Increase in notes receivable........................................         (355)      --        --          --        --
Increase in other assets............................................         (974)   (1,536)    (3,319)      (152)      (59)
Investments in real estate loans....................................      (79,232)  (28,881)   (69,857)   (17,650)  (14,708)
Increase in other long-term liabilities.............................        1,168       --        --          --        --
Payments received (revenue recognized) in excess of
  revenue recognized (cash received) on leases......................          437        76      1,394         (7)      --
                                                                          -------   -------    -------    --------   ------
Net cash used in investing activities...............................      (41,431)  (32,559)   (63,139)    (1,060)   (6,113)

CASH FLOWS FROM FINANCING ACTIVITIES:
Long-term borrowings................................................         --      15,570    129,320        536     2,000
Short-term borrowings...............................................        6,670      (110)      --          --      2,500
Dividends paid    ..................................................         (470)     (190)    (1,404)      (756)     (161)
(Increase) decrease in other assets.................................          (15)      --      (5,376)       (31)    4,864
Principal payments on long-term borrowing...........................         (704)   (2,043)   (22,148)       (27)   (4,524)
Principal payments on short-term borrowing..........................       (2,245)      --        --          --        --
Purchase of treasury stock..........................................         (440)      --        --          (17)     (284)
Proceeds from issuance of stock.....................................           85    19,659     23,781         93       --
                                                                          -------   -------   --------    -------   -------
Net cash provided by (used in) financing activities.................        2,881    32,886    124,173       (202)    4,395
                                                                          -------   -------   --------    -------   -------
Increase (decrease) in cash and cash equivalents....................      (41,193)    3,167     65,125      1,697      (140)
Cash and cash equivalents at beginning of period....................       69,279     4,154      4,154      2,457     2,597
                                                                          -------   -------   --------    -------   -------
Cash and cash equivalents at end of period..........................      $28,086   $ 7,321   $ 69,279    $ 4,154   $ 2,457
                                                                          =======   =======   ========    =======   =======
</TABLE>

          See accompanying notes to consolidated financial statements

                                      F-6

<PAGE>



                            RESOURCE AMERICA, INC.
                  NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
        (Information as of December 31, 1997 and for the quarters ended
                   December 31, 1997 and 1996 is Unaudited)

NOTE 1-NATURE OF OPERATIONS

         Resource America, Inc. (the "Company") is a specialty finance company
engaged in three lines of business: (1) the financing of mortgage loans,
including the acquisition and resolution of commercial real estate loans and,
beginning in the fiscal year ending September 30, 1998, the origination,
acquisition and sale of residential loans; (2) commercial equipment leasing,
and (3) energy operations, including natural oil and gas production. Based on
net assets and net income, the financing of mortgage loans is the dominant
current business line.

         The markets for the Company's business lines are as follows: in the
financing of mortgage loans, the Company obtains its commercial mortgage loans
on properties located throughout the United States from various financial
institutions and other organizations, while its residential mortgage loans
will be obtained through direct mail supported by outbound telemarketing and
several wholesale channels to potential borrowers throughout the United
States; in commercial equipment leasing, the Company markets its equipment
leasing products nationwide through equipment manufacturers, regional
distributors and other vendors; and in energy, gas is sold to a number of
customers such as gas brokers and local utilities; oil is sold at the well
site to regional oil refining companies in the Appalachian basin.

         The Company's ability to acquire and resolve commercial mortgage
loans, obtain residential mortgage loans and to fund equipment lease
transactions will be dependent on the continued availability of funds. The
availability of third-party financing for each of these specialty finance
businesses will be dependent upon a number of factors over which the Company
has limited or no control, including general conditions in the credit markets,
the size and liquidity of the market for the types of real estate loans or
equipment leases in the Company's portfolio and the respective financial
performance of the loans and equipment leases in the Company's portfolio.

         The Company's growth will also depend on its continued ability to
generate attractive opportunities for acquiring commercial mortgage loans at a
discount and to originate equipment leases. The availability of loans for
acquisition on terms acceptable to the Company will be dependent upon a number
of factors over which the Company has no control, including economic
conditions, interest rates, the market for and value of properties securing
loans which the Company may seek to acquire, and the willingness of financial
institutions to dispose of troubled or under-performing loans in their
portfolios.

         Mortgage loans and equipment leases are subject to the risk of
default in payment by borrowers and lessees. Mortgage loans are further
subject to the risk that declines in real estate values could result in the
Company being unable to realize the property values projected.


                                      F-7

<PAGE>



NOTE 2-SUMMARY OF SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES

Principles of Consolidation

         The consolidated financial statements include the accounts of the
Company, and its wholly owned subsidiaries and its pro rata share of the
assets, liabilities, income, and expenses of the oil and gas partnerships in
which the Company has an interest. All material intercompany transactions have
been eliminated. All per share amounts and references to numbers of shares
give effect to 6% stock dividends paid in both January and April 1996 and a
five-for-two stock split (effected in the form of a 150% stock dividend) in
May 1996.

Use of Estimates

         Preparation of the financial statements in conformity with generally
accepted accounting principles requires management to make estimates and
assumptions that affect the reported amounts of assets and liabilities at the
date of the financial statements and the reported amounts of revenues and
expenses during the reporting period. Actual results could differ from these
estimates.

         In the opinion of management, all adjustments (consisting of normally
recurring accruals) necessary for a fair statement of the results of
operations for the interim period included herein have been made.

Impairment of Long-Lived Assets

         The Company reviews its long-lived assets for impairment whenever
events or circumstances indicate that the carrying amount of an asset may not
be recoverable. If it is determined that an asset's estimated future cash
flows will not be sufficient to recover its carrying amount, an impairment
charge will be recorded to reduce the carrying amount for that asset to its
estimated fair value.

Stock-Based Compensation

         The Company adopted the disclosure only option under Statement of
Financial Accounting Standards ("SFAS") No. 123, Accounting for Stock Based
Compensation, effective January 1, 1997. As such, the Company recognizes
compensation expense with respect to stock option grants to employees using
the intrinsic value method prescribed by Accounting Principles Board Opinion
No. 25. Accordingly, SFAS No. 123 had no impact on the Company's financial
position or results of operations (see Note 9).

Transfers of Financial Assets

         The Company adopted SFAS No. 125, Accounting for Transfers and
Servicing of Financial Assets and Extinguishments of Liabilities effective
January 1, 1997. This statement is effective for transfers and servicing of
financial assets and extinguishments of liabilities occurring after December
31, 1996, and is to be applied prospectively. Earlier or retroactive
application was not permitted. The adoption of SFAS 125 did not have a
material impact on the Company's financial position or results of operations.


                                      F-8

<PAGE>



Oil and Gas Properties

         The Company follows the successful efforts method of accounting.
Accordingly, property acquisition costs, costs of successful exploratory
wells, all development costs, and the cost of support equipment and facilities
are capitalized. Costs of unsuccessful exploratory wells are expensed when
such wells are determined to be nonproductive. The costs associated with
drilling and equipping wells not yet completed are capitalized as uncompleted
wells, equipment, and facilities. Geological and geophysical costs and the
costs of carrying and retaining undeveloped properties, including delay
rentals, are expensed as incurred.

         Production costs, overhead, and all exploration costs other than
costs of exploratory drilling are charged to expense as incurred.

         Unproved properties are assessed periodically to determine whether
there has been a decline in value and, if such decline is indicated, a loss is
recognized. The Company compares the carrying value of its oil and gas
producing properties to the estimated future cash flow, net of applicable
income taxes, from such properties in order to determine whether their
carrying values should be reduced. No adjustment was necessary during the
fiscal years ended September 30, 1997, 1996 or 1995.

         On an annual basis, the Company estimates the costs of future
dismantlement, restoration, reclamation, and abandonment of its gas and oil
producing properties. Additionally, the Company evaluates the estimated
salvage value of equipment recoverable upon abandonment. At September 30, 1997
and 1996 the Company's evaluation of equipment salvage values was greater than
or equal to the estimated costs of future dismantlement, restoration,
reclamation, and abandonment.

Depreciation, Depletion and Amortization

         Proved developed oil and gas properties, which include intangible
drilling and development costs, tangible well equipment, and leasehold costs,
are amortized on the unit-of-production method using the ratio of current
production to the estimated aggregate proved developed oil and gas reserves.

         Depreciation of property and equipment, other than oil and gas
properties, is computed using the straight-line method over the estimated
economic lives, which range from 3 to 25 years.

Other Assets

    Included in other assets are intangible assets that consist primarily of
contracts acquired through acquisitions recorded at fair value on their
acquisition dates, the excess of the acquisition cost over the fair value of
the net assets of a business acquired (goodwill) and deferred financing costs.
The contracts acquired are being amortized on a declining balance method over
their respective estimated lives, ranging from five to thirteen years,
goodwill is being amortized on a straight-line basis over fifteen years,
deferred financing costs are being amortized over the terms of the related
loans (two to seven years) and other costs are being amortized over varying
periods of up to five years.


                                      F-9

<PAGE>



    Other assets at December 31, 1997 and September 30, 1997 and 1996 were:
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>

                                                                                               September 30,
                                                                       December 31,            -------------
                                                                           1997           1997              1996
                                                                           ----           ----              ----
                                                                       (Unaudited)
                                                                                   (in thousands)

<S>                                                                       <C>           <C>                <C>   
         Contracts acquired.......................................        $1,712        $ 1,636            $  549
         Goodwill.................................................         4,061            709               518
         Deferred financing costs.................................         5,092          5,240               512
         Investment in real estate partnerships...................         1,827          1,827                22
         Restricted cash..........................................           854          1,052               935
         Other ...................................................         2,777          1,792               410
                                                                         -------        -------            ------
                                                                         $16,323        $12,256            $2,946
                                                                         =======        =======            ======
</TABLE>

Fair Value of Financial Instruments

         The following methods and assumptions were used by the Company in
estimating the fair value of each class of financial instruments for which it
is practicable to estimate fair value.

         For cash and cash equivalents, receivables and payables, the carrying
amounts approximate fair value because of the short maturity of these
instruments. For long-term debt, including current maturities, the fair value
of the Company's long-term debt approximates historically recorded cost since
interest rates approximate market.

         Based upon available market information and appropriate valuation
methods, the Company believes the carrying cost of investments in direct
financing leases approximates fair value.

         For investments in real estate loans, the Company believes the
carrying amounts of the loans are reasonable estimates of their fair value
considering the nature of the loans and the estimated yield relative to the
risks involved.

Concentration of Credit Risk

         Financial instruments which potentially subject the Company to
concentrations of credit risk consist principally of periodic temporary
investments of excess cash. The Company places its temporary excess cash
investments in high quality short-term money market instruments, principally
at Jefferson Bank (see Note 3), and other high quality financial institutions.
The amounts of these instruments may at times be in excess of the FDIC
insurance limit. At December 31, 1997 and September 30, 1997, the Company had
$27.9 million and $67.7 million, respectively, in deposits at Jefferson Bank,
of which $26.9 million and $66.6 million, respectively, were over the FDIC
insurance limit. No losses have been experienced on such investments.

                                     F-10

<PAGE>




Revenue Recognition

Real Estate Finance

         The difference between the Company's cost basis in a loan and the sum
of projected cash flows from, and the appraised value of, the underlying
property (up to the amount of the loan) is accreted into interest income over
the estimated life of the loan using a method which approximates the level
interest method. Projected cash flows and appraised values of the property are
reviewed on a regular basis and changes to the projected amounts reduce or
increase the amounts accreted into interest income over the remaining life of
the loan.

         Gains on the sale of a senior lien interest in a loan (or gains, if
any, from the refinancing of a loan) are recognized based on an allocation of
the Company's cost basis between the portion of the loan sold or refinanced
and the portion retained based upon the fair value of those respective
portions on the date of sale or refinance. Any gain recognized on a sale of a
senior lien interest or a refinancing is brought into income at the time of
such sale or refinancing.

Equipment Leasing

         Direct finance leases, as defined by SFAS No. 13, Accounting for
Leases, are accounted for by recording on the balance sheet the total future
minimum lease payments receivable plus the estimated unguaranteed residual
value of leased equipment less the unearned lease income. Unearned lease
income represents the excess of the total future minimum lease payments plus
the estimated unguaranteed residual value expected to be realized at the end
of the lease term over the cost of the related equipment. Unearned lease
income is recognized as revenue over the term of the lease by the effective
interest method. Initial direct costs incurred in consummating a lease are
capitalized as part of the investment in direct finance leases and amortized
over the lease term as a reduction in the yield.

         Gains arising from the sale of direct financing leases and notes
secured by equipment leases occur when the Company obtains permanent funding
through the sale of a pool of leases to a third party. Subsequent to a sale,
the Company has no remaining interest in the pool of leases or equipment
except (i) if a note is delivered as part of the sale proceeds, a security
interest in the pool, and (ii) the obligation of the Company under certain
circumstances to replace non-performing leases in the pool. Upon consummation
of the sale transaction, the Company records a provision for anticipated
losses under its guaranty. At December 31, 1997 and September 30, 1997, the
Company had guaranteed approximately $4.9 million and $5.5 million,
respectively, of lease receivables with respect to leases sold.

         Equipment leasing revenues also consist of management fees, brokerage
fees and a share of net income from partnerships in which a subsidiary of the
Company serves as general partner. Management fees are earned for management
services provided to the partnerships. Such fees are recognized as earned (see
Limited Partnerships, below).

                                     F-11

<PAGE>




Energy Operations

         Working interest, royalties and override revenues are recognized as
production and delivery takes place. Well service income is recognized as
revenue as services are performed.

Cash Flow Statements

         The Company considers temporary investments with a maturity at the
date of acquisition of 90 days or less to be cash equivalents.

Supplemental disclosure of cash flow information:
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>

                                                          Quarter Ended                   Years Ended
                                                           December 31,                   September 30,
                                                          ---------------        -------------------------------
                                                          1997       1996        1997          1996        1995
                                                          ----       ----        ----          ----        ----
                                                            (Unaudited)
                                                                             (in thousands)

<S>                                                        <C>         <C>      <C>             <C>         <C>   
         Cash paid during the periods for:
           Interest..................................      $  173      $575     $ 2,727         $797        $1,104
           Income taxes..............................       4,180       450       2,094          770           255

                                                   ------------------------------

         Non-cash activities include the following:
           Notes received in exchange for -
             Sales of leases.........................      $3,891    $3,260     $13,275        $--           $--
             Sale of mortgages.......................       8,093      --          --           --            --
           Debt assumed upon acquisition of
             real estate loan........................        --        --         2,381         --            --
           Receipt of note in satisfaction of
             real estate sale........................       1,000      --         3,500         --            --
           Note payable issued in acquisition........                   925        --           --
           Stock issued in acquisition...............       2,500       --          315         --            --

                                                   ------------------------------

         Details of acquisition:
           Fair value of assets acquired.............      $3,545     $--       $ 2,466        $--          $1,189
           Debt issued...............................        --        --          (925)        --            --
           Stock issued..............................      (2,500)     --          (315)        --            --
          Liabilities assumed........................         (48)     --          --           --            (312)
                                                          -------     -----      ------        -----       --------
         Net cash paid...............................      $  997     $--       $ 1,226        $--          $  877
                                                           ======     =====     =======        =====        ======

</TABLE>
                                     F-12

<PAGE>

Limited Partnerships

         The Company conducts certain energy and leasing activities through,
and a portion of its revenues and are attributable to, limited partnerships
("Partnerships"). The Company serves as general partner of the Partnerships
and assumes customary rights and obligations for the Partnerships. As the
general partner, the Company is liable for Partnership liabilities and can be
liable to limited partners if it breaches its responsibilities with respect to
the operations of the Partnerships.

         The Company is entitled to receive management fees, reimbursement for
administrative costs incurred, and to share in the Partnerships' revenue and
costs and expenses, according to the respective Partnership agreements. Such
fees and reimbursements are recognized as income and are included in energy
services and equipment leasing revenue. Amounts reimbursed for costs incurred
as operator of certain oil and gas partnership properties and as the general
partner in certain equipment leasing partnerships for the quarters ended
December 31, 1997 and 1996 was $880,000 and $673,000, respectively, and for
the years ended September 30, 1997, 1996, and 1995 approximated $1.8 million,
$1.6 million, and $.5 million, respectively. The Company includes in its
operations the portion of the oil and gas Partnerships' revenues and expenses
applicable to its interests therein.

Income Taxes

         The Company records deferred tax assets and liabilities, as
appropriate, to account for the estimated future tax effects attributable to
temporary differences between the financial statement and tax bases of assets
and liabilities and the value at currently enacted tax rates, of operating
loss carryforwards. The deferred tax provision or benefit each year represents
the net change during that year in the deferred tax asset and liability
balances.

Earnings Per Share

         In February 1997, the Financial Accounting Standards Board ("FASB")
issued SFAS No. 128 "Earnings per Share." This statement is effective for
financial statements issued for periods ending after December 15, 1997;
earnings per share data included herein have been restated to reflect the new
standard. Under this statement the previous calculation of primary earnings
per share ("EPS") is changed to exclude the dilutive effect of stock options
and is referred to as Basic EPS.

         Earnings per share-basic are determined by dividing net income by the
weighted average number of common shares outstanding during the period.
Earnings per share - diluted are computed by dividing net income by the
weighted average number of shares and dilutive potential common shares
outstanding during the period. Dilutive potential common shares include shares
issuable under the terms of various stock option and warrant agreements net of
the number of such shares that could have been reacquired (at the weighted
average

                                     F-13

<PAGE>



price of the Company's Common Stock during the period) with the proceeds
received from the exercise of the options and warrants (see Notes 8 and 9).

Reclassifications

         Certain reclassifications have been made to the consolidated
financial statements for the quarter ended December 31, 1996 to conform with
the presentation for the quarter ended December 31, 1997. In addition, certain
reclassifications have been made to the consolidated financial statements for
the fiscal years ended September 30, 1996 and 1995 to conform with the
presentation for the fiscal year ended September 30, 1997.

NOTE 3-TRANSACTIONS WITH RELATED PARTIES

         Until April 1996, the Chairman of the Company was of counsel to
Ledgewood Law Firm, P.C. ("LLF") which provides legal services to the Company.
LLF was paid $803,000, $402,000 and $562,000 during fiscal 1997, 1996 and
1995, respectively, for legal services rendered to the Company. The Chairman
of the Company receives certain debt service payments from LLF related to the
termination of his affiliation with such firm and its redemption of his
interest therein.

         The Company holds commercial real estate loans of borrowers whose
underlying properties are managed by Brandywine Construction & Management,
Inc. ("BCMI"). The Chairman of the Company is Chairman of the Board of
Directors and a minority stockholder (approximately 8%) of BCMI. The Company
has advanced funds to certain of these borrowers for improvements on their
properties which have been performed by BCMI. In several instances, the
President of BCMI has also acted as the general partner of the borrower or as
an officer of a corporate general partner. BCMI has subordinated receipt of
its management fees to receipt by the Company from the properties of minimum
debt service payments required under the obligations held by the Company.

         The Company also maintains normal banking and borrowing relationships
with Jefferson Bank, a subsidiary of JeffBanks, Inc. The Chairman of the
Company is an officer and director of JeffBanks, Inc. and, together with his
spouse, is a principal stockholder thereof; his spouse is Chairman and Chief
Executive Officer of Jefferson Bank. Another officer and director of the
Company is a director of Jefferson Bank. The Company anticipates that it may,
in the future, effect borrowings from Jefferson Bank; it anticipates that any
such borrowings will be on terms similar to those which could be obtained by
an unrelated borrower. Jefferson Bank is also a tenant at two properties which
secure loans held by the Company. Management believes that the terms of the
leases with Jefferson Bank are typical of similar leases for similar space.

         In August 1997, the Company, through a subsidiary, acquired a loan
with a face amount of $2.3 million from Jefferson Bank at a cost of $1.6
million. The loan is secured by a property owned by a partnership in which an
officer of the Company and the Chairman of

                                     F-14

<PAGE>



the Company, together with his wife, are limited partners. The Company leases
its headquarters space at such property. LLF and BCMI are also tenants at such
property (see Note 10). In September 1997, the Company sold a senior lien
interest in this loan to an unrelated party, recognizing a gain of $224,000.

         In June 1997, the Company acquired two loans with an aggregate face
amount of $7.0 million from a partnership in which an officer of the Company
and the Chairman of the Company, together with his wife, are limited partners.
The officer of the Company was previously the general partner of such
partnership. The Company acquired such loan at a cost of $3.0 million. In
September 1997, the Company sold a senior lien interest in one loan to an
unrelated third party and was paid off with respect to the other loan,
recognizing an aggregate gain of $804,000.

         In June 1997 the Company sold two senior lien interests to two
different limited partnerships for $875,000 and $2.25 million, realizing gains
of $310,000 and $811,000, respectively. Officers and directors of the Company
hold beneficial interests in these partnerships totalling 21.3% and 18.3%,
respectively.

         In December 1996, the Company, through a subsidiary, acquired a loan
with a face amount of $52.7 million from an unaffiliated third party at a cost
of $19.3 million. The property securing such loan is owned by two
partnerships: 1845 Associates (the "Building Partnership"), which owns the
office building and Mutual Associates (the "Garage Partnership"), which owns
the parking garage. Pursuant to a loan restructuring agreement entered into in
1993, prior to the Company having any interest in the loan, an affiliate of
the holder of the loan is required to hold, as additional security for the
loan, general partnership interests in both the Building Partnership and the
Garage Partnership. The partnership interest in the Building Partnership was
assigned to a limited partnership of which another subsidiary of the Company
is general partner and RPI Partnership is limited partner. The partnership
interest in the Garage Partnership was assigned to a limited partnership of
which a third subsidiary of the Company is general partner and RPI Partnership
is limited partner. RPI Partnership is a limited partnership in which officers
of the Company, including the Chairman, are limited partners. Although the
Company does not anticipate any economic benefit to RPI Partnership, any which
may be received will be assigned and transferred to the Company.

         In December 1997 the Company sold a senior lien interest to a limited
partnership for $1,000,000 in the form of an interest bearing note, realizing a
gain of $267,000. The note was repaid in February 1998. Officers and directors
of the Company hold an aggregate beneficial interest in the partnership of
17.8%.

         Management believes that any other such commercial real estate
transactions and balances involving parties that may be considered to be
related parties are not material.


                                     F-15

<PAGE>



         The Company administers the activities of certain energy partnerships
that it sponsors (see Note 2). Energy service revenues primarily represent
services provided to Partnerships and joint ventures managed by the Company.
In accordance with industry practice, the Company charges each producing well
in the Partnerships and joint ventures a fixed monthly overhead fee and a
proportionate share of certain lease operating expenses. These charges are to
reimburse the Company for certain operating and general and administrative
expenses.

NOTE 4-INVESTMENTS IN REAL ESTATE LOANS

         The Company has focused its real estate activities on the purchase of
income producing mortgages at a discount from both the face value of such
mortgages and the appraised value of the properties underlying the mortgages.
Cash received by the Company for payment on each mortgage is allocated between
principal and interest with the interest portion of the cash received being
recorded as income to the Company. Additionally, the Company records as income
the accretion of a portion of the discount to the underlying collateral value.
For the quarters ended December 31, 1997 and 1996, the accretion of discount
amounted to $1.7 millon and $793,000, respectively. This accretion of discount
amounted to $4.1 million and $1.0 million during the years ended September 30,
1997 and 1996, respectively. As the Company sells senior lien interests or
receives funds from refinancings in such mortgages, a portion of the cash
received is utilized to reduce the cumulative accretion of discount included
in the carrying value of the Company's investment in real estate loans.

         At December 31, 1997 and at September 30, 1997 and 1996, the Company
held real estate loans having aggregate face values of $330.1 million, $233.7
million and $100.5 million, respectively, which were being carried at
aggregate costs of $128.9 million, $88.8 million and $21.8 million, including
cumulative accretion. Amounts receivable, net of senior lien interests, were
$236.9 million, $178.1 million, $61.8 million at December 31, 1997 and
September 30, 1997 and 1996, respectively.


                                     F-16

<PAGE>



         The following is a summary of the changes in the carrying value of
the Company's investments in real estate loans for the years ended September
30, 1997 and 1996:
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>

                                                                                 Years Ended
                                                          Quarter Ended         September 30,
                                                           December 31,      --------------------
                                                               1997           1997          1996  
                                                               ----           ----          ----  
                                                            (Unaudited)
                                                                     (in thousands)

<S>                                                     <C>               <C>            <C>   
                                                                      
         Balance, beginning of period...........        $ 88,816            $21,798        $17,991
         New loans..............................          63,648             71,720         15,127
         Additions to existing loans............           1,998              1,860          2,564
         Reserve for possible losses............             (52)              (400)         --
         Accretion of discount..................           1,666              4,124            954
         Collections of principal...............         (35,250)              (517)        (9,377)
         Cost of loans sold.....................          (3,784)            (9,769)        (5,461)
         Investment in residential loans........          11,842              --             --
                                                        --------            -------        -------
         Balance, end of period.................        $128,884            $88,816        $21,798
                                                        ========            =======        =======
</TABLE>
                                                                    
         A summary of activity in the Company's allowance for possible losses
related to real estate loans for the quarter ended December 31, 1997 and for
the year ended September 30, 1997 is as follows:
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>

                                                                  Quarter Ended            Year Ended
                                                                  December 31,            September 30,
                                                                        1997                  1997
                                                                  ----------------         ----------
                                                                     (Unaudited)
                                                                               (in thousands)
           
<S>                                                                       <C>                   <C>
         Balance, beginning of period......................               $400                  $--
         Provision for possible losses.....................                 68                   400
         Writeoffs.........................................                --                    --
                                                                          ----                  ---
         Balance, end of period............................               $468                  $400
                                                                          ====                  ====
</TABLE>


                                     F-17

<PAGE>



NOTE 5-INVESTMENT IN DIRECT FINANCING LEASES

         Components of the net investment in direct financing leases as of
December 31, 1997 and 1996 and September 30, 1997 and 1996, as well as future
minimum lease payments receivable, including residual values, are as follows:
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>

                                                                                September 30,
                                                           December 31,      --------------------
                                                               1997           1997          1996  
                                                               ----           ----          ----  
                                                            (Unaudited)
                                                                     (in thousands)

<S>                                                     <C>               <C>            <C>   
         Total future minimum lease payments
           receivable................................        $5,383          $4,186          $847
         Initial direct costs, net of amortization...            95              75            67
         Unguaranteed residual.......................           425             310            75
         Unearned lease income.......................        (1,205)           (932)         (253)
         Allowance for possible losses...............          (492)           (248)           (7)
                                                             ------          -------         -----
         Net investment in direct financing leases...        $4,206          $3,391          $729
                                                             ======          ======          ====
</TABLE>

         At September 30, 1997, minimum lease payments for each of the five
succeeding fiscal years are as follows: 1998 - $1.4 million; 1999 - $1.0
million; 2000 - $914,000; 2001 - $502,000; and 2002 - $365,000.

         A summary of activity in the Company's allowance for possible losses
related to direct financing leases for the quarter ended December 31, 1997 and
the years ended September 30, 1997 and 1996 are as follows:
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>

                                                                                            Year Ended
                                                                   Quarter Ended           September 30,
                                                                    December 31,      ------------------------
                                                                        1997             1997            1996
                                                                        ----             ----            ----
                                                                    (Unaudited)
                                                                                (in thousands)

<S>                                                                        <C>            <C>              <C>
         Balance, beginning of period.........................             $248           $   7            $--
         Provision for possible losses........................              250             253              7
         Write offs...........................................               (6)            (12)            --
                                                                        --------           ----            ---
         Balance, end of period...............................             $492            $248            $ 7
                                                                           ====            ====            ===
</TABLE>

         Unguaranteed residual value represents the estimated amount to be
received at contract termination from the disposition of equipment financed
under direct financing leases. Amounts to be realized at contract termination
depend on fair market value of the related equipment and may vary from the
recorded estimate. Residual values are reviewed periodically to determine if
the equipment's fair market is below its recorded value.

                                     F-18

<PAGE>




         Certain of the leases include options to purchase the underlying
equipment at the end of the lease term at fair value or the stated residual
which is not less that the book value at termination.


                                     F-19

<PAGE>



NOTE 6-LONG-TERM DEBT

Long-term debt consists of the following:
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                             September 30,
                                                                    December 31,      ------------------------
                                                                        1997             1997            1996
                                                                        ----             ----            ----
                                                                    (Unaudited)
                                                                                (in thousands)

<S>                                                                       <C>             <C>              <C>  
12% senior unsecured notes payable, interest
due semi-annually, principal due August 2004..................            $115,000        $115,000         $  --

9.5% senior secured note payable, repaid
in July 1997..................................................               --              --             7,902

Loan payable to a bank, secured by a certificate of deposit, 20 equal
semiannual installments of $32,143 through February 2003, and quarterly
payments of interest at 1/2% above the prime rate
through 2003 (See Note 9).....................................                 353             353            418

Secured warehouse credit facility at 0.9% above LIBOR
(6.62% at December 31, 1997)..................................               4,425            --             --

Unsecured loan, monthly installments of approximately $5,200 including
interest at 2.25% above the prime rate (but not less than 7% nor greater than
14.25%) through April 2004 at which time the unpaid balance is due. This loan
was
refinanced in December 1996 ..................................                --              --              536

Loans payable, secured by real estate, monthly installments totaling
approximately $39,000 including interest ranging from prime (8.5% at September
30, 1997) to 10.25%, due at various times from
December 2001 through January 2019............................               2,513           3,216            215

Unsecured note payable, due in two equal annual Installments of principal and
interest beginning March 1998, interest at LIBOR (6 9/32% at
September 30, 1997)...........................................                 925             925          --
                                                                        ----------       ---------       -----
                                                                           123,216          19,494          9,071
Less current maturities.......................................               5,100             708            105
                                                                        ----------       ---------       --------
                                                                          $118,116        $118,786        $ 8,966
                                                                          ========        ========        =======
</TABLE>

                                     F-20

<PAGE>




         As of September 30, 1997 the long-term debt maturing over the next
five fiscal years is as follows: 1998 - $708,000; 1999 - $727,000; 2000 -
$285,000; 2001 - $309,000; and 2002 -$712,000.

         In July 1997, the Company issued $115 million of 12% Senior Unsecured
Notes (the "12% Notes") due August 2004 in a private placement. Provisions of
the 12% Notes limit dividend payments, mergers and indebtedness, place
restrictions on liens and guarantees and require the maintenance of certain
financial ratios. At September 30, 1997, the Company was in compliance with
such provisions. In November 1997, the Company filed a registration statement
with the Securities and Exchange Commission offering to exchange the privately
placed 12% Notes with a like amount of fully registered 12% Notes.

         In May 1994, the Company privately placed with an insurance company a
9.5% senior secured note in the principal amount of $8 million together with
an immediately exercisable detachable warrant to purchase, at any time through
May 24, 2004, 449,440 shares, subject to adjustment, of the Company's common
stock at an exercise price of $3.38 per share. The value assigned to the
warrant ($100,000) was accounted for as paid-in capital, resulting in a
discount which was being amortized on a straight-line basis over the life of
the note. The senior note was collateralized by substantially all of the
Company's oil and gas properties and certain of the Company's real estate
loans. This note was paid in full in July 1997 from proceeds of the offering
of the 12% Notes. The warrants were exercised in July 1997. (See Note 8.)

         In December 1996, FLI, the Company's equipment leasing subsidiary,
entered into a secured revolving credit and term loan facility with a maximum
borrowing limit of $20 million with two banking institutions. Interest on the
revolving credit and term loan borrowings is payable at a rate equal to the
London Interbank Offered Rate ("LIBOR") plus 1.75% and LIBOR plus 2.25% per
annum, respectively. The credit facility expires on March 31, 1998 and is
renewable annually at the lenders' discretion. A commitment fee of 3/8% per
annum is assessed on the unused portion of the borrowing limit. Borrowings
under this facility are collateralized by the leases and the underlying
equipment being financed and are guaranteed by the Company. The agreement
contains certain covenants pertaining to FLI and the Company including the
maintenance of certain financial ratios and restrictions on changes in the
FLI's ownership and a key management position. During fiscal 1997, the maximum
borrowing under this facility was $7.1 million, all of which was repaid prior
to fiscal year end. There were no borrowings under this facility during the
quarter ended December 31, 1997.

         In September 1997, FMF, the Company's residential mortgage lending
business, entered into a secured credit facility with a maximum borrowing
limit of $5 million with a banking institution. In December 1997, the limit
was raised to $20 million. Interest on each draw under this facility is
payable at FMF's election, at either the institution's prime rate, or at the
federal funds rate plus 2.5%, or at an adjusted LIBOR plus 1.5%. The credit
facility expires in September 1998 unless renewed by the parties. Borrowings
under this facility are

                                     F-21

<PAGE>



collateralized by the mortgage loans and the underlying property being
financed. The agreement contains certain covenants pertaining to FMF and the
Company including the maintenance of certain financial ratios. During fiscal
1997 there were no borrowings under this facility.

         In October 1997, FMF established a $15 million warehouse credit
facility with a financial institution, bearing interest at LIBOR or, if
unavailable, the interbank eurodollars market rate, plus 90 basis points. The
facility is collateralized by a first lien interest in the loans being
financed by facility draws. The facility expires in October 1998. The
agreement contains certain covenants pertaining to FMF, including the
maintenance of certain financial ratios. In the quarter ended December 31,
1997, borrowings under this facility were $6.7 million of which $2.3 million
was repaid prior to December 31, 1997.

         In October 1997, the Company obtained a $5 million credit facility
from a banking institution for purposes of acquiring oil and gas assets. The
credit facility permits draws based on a percentage of reserves of oil and gas
properties pledged as security for the facility. Draws under the facility bear
interest at this institutions prime rate plus 25 basis points. The facility
terminates in June 1999. The agreement contains certain covenants pertaining
to the Company, including the maintenance of certain financial ratios.

NOTE 7-INCOME TAXES

         The following table details the components of the Company's income
tax expense for the fiscal years 1997, 1996 and 1995.
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>

                                                                        Year Ended
                                                                       September 30,
                                                                  ----------------------------
                                                                   1997      1996        1995
                                                                   ----      ----        ----
                                                                        (in thousands)

<S>                                                                 <C>        <C>        <C> 
         Provision for Federal income tax:
           Current.............................................     $6,186     $1,147     $157
           Deferred............................................     (2,206)     1,059      473
                                                                    ------     ------     ----
                                                                    $3,980     $2,206     $630
                                                                    ======     ======     ====
</TABLE>

                                     F-22

<PAGE>

         A reconciliation between the statutory Federal income tax rate and
the Company's effective Federal income tax rate is as follows:

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                     Year Ended
                                                                                    September 30,
                                                                               ---------------------------
                                                                                1997      1996        1995
                                                                                ----      ----        ----

                                                                                     (in thousands)

<S>                                                                               <C>       <C>         <C>
         Statutory tax rate...................................                    34%       34%         34%
         Statutory depletion..................................                     (2)       (4)         (4)
         Non-conventional fuel and low-income
           housing credits....................................                     (3)      --           (1)
         Tax-exempt interest..................................                     (2)      --          --
         Adjustment to valuation allowance
           for deferred tax assets............................                    --        --           (7)
         Other................................................                    --        --           (3)
                                                                                 ----      ----          ---
                                                                                  27%       30%         19%
                                                                                  ===       ===         ===
</TABLE>

The components of the net deferred tax liability are as follows:

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                     Year Ended
                                                                                    September 30,
                                                                               ---------------------------
                                                                                1997                  1996 
                                                                                ----                  ----

                                                                                     (in thousands)

<S>                                                                               <C>                <C>
         Deferred tax assets:
           Tax credit carryforwards...................................           $  507              $ --
           Alternative minimum tax credit
            carryforwards.............................................               --                  61
           Interest receivable........................................            1,490                  45
           Net operating loss carryforwards...........................              357                 --
           Provision for possible losses..............................              220               --
                                                                                 ------             ----
                                                                                  2,574                 106

         Deferred tax liabilities:
           Depreciation...............................................           (2,290)             (2,160)
           ESOP benefits..............................................             (120)               (140)
           Other items, net...........................................             (164)                (12)
                                                                                 ------            --------
                                                                                 (2,574)             (2,312)
                                                                                 ------             -------
           Net deferred tax liability.................................         $  --                $(2,206)
                                                                               ========             =======
</TABLE>


                                     F-23

<PAGE>



NOTE 8-STOCKHOLDERS' EQUITY

         In July 1997, the Company issued 983,150 unregistered shares of the
Company's common stock pursuant to the exercise of warrants held by the holder
of the Company's 9.5% senior secured note payable due 2004, realizing proceeds
of $3.66 million. The 983,150 shares were subsequently sold by the holder in a
separate private placement to a small group of institutional investors.

         In December 1996, the Company closed a public offering of 1.66
million shares of its Common Stock. The Company received proceeds from the
offering of $19.99 million, before offering expenses of $515,000.

         In September 1996, the Company's stockholders authorized an amendment
to the Certificate of Incorporation of the Company to increase the total
authorized capital stock to 9 million shares, of which 8 million shares were
Common Stock and 1 million shares were Preferred Stock.

         On December 20, 1995 and March 12, 1996, the Board of Directors
declared 6% stock dividends on the Common Stock. Furthermore, on May 9, 1996
the Board of Directors authorized a five-for-two stock split effected in the
form of a 150% stock dividend . These stock dividends resulted in the issuance
of 1.2 million additional shares of Common Stock. Earnings per share and
weighted average shares outstanding reflect the above transactions.

NOTE 9-EMPLOYEE BENEFIT PLANS

Employee Stock Ownership Plan

         The Company sponsors an Employee Stock Ownership Plan ("ESOP"), which
is a qualified non-contributory retirement plan established to acquire shares
of the Company's Common Stock for the benefit of all employees who are 21
years of age or older and have completed 1,000 hours of service for the
Company. Contributions to the ESOP are made at the discretion of the Board of
Directors. The ESOP has borrowed funds to purchase shares from the Company,
which borrowed the funds for the loan to the ESOP from a bank.

         The Common Stock purchased by the ESOP with the money borrowed is
held by the ESOP trustee in a suspense account. On an annual basis, a portion
of the Common Stock is released from the suspense account and allocated to
participating employees. Any dividends on ESOP shares are used to pay
principal and interest on the loan. As of September 30, 1997, there were
113,930 shares allocated to participants which constitute substantially all
shares in the plan. Compensation expense related to the plan was $12,600 for
both quarters ended December 31, 1997 and 1996. Compensation expense related
to the plan amounted to $50,400, $50,300 and $91,000 for the years ended
September 30, 1997, 1996 and 1995, respectively.


                                     F-24

<PAGE>



         The loan from the bank to the Company is payable in semiannual
installments through February 1, 2003. The loan from the Company to the ESOP
was fully repaid in August 1996. Both the loan obligation and the unearned
benefits expense (a reduction in stockholders' equity) will be reduced by the
amount of any loan principal payments made by the Company.

Employee Savings Plan

         The Company sponsors an Employee Retirement Savings Plan and Trust
under Section 401(k) of the Internal Revenue Code which allows employees to
defer up to 10% of their income (subject to certain limitations) on a pretax
basis through contributions to the savings plan. The Company matches up to
100% of each employee's contribution. Included in general and administrative
expenses are $67,900 and $17,100 for the quarters ended December 31, 1997 and
1996, respectively. Included in general and administrative expenses are
$131,900, $44,700 and $28,100 for the Company's contributions for the years
ended September 30, 1997, 1996 and 1995, respectively.

Stock Options

         The Company has three employee stock option plans, those of 1984,
1989 and 1997. The 1984 and 1989 plans authorize the granting of up to 56,180
and 589,890 (as amended during the fiscal year ended September 30, 1996)
shares, respectively, of the Company's common stock in the form of incentive
stock options ("ISO's"), non-qualified stock options and stock appreciation
rights ("SAR's"). No further grants may be made under these two plans.

         In April 1997, the stockholders approved the Resource America, Inc.,
1997 Key Employee Stock Option Plan ("Employee Plan"). This plan, for which
275,000 shares were reserved, provides for the issuance of ISO's and
non-qualified stock options. In the first quarter of fiscal 1998 and in fiscal
1997, options for 42,205 and 25,000 shares, respectively, were issued under
this plan.

         Options under the 1984, 1989 and 1997 plans become exercisable as to
25% of the optioned shares each year after the date of grant, and expire not
later than ten years after grant. The Company received $506,400 from the
exercise of stock options in fiscal 1997.


                                     F-25

<PAGE>



         Transactions for all three stock option plans are as follows:
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>

                                                                  Year Ended September 30,
                                    -------------------------------------------------------------------------
                                               1997                       1996                       1995
                                    -------------------------- -------------------------- --------------------
                                              Weighted                   Weighted                  Weighted
                                               Average                    Average                   Average
                                    Shares  Exercise Price    Shares   Exercise Price   Shares   Exercise Price
                                    ------  --------------    ------   --------------   ------   --------------

<S>                                 <C>         <C>           <C>          <C>           <C>         <C>  
Outstanding - beginning of year     348,316     $  6.21       202,248      $2.88         202,248     $2.88
   Granted                           25,000     $ 39.50       202,248      $8.58             -       $  -
   Exercised                       (144,663)    $  3.50       (28,090)     $2.76             -       $  -
   Cancelled                           -        $   -         (28,090)     $2.76             -       $  -
                                   --------                   -------                    -------
Outstanding - end of year           228,653     $ 11.56       348,316      $6.21         202,248     $2.88
                                   ========                   =======                    =======
Exercisable, at end of year          63,554     $  7.06       109,551      $2.92         101,124     $2.88
                                   ========                   =======                    =======
Available for grant                 250,000                      -                         5,618
                                   ========                   =======                    =======

Weighted average fair
 value per share of options
 granted during the year             $35.93                     $6.51                        -
                                     ======                     =====                    =======

                                                 Outstanding                            Exercisable
                                ------------------------------------------    ---------------------------
                                           Weighted
                                           Average            Weighted                      Weighted
  Range of                                 Contractual         Average                       Average
Exercise Prices                 Shares     Life (Years)     Exercise Price    Shares      Exercise Price
- ---------------                 ------     ------------     --------------    ------      --------------

$2.76 - $3.04                    16,854        5.56           $  2.76          16,854       $  2.76
$8.19 - $9.01                   186,799        5.66           $  8.61          46,700       $  8.61
$39.50 - $39.50                  25,000        9.91           $ 39.50           -           $ 39.50
                                -------                                        ------
                                228,653                                        63,554
                                =======                                        ======

</TABLE>
         In addition, a key employee of Fidelity Leasing, Inc. ("FLI"), a
wholly owned subsidiary of the Company, has received options to purchase 10%
of the common stock of FLI (1 million shares) at an aggregate price of
$220,000 and, should FLI declare a dividend, will receive payments on the
options in an amount equal to the dividends that would have been paid on the
shares subject to the options had they been issued. In the event that, prior
to becoming a public company, FLI issues stock to anyone other than the
Company or the key employee, the employee is entitled to receive such
additional options as will allow him to maintain a 10% equity position in FLI
upon exercise of all options held by such employee (excluding shares issuable
pursuant to the employee option plan referred to below), at an exercise price
equal to the price paid or value received in the additional issuance. FLI does
not anticipate making any such issuances.

         The options issued to the key employee vest 25% per year beginning in
March 1997 (becoming fully invested in March 2000), and terminate in March
2005. The options become fully vested and immediately exercisable in the event
of a change in control of FLI. The key

                                     F-26

<PAGE>



employee has certain rights, commencing after March 5, 2000, to require FLI to
register his option shares under the Securities Act of 1933. In the event FLI
does not become a public company by March 5, 2001, the key employee may
require that FLI thereafter buy, for cash, FLI shares subject to his options
at a price equal to ten times FLI's net earnings (as defined in the agreement)
per share for the fiscal year ended immediately prior to the giving of notice
of his exercise of this right. FLI is required to purchase 25% of such
employee's shares in each year following such employee's exercise of this
right.

         FLI has also established another option plan providing for the
granting of options, at the discretion of FLI's board of directors, for up to
500,000 shares of common stock to other employees of FLI. As of September 30,
1997, options for 393,000 shares had been issued to certain employees.

         Transactions for both FLI stock option plans are as follows:
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>

                                                                            Year Ended September 30,
                                                              -------------------------------------------------
                                                                         1997                       1996
                                                              -------------------------- ----------------------
                                                                         Weighted                  Weighted
                                                                          Average                   Average
                                                              Shares   Exercise Price   Shares   Exercise Price
                                                              ------   --------------   ------   --------------
<S>                                                           <C>          <C>         <C>           <C> 
         Outstanding - beginning of year                    1,000,000      $.22             -        $ -
            Granted                                           393,000      $.22        1,000,000     $.22
            Exercised                                           -          $  -             -        $ -
            Cancelled                                           -          $  -             -        $ -
                                                           ----------                -----------
         Outstanding - end of year                          1,393,000      $  -        1,000,000     $.22
                                                            =========                  =========
         Exercisable, at end of year                          250,000      $.22             -        $ -
                                                            =========                  =========
         Available for grant                                  107,000                    500,000
                                                            =========                  =========

         Weighted average fair
          value per share of options
          granted during the year                          $      .11                 $      .10
                                                           ==========                 ==========

                                                 Outstanding                            Exercisable
                                -------------------------------------------   ----------------------------
                                           Weighted
                                           Average            Weighted                      Weighted
  Range of                                 Contractual         Average                       Average
Exercise Prices                 Shares     Life (Years)     Exercise Price    Shares      Exercise Price
- ---------------                 ------     ------------     --------------    ------      --------------

$.22 - $.22                    1,393,000       8.79              $.22         250,000          $.22
                               =========                                      =======
</TABLE>

         Fidelity Mortgage Funding, Inc. ("FMF"), another wholly-owned
subsidiary of the Company (and in which the Company owns 17 million shares of
common stock), has established an option plan pursuant to which 3 million
shares of FMF's common stock (representing 15% of FMF's common stock on a
fully-diluted basis) have been reserved for options which may be issued to key
employees. Under the program, a director and officer of

                                     F-27

<PAGE>



the Company who is also the Chairman of FMF has received options to purchase 2
million shares (representing 10% of FMF's common stock on a fully-diluted
basis) at an aggregate price of $235,294 ($.118 per share) and, should FMF
declare a dividend, will receive payments on the options in an amount equal to
the dividends that would have been paid on the shares subject to the options
had they been issued. The options generally will have the same terms as those
relating to the FLI options, except that (i) the option term and vesting
period commenced in April 1997 and (ii) the period during which the
officer/director may sell FMF shares to FMF will commence in April 2002. The
options become fully vested and immediately exercisable in the event of a
change in control or potential change in control of FMF or the Company. In
addition, as part of the program, at September 30, 1997, FMF had granted
options to (i) its President and Chief Operating Officer to purchase 800,000
shares at an aggregate price of $100,000 ($.125 per share) (representing 4% of
FMF's common stock on a fully-diluted basis), and (ii) to certain other of its
employees to purchase 145,000 shares at an aggregate price of $18,125 ($.125
per share), leaving 55,000 shares reserved for issuance of options under the
plan at September 30, 1997.

         Transactions for the FMF stock option plan are as follows:
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>

                                                              Year Ended September 30, 1997
                                                              -----------------------------
                                                                                  Weighted
                                                                                   Average
                                                              Shares            Exercise Price
                                                              ------            --------------

<S>                                                          <C>                     <C> 
         Outstanding - beginning of year                        -                     -
            Granted                                          2,945,000               $.12
            Exercised                                           -                     -
            Cancelled                                           -                     -
                                                           -----------
         Outstanding - end of year                           2,945,000               $.12
         Exercisable, at end of year                            -                     -
                                                           ===========
         Available for grant                                    55,000
                                                            ==========

         Weighted average fair
          value per share of options
          granted during the year                          $       .06
                                                           ===========

                                                 Outstanding                            Exercisable
                                -------------------------------------------   -----------------------------
                                           Weighted
                                           Average            Weighted                      Weighted
  Range of                                 Contractual         Average                       Average
Exercise Prices                 Shares     Life (Years)     Exercise Price    Shares      Exercise Price
- ---------------                 ------     ------------     --------------    ------      --------------

$.118 - $.125                  2,945,000       9.63              $.12           --               -
                               =========                                       =====
</TABLE>

         As discussed in Note 2, the Company accounts for its stock-based
awards using the intrinsic value method in accordance with Accounting
Principles Board Opinion No. 25, Accounting for Stock Issued to Employees, and
its related interpretations. Accordingly, no

                                     F-28

<PAGE>



compensation expense has been recognized in the financial statements for these
employee stock arrangements.

         SFAS No. 123, Accounting for Stock-Based Compensation, requires the
disclosure of pro forma net income and earnings per share as if the Company
had adopted the fair value method for stock options granted after June 30,
1996. No such options were granted in fiscal 1996. Under SFAS No. 123, the
fair value of stock-based awards to employees is calculated through the use of
option pricing models, even though such models were developed to estimate the
fair value of freely tradable, fully transferable options without vesting
restrictions, which significantly differ from the Company's stock option
awards. These models also require subjective assumptions, including future
stock price volatility and expected time to exercise, which greatly affect the
calculated values. The Company's calculations were made using the
Black-Scholes option pricing model with the following weighted average
assumptions: expected life, 5 or 10 years following vesting; stock volatility,
96%, 87% and 144% in 1997, 1996 and 1995 respectively; risk free interest
rate, 6.6%, 6.0% and 6.0% in 1997, 1996 and 1995 respectively; and no
dividends during the expected term. The Company's calculations are based on a
multiple option valuation approach and forfeitures are recognized as they
occur. If the computed fair values of the awards had been amortized to expense
over the vesting period of the awards, pro forma net income would have been
$10.5 million ($3.02 per share - basic; $2.40 per share - diluted) in fiscal
1997.

         In addition to the various stock option plans, in May 1997 the
stockholders approved the Resource America, Inc. Non-Employee Director
Deferred Stock and Defined Compensation Plan (the "Director Plan") for which
25,000 shares were reserved for issuance. Each director vests in shares
granted under the Director Plan on the fifth anniversary of the date of grant.
If a director terminates service prior to such fifth anniversary, all of the
shares granted are forfeited. In May 1997, 1,000 shares were granted under the
Director Plan to each of the Company's four non-employee directors. The fair
value of the grants ($22.50 per share, $90,000 in total) is being charged to
operations over the five year vesting period.


                                     F-29

<PAGE>



NOTE 10-COMMITMENTS

         The Company leases office space under leases with varying expiration
dates through 2002 (see Note 3). Rental expense was $238,600, $188,900 and
$60,500 for the years ended September 30, 1997, 1996 and 1995, respectively.
Future minimum rental commitments for the next five fiscal years were as
follows:
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>

                                                    December 31, 1997          September 30, 1997
                                                    -----------------          ------------------
                                                        (Unaudited)

<S>                                                          <C>                         <C>     
                  1998..............................         $506,801                    $445,300
                  1999..............................          523,825                     437,000
                  2000..............................          523,825                     437,000
                  2001..............................          501,925                     415,100
                  2002..............................          486,625                     399,800
</TABLE>

         As of December 31, 1997 and September 30, 1997, the Company had
outstanding commitments to fund the purchase of equipment which it intends to
lease, with an aggregate cost of $4.1 million and $11.4 millon, respectively.
The Company believes, based on its past experience, that approximately $1.8
million and $4.0 millon, respectively, will be funded.

         As of December 31, 1997 and September 30, 1997, subsidiaries of the
Company had four and two warehouse lines of credit which allow them to borrow
up to $60 million and $25 millon, respectively. As of December 31, 1997, $4.4
million was outstanding with respect to these lines of credit. No borrowings
were outstanding at September 30, 1997.

         The Company has an employment agreement with its Chairman pursuant to
which the Company has agreed to provide him with a supplemental employment
retirement plan ("SERP") and with certain financial benefits upon termination
of his employment. Under the SERP, he will be paid an annual benefit of 75% of
his Average Income after he has reached Retirement Age (each as defined in the
employment agreement). Upon termination, he is entitled to receive lump sum
payments in various amounts of between 25% and five times Average Compensation
(depending upon the reason for termination) and, for termination due to
disability, a monthly benefit equal to the SERP benefit (which will terminate
upon commencement of payments under the SERP). During the first quarter of
fiscal 1998, the Company accrued $87,000 with respect to these commitments.
During fiscal 1997, the Company accrued $240,000 with respect to these
commitments.

NOTE 11-ACQUISITIONS

         In June 1997, the Company acquired equity interests in 288 wells
(representing 78 wells net to the Company's interest) and operating rights to
an additional 62 wells, together with 220 miles of natural gas pipelines and
21,830 gross acres (9,340 net acres) of mineral rights, for $1.25 million in
cash, $925,000 by a note and 17,000 shares of the Company's

                                     F-30

<PAGE>



Common Stock. The acquisition was accounted for as a purchase and,
accordingly, the assets and liabilities acquired have been recorded at their
estimated fair market values at the date of acquisition. The purchase price
resulted in an excess of costs over net assets acquired (goodwill) of
approximately $400,000, which is being amortized on a straight line basis over
15 years.

         In April 1997, the Company acquired all the outstanding shares of
Bryn Mawr Resources, Inc. ("BMR") for 579,623 shares of common stock. BMR's
only asset was 579,623 shares of the Company's Common Stock held by
subsidiaries of BMR (excluding 3,807 shares of the Company's Common Stock
attributable to minority interests held by third parties in BMR's
subsidiaries).

         In December 1997, the Company acquired equity interests in
approximately 135 wells (representing approximately 88 net wells, together
with 60 miles of natural gas pipelines and 17,000 gross acres of mineral
rights, for $900,000 in cash. This acquisition was recorded as a purchase.

         These acquisitions were immaterial to the results of operations of
the Company, and therefore pro forma information is excluded.


                                     F-31

<PAGE>



NOTE 12-INDUSTRY SEGMENT INFORMATION AND MAJOR CUSTOMERS

         The Company operates in three principal industry segments - real
estate, leasing and energy. Segment data for the quarters ended December 31,
1997 and 1996 and for years ended September 30, 1997, 1996 and 1995 are as
follows:
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>

                                                                        As of and for the
                                                  -----------------------------------------------------------
                                                     Quarter Ended                     Year Ended
                                                      December 31,                    September 30,
                                                  ----------------------    ---------------------------------
                                                     1997        1996         1997        1996         1995
                                                  ---------      -------    --------     -------      -------
                                                        (Unaudited)
                                                                        (in thousands)
<S>                                                <C>            <C>       <C>          <C>          <C>    
         Revenue:
           Real estate                             $  9,392       $3,219    $ 19,144     $ 7,171      $ 6,114
           Leasing                                    3,172        1,202       7,162       4,466        --
           Energy                                     1,815        1,339       5,608       5,157        5,332
           Corporate                                    698           84         930         197          148
                                                  ---------      -------    --------     -------      -------
                                                   $ 15,077      $ 5,844     $32,844     $16,991      $11,594
                                                   ========      =======     =======     =======      =======

         Depreciation, Depletion and
         Amortization:
           Real estate                             $    158      $    10     $    36     $    38      $    37
           Leasing                                      138           81         398         204        --
           Energy                                       239          288       1,202       1,061        1,254
           Corporate                                    (27)        --           (22)         65           44
                                                   --------      -------      ------     -------      -------
                                                   $    508      $   379      $1,614     $ 1,368      $ 1,335
                                                   ========      =======      ======     =======      =======

         Operating Profit (Loss):
           Real estate                             $  7,467      $ 2,865     $16,546     $ 6,281      $ 5,276
           Leasing                                    1,430          214       2,457       1,916        --
           Energy                                       518          372       1,699       1,646        1,317
           Corporate                                 (3,692)        (679)     (5,845)     (2,497)      (3,248)
                                                   --------      -------    ---------    --------     --------
                                                   $  5,723      $ 2,772    $ 14,857     $ 7,346      $ 3,345
                                                   ========      =======    ========     =======      =======

         Identifiable Assets:
           Real estate                             $140,280      $51,518    $ 92,287     $22,087      $18,225
           Leasing                                   16,251        7,192      10,647       3,019          991
           Energy                                    16,242       12,895      15,016      12,675       13,790
           Corporate                                 35,146        8,806      77,169       6,178        4,544
                                                   --------      -------    --------     -------      -------
                                                   $207,919      $80,411    $195,119     $43,959      $37,550
                                                   ========      =======    ========     =======      =======

         Capital Expenditures:
           Real Estate                             $    561     $      5    $     59    $     17     $    172
           Leasing                                      174           54         585         531         --
           Energy                                     1,239           71       1,513         501          637
           Corporate                                  --           --            507          48            8
                                                  ---------     --------    --------    --------    ---------
                                                  $   1,974      $   130    $  2,664     $ 1,097     $    817
                                                  =========      =======    ========     =======     ========
</TABLE>

                                     F-32

<PAGE>




         Operating profit (loss) represents total revenue less costs
attributable thereto, including interest and provision for possible losses,
and less depreciation, depletion and amortization, excluding general corporate
expenses.

         The Company's natural gas is sold under contract to various
purchasers. For the years ended September 30, 1997 and 1996, gas sales to two
purchasers accounted for 29% and 12% and 29% and 13% of the Company's total
production revenues, respectively. Gas sales to one purchaser individually
accounted for 15% of total revenues for the year ended September 30, 1995.

         In commercial mortgage loan acquisition and resolution, interest and
fees earned from a single borrower in the fiscal year ended September 30, 1997
approximated 20%, while for the fiscal year ended September 30, 1996 interest
and fees from a (different) single borrower approximated 24% of total
revenues. No single borrower generated revenues in excess of 10% in fiscal
1995.

NOTE 13-SUPPLEMENTAL OIL AND GAS INFORMATION

         Results of operations for oil and gas producing activities:
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>

                                                 Quarter Ended
                                                  December 31,                    Year Ended September 30,
                                             -----------------------        ------------------------------------
                                               1997           1996            1997          1996            1995
                                             -------        --------        --------      --------       -------
                                             (Unaudited)
                                                                    (in thousands)

<S>                                          <C>             <C>               <C>          <C>           <C>   
         Revenues........................    $1,232          $  950            $3,936       $3,421        $3,452
         Production costs................      (519)           (366)           (1,636)      (1,421)       (1,502)
         Exploration expenses............       (56)            (46)             (187)        (161)         (230)
         Depreciation, depletion,
            and amortization.............      (185)           (198)             (712)        (781)         (922)
         Income taxes....................      (146)           (134)             (197)         (96)         -
                                              -----          ------            -------     -------       ----
         Results of operations for
            producing activities.........    $  326          $  206            $1,204       $  962        $  798
                                             ======          ======            ======       ======        ======

</TABLE>

                                     F-33

<PAGE>



Capitalized Costs Related to Oil and Gas Producing Activities

         The components of capitalized costs related to the Company's oil and
gas producing activities (less impairment reserve of $28,000, $22,000, and
$30,000 at September 30, 1997, 1996, and 1995, respectively and $29,000 at
December 31, 1997), are as follows:
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>

                                                   December 31,                     September 30,
                                                 ---------------        ---------------------------------------
                                                       1997               1997            1996           1995
                                                 ---------------        --------        --------        --------
                                                 (Unaudited)
                                                                          (in thousands)

<S>                                                 <C>                  <C>             <C>             <C>    
         Proved properties.....................     $24,142              $23,254         $22,549        $22,416
         Unproved properties...................         974                  846             482            650
         Pipelines, equipment and                                   
            other interests....................       2,460                2,445           2,540          2,488
                                                    -------              -------         -------        -------
                                                     27,576               26,545          25,571         25,554
         Accumulated depreciation,                                  
           depletion and amortization..........     (15,198)             (15,145)        (14,306)       (13,590)
                                                    -------              -------         -------        -------
             Net capitalized costs.............     $12,378              $11,400         $11,265        $11,964
                                                    =======              =======         =======        =======
</TABLE>                                                          

Costs Incurred in Oil and Gas Producing Activities

         The costs incurred by the Company in its oil and gas activities
during the quarters ended December 31, 1997 and 1996, and during the fiscal
years 1997, 1996 and 1995 are as follows:
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>

                                                 Quarter Ended                       Year Ended
                                                  December 31,                      September 30,
                                             ----------------------         -----------------------------
                                              1997           1996            1997      1996         1995
                                             -------        -------         -------   ------       ------
                                                  (Unaudited)
                                                                 (in thousands)

<S>                                           <C>          <C>              <C>       <C>           <C> 
         Property acquisition costs:                                    
           Unproved properties...........     $  5         $  1             $321      $  2          $  5
           Proved properties.............      990           38              782       157           388
         Exploration costs...............      185           44              238       317           317
         Development costs...............       73            7              144       176           211
</TABLE>                                                               
                                                                       
Oil and Gas Reserve Information (unaudited)                            
                                                                       
         The Company's estimates of net proved developed oil and gas r eserves
and the present value thereof have been verified by E.E. Templeton &   
Associates, Inc., an independent                                      

                                     F-34

<PAGE>



petroleum engineering firm. The Company does not estimate the value of its
proven undeveloped reserves.

         The Company's oil and gas reserves are located within the United
States. There are numerous uncertainties inherent in estimating quantities of
proved reserves and in projecting future net revenues and the timing of
development expenditures. The reserve data presented represent estimates only
and should not be construed as being exact. In addition, the standardized
measures of discounted future net cash flows may not represent the fair market
value of the Company's oil and gas reserves or the present value of future
cash flows of equivalent reserves, due to anticipated future changes in oil
and gas prices and in production and development costs and other factors for
which effects have not been provided.

         The standardized measure of discounted future net cash flows is
information provided for the financial statement user as a common base for
comparing oil and gas reserves of enterprises in the industry.
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>

                                                                                Gas              Oil
                                                                                (mcf)            (bbls)
                                                                             ----------          -------
<S>                                                                             <C>               <C>   
         Balance at September 30, 1994........................               12,112,116          296,859
         Purchases of reserves in-place.......................                  893,104           23,284
         Current additions....................................                  430,330            3,641
         Sales of reserves in-place...........................                  (79,294)            (628)
         Revisions to previous estimates......................                  624,471           14,423
         Production...........................................               (1,198,245)         (36,420)
                                                                             ----------          -------
         Balance at September 30, 1995........................               12,782,482          301,159

         Purchase of reserves in-place........................                  293,602            8,880
         Current additions....................................                  237,070              726
         Sales of reserves in-place...........................                  (18,645)          (1,885)
         Revision to previous estimates.......................                  723,242           35,002
         Production...........................................               (1,165,477)         (33,862)
                                                                             ----------          -------
         Balance at September 30, 1996........................               12,852,274          310,020

         Purchase of reserves in-place........................                1,903,853           45,150
         Current additions....................................                   15,984                0
         Sales of reserves in-place...........................                   (1,393)               0
         Revision to previous estimates.......................                1,614,704           38,654
         Production...........................................               (1,227,887)         (35,811)
                                                                             ----------          -------
         Balance at September 30, 1997........................               15,157,535          358,013
                                                                             ==========          =======

</TABLE>

                                     F-35

<PAGE>



         Presented below is the standardized measure of discounted future net
cash flows and changes therein relating to proved developed oil and gas
reserves. The estimated future production is priced at year-end prices. The
resulting estimated future cash inflows are reduced by estimated future costs
to develop and produce the proved developed reserves based on year-end cost
levels. The future net cash flows are reduced to present value amounts by
applying a 10% discount factor.
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>

                                                                       Year Ended September 30,
                                                             -------------------------------------------
                                                               1997              1996            1995
                                                              -------          --------         --------
                                                                           (in thousands)

<S>                                                           <C>              <C>              <C>     
         Future cash inflows............................      $42,634          $ 34,516         $ 30,257
         Future production and
            development costs...........................      (21,585)          (16,764)         (15,200)
         Future income tax expense......................       (2,740)           (2,732)          (1,260)
                                                              -------          --------         --------
         Future net cash flows..........................       18,309            15,020           13,797
         Less 10% annual discount for
           estimated timing of cash flows...............       (8,186)           (6,671)          (5,987)
                                                              -------          --------         --------
         Standardized measure of discounted
           future net cash flows........................      $10,123          $  8,349         $  7,810
                                                              =======          ========         ========
</TABLE>


                                     F-36

<PAGE>



         The following table summarizes the changes in the standardized
measure of discounted future net cash flows from estimated production of
proved developed oil and gas reserves after income taxes.

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>

                                                                       Year Ended September 30,
                                                             -------------------------------------------
                                                               1997              1996            1995
                                                              -------          --------         --------
                                                                           (in thousands)

<S>                                                           <C>              <C>              <C>     
         Balance, beginning of year......................     $ 8,349            $7,810           $7,961
         Increase (decrease) in discounted
           future net cash flows:
         Sales and transfers of oil and gas
           net of related costs..........................      (2,411)           (1,928)          (1,870)
         Net changes in prices and production
           costs.........................................         512             1,392             (187)
         Revisions of previous quantity
           estimates.....................................       2,483               697              418
         Extensions, discoveries, and improved
           recovery less related costs...................          10               145              253
         Purchases of reserves in-place..................       1,474               242              612
         Sales of reserves in-place, net of
           tax effect....................................          (1)              (26)             (46)
         Accretion of discount...........................         997               851              842
         Net change in future income taxes...............         (14)             (924)            (240)
         Other...........................................      (1,276)               90               67
                                                              -------            ------           ------
         Balance, end of year............................     $10,123            $8,349           $7,810
                                                              =======            ======           ======
</TABLE>

NOTE 14 - EVENT (UNAUDITED) SUBSEQUENT TO THE DATE OF THE INDEPENDENT
AUDITORS' REPORT

         The Company is the sponsor of Resource Asset Investment Trust (the
"REIT"), a recently formed real estate investment trust which commenced
operations in January 1998. RAIT has been formed to acquire and provide
mortgage financing in situations that generally do not conform to the debt
underwriting standards of institutional lenders or sources that provide
financing through securitization.

         The chairman of RAIT is the spouse of the chairman of the Company;
their son, who is not otherwise an officer or director of the Company, is the
Company's representative on RAIT's board of trustees.

         In January 1998, the Company sold 10 loans and senior lien interests
in two other loans. The aggregate price paid by RAIT for the loans and the
senior lien interests was $20.1 million (including $2.0 million attributable
to senior lien interests acquired by the Company

                                     F-37

<PAGE>



and sold to RAIT, at cost, in connection with such purchase. The Company
realized a gain on such sale of $3.0 million. The Company anticipates selling
further loans to RAIT.

                                     F-38

<PAGE>



No person is authorized to give any information or to make any representation
not contained in this Prospectus and any information or representation not
contained herein must not be relied upon as having been authorized by the
Company or any Underwriter. This Prospectus does not constitute an offer of
any securities other than the securities to which it relates or an offer to
any person in any jurisdiction where such an offer would be unlawful. Neither
the delivery of this Prospectus nor any sale made hereunder shall, under any
circumstances, create any implication that there has been no change in the
affairs of the Company since the date hereof.

                              ------------------

                               TABLE OF CONTENTS

                              ------------------
                                                                          Page
                                                                          ----

Available Information....................................................   3
Additional Information...................................................   3
Incorporation of Certain Documents
  by Reference...........................................................   4
Prospectus Summary.......................................................   5
Risk Factors.............................................................  12
Price Range of Common Stock and
 Dividend Policy.........................................................  29
Capitalization...........................................................  31
Selected Consolidated Financial Data.....................................  32
Use of Proceeds..........................................................  35
Management's Discussion and Analysis
  of Financial Condition and Results
  of Operations..........................................................  35
Business.................................................................  54
Management...............................................................  91
Security Ownership of Certain
  Beneficial Owners and Management.......................................  98
Description of Capital Stock............................................. 100
Shares Eligible for Future Sale.......................................... 103
Underwriting............................................................. 105
Legal Matters............................................................ 107
Independent Auditors..................................................... 107
Consolidated Financial Statements........................................ F-1


<PAGE>

                               1,500,000 Shares


                                    [LOGO]



                            RESOURCE AMERICA, INC.


                                 Common Stock


                                 ------------
                                  PROSPECTUS
                                 ------------


                              FRIEDMAN, BILLINGS,
                              RAMSEY & CO., INC.

                             BANCAMERICA ROBERTSON
                                   STEPHENS

                               JANNEY MONTGOMERY
                                  SCOTT INC.


                              ____________, 1998

<PAGE>

                PART II. INFORMATION NOT REQUIRED IN PROSPECTUS

Item 14.  Other Expenses of Issuance and Distribution.

Registration and Filing Fees:

         Securities and Exchange Commission.......................   $23,987.73
         NASD ....................................................    17,500.00
                                                                     ----------
         Total Registration and Filing Fees.......................   $41,487.73
                                                                         
Printing and Engraving*...........................................       
Legal*............................................................       
Blue Sky*.........................................................       
Accounting*.......................................................       
Transfer Agent....................................................       
Total Other Expenses*.............................................
                                                                     ----------
Total Expenses....................................................
                                                                     ==========
- ---------
*Estimate                                                                 

Item 15.  Indemnification of Directors and Officers

         As permitted by Section 102(b)(7) of the Delaware General Corporation
Law, the Company's Certificate of Incorporation provides that directors of the
Company shall not be personally liable to the Company or its stockholders for
monetary damages for breach of fiduciary duty as a director, except for
liability (i) for any breach of the director's duty of loyalty to the Company
or its stockholders, (ii) for acts or omissions not in good faith or which
involve intentional misconduct or a knowing violation of law, (iii) under
Section 174 of the Delaware General Corporation Law, relating to prohibited
dividends or distributions or the repurchase or redemption of stock, or (iv)
for any transaction from which the director derives an improper personal
benefit. In addition, the Company's By-laws provide for indemnification of the
Company's officers and directors to the fullest extent permitted under
Delaware law. Insofar as indemnification for liabilities arising under the
Securities Act may be permitted to directors, officers or persons controlling
the Company pursuant to the foregoing provisions, or otherwise, the Company
has been informed that in the opinion of the Commission such indemnification
is against public policy as expressed in the Securities Act and is, therefore,
unenforceable.

         The Company maintains directors' and officers' liability insurance
against any actual or alleged error, misstatement, misleading statement, act,
omission, neglect or breach of duty by any director or officer, excluding
certain matters including fraudulent, dishonest or criminal acts or
self-dealing.



<PAGE>



Item 16. Exhibits and Financial Statement Schedules.

          a.   Exhibits.

                1.*   Form of Underwriting Agreement.

                2.    Agreement and Plan of Merger among Tri-Star Financial
                      Services, Inc. Frank Pellegrini, Resource Tri-Star
                      Acquisition Corp. and the Registrant(1)

                3.1   Restated Certificate of Incorporation of the
                      Registrant.(2)

                3.2   Bylaws of the Registrant, as amended.(2)

                4.    Form of certificate for Common Stock.(2)

                4.2   Indenture with respect to 12% senior notes due 2004
                      (including form of note).(3)

                5.*   Opinion of Ledgewood Law Firm, P.C., as to the legality
                      of the securities being registered (including consent).

                10.1  Receivables Purchase Agreement (lease sales)

                10.2  Purchase and Sale Agreement (lease sales)

                12.   Statement regarding computation of ratios.(1)

                23.1  Consent of E. E. Templeton & Associates, Inc.

                23.2  Consent of Grant Thornton LLP

                23.3  Consent of Ledgewood Law Firm, P.C. (included in Exhibit
                      5)

                24.   Power of Attorney (included as part of signature pages
                      to this registration statement).
- ---------
*        To be filed by amendment.

(1)      Filed previously as an Exhibit to the Company's Annual Report on Form
         10-K for the year ended September 30, 1997.
(2)      Filed previously as an Exhibit to the Company's Registration
         Statement on Form S-1 (Registration No. 333-13905) and by this
         reference incorporated herein.
(3)      Filed previously as an Exhibit to the Company's Registration
         Statement on Form S-4 (Registration No. 333-40231) and by this
         reference incorporated herein.



<PAGE>



Item 17.  Undertakings.

         The undersigned registrant hereby undertakes that, for purposes of
determining any liability under the Securities Act, each filing of the
registrant's annual report pursuant to section 13(a) or section 15(d) of the
Exchange Act (and, where applicable, each filing of an employee benefit plan's
annual report pursuant to section 15(d) of the Exchange Act) that is
incorporated by reference in the registration statement shall be deemed to be
a new registration statement relating to the securities offered therein, and
the offering of such securities at that time shall be deemed to be the initial
bona fide offering thereof.

         Insofar as indemnification for liabilities arising under the
Securities Act may be permitted to directors, officers and controlling persons
of the registrant pursuant to the provisions of registrant's Certificate of
Incorporation, Bylaws or otherwise, the registrant has been advised that in
the opinion of the Securities and Exchange Commission such indemnification is
against public policy as expressed in the Securities Act and is, therefore,
unenforceable. In the event that a claim for indemnification against such
liabilities (other than the payment by the registrant of expenses incurred or
paid by a director, officer or controlling person of the registrant in the
successful defense of any action, suit or proceeding) is asserted by such
director, officer or controlling person in connection with the securities
being registered, the registrant will, unless in the opinion of its counsel
the matter has been settled by controlling precedent, submit to a court of
appropriate jurisdiction the question whether such indemnification by it is
against public policy as expressed in the Securities Act and will be governed
by the final adjudication of such issue.

The undersigned registrant undertakes that:

         1. For purposes of determining any liability under the Securities
Act, the information omitted from the form of prospectus filed as part of this
registration statement in reliance upon Rule 430A and contained in a form of
prospectus filed by the registrant pursuant to Rule 424(b)(1) or (4), or
497(h) under the Securities Act shall be deemed to be part of this
registration statement as of the time it was declared effective.

         2. For the purposes of determining any liability under the Securities
Act, each post-effective amendment that contains a form of prospectus shall be
deemed to be a new registration statement relating to the securities offered
therein, and the offering of such securities at that time shall be deemed to
be the initial bona fide offering thereof.



<PAGE>



                                  SIGNATURES

         Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Act of 1933, the
registrant certifies that it has reasonable grounds to believe that it meets
all of the requirements for filing on Form S-3 and has duly caused this
registration statement to be signed on its behalf by the undersigned,
thereunto duly authorized, in the City of Philadelphia, Commonwealth of
Pennsylvania, on March 3, 1998.

                                    RESOURCE AMERICA, INC.



                                    By: /s/ Edward E. Cohen
                                        -----------------------------------
                                        Edward E. Cohen, Chairman of the
                                        Board of Directors, Chief Executive
                                        Officer and President




<PAGE>



                               POWER OF ATTORNEY

         Each person whose signature appears below in so signing also makes,
constitutes and appoints Edward E. Cohen, Steven J. Kessler, Michael L.
Staines, and each of them acting alone, his true and lawful attorney-in-fact,
with full power of substitution, for him in any and all capacities to execute
and cause to be filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission any and all
amendments and post-effective amendments to this registration statement with
exhibits thereto and other documents in connection therewith, and hereby
ratifies and confirms all that said attorney-in-fact or said
attorney-in-fact's substitute or substitutes may do or cause to be done by
virtue hereof.

                                  SIGNATURES

         Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Act of 1933, this
registration statement has been signed by the following persons in the
capacities and on the dates indicated.


/s/ Edward E. Cohen
- -------------------------------               Date: March  3, 1998
EDWARD E. COHEN, Chairman of
the Board of Directors,
Chief Executive Officer,
President and Director
(Chief Executive Officer)

/s/ Carlos C. Campbell
- -------------------------------               Date: March  3, 1998
CARLOS C. CAMPBELL, Director

/s/ Daniel G. Cohen
- -------------------------------               Date: March  3, 1998
DANIEL G. COHEN, Executive Vice
President and Director

/s/ Andrew M. Lubin
- -------------------------------               Date: March  3, 1998
ANDREW M. LUBIN, Director

/s/ Scott F. Schaeffer
- -------------------------------               Date: March  3, 1998
SCOTT F. SCHAEFFER, Executive Vice
President and Director

                   [SIGNATURES CONTINUED ON FOLLOWING PAGE]


<PAGE>



                    [SIGNATURES CONTINUED FROM PRIOR PAGE]


/s/ Alan D. Schreiber, M.D.
- -------------------------------               Date: March  3, 1998
ALAN D. SCHREIBER, M.D.,
Director

/s/ Michael L. Staines
- -------------------------------               Date: March  3, 1998
MICHAEL L. STAINES, Senior
Vice President, Secretary
and Director

/s/ John S. White
- -------------------------------               Date: March  3, 1998
JOHN S. WHITE, Director

/s/ Steven Kessler
- -------------------------------               Date: March  3, 1998
STEVEN J. KESSLER, Senior Vice President
- - Finance and Chief Financial Officer

/s/ Nancy J. McGurk
- -------------------------------               Date: March  3, 1998
NANCY J. MCGURK, Vice
President - Finance
(Chief Accounting Officer)

<PAGE>

                                Exhibit Index

                1.*   Form of Underwriting Agreement.

                2.    Agreement and Plan of Merger among Tri-Star Financial
                      Services, Inc. Frank Pellegrini, Resource Tri-Star
                      Acquisition Corp. and the Registrant(1)

                3.1   Restated Certificate of Incorporation of the
                      Registrant.(2)

                3.2   Bylaws of the Registrant, as amended.(2)

                4.    Form of certificate for Common Stock.(2)

                4.2   Indenture with respect to 12% senior notes due 2004
                      (including form of note).(3)

                5.*   Opinion of Ledgewood Law Firm, P.C., as to the legality
                      of the securities being registered (including consent).

                10.1  Receivables Purchase Agreement (lease sales)

                10.2  Purchase and Sale Agreement (lease sales)

                12.   Statement regarding computation of ratios.(1)

                23.1  Consent of E. E. Templeton & Associates, Inc.

                23.2  Consent of Grant Thornton LLP

                23.3  Consent of Ledgewood Law Firm, P.C. (included in Exhibit
                      5)

                24.   Power of Attorney (included as part of signature pages
                      to this registration statement).
- ---------
*        To be filed by amendment.

(1)      Filed previously as an Exhibit to the Company's Annual Report on Form
         10-K for the year ended September 30, 1997.
(2)      Filed previously as an Exhibit to the Company's Registration
         Statement on Form S-1 (Registration No. 333-13905) and by this
         reference incorporated herein.
(3)      Filed previously as an Exhibit to the Company's Registration
         Statement on Form S-4 (Registration No. 333-40231) and by this
         reference incorporated herein.



<PAGE>

                                                                EXECUTION COPY



==============================================================================

                               U.S. $50,000,000

                        RECEIVABLES PURCHASE AGREEMENT

                         Dated as of December 18, 1997

                                     Among

                         SW LEASING PORTFOLIO IV, INC.

                                 as the Seller
                                 -------------

                            FIDELITY LEASING, INC.

                                as the Servicer
                                ---------------

                                 the INVESTORS

                                 named herein
                                 ------------

                     VARIABLE FUNDING CAPITAL CORPORATION

                               as the Purchaser
                               ----------------

                       FIRST UNION CAPITAL MARKETS CORP.

                               as the Deal Agent
                               -----------------

                           FIRST UNION NATIONAL BANK

                            as the Liquidity Agent
                            ----------------------

                                      and

                         HARRIS TRUST AND SAVINGS BANK

                as the Collateral Custodian and Backup Servicer
                -----------------------------------------------

==============================================================================



<PAGE>



                               TABLE OF CONTENTS

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                                               Page

<S>                                                                                                            <C>
ARTICLE I  DEFINITIONS............................................................................................1
         Section 1.1 Certain Defined Terms........................................................................1
         Section 1.2 Other Terms.................................................................................23
         Section 1.3 Computation of Time Periods.................................................................23
ARTICLE II  THE PURCHASE FACILITY................................................................................23
         Section 2.1 Purchases of Asset Interests................................................................23
         Section 2.2 The Initial Purchase, Subsequent Purchases and Incremental Purchases........................24
         Section 2.3 Reduction of the Purchase Limit; Repurchase.................................................25
         Section 2.4 Determination of Yield......................................................................25
         Section 2.5 [reserved]..................................................................................25
         Section 2.6 Dividing or Combining Asset Interests.......................................................25
         Section 2.7 Non-Liquidation Settlement Procedures.......................................................26
         Section 2.8 Settlement Procedures Following a Termination Date..........................................27
         Section 2.9 Settlement Procedures Following a Restricting Event.........................................28
         Section 2.10 Collections and Allocations................................................................30
         Section 2.11 Payments, Computations, Etc................................................................30
         Section 2.12 Optional Repurchase........................................................................31
         Section 2.13 Fees.......................................................................................31
         Section 2.14 Increased Costs; Capital Adequacy; Illegality..............................................32
         Section 2.15 Taxes......................................................................................33
         Section 2.16 Assignment of the Purchase Agreement.......................................................35
         Section 2.17 Substitution of Contracts..................................................................35
ARTICLE III  CONDITIONS OF PURCHASES.............................................................................37
         Section 3.1 Conditions Precedent to Initial Purchase....................................................37
         Section 3.2 Conditions Precedent to All Purchases and Remittances of Collections........................37
         Section 3.3 Delivery of Contract Files..................................................................38
ARTICLE IV  REPRESENTATIONS AND WARRANTIES.......................................................................38
         Section 4.1 Representations and Warranties of the Seller................................................38
         Section 4.2 Representations and Warranties of Seller Relating to the Agreement and the Contracts........42
         Section 4.3 Representations and Warranties of the Seller Relating to the Purchase    
         Limit and Capital Limit.................................................................................44
ARTICLE V  GENERAL COVENANTS OF THE SELLER.......................................................................44
         Section 5.1 General Covenants...........................................................................44
         Section 5.2 Covenants of Seller.........................................................................44
         Section 5.3 Release of Lien on Equipment................................................................48
         Section 5.4 Hedging of Contracts........................................................................49
         Section 5.5 Retransfer of Ineligible Contracts..........................................................49
         Section 5.6 Retransfer of Assets........................................................................50
</TABLE>
                                       i
<PAGE>

<TABLE>
<S>                                                                                                             <C>
ARTICLE VI  ADMINISTRATION AND SERVICING OF CONTRACTS............................................................51
         Section 6.1 Appointment and Acceptance; Duties..........................................................51
         Section 6.2 Collection of Payments......................................................................54
         Section 6.3 Servicer Advances...........................................................................55
         Section 6.4 Realization Upon Defaulted Contract.........................................................56
         Section 6.5 Maintenance of Insurance Policies...........................................................56
         Section 6.6 Representations and Warranties of Servicer..................................................57
         Section 6.7 Representations and Warranties of Backup Servicer and Collateral Custodian..................58
         Section 6.8 Covenants of Servicer.......................................................................60
         Section 6.9 Covenants of Backup Servicer and Collateral Custodian.......................................60
         Section 6.10 Servicing Compensation.....................................................................61
         Section 6.11 Custodial Compensation.....................................................................61
         Section 6.12 Payment of Certain Expenses by Servicer....................................................61
         Section 6.13 Reports....................................................................................62
         Section 6.14 Annual Statement as to Compliance..........................................................62
         Section 6.15 Annual Independent Public Accountant's Servicing Reports...................................62
         Section 6.16 Adjustments................................................................................63
         Section 6.17 Merger or Consolidation of the Servicer....................................................63
         Section 6.18 Limitation on Liability of the Servicer and Others.........................................64
         Section 6.19 Indemnification of the Seller, the Backup Servicer, the....................................64
         Collateral Custodian, the Deal Agent and the Purchasers.................................................64
         Section 6.20 The Servicer Not to Resign.................................................................65
         Section 6.21 Access to Certain Documentation and Information                                          
         Regarding the Contracts.................................................................................65
         Section 6.22 Backup Servicer............................................................................66
         Section 6.23 Identification of Records..................................................................68
         Section 6.24 Servicer Defaults..........................................................................68
         Section 6.25 Appointment of Successor Servicer..........................................................70
         Section 6.26 Notification...............................................................................71
         Section 6.27 Protection of Right, Title and Interest to Assets..........................................71
         Section 6.28 Release of Contract Files..................................................................72
ARTICLE VII  PAYOUT AND RESTRICTING EVENTS.......................................................................72
         Section 7.1 Payout Events...............................................................................72
         Section 7.2 Restricting Events..........................................................................72
ARTICLE VIII  INDEMNIFICATION....................................................................................74
         Section 8.1 Indemnities by the Seller...................................................................74
ARTICLE IX  THE DEAL AGENT AND THE LIQUIDITY AGENT...............................................................77
         Section 9.1 Authorization and Action....................................................................77
         Section 9.2 Delegation of Duties........................................................................77
         Section 9.3 Exculpatory Provisions......................................................................78
         Section 9.4 Reliance....................................................................................79
         Section 9.5 Non-Reliance on Deal Agent, Liquidity Agent and Other Purchasers............................79
         Section 9.6 Reimbursement and Indemnification...........................................................80
         Section 9.7 Deal Agent and Liquidity Agent in their Individual Capacities...............................80
</TABLE>
                                      ii
<PAGE>

<TABLE>
<S>                                                                                                             <C>
         Section 9.8 Successor Deal Agent or Liquidity Agent.....................................................80
ARTICLE X  ASSIGNMENTS; PARTICIPATIONS...........................................................................81
         Section 10.1 Assignments and Participations.............................................................81
ARTICLE XI  MISCELLANEOUS........................................................................................84
         Section 11.1 Amendments and Waivers.....................................................................84
         Section 11.2 Notices, Etc...............................................................................85
         Section 11.3 Ratable Payments...........................................................................85
         Section 11.4 No Waiver, Rights and Remedies.............................................................86
         Section 11.5 Binding Effect.............................................................................86
         Section 11.6 Term of this Agreement.....................................................................86
         Section 11.7 GOVERNING LAW; CONSENT TO JURISDICTION; WAIVER OF OBJECTION TO VENUE.......................86
         Section 11.8 WAIVER OF JURY TRIAL.......................................................................87
         Section 11.9 Costs, Expenses and Taxes..................................................................87
         Section 11.10 No Proceedings............................................................................88
         Section 11.11 Recourse Against Certain Parties..........................................................88
         Section 11.12 Protection of Ownership Interests of the Purchasers; Intent of Parties; Security Interest;
         Third Party Beneficiary.................................................................................88
         Section 11.13 Confidentiality...........................................................................89
         Section 11.14 Execution in Counterparts; Severability; Integration......................................91
</TABLE>



<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                   EXHIBITS

<S>              <C>
EXHIBIT A         Form of Notice of Sale
EXHIBIT B         Form of Lock-Box Notices
EXHIBIT C         "Limited Purpose" provisions of Seller's Certificate of Incorporation
EXHIBIT D         Form of Assignment and Acceptance
EXHIBIT E         Form of Monthly Report
EXHIBIT F         Form of Servicer's Certificate
EXHIBIT G         Form of Purchase Certificate
EXHIBIT H         Form of Hedging Agreement (including Schedule and Confirmation)

                                   SCHEDULES

SCHEDULE I        Condition Precedent Documents
SCHEDULE II       Lock-Box Banks and Lock-box Accounts
SCHEDULE III      Tradenames, Fictitious Names and "Doing Business As" Names
SCHEDULE IV       Location of Contract Files 
SCHEDULE V        List of Contracts
</TABLE>

                                     iii
<PAGE>


         THIS RECEIVABLES PURCHASE AGREEMENT (the "Agreement") is made as of
December 18, 1997, among:

         (1) SW LEASING PORTFOLIO IV, INC., a Pennsylvania corporation, as
seller (the "Seller");

         (2) FIDELITY LEASING, INC., a Pennsylvania corporation ("Fidelity"),
as servicer (the "Servicer");

         (3) the financial institutions listed on the signature pages of this
Agreement under the heading "Investors" and their respective successors and
assigns (the "Investors");

         (4) VARIABLE FUNDING CAPITAL CORPORATION, a Delaware corporation
("VFCC");

         (5) FIRST UNION CAPITAL MARKETS CORP. ("FCMC"), as deal agent (the
"Deal Agent") and as documentation agent (the "Documentation Agent");

         (6) FIRST UNION NATIONAL BANK ("First Union"), as liquidity agent
(the "Liquidity Agent"); and

         (7) HARRIS TRUST AND SAVINGS BANK, as collateral custodian (the
"Collateral Custodian") and backup servicer (the "Backup Servicer").

         IT IS AGREED as follows:

                                   ARTICLE I

                                  DEFINITIONS

                  Section 1.1       Certain Defined Terms.

         (a) Certain capitalized terms used throughout this Agreement are
defined above or in this Section 1. 1.

         (b) As used in this Agreement and its exhibits, the following terms
shall have the following meanings (such meanings to be equally applicable to
both the singular and plural forms of the terms defined).

ADCB: On any date of determination, the sum of the Discounted Contract Balance
of each Eligible Contract (excluding all Defaulted Contracts, Casualty Loss
Contracts, Early Termination Contracts and Contracts subject to a Warranty
Event) included in the Asset Pool as of the date of such determination.


<PAGE>

Addition Date: With respect to any Additional Contracts, the date on which
such Additional Contracts become Pool Assets.

Additional Contracts: All Contracts that become Pool Assets after the Closing
Date.

Additional Cut Off Date: Each date on and after which Collections on an
Additional Contract are to be transferred to the Asset Pool. 

Adjusted Eurodollar Rate: On any day, an interest rate per annum equal to the 
quotient, expressed as a percentage and rounded upwards (if necessary), to the 
nearest 1/100 of 1%, obtained by dividing (i) the LIBOR Rate on such day by (ii)
decimal equivalent of 100% minus the Eurodollar Reserve Percentage on such day.

Administration Agreement: That certain Administration Agreement executed
between VFCC and First Union Capital Markets Corp., as the same may be
amended, supplemented, or otherwise modified from time to time.

Adverse Claim: A lien, security interest, charge, encumbrance or other right
or claim of any Person.

Affected Party: As defined in Section 2.14(a).

Affiliate: With respect to a Person means any other Person controlling,
controlled by or under common control with such Person. For purposes of this
definition, "control" when used with respect to any specified Person means the
power to direct the management and policies of such Person, directly or
indirectly, whether through the ownership of voting securities, by contract or
otherwise; and the terms "controlling" or "controlled" have meanings
correlative to the foregoing.

Agent's Account: A special account (account number 01 41 96 47) in the name of
the Deal Agent or, so long as VFCC is the sole Purchaser hereunder, in the
name of VFCC maintained at Bankers Trust Company.

Aggregate Unpaids: At any time, an amount, equal to the sum of all Yield
(accrued and to accrue), Capital and all other amounts owed hereunder, under
any Hedging Agreement (including, without limitation, payments in respect of
the termination of any such Hedging Agreement) or under any fee letter
delivered by the Originator to the Deal Agent and the Purchasers at such time
(whether due or accrued).

Agreement: This Receivables Purchase Agreement, dated as of December 18, 1997,
as amended, modified, supplemented or restated from time to time.

Alternative Rate: An interest rate per annum equal to the Adjusted Eurodollar
Rate or the Base Rate, as the Deal Agent shall select in accordance with the
terms of the Agreement; provided, however, that the "Alternative Rate" shall


                                      2
<PAGE>

be the Base Rate if the relevant Purchaser shall have notified the Deal Agent
that a Eurodollar Disruption Event has occurred.

Asset: All right, title and interest of the transferring party in, to and
under any and all of the following:

                  (i) the Existing Contracts and Additional Contracts, and all
         monies due or to become due in payment of such Contracts on and after
         the related Cut Off Date, including but not limited to any Prepayment
         Amounts, any payments in respect of a casualty or early termination,
         and any Recoveries received with respect thereto, but excluding any
         Scheduled Payments due prior to the related Cut Off Date and any
         Excluded Amounts;

                  (ii) the Equipment related to such Contracts including all
         proceeds from any sale or other disposition of such Equipment;

                  (iii) the Contract Files,

                  (iv) all payments made or to be made in the future with
         respect to such Contracts or the obligor thereunder and under any
         guarantee or similar credit enhancement with respect to such
         Contracts;

                  (v) all Insurance Proceeds with respect to each such
         Contract; and

                  (vi) all income and proceeds of the foregoing.

Asset Interest: At any time, an undivided variable percentage ownership
interest in all Assets. The undivided percentage interest of an Asset Interest
shall equal

                              C  +  C x  R
                                   -------
                                      AC
                       ----------------------
                                  ADCB

         where:

              C     =    equals the Capital in respect of such Asset Interest.

              AC    =    equals the aggregate Capital on such date.

              R     =    equals the Overcollateralization on such date.

Asset Pool:  At any time, all then outstanding Assets.

Assignment and Acceptance: An assignment and acceptance entered into by an
Investor and an Eligible Assignee, and accepted by the Deal Agent, in
substantially the form of Exhibit D hereto.

                                      3
<PAGE>

Backup Servicer: Harris Trust and Savings Bank and its permitted successors
and assigns.

Backup Servicer and Collateral Custodian Fee Letter: The letter dated as of
the Closing Date, among Fidelity, the Deal Agent, the Backup Servicer and
Collateral Custodian setting forth among other things the Backup Servicer Fee
and the Collateral Custodial Fee.

Backup Servicer Fee Rate: The rate per annum set forth in the Backup Servicer
and Collateral Custodian Fee Letter, dated as of the Closing Date.

Backup Servicing Fee: As defined in Section 6.22.

Bankruptcy Code: The Federal Bankruptcy Code, as amended from time to time
(Title 11 of the United States Code).

Base Rate: On any date, a fluctuating rate of interest per annum equal to the
higher of (a) the Prime Rate or (b) the Federal Funds Rate plus 1.0%.

Benefit Plan: Any employee benefit plan as defined in Section 3(3) of ERISA in
respect of which the Seller or any ERISA Affiliate of the Seller is, or at any
time during the immediately preceding six years was, an "employer" as defined
in Section 3(5) of ERISA.

Blended Discount Rate: For any Determination Date, a rate per annum equal to
the weighted average (calculated based on the applicable Outstanding Balances)
of (i) the Blended Discount Rate as of the immediately preceding Determination
Date and (ii) the Sale Discount Rate, if any, for any Contract transferred to
the Asset Pool on the most recent Purchase Date, if any, occurring on or after
the immediately preceding Determination Date; provided, however, that the
Blended Discount Rate for the first Determination Date following the Closing
Date shall be the Sale Discount Rate applicable to the Original Contracts.

Business Day: Any day of the year other than a Saturday or a Sunday on which
(a) banks are not required or authorized to be closed in New York City,
Philadelphia, Pennsylvania, Charlotte, North Carolina and Chicago, Illinois,
and (b) if the term "Business Day" is used in connection with the Adjusted
Eurodollar Rate, dealings in United States dollar deposits are carried on in
the London interbank market.

Capital: For each Asset Interest, the amount paid to the Seller for such Asset
Interest at the time of its purchase by the Purchaser pursuant to this
Agreement, reduced from time to time by Collections distributed on account of
such Capital pursuant to Sections 2.7, 2.8 or 2.9; provided, however, that
such Capital shall not be reduced by any distribution or any portion of
Collections if at any time such distribution is rescinded or must be returned
for any reason.

Capital Limit: At any time, the product of (i) the ADCB and (ii) the lesser of
(a) 88% and (b) 100% - (three and a half (3 1/2) multiplied by the Net Loss to
Liquidation Ratio).



                                      4
<PAGE>

Casualty Loss: With respect to any item of Equipment, the loss, theft, damage
beyond repair or governmental condemnation or seizure of such item of
Equipment.

Casualty Loss Contract:  Any Contract that is subject to a Casualty Loss.

Closing Date:  December 18, 1997.

Code: The Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as amended.

Collateral Custodian: Harris Trust and Savings Bank and its permitted
successors and assigns.

Collection Account: As defined in Section 6.2(f).

Collection Date: The date following the Termination Date on which the
aggregate outstanding Capital has been reduced to zero, the Purchasers have
received all Yield and other amounts due to the Purchasers in connection with
this Agreement and the Deal Agent has received all amounts due to it in
connection with this Agreement.

Collections: (a) All cash collections and other cash proceeds of any Asset,
including, without limitation, Scheduled Payments, Prepayments, Insurance
Proceeds and Recoveries, all as related to amounts attributable to the
Contracts in the Asset Pool or the related Equipment, but excluding any
Excluded Amounts, (b) Residual Proceeds and (c) any other funds received by
the Seller or the Servicer with respect to any Contract or related Equipment.

Commercial Paper Notes: On any day, any short-term promissory notes issued by
VFCC with respect to financing its purchase of an Asset Interest hereunder.

Commitment: For each Investor, the commitment of such Investor to make
purchases from the Seller in an amount not to exceed the amount set forth
opposite such Investor's name on the signature pages of this Agreement, as
such amount may be modified in accordance with the terms hereof.

Commitment Fee:  As defined in Section 2.13(a) hereof.

Commitment Fee Rate:  The rate per annum set forth in the Program Fee Agreement.

Commitment Termination Date: December 17, 1998 or such later date to which the
Commitment Termination Date may be extended (if extended) in the sole
discretion of VFCC and each Investor in accordance with the terms of Section
2.1(b).

Contract: Any lease of Equipment by the Originator or by a third party, in
each case as lessor, to an Obligor.



                                      5
<PAGE>

Contract Files: With respect to each Contract, the fully executed original
counterpart (for UCC purposes) of the Contract, the original certificate of
title or other title document with respect to the related Equipment (if
applicable), and otherwise such documents, if any, that the Collateral
Custodian holds, evidencing ownership of such Equipment (if applicable) and
all other documents originally delivered to the Seller or held by the
Collateral Custodian with respect to any Contract.

Contract List: The contract list provided by the Seller to the Deal Agent and
the Collateral Custodian, in the form of Schedule V hereto.

CP Disruption Event: The inability of a Purchaser, at any time, whether as a
result of a prohibition, a contractual restriction or any other event or
circumstance whatsoever, to raise funds through the issuance of its commercial
paper notes (whether or not constituting commercial paper notes issued to fund
Purchases hereunder) in the United States commercial paper market.

CP Rate: For any Fixed Period, the per annum rate equivalent to the weighted
average of the per annum rates paid or payable by VFCC from time to time as
interest on or otherwise (by means of interest rate hedges or otherwise) in
respect of the promissory notes issued by VFCC that are allocated, in whole or
in part, by the Deal Agent (on behalf of VFCC) to fund or maintain the Asset
Interest during such period, as determined by the Deal Agent (on behalf of
VFCC) and reported to the Seller and the Servicer, which rates shall reflect
and give effect to the commissions of placement agents and dealers in respect
of such promissory notes, to the extent such commissions are allocated, in
whole or in part, to such promissory notes by the Deal Agent (on behalf of
VFCC); provided, however, that if any component of such rate is a discount
rate, in calculating the "CP Rate", the Deal Agent shall for such component
use the rate resulting from converting such discount rate to an interest
bearing equivalent rate per annum.

Credit and Collection Policy: The written credit and collection policies of
the Originator and Servicer in effect on the date hereof, as amended or
supplemented from time to time in accordance with Section 4.1(j).

Custodial Fee:  As defined in Section 6.11.

Cut Off Date: With respect to each Existing Contract, the date on and after
which Collections on such Existing Contract are to be transferred to the Asset
Pool, and with respect to each Additional Contract, the related Additional Cut
Off Date.

Default Ratio: As of any Determination Date, the percentage equivalent of a
fraction, the numerator of which is equal to twice the sum of the Discounted
Contract Balance of Contracts that became Defaulted Contracts (net of
Recoveries related thereto) during the immediately preceding six calendar
months and the denominator of which is the average of the ADCB as of each of
the current Determination Date and each of the immediately preceding five
Determination Dates.



                                      6
<PAGE>

Defaulted Contract: (i) A Contract in the Asset Pool as to which the Servicer
has determined or should have determined in accordance with its Credit and
Collection Policy that such Contract is not collectible or is subject to
repossession, or (ii) a Contract in the Asset Pool as to which all or a
portion of any one or more Scheduled Payments is more than 120 days past due
in an aggregate amount equal to the higher of (A) ten dollars or more or (B)
ten percent or more of any Scheduled Payment.

Delinquency Ratio: As of any Determination Date, the percentage equivalent of
a fraction, the numerator of which is the average of the Discounted Contract
Balance of Delinquent Contracts as of such Determination Date and each of the
immediately preceding two Determination Dates and the denominator of which is
the average of the ADCB as of such Determination Date and each of the
immediately preceding two Determination Dates.

Delinquent Contract: A Contract in the Asset Pool as to which all or a portion
of any one or more Scheduled Payments is 60 days or more past due.

Determination Date:  The last Business Day of each calendar month.

Discounted Contract Balance: With respect to any Contract, (i) as of the
related Cut Off Date, the present value of all remaining Scheduled Payments
becoming due under such Contract after the applicable Cut Off Date discounted
monthly at the Sale Discount Rate and (ii) as of any other date of
determination, the present value of all remaining Scheduled Payments becoming
due under such Contract after such Determination Date discounted monthly at
the applicable Blended Discount Rate.

         The "Discounted Contract Balance" for each Contract shall be
calculated assuming:

                  (a) all payments due in any Monthly Period as due on the
         last day of the Monthly Period;

                  (b) payments are discounted on a monthly basis using a 30
         day month and a 360 day year; and

                  (c) all security deposits and drawings under letters of
         credit, if any, issued in support of a Contract are applied to reduce
         Scheduled Payments in inverse order of the due date thereof.

Early Termination Contracts: Any Contract that the Servicer has allowed the
related Obligor to terminate prior to the date on which the final Scheduled
Payment is due thereunder.

Eligible Assignee: (a) A Person whose short-term rating is at least A-1 from
S&P and P-1 from Moody's, or whose obligations under this Agreement are
guaranteed by a Person whose short-term rating is at least A-1 from S&P and
P-1 from Moody's, or (b) such other Person satisfactory to VFCC, the Deal


                                      7
<PAGE>

Agent and each of the rating agencies rating the Commercial Paper and
approved, in writing, by the Seller; provided, however, that no such approval
shall be required in the event any Investor is required by any rating agency
rating VFCC's commercial paper notes or by any regulatory agency to make an
assignment.

Eligible Contract: On any Determination Date, each Contract with respect to
which each of the following is true:

         (a) the information with respect to the Contract and the Equipment
subject to the Contract is true and correct in all material respects;

         (b) immediately prior to the transfer hereunder of the Contract and
any related Equipment (or security interest therein), the Contract was owned
by the Seller free and clear of any Adverse Claim;

         (c) no Scheduled Payment related to the Contract is (i) more than 60
days delinquent, (ii) a payment as to which the Servicer has failed to make a
Servicer Advance, (iii) a payment as to which the related Equipment has been
repossessed or (iv) a payment as to which the related Equipment has been
charged-off in accordance with the credit and collection policies of the
Servicer;

         (d) the Contract is not a Defaulted Contract;

         (e) no provision of the Contract has been waived, altered or modified
in any respect except as allowed under the Credit and Collection Policy of the
Servicer;

         (f) the Contract is a valid and binding payment obligation of the
Obligor and is enforceable in accordance with its terms (except as may be
limited by applicable Insolvency Laws and the availability of equitable
remedies);

         (g) the Contract is not and will not be subject to rights of
rescission, setoff, counterclaim or defense and no such rights have been
asserted or threatened with respect to the Contract;

         (h) the Contract, at the time it is sold to VFCC does not violate the
laws of the United States or any state in any manner which would create
liability for any Purchaser or which would materially and adversely affect the
enforceability or collectibility of such Contract;

         (i) (i) the Contract and any related Equipment have not been sold,
transferred, assigned or pledged by the Seller to any other Person and, with
respect to a Contract that is a "true lease," any Equipment related to such
true lease is owned by the Seller free and clear of any Liens of any third
parties (except for any Permitted Liens) and (ii) such Contract is secured by
a fully perfected Lien of the first priority on the related Equipment but only
to the extent that the Contract has (i) a $1.00 purchase option exercisable at


                                      8
<PAGE>

the expiration of its term and the Equipment has a residual value in excess of
$10,000,00 at such time; (ii) a fixed price purchase option exercisable at the
expiration of its term and the Equipment has a residual value in excess of
$10,000.00 at such time; or (iii) a fair market value purchase price option
exercisable at the expiration of its term and the residual value of the
Equipment exceeds $50,000.00 at such time;

         (j) the Contract constitutes chattel paper, an account, an instrument
or a general intangible as defined under the UCC and if the Contract
constitutes "chattel paper" for purposes of the UCC, there is not more than
one "secured party's original" counterpart of the Contract;

         (k) all filings necessary to evidence the conveyance or transfer to
the Deal Agent of the Contract and all right, title and interest in the
related Equipment have been made in all appropriate Jurisdictions;

         (l the Obligor is not the subject of bankruptcy or other insolvency
proceedings;

         (m) the Obligor's billing address is in the United States and the
Contract is a U.S. dollar-denominated obligation;

         (n) the Contract does not require the prior written consent of an
Obligor or contain any other restriction on the transfer or assignment of the
Contract (other than a consent or waiver of such restriction that has been
obtained prior to the Closing Date, with respect to an Existing Contract, or
the Addition Date, with respect to an Additional Contract);

         (o) the obligations of the related Obligor under the Contract are
irrevocable, unconditional and non-cancelable (without the right to set off
for any reason and net of any maintenance or cost per copy charges);

         (p) the Contract has a remaining term to maturity of not greater than
60 months, provided, however, that up to 10% (by ADCB) may have a remaining
term to maturity of not greater than 72 months;

         (q) no adverse selection procedure was used in selecting the Contract
for the Asset Pool;

         (r) the Obligor under the Contract is required to maintain casualty
insurance or to self-insure with respect to the related Equipment in
accordance with the Servicer's normal requirements;

         (s) the Contract is not a "consumer lease" as defined In Section
2A-103(l)(e) of the UCC;

         (t) the Contract is not subject to any guarantee by the Servicer nor
has the Seller or the Originator established any specific credit reserve with
respect to the related Obligor;

                                      9
<PAGE>

         (u) the Contract provides that (i) the Originator, the Seller or the
Servicer may accelerate all remaining Scheduled Payments if the Obligor is in
default under any of its obligations under such Contract and (ii) the Obligor
thereof may not elect to utilize its security deposit to offset any remaining
Scheduled Payment;

         (v) the Obligor under the Contract is required to maintain the
Equipment in good working order and bear all costs of operating the Equipment
(including the payment of Taxes);

         (w) no provision of such Contract provides for a Prepayment Amount
less than the amount calculated in accordance with the definition of
Prepayment Amount;

         (x) the Contract has not been terminated as a result of a Casualty
Loss to the related Equipment or for any other reason;

         (y) the Discounted Contract Balance of such Contract, when aggregated
with the Discounted Contract Balance of each other Contract having the same
Obligor, does not exceed the Portfolio Concentration Criteria;

         (z) the Discounted Contract Balance of such Contract does not include
the amount of any security deposit held by the Servicer or the Seller;

         (aa) such Contract provides that in the event of a Casualty Loss, the
Obligor is required to pay an amount not less than the present value of all
remaining Scheduled Payments discounted at the applicable Sale Discount Rate
plus any past due amounts as of the date of determination;

         (bb) the Obligor thereunder has represented to the Originator that
such Obligor has accepted the related Equipment and has had a reasonable
opportunity to inspect and test such Equipment and the Originator has not been
notified of any defects therein; and

         (cc) all payments in respect of a Contract will be made free and
clear of, and without deduction or withholding for or on account of, any
Taxes, unless such withholding or deduction is required by law.

Equipment: The tangible assets financed or leased by an Obligor pursuant to a
Contract and/or, unless the context otherwise requires, a security interest in
such assets, such tangible assets to consist of small ticket equipment,
including without limitation small manufacturing, automotive repair, printing,
information and document processing and storage, telecommunications and office
equipment.

ERISA: The U.S. Employee Retirement Income Security Act of 1974, as amended
from time to time, and the regulations promulgated and rulings issued
thereunder.



                                      10
<PAGE>

ERISA Affiliate: (a) Any corporation which is a member of the same controlled
group of corporations (within the meaning of Section 414(b) of the Code) as
the Seller; (b) A trade or business (whether or not incorporated) under common
control (within the meaning of Section 414(c) of the Code) with the Seller or
(c) A member of the same affiliated service group (within the meaning of
Section 414(m) of the Code) as the Seller, any corporation described in clause
(a) above or any trade or business described in clause (b) above.

Eurocurrency Liabilities: As defined in Regulation D of the Board of Governors
of the Federal Reserve System, as in effect from time to time.

Eurodollar Disruption Event: The occurrence of any of the following: (a) a
determination by a Purchaser that it would be contrary to law or to the
directive of any central bank or other governmental authority (whether or not
having the force of law) to obtain United States dollars in the London
interbank market to make, fund or maintain any Purchase, (b) the failure of
one or more of the Reference Banks to furnish timely information for purposes
of determining the Adjusted Eurodollar Rate, (c) a determination by a
Purchaser that the rate at which deposits of United States dollars are being
offered to such Purchaser in the London interbank market does not accurately
reflect the cost to such Purchaser of making, funding or maintaining any
Purchase or (d) the inability of a Purchaser to obtain United States dollars
in the London interbank market to make, fund or maintain any Purchase.

Eurodollar Reserve Percentage: Of any Reference Bank for any period, for any
Capital means the percentage applicable during such period (or, if more than
one such percentage shall be so applicable, the daily average of such
percentages for those days in such period during which any such percentage
shall be so applicable) under regulations issued from time to time by the
Board of Governors of the Federal Reserve System (or any successor) for
determining the maximum reserve requirement (including, without limitation,
any emergency, supplemental or other marginal reserve requirement) for such
Reference Bank with respect to liabilities or assets consisting of or
including Eurocurrency Liabilities having a term of one, two or three months,
as applicable based upon the related LIBOR Rate.

Excess Funds: On any Payment Date, any amount payable to the Seller pursuant
to Sections 2.7(a)(x), 2.8(b)(x) or 2.9(b)(x), as the case may be.

Excluded Amounts: (a) Any collections on deposit in the Collection Account or
otherwise received by the Servicer on or with respect to the Asset Pool or
related Equipment, which collections are attributable to any Taxes, fees or
other charges imposed by any Governmental Authority, (b) any collections
representing reimbursements of insurance premiums or payments for services
that were not financed by the Originator, (c) any collections with respect to
Contracts retransferred or substituted for with respect to a Warranty Event,
or otherwise replaced by a Substitute Contract and (d) any late fees,
insufficient funds charges, inspection charges, collection fees, delinquency
fees, repossession fees or UCC fees, extension fees, documentation fees,
maintenance fees and insurance fees.



                                      11
<PAGE>

Existing Contracts: The Contracts purchased by the Seller under the Purchase
Agreement and owned by the Seller on the Closing Date.

Facility Financing Statement:  As defined in Schedule I.

Fee Letter: The letter, dated as of the Closing Date, among the Seller, the
Servicer, and the Deal Agent setting forth, among other things, the Servicer
Fee.

Federal Funds Rate: For any period, a fluctuating interest rate per annum
equal for each day during such period to the weighted average of the federal
funds rates as quoted by First Union and confirmed in Federal Reserve Board
Statistical Release H.15(519) or any successor or substitute publication
selected by First Union (or, if such day is not a Business Day, for the next
preceding Business Day), or, if, for any reason, such rate is not available on
any day, the rate determined, in the sole opinion of First Union, to be the
rate at which federal funds are being offered for sale in the national federal
funds market at 9:00 A.M. Charlotte, North Carolina time.

First Union: First Union National Bank, in its individual capacity, and its
successors or assigns.

Fixed Period: For any Payment Date the period beginning on, and including the
13th day of the immediately preceding calendar month (or, with respect to the
first Fixed Period, the Closing Date) and ending on, but excluding the 13th
day of the current calendar month.

GAAP: Generally accepted accounting principles as in effect from time to time
the United States.

Governmental Authority: With respect to any Person, any nation or government,
any state or other political subdivision thereof, any entity exercising
executive, legislative, judicial, regulatory or administrative functions of or
pertaining to government and any court or arbitrator having jurisdiction over
such Person.

H.15: As defined in Section 5.4.

Hedge Counterparty: An entity (i) (A) whose commercial paper or short-term
deposit rating is at least P-1 from Moody's and at least A-1 from S & P and
(B) who shall agree that, in the event that its commercial paper or short-term
deposit rating is reduced below A-1 by S&P or P-1 by Moody's, it shall secure
its obligations in a manner as the Deal Agent may reasonably request or assign
its obligations to a Person meeting the requirements of clauses (i)(A) and
(ii) hereof, and (ii) which shall be rated at least A and A2 by S&P and
Moody's, respectively and (iii) which has entered into a Hedging Agreement.

Hedged Amount: As defined in Section 5.4.



                                      12
<PAGE>

Hedged Costs: With respect to any Payment Date, the amount of hedging costs,
including, without limitation, payments to the Hedge Counterparty, as payable
out of funds in the Collection Account on such Payment Date as provided by
Section 2.7.

Hedged Level: As defined in Section 5.4.

Hedging Agreement: With respect to this Agreement, each hedging agreement
entered into by the Seller and a Hedge Counterparty.

Increased Costs: Any amounts required to be paid by the Seller to an Affected
Party pursuant to Section 2.12.

Incremental Purchase: Any Purchase that increases the aggregate outstanding
Capital hereunder.

Indebtedness: With respect to any Person at any date, (a) all indebtedness of
such Person for borrowed money or for the deferred purchase price of property
or services (other than current liabilities incurred in the ordinary course of
business and payable in accordance with customary trade practices) or which is
evidenced by a note, bond, debenture or similar instrument, (b) all
obligations of such Person under capital leases, (c) all obligations of such
Person in respect of acceptances issued or created for the account of such
Person and (d) all liabilities secured by any Lien on any property owned by
such Person even though such Person has not assumed or otherwise become liable
for the payment thereof.

Indemnified Amounts: As defined in Section 8. 1

Indemnified Persons: As defined in Section 6.19.

Ineligible Contract: As defined in Section 5.5.

Insolvency Event: With respect to a specified Person, (a) the filing of a
decree or order for relief by a court having jurisdiction in the premises in
respect of such Person or any substantial part of its property in an
involuntary case under any applicable Insolvency Law now or hereafter in
effect, or appointing a receiver, liquidator, assignee, custodian, trustee,
sequestrator or similar official for such Person or for any substantial part
of its property, or ordering the winding-up or liquidation of such Person's
affairs, and such decree or order shall remain unstayed and in effect for a
period of 60 consecutive days; or (b) the commencement by such Person of a
voluntary case under any applicable Insolvency Law now or hereafter in effect,
or the consent by such Person to the entry of an order for relief in an
involuntary case under any such law, or the consent by such Person to the
appointment of or taking possession by a receiver, liquidator, assignee,
custodian, trustee, sequestrator or similar official for such Person or for
any substantial part of its property, or the making by such Person of any
general assignment for the benefit of creditors, or the failure by such Person
generally to pay its debts as such debts become due, or the taking of action
by such Person in furtherance of any of the foregoing.



                                      13
<PAGE>

Insolvency Laws: The Bankruptcy Code of the United States of America and all
other applicable liquidation, conservatorship, bankruptcy, moratorium,
rearrangement, receivership, insolvency, reorganization, suspension of
payments, or similar debtor relief laws from time to time in effect affecting
the rights of creditors generally.

Instrument: Any "instrument" (as defined in Article 9 of the UCC), other than
an instrument which constitutes part of chattel paper.

Insurance Policy: With respect to any Contract, an insurance policy covering
physical damage to or loss of the related Equipment.

Insurance Proceeds: Depending on the context, any amounts payable or any
payments made, to the Servicer under any Insurance Policy.

Investment: With respect to any Person, any direct or indirect loan, advance
or investment by such Person in any other Person, whether by means of share
purchase, capital contribution, loan or otherwise, excluding the acquisition
of Assets pursuant to the Purchase Agreement and excluding commission, travel
and similar advances to officers, employees and directors made in the ordinary
course of business.

Issuer: VFCC and any other Purchaser whose principal business consists of
issuing commercial paper or other securities to fund its acquisition and
maintenance of receivables, accounts, instruments, chattel paper, general
intangibles and other similar assets.

LIBOR Rate: For any period of one, two or three months chosen by the Deal
Agent (the "LIBOR Period"), an interest rate per annum equal the rate
appearing on the Telerate Page 3750 as of 11:00 a.m. (London time) on the
Business Day which is the second Business Day immediately preceding the first
day of such LIBOR Period for a term equal to such LIBOR Period or, if no such
rate appears on such day, the average (rounded upward to the nearest
one-sixteenth (1/16) of one percent) per annum rate of interest determined by
First Union at its principal office in Charlotte, North Carolina (each such
determination, absent manifest error, to be conclusive and binding) as of two
Business Days prior to the first day of the applicable LIBOR Period, to be the
rate at which deposits in immediately available funds in U.S. dollars are
being, have been, or would be offered or quoted by First Union to major banks
in the interbank market for Eurodollar deposits at or about 11:00 A.M.
(Charlotte, North Carolina time) on such day, for a term comparable to such
LIBOR Period and in an amount approximately equal to the Capital allocated to
such LIBOR Period by the Deal Agent.

Lien: With respect to any Asset, (a) any mortgage, lien, pledge, charge
security interest or encumbrance of any kind in respect of such Asset or (b)
the interest of a vendor or lessor under any conditional sale agreement,
financing lease or other title retention agreement relating to such Asset.



                                      14
<PAGE>

Liquidation Expenses: With respect to any Contract, the aggregate amount of
all out-of-pocket expenses reasonably incurred by the Servicer (including
amounts paid to any subservicer) and any reasonably allocated costs of
internal counsel, in each case in accordance with the Servicer's customary
procedures in connection with the repossession, refurbishing and disposition
of any related Equipment upon or after the expiration or earlier termination
of such Contract and other out-of-pocket costs related to the liquidation of
any such Equipment, including the attempted collection of any amount owing
pursuant to such Contract if it is a Defaulted Contract.

Liquidity Bank: Each liquidity bank that is a party to the Liquidity Purchase
Agreement dated as of December 18, 1997, among the Purchaser, First Union, as
liquidity agent, and each other liquidity bank a party thereto.

Lock-Box: A post office box to which Collections are remitted for retrieval by
a Lock-Box Bank and deposited by such Lock-Box Bank into a Lock-Box Account.

Lock-Box Account: An account maintained for the purpose of receiving
Collections at a bank or other financial institution which has executed a
Lock-Box Notice for the purpose of receiving Collections.

Lock-Box Bank: Any of the banks or other financial institutions holding one or
more Lock-Box Accounts.

Lock-Box Notice: A notice, in substantially the form of Exhibit B, among the
Seller, the Originator (if applicable) and a Lock-Box Bank.

Monthly Period: As to any Determination Date, the calendar month ended on such
Determination Date.

Monthly Report:  As defined in Section 6.13(a).

Moody's:  Moody's Investors Service, Inc., and any successor thereto.

Multiemployer Plan: A "multiemployer plan" as defined in Section 4001(a)(3) of
ERISA which is or was at any time during the current year or the immediately
preceding five years contributed to by the Seller or any ERISA Affiliate on
behalf of its employees.

Net Loss to Liquidation Ratio: At any time, the product of the Default Ratio
and the weighted average life (in years, rounded upwards to the nearest tenth
of a year) of the Asset Pool.

Notice of Sale: A notice, substantially in the form of Exhibit A hereto,
delivered pursuant to Section 2.2.

Obligor: A Person obligated to make payments pursuant to a Contract including
any guarantor thereof.



                                      15
<PAGE>

Officer's Certificate: A certificate signed by any officer of the Seller or
the Servicer and delivered to the Collateral Custodian, as the case may be.

Opinion of Counsel: A written opinion of counsel, who may be counsel for
Seller or the Servicer and who shall be reasonably acceptable to the Deal
Agent.

Original Contract: Each Contract identified by account number and Outstanding
Balance as of the related Cut Off Date in the Contract List.

Originator:  Fidelity Leasing, Inc. or any wholly owned subsidiary thereof.

Originator Assets: Any Asset that was transferred to the Seller by the
Originator.

Outstanding Balance: Of any Asset at any time, the then outstanding principal
balance thereof.

Overcollateralization: On any day, the difference between the (i) the ADCB on
such day and (ii) the aggregate Capital on such day.

Payment Date: The 20th day of each calendar month or, if such day is not a
Business Day, the next succeeding Business Day.

Payout Event:  As defined in Section 7. 1.

Permitted Investments:  Any one or more of the following types of investments:

         (a) marketable obligations of the United States of America, the full
and timely payment of which are backed by the full faith and credit of the
United States of America and which have a maturity of not more than 270 days
from the date of acquisition;

         (b marketable obligations, the full and timely payment of which are
directly and fully guaranteed by the full faith and credit of the United
States of America and which have a maturity of not more than 270 days from the
date of acquisition;

         (c) bankers' acceptances and certificates of deposit and other
interest-bearing obligations (in each case having a maturity of not more than
270 days from the date of acquisition) denominated in dollars and issued by
any bank with capital, surplus and undivided profits aggregating at least
$100,000,000, the short-term obligations of which are rated A-1 by S&P and P-1
by Moody's;

         (d) repurchase obligations with a term of not more than ten days for
underlying securities of the types described in clauses (a), (b) and (c) above
entered into with any bank of the type described in clause (c) above;



                                      16
<PAGE>

         (e) commercial paper rated at least A-1 by S&P and P-1 by Moody's;
and,

         (f) demand deposits, time deposits or certificates of deposit (having
original maturities of no more than 365 days) of depository institutions or
trust companies incorporated under the laws of the United States of America or
any state thereof (or domestic branches of any foreign bank) and subject to
supervision and examination by federal or state banking or depository
institution authorities; provided, however that at the time such investment,
or the commitment to make such investment, is entered into, the short-term
debt rating of such depository institution or trust company shall be at least
A-1 by S&P and P-1 by Moody's.

Permitted Liens: (a) shall mean, with respect to Contracts in the Asset Pool:

                  (i) Liens for state, municipal or other local taxes if such
         taxes shall not at the time be due and payable, (ii) Liens in favor
         of the Seller created pursuant to a Purchase Agreement and
         transferred to the Asset Pool hereunder and (iii) Liens in favor of
         the Deal Agent as agent for the Purchasers created pursuant to this
         Agreement; and

         (b) with respect to the related Equipment:

                  (i) materialmen's, warehousemen's and mechanics' liens and
         other Liens arising by operation of law in the ordinary course of
         business for sums not due, (ii) Liens for state, municipal or other
         local taxes if such taxes shall not at the time be due and payable,
         (iii) Liens in favor of the Seller created pursuant to a Purchase
         Agreement and transferred to the Asset Pool hereunder and (iv) Liens
         in favor of the Deal Agent as agent for the Purchasers created
         pursuant to this Agreement.

Person: An individual, partnership, corporation (including a business trust),
limited liability company, joint stock company, trust, unincorporated
association, sole proprietorship, joint venture, government (or any agency or
political subdivision thereof) or other entity.

Pool Assets: On any day any Asset in the Asset Pool.

Portfolio Concentration Criteria: The following concentration limitations at
all times measured on the basis of percentage of ADCB:

         (a) the sum of the Discounted Contract Balances of Contracts relating
to any one individual Obligor is limited to the greater of 1.5% of the ADCB,

         (b the sum of the Discounted Contract Balance of the 25 obligors with
the largest aggregate Discounted Contract Balances is limited to 15% of the
ADCB;

         (c) the sum of the Discounted Contract Balances of Obligors located
in any one state is limited to 10% of the ADCB;



                                      17
<PAGE>

         (d) the sum of the Discounted Contract Balances of Contracts whose
Obligors are municipalities or other government related organizations is
limited to 1% of the ADCB; and

         (e) the sum of the Discounted Contract Balances of which the payment
terms are non-monthly is limited to 10% of the ADCB.

Prepaid Contract: Any Contract that has terminated or been prepaid in full
prior to its scheduled expiration date (including because of a Casualty Loss),
other than a Defaulted Contract.

Prepayment Amount: As specified in Section 6.2(b).

Prepayments: Any and all (i) partial and full prepayments on a Contract
(including, with respect to any Contract and any Monthly Period, any Scheduled
Payment or portion thereof which is due in a subsequent Monthly Period which
the Servicer has received, and expressly permitted the related Obligor to
make, in advance of its scheduled due date, and which will be applied to such
Scheduled Payment on such due date), (ii) cash proceeds or rents realized from
the sale, lease, re-lease or re-financing of Equipment under a Prepaid
Contract, net of Liquidation Expenses, and (iii) Recoveries.

Prime Rate: The rate announced by First Union from time to time as its prime
rate in the United States, such rate to change as and when such designated
rate changes. The Prime Rate is not intended to be the lowest rate of interest
charged by First Union in connection with extensions of credit to debtors.

Program Fee:  As defined in Section 2.13(b).

Program Fee Agreement: The letter agreement, the Closing Date, among the
Seller, the Servicer and the Deal Agent, setting forth, among other things,
the Commitment Fee, the Program Fee and the Servicing Fee.

Program Fee Rate:  The rate per annum set forth in the Program Fee Agreement.

Purchase: A purchase by a Purchaser of an undivided interest in the Assets
from the Seller pursuant to Article II, including without limitation, the
remittance by the Servicer to the Seller of Collections of Pool Assets
pursuant to Section 2.7(b).

Purchase Agreement: The Purchase and Sale Agreement dated as of the date
hereof, between the Originator and the Seller, as amended, modified,
supplemented or restated from time to time.

Purchase Certificate: Each certificate, in the Form of Exhibit G, delivered on
the date of the Initial Purchase and on the date of each Incremental Purchase.

Purchase Date: The Closing Date, and as to any Incremental Purchase, any
Business Day that is (i) at least one (1) calendar week following the
immediately preceding Purchase Date and (ii) two (2) Business Days immediately


                                      18
<PAGE>

following the receipt by the Deal Agent of a written request by the Seller to
sell an Asset Interest, such notice to be in the form of Exhibit A hereto and
to conform to requirements of Section 3.2 hereof.

Purchase Limit: At any time, $50,000,000, on or after the Termination Date,
the "Purchase Limit" shall mean the aggregate outstanding Capital.

Purchasers: Collectively, VFCC and the Investors and any other Person that
agrees, pursuant to the pertinent Assignment and Acceptance, to purchase an
Asset Interest pursuant to this Agreement.

Qualified Institution:  As defined in Section 6.2.

Rating Agency: Each of Standard & Poor's, Moody's and any other rating agency
that has been requested to issue a rating with respect to the commercial paper
notes issued by the Issuer.

Records: All Contracts and other documents, books, records and other
information (including without limitation, computer programs, tapes, disks,
punch cards, data processing software and related property and rights)
maintained with respect to Assets and the related Obligors which the Seller
has itself generated, in which the Seller has acquired an interest pursuant to
the Purchase Agreement or in which the Seller has otherwise obtained all
interest.

Recoveries: With respect to a Defaulted Contract, proceeds from the sale,
lease, re-lease or refinancing of the Equipment, proceeds of any related
Insurance Policy and any other recoveries with respect to such Defaulted
Contract and the related Equipment and related property, and other amounts
representing late fees and penalties net of Liquidation Expenses and amounts,
if any, so received that are required to be refunded to the Obligor on such
Contract.

Reference Bank: Any bank which furnishes information for purposes of
determining the Adjusted Eurodollar Rate.

Register:  As defined in Section 10. 1(c).

Reinvestment Termination Date: The Business Day that the Seller designates as
the Reinvestment Termination Date by notice to the Deal Agent at least ten
Business Days prior to such Business Day or, if any of the conditions
precedent in Section 3.2 are not satisfied, the Business Day that the Deal
Agent designates as the Reinvestment Termination Date by notice to the Seller
at least one Business Day prior to such Business Day.

Replaced Contract: As defined in Section 2.17(a).

Reporting Date: The 16th day of the month or the first Business Day
thereafter.



                                      19
<PAGE>

Required Investors: At a particular time, Investors with Commitments in excess
of 66 2/3 % of the Purchase Limit.

Required Reports: Collectively, the Monthly Report, the Servicer's Certificate
and the quarterly financial statement of the Servicer required to be delivered
to the Deal Agent pursuant to Section 6.13(c) hereof.

Requirements of Law: For any Person shall mean the certificate of
incorporation or articles of association and by-laws or other organizational
or governing documents of such Person, and any law, treaty, rule or
regulation, or order or determination of an arbitrator or Governmental
Authority, in each case applicable to or binding upon such Person or to which
such Person is subject, whether Federal, state or local (including, without
limitation, usury laws, the Federal Truth in Lending Act, and Regulation Z and
Regulation B of the Board of Governors of the Federal Reserve System).

Residual Proceeds: With respect to any Contract or any item of Equipment, the
net proceeds for the sale, re-lease or other disposition of the equipment upon
the expiration, or early termination, of the term of such Contract.

Responsible Officer: As to any Person (other than the Collateral Custodian and
Backup Servicer), any officer of such Person with direct responsibility for
the administration of this Agreement and also, with respect to a particular
matter, any other officer to whom such matter is referred because of such
officer's knowledge of and familiarity with the particular subject, and with
respect to the Collateral Custodian and Backup Servicer it shall mean any
officer within the office at the address set forth under its name on the
signature pages hereof including any Vice President, Managing Director,
Assistant Vice President, Secretary, Assistant Secretary or Assistant
Treasurer or any other officer of the Collateral Custodian and Backup Servicer
customarily performing functions similar to those performed by any of the
above designated officers and, with respect to a particular matter, any other
officer to whom such matter is referred because of such officer's knowledge
and familiarity with the particular subject.

Restricting Event: As defined in Section 7.2.

Retransfer Date: As defined in Section 5.6.

S&P: Standard & Poor's Ratings Services, a division of The McGraw-Hill
Companies, Inc. and any successor thereto.

Sale Discount Rate: For any Contract to be transferred to the Asset Pool by
the Seller, a rate per annum, calculated on the Business Day immediately
preceding such transfer, equal to the sum of (i) the fixed interest rate
associated with the Hedge Agreement related to such purchase, (ii) the Program
Fee Rate, (iii) .05% and (iv) the Servicing Fee Rate.



                                      20
<PAGE>

Scheduled Payments: On any Determination Date with respect to any Contract,
(a) each monthly, quarterly, annual or seasonal rent or financing (whether
principal or principal and interest) payment scheduled to be made by the
Obligor thereof after such Determination Date under the terms of such
Contract, reduced by a number of such scheduled payments equal to a number
(rounding upwards to the next highest integer if such number is not an
integer) obtained by dividing (i) the dollar amount of any security deposit
related to such Contract by (ii) the amount of a single scheduled payment
under such Contract, (b) any payment due from the Obligor of such Contract at
the expiration or other termination of such Contract and (c) any payments in
connection with a Warranty Event.

Seller: SW Leasing Portfolio IV, Inc., or any permitted successor thereto.

Seller Note: As defined in the Purchase Agreement.

Servicer: Fidelity Leasing, Inc. and its permitted successors and assigns.

Servicer Advance: An advance of Scheduled Payments made by the Servicer
pursuant to Section 6.3.

Servicer Default: As specified in Section 6.24.

Servicer's Certificate: As defined in Section 6.13(b).

Servicing Fee: As specified in Section 2.13(c).

Servicing Fee Rate: The rate per annum set forth in the Fee Letter.

Solvent: As to any Person at any time, having a state of affairs such that all
of the following conditions are met: (a) the fair value of the property of
such Person is greater than the amount of such Person's liabilities (including
disputed, contingent and unliquidated liabilities) as such value is
established and liabilities evaluated for purposes of Section 101(31) of the
Bankruptcy Code; (b) the present fair salable value of the property of such
Person in an orderly liquidation of such Person is not less than the amount
that will be required to pay the probable liability of such Person on its
debts as they become absolute and matured; (c) such Person is able to realize
upon its property and pay its debts and other liabilities (including disputed,
contingent and unliquidated liabilities) as they mature in the normal course
of business; (d) such Person does not intend to, and does not believe that it
will, incur debts or liabilities beyond such Person's ability to pay as such
debts and liabilities mature; and (e) such Person is not engaged in business
or a transaction, and is not about to engage in a business or a transaction,
for which such Person's property would constitute unreasonably small capital.

Structuring Fee: The structuring fee agreed to between the Seller and the Deal
Agent in the Program Fee Agreement.



                                      21
<PAGE>

Substitute Contract: On any day, an Eligible Contract which meets each of the
conditions for substitution set forth in Schedule IV hereto.

Successor Servicer:  As defined in Section 6.25(a).

Swap Rate:  As defined in Section 5.4.

Taxes: Any present or future taxes, levies, imposts, duties, charges,
assessments or fees of any nature (including interest, penalties, and
additions thereto) that are imposed by any government or other taxing
authority.

Termination Date: The earliest of (a) the date of termination of the Purchase
Limit pursuant to Section 2.3, (b) the date of the occurrence of a Payout
Event pursuant to Section 7. 1, (c) the Reinvestment Termination Date and (d)
Commitment Termination Date.

Termination Notice:  As defined in Section 6.24.

Transaction:  As defined in Section 3.2.

Transaction Documents: This Agreement, the Purchase Agreement, the Liquidity
Purchase Agreement, dated as of the date hereof between VFCC and First Union,
and the Custodial Agreement, dated as of the date hereof between the Seller,
the Servicer, the Deal Agent and the Collateral Custodian, and any additional
document the execution of which is necessary or incidental to carrying out the
terms of the foregoing documents.

UCC: The Uniform Commercial Code as from time to time in effect in the
specified jurisdiction.

United States:  The United States of America.

Unreimbursed Servicer Advances: At any time, the amount of all previous
Servicer Advances (or portions thereof) as to which the Servicer has not been
reimbursed as of such time pursuant to Section 2.7 and which the Servicer has
determined in its sole discretion will not be recoverable from Collections
with respect to the related Contract.

Warranty Event: As to any Pool Asset, the occurrence and continuance of a
material breach of any representation or warranty relating to such Contract.

Yield:  For each Asset Interest for any Fixed Period, the product of:

                            YR x C x ED
                                     ---
                                     360

where:



                                      22
<PAGE>

         C = the Capital of such Asset Interest.

         YR = the weighted average of the Yield Rates applicable during such
Fixed Period.

         ED = the actual number of days elapsed during such Fixed Period.

provided, however that (i) no provision of this Agreement shall require the
payment or permit the collection of Yield in excess of the maximum permitted
by applicable law and (ii) Yield shall not be considered paid by any
distribution if at any time such distribution is rescinded or must otherwise
be returned for any reason.

         Yield Rate:  For any Asset Interest for any Fixed Period:

         (a) to the extent the relevant Purchaser funded the applicable Asset
Interest through the issuance of commercial paper, a rate equal to the CP
Rate, or

         (b) to the extent the relevant Purchaser did not fund the applicable
Asset Interest through the issuance of commercial paper, a rate equal to the
Alternative Rate or such other rate as the Deal Agent and the Seller shall
agree to in writing.

                  Section 1.2       Other Terms.

         All accounting terms not specifically defined herein shall be
construed in accordance with GAAP. All terms used in Article 9 of the UCC in
the State of New York, and not specifically defined herein, are used herein as
defined in such Article 9.

                  Section 1.3       Computation of Time Periods.

         Unless otherwise stated in this Agreement, in the computation of a
period of time from a specified date to a later specified date, the word
"from" means "from and including" and the words "to" and "until" each mean "to
but excluding."


                                  ARTICLE II

                             THE PURCHASE FACILITY

                  Section 2.1       Purchases of Asset Interests.

         (a) On the terms and conditions hereinafter set forth, the Seller may
on any Purchase Date, at its option, sell and assign Asset Interests to the
Purchasers. The Deal Agent may act on behalf of and for the benefit of the


                                      23
<PAGE>

Purchasers in this regard. VFCC may, in its sole discretion, purchase, or if
VFCC shall decline to purchase, the Liquidity Agent shall purchase on behalf
of the Investors, Asset Interests from time to time during the period from the
date hereof to but not including the Termination Date. Under no circumstances
shall any Purchaser make the initial Purchase or any Incremental Purchase if,
after giving effect to such Purchase or Incremental Purchase, the aggregate
Capital outstanding hereunder would exceed the lesser of (i) the Purchase
Limit or (ii) the Capital Limit.

         (b) The Seller may, within 60 days, but no later than 45 days, prior
to the then existing Commitment Termination Date, by written notice to the
Deal Agent, make written request for VFCC and the Investors to extend the
Commitment Termination Date for an additional period of 364 days. The Deal
Agent will give prompt notice to VFCC and each of the Investors of its receipt
of such request for extension of the Commitment Termination Date. VFCC and
each Investor shall make a determination, in their sole discretion and after a
full credit review, not less than 15 days prior to the then applicable
Commitment Termination Date as to whether or not it will agree to extend the
Commitment Termination Date; provided, however, that the failure of VFCC or
any Investor to make a timely response to the Seller's request for extension
of the Commitment Termination Date shall be deemed to constitute a refusal by
VFCC or the Investor, as the case may be, to extend the Commitment Termination
Date. The Commitment Termination Date shall only be extended upon the consent
of both (i) VFCC and (ii) 100% of the Investors.

         Section 2.2       The Initial Purchase, Subsequent Purchases and 
                           Incremental Purchases.

         (a) Subject to the conditions described in Section 2.1, the initial
Purchase and each Incremental Purchase shall be made in accordance with the
procedures described in Section 2.2(b). After the Collection Date has
occurred, each of the Purchasers and the Deal Agent, in accordance with their
respective interests, shall assign and transfer to the Seller their respective
remaining interest in Asset Interests to the Seller free and clear of any
Adverse Claim resulting solely from an act or omission by a Purchaser or the
Deal Agent, but without any other representation or warranty, express or
implied.

         (b) The initial Purchase and each Incremental Purchase shall be made
pursuant to the terms of a Purchase Certificate in the form of Exhibit G
hereto, after receipt by the Purchaser of a Notice of Sale delivered by the
Seller to the Deal Agent (with a copy to the Collateral Custodian) at least
two Business Days prior to such proposed Purchase Date and each such notice
shall specify (i) the aggregate amount of such initial Purchase or Incremental
Purchase which amount must satisfy the applicable minimum requirement set
forth in the following sentence and (ii) the date of such Purchase or
Incremental Purchase. The Seller shall deliver no more than two such notices
in any calendar month, and each amount specified in any such notice must
satisfy the following minimum requirements, as applicable, as a condition to
the related Purchase: (i) the initial Purchase shall be in an amount equal to
$10,000,000 or an integral multiple of $10,000 in excess thereof; (ii) each
Incremental Purchase hereunder shall be in an amount equal to $5,000,000 or an
integral multiple of $10,000 in excess thereof; provided, however, that if
such Incremental Purchase is to be made hereunder at a time when there are no


                                      24
<PAGE>

outstanding Commercial Paper Notes issued in respect of a Purchase of
$5,000,000 or an integral multiple of $10,000 in excess thereof, then such
Incremental Purchase shall be in an amount equal to $10,000,000 or an integral
multiple of $10,000 in excess thereof. Following receipt of such notice, the
Deal Agent will consult with VFCC in order to assist VFCC in determining
whether or not to make the purchase. If VFCC declines to make a proposed
purchase, the initial Purchase or Incremental Purchase will be made by the
Investors. On the date of such Purchase or Incremental Purchase, as the case
may be, VFCC or each Investor shall, upon satisfaction of the applicable
conditions set forth in Article III, make available to the Seller in same day
funds, at such bank or other location reasonably designated by Seller in its
Notice of Sale given pursuant to this Section 2.2(b), an amount equal to (i)
the Capital of the Asset Interest related to such initial Purchase or
Incremental Purchase, as the case may be, in the case of a purchase by VFCC or
(ii) such Investor's pro rata share of the Capital related to such Asset
Interest, in the case of a purchase by the Investors.

                  Section 2.3       Reduction of the Purchase Limit; Repurchase.

         (a) The Seller may, upon at least five Business Days' notice to the
Deal Agent, terminate in whole or reduce in part the portion of the Purchase
Limit that exceeds the sum of the aggregate Capital and Yield accrued and to
accrue thereon, and the Commitments of the Investors shall be reduced
proportionately; provided, however, that each partial reduction of the
Purchase Limit shall be in an aggregate amount equal to $1,000,000 or an
integral multiple thereof. Each notice of reduction or termination pursuant to
this Section 2.3(a) shall be irrevocable.

         (b) Pursuant to the provisions of Section 2.7(b), Section 2.8(c) and
Section 2.9(c), the Seller may, at any time prior to the occurrence of the
Termination Date, reduce the aggregate outstanding Capital by remitting to the
Deal Agent, for application by the Deal Agent to reduce the Capital of each
(i) cash and (ii) instructions to apply such cash to the reduction of Capital.

                  Section 2.4       Determination of Yield.

         The Deal Agent shall determine the Yield (including unpaid Yield, if
any, due and payable on a prior Payment Date) to be paid on each Payment Date
for the Fixed Period and shall advise the Servicer thereof on the first
Business Day after the Fixed Period.

                  Section 2.5       [reserved].

                  Section 2.6       Dividing or Combining Asset Interests.

         The Deal Agent may, with the consent of a Purchaser, take any of the
following actions at the end of such Fixed Period with respect to any Asset
Interest: (i) divide the Asset Interest owned by a Purchaser into two or more
portions of Asset Interests having aggregate Capital equal to the Capital of
such divided Asset Interest, (ii) combine one portion of an Asset Interest of
a Purchaser with another portion of an Asset Interest of such Purchaser with a


                                      25
<PAGE>

Fixed Period ending on the same day, creating a new portion of an Asset
Interest having Capital equal to the Capital of the two portions of Asset
Interest combined or (iii) combine the Asset Interest of a Purchaser with the
Asset Interest to be purchased on such day by such Purchaser, creating a new
Asset Interest having Capital equal to the Capital of the two Asset Interests
combined; provided, that an Asset Interest of VFCC may not be combined with an
Asset Interest of the Investors.

                  Section 2.7       Non-Liquidation Settlement Procedures.

         The provisions of this Section 2.7 shall apply during the term of
this Agreement prior to the occurrence of the Payout Event.

         (a) On each Payment Date, the Servicer shall pay to the following
Persons, from (i) the Collection Account, to the extent of available funds,
and (ii) a Servicer Advance if made or required pursuant to Section 6.3, the
following amounts in the following order of priority:

                  (i) FIRST, to any Hedging Counterparty, an amount equal to
         any accrued and unpaid amounts under any Hedge Agreement, for the
         payment thereof;

                  (ii) SECOND, to the Servicer, in an amount equal to any
         Unreimbursed Servicer Advances, for the payment thereof;

                  (iii) THIRD, to the Servicer, in an amount equal to any
         accrued and unpaid Servicing Fee arrearage, for the payment thereof;

                  (iv) FOURTH, to the Servicer, in amount equal to any accrued
         and unpaid Servicing Fee, for the payment thereof;

                  (v) FIFTH, to the extent not paid for by Fidelity, to the
         Backup Servicer, in an amount equal to any accrued and unpaid Backup
         Servicing Fee, for the payment thereof;

                  (vi) SIXTH, to the extent not paid for by Fidelity, to the
         Collateral Custodian, in an amount equal to any accrued and unpaid
         Custodial Fee, for the payment thereof;

                  (vii) SEVENTH, to the Deal Agent for the ratable payment to
         each Purchaser, in an amount equal to any accrued and unpaid Program
         Fee and Yield for such Payment Date;

                  (viii) EIGHTH, to the Deal Agent, in the amount of unpaid
         Increased Costs and/or Taxes, for payment to the Purchasers in
         respect thereof;

                  (ix) NINTH, to the extent that funds are available, any
         remaining amounts may be reinvested in Eligible Contracts; provided,
         however, that if the aggregate Capital exceeds the lesser of (i) the
         Capital Limit; or (ii) the Purchase Limit an amount equal to such
         excess shall be paid to the Deal Agent to pay down Capital
         outstanding;



                                      26
<PAGE>

                  (x) TENTH, to the extent funds are available to satisfy any
         unpaid Indemnified Amounts, amounts required to be paid by the Seller
         pursuant to the indemnification provisions of Section 8.1 and any
         other amounts due hereunder; and

                  (xi) ELEVENTH, any remaining amount shall be distributed to
         the Seller for application to the payment, in the following order of
         priority, of interest accrued and unpaid on, and the reduction to
         zero of the principal amount of, the Seller Note.

         (b) Notwithstanding anything to the contrary contained in this
Section 2.7 or any other provision in this Agreement, if on any Business Day
prior to the Payout Event the aggregate outstanding amount of Capital shall
exceed the lesser of (i) the Purchase Limit or (ii) the Capital Limit, then
the Seller shall remit to the Deal Agent, prior to any reinvestment of funds
as set forth in item NINTH of Section 2.7(a) and in any event no later than
the close of business of the Deal Agent on the next succeeding Business Day, a
payment (to be applied by the Deal Agent to outstanding Capital allocated to
Monthly Periods selected by the Deal Agent, in its reasonable discretion) in
such amount as may be necessary to reduce outstanding Capital to an amount
less than or equal to the lesser of (i) the Purchase Limit or (ii) the Capital
Limit.

                  Section 2.8       Settlement Procedures Following a 
                                    Termination Date.

         The provisions of this Section 2.8 shall apply during the term of
this Agreement after the occurrence of a Payout Event provided that no
Restricting Event has occurred.

         (a)      [reserved].

         (b) On each Payment Date, the Servicer shall pay to the following
Persons, from (i) the Collection Account, to the extent available funds and
(ii) a Servicer Advance if made or required pursuant to Section 6.3, the
following amounts in the following order of priority:

                  (i) FIRST, to any Hedging Counterparty, an amount equal to
         any accrued and unpaid amounts under any Hedging Agreement, for the
         payment thereof;

                  (ii) SECOND, to the Servicer, in an amount equal to any
         Unreimbursed Servicer Advances, for the payment thereof;

                  (iii) THIRD, to the Servicer, in an amount equal to any
         accrued and unpaid Servicing Fee arrearage, for the payment thereof;

                  (iv) FOURTH, to the Servicer, in an amount equal to any
         accrued and unpaid Servicing Fee, for the payment thereof;

                  (v) FIFTH, to the extent not paid for by Fidelity, to the
         Backup Servicer, in an amount equal to any accrued and unpaid Backup
         Servicing Fee, for the payment thereof;



                                      27
<PAGE>

                  (vi) SIXTH, to the extent not paid for by Fidelity, to the
         Collateral Custodian, in an amount equal to any accrued and unpaid
         Custodial Fee, for the payment thereof;

                  (vii) SEVENTH, to the Deal Agent, in an amount equal to any
         accrued and unpaid Program Fee and Yield for such Payment Date;

                  (viii) EIGHTH, to the Deal Agent, in the amount of unpaid
         Increased Costs and/or Taxes, for payment to the Purchasers in
         respect thereof;

                  (ix) NINTH, to the Deal Agent for payment to the Purchasers
         in an amount necessary to reduce the aggregate Capital to an amount
         equal to the product of (i) the Asset Interest and (ii) the ADCB as
         of the current Determination Date;

                  (x) TENTH, to the extent funds are available to satisfy any
         unpaid Indemnified Amounts required to be paid by the Seller pursuant
         to the indemnification provisions of Section 8.1, and any other
         amounts due hereunder; and

                  (xi) ELEVENTH, any remaining amount shall be distributed to
         the Seller for application to the payment, in the following order of
         priority, of interest accrued and unpaid on, and the reduction to
         zero of the principal amount of, the Seller Note, provided, however,
         that if the Overcollateralization is less than or equal to the
         product of (i) 0.05 and (ii) the Purchase Limit as of the day
         immediately preceding the occurrence of a Termination Date, the
         amount which would have been distributed to the Seller will be
         distributed to the Purchaser in reduction, to zero, of the aggregate
         Capital.

         (c) If at any time on or after the occurrence of a Payout Event, the
Deal Agent or the Seller determines that as of the close of business on the
day immediately preceding the Termination Date the outstanding amount of
Capital exceeded the lesser of (i) the Purchase Limit, or (ii) the Capital
Limit, then the Seller shall immediately remit to the Deal Agent, for the
benefit of the Purchaser, a payment (to be applied by the Deal Agent to
outstanding Capital allocated to Monthly Periods selected by the Deal Agent,
in its reasonable discretion) in such amount as may be necessary to reduce the
amount of Capital to the lesser of (i) the Purchase Limit, or (ii) the Capital
Limit as of the close of business on the date immediately preceding the Payout
Event.

                  Section 2.9       Settlement Procedures Following a 
                                    Restricting Event.

         The provisions of this Section 2.9 shall apply during the term of
this Agreement after the occurrence of a Restricting Event.

         (a)      [reserved].



                                      28
<PAGE>

         (b) On each Payment Date, the Servicer shall pay to the following
Persons, from (i) the Collection Account, to the extent of available funds and
(ii) a Servicer Advance if made or required pursuant to Section 6.3, the
following amounts in the following order of priority:

                  (i) FIRST, to any Hedging Counterparty, an amount equal to
         any accrued and unpaid amounts under any Hedge Agreement, for the
         payment thereof;

                  (ii) SECOND, to the Servicer, in an amount equal to any
         Unreimbursed Servicer Advances, for the payment thereof;

                  (iii) THIRD, to the Servicer, in an amount equal to any
         accrued and unpaid Servicing Fee arrearage, for the payment thereof;

                  (iv) FOURTH, to the Servicer, in an amount equal to any
         accrued and unpaid Servicing Fee, for the payment thereof;

                  (v) FIFTH, to the extent not paid for by Fidelity, to the
         Backup Servicer, in an amount equal to any accrued and unpaid Backup
         Servicing Fee, for the payment thereof;

                  (vi) SIXTH, to the extent not paid for by Fidelity, to the
         Collateral Custodian, in an amount equal to any accrued and unpaid
         Custodial Fee, for the payment thereof;

                  (vii) SEVENTH, to the Deal Agent, for the ratable payment to
         each Purchaser in an amount equal to any accrued and unpaid Program
         Fee and Yield for such Payment Date;

                  (viii) EIGHTH, to the Deal Agent, in the amount of unpaid
         Increased Costs and/or Taxes, for payment to the Purchasers in
         respect thereof;

                  (ix) NINTH, to the extent that funds are available, to the
         Deal Agent for the Purchasers in reduction of aggregate Capital;

                  (x) TENTH, to the extent funds are available to satisfy any
         unpaid Indemnified Amounts, amounts required to be paid by the Seller
         pursuant to the indemnification provisions of Section 8.1, and other
         amounts due hereunder; and

                  (xi) ELEVENTH, upon the reduction of the Capital to zero and
         the payment in full of the Aggregate Unpaids, any remaining amount
         shall be distributed to the Seller for application to the payment, in
         the following order of priority, of interest accrued and unpaid on,
         and the reduction to zero of the principal amount of, the Seller
         Note.

         (c) If at any time on or after the Restricting Event, the Deal Agent
or the Seller determines that as of the close of business on the day
immediately preceding Termination Date the outstanding amount of Capital
exceeded the lesser of (i) the Purchase Limit, or (ii) the Capital Limit, then


                                      29
<PAGE>

the Seller shall immediately remit to the Deal Agent, for the benefit of the
Purchaser, a payment (to be applied by the Deal Agent to outstanding Capital
allocated to Monthly Periods selected by the Deal Agent, in its reasonable
discretion) in such amount as may be necessary to reduce the amount of Capital
to the lesser of (i) the Purchase Limit, or (ii) the Capital Limit as of the
close of business on the date immediately preceding the Restricting Event.

                  Section 2.10      Collections and Allocations.

         (a) Collections. The Servicer shall transfer, or cause to be
transferred, all Collections on deposit in the form of available funds in the
Lock Box Account to the Collection Account by the close of business on the
Business Day such Collections are received in the Lock Box Account. The
Servicer shall promptly (but in no event later than two Business Days after
the receipt thereof) deposit all Collections received directly by it in the
Collection Account. The Servicer shall make such deposits or payments on the
date indicated therein by electronic funds transfer through the Automated
Clearing House system, or by wire transfer, in immediately available funds.

         (b) Initial Deposits. On the Closing Date and on each Addition Date
thereafter, the Servicer will deposit (in immediately available funds) into
the Collection Account all Collections received after the applicable Cut Off
Date and through and including the Closing Date or Addition Date, as the case
may be, in respect of Contracts being transferred to the Asset Pool on such
date.

         (c) Excluded Amounts. The Servicer may withdraw from the Collection
Account any Collections constituting Excluded Amounts if the Servicer has,
prior to such withdrawal, delivered to the Deal Agent a report setting forth
the calculation of such Excluded Amounts in a format reasonably satisfactory
to the Deal Agent.

                  Section 2.11      Payments, Computations, Etc.

         (a) Unless otherwise expressly provided herein, all amounts to be
paid or deposited by the Seller or the Servicer hereunder shall be paid or
deposited in accordance with the terms hereof no later than 11:00 A.M.
(Charlotte, North Carolina time) on the day when due in lawful money of the
United States in immediately available funds to the Agent's Account. The
Seller shall, to the extent permitted by law, pay to the Purchaser interest on
all amounts not paid or deposited when due hereunder at 1% per annum above the
Base Rate, payable on demand; provided, however, that such interest rate shall
not at any time exceed the maximum rate permitted by applicable law. Such
interest shall be retained by the Deal Agent except to the extent that such
failure to make a timely payment or deposit has continued beyond the date for
distribution by the Deal Agent of such overdue amount to the Purchasers, in
which case such interest accruing after such date shall be for the account of,
and distributed by the Deal Agent to the Purchasers. All computations of


                                      30
<PAGE>

interest and all computations of Yield and other fees hereunder shall be made
on the basis of a year of 360 days for the actual number of days (including
the first but excluding the last day) elapsed.

         (b) Whenever any payment hereunder shall be stated to be due on a day
other than a Business Day, such payment shall be made on the next succeeding
Business Day, and such extension of time shall in such case be included in the
computation of payment of Yield, interest or any fee payable hereunder, as the
case may be.

         (c) If any Purchase or Incremental Purchase requested by the Seller
and approved by a Purchaser and the Deal Agent pursuant to Section 2.2, is
not, for any reason whatsoever related to a default or nonperformance by the
Seller, made or effectuated, as the case may be, on the date specified
therefor, the Seller shall indemnify the Purchaser against any reasonable
loss, cost or expense incurred by the Purchaser, including, without
limitation, any loss (including loss of anticipated profits, net of
anticipated profits in the reemployment of such funds in the manner determined
by the Purchaser), cost or expense incurred by reason of the liquidation or
reemployment of deposits or other funds acquired by the Purchaser to fund or
maintain such Purchase or Incremental Purchase, as the case may be, during
such Monthly Period.

                  Section 2.12      Optional Repurchase.

         At any time following the Termination Date when the ADCB is less than
ten percent of the ADCB as of the Termination Date, the Servicer may notify
the Deal Agent in writing of its intent to purchase all remaining Assets in
the Asset Pool. On the Payment Date next succeeding any such notice, the
Servicer shall purchase all such Assets for a price equal to the sum of (i)
the Aggregate Unpaids, (ii) all Yield accrued and to accrue, as reasonably
determined by the Deal Agent, and (iii) all accrued and unpaid Commitment
Fees, Program Fees, Backup Servicing Fees, Custodial Fees, Increased Costs,
Taxes, hedging costs, breakage fees and any other amounts payable by the
Seller hereunder or under or with respect to any Hedging Agreement.

                  Section 2.13      Fees.

         (a) Fidelity, in its individual capacity, shall pay to the Deal Agent
from its own funds on each Payment Date, monthly in arrears, a fee (the
"Commitment Fee"), as set forth in the Program Fee Agreement.

         (b) Fidelity, in its individual capacity, shall pay to the Deal Agent
from the Collection Account on each Payment Date, monthly in arrears, a fee
(the "Program Fee") agreed to between Fidelity and the Deal Agent in the fee
letter agreement between such parties dated the date hereof (the "Program Fee
Agreement").

         (c) The Servicer shall be entitled to receive a fee (the "Servicing
Fee"), monthly in arrears in accordance with Section 2.7(a), 2.8(b) or 2.9(b),
as applicable, which fee shall be equal to the product of (i) the Servicing
Fee Rate agreed to between the Servicer and the Deal Agent in the Program Fee
Agreement and (ii) ADCB for the immediately preceding Determination Date.



                                      31
<PAGE>

         (d) The Backup Servicer shall be entitled to receive the Backup
Servicing Fee in accordance with Section 2.7(a), 2.8(b) or 2.9(b) as
applicable.

         (e) The Collateral Custodian shall be entitled to receive the
Custodial Fee in accordance with Section 2.7(a), 2.8(b) or 2.9(b), as
applicable.

         (f) The Seller shall pay to the Deal Agent, on the Closing Date, the
Structuring Fee in immediately available funds.

                  Section 2.14      Increased Costs; Capital Adequacy;
                                    Illegality.

         (a) If either (i) the introduction of or any change (including,
without limitation, any change by way of imposition or increase of reserve
requirements) in or in the interpretation of any law or regulation or (ii) the
compliance by a Purchaser or any Affiliate thereof (each of which, an
"Affected Party") with any guideline or request from any central bank or other
governmental agency or authority (whether or not having the force of law), (A)
shall subject an Affected Party to any Tax (except for Taxes on the overall
net income of such Affected Party), duty or other charge with respect to an
Asset Interest, or any right to make Purchases hereunder, or on any payment
made hereunder or (B) shall impose, modify or deem applicable any reserve
requirement (including, without limitation, any reserve requirement imposed by
the Board of Governors of the Federal Reserve System, but excluding any
reserve requirement, if any, included in the determination of Yield), special
deposit or similar requirement against assets of, deposits with or for the
amount of, or credit extended by, any Affected Party or (C) shall impose any
other condition affecting an Asset Interest or a Purchaser's rights hereunder,
the result of which is to increase the cost to any Affected Party or to reduce
the amount of any sum received or receivable by an Affected Party under this
Agreement, then within ten days after demand by such Affected Party (which
demand shall be accompanied by a statement setting forth the basis for such
demand), the Seller shall pay directly to such Affected Party such additional
amount or amounts as will compensate such Affected Party for such additional
or increased cost incurred or such reduction suffered.

         (b) If either (i) the introduction of or any change in or in the
interpretation of any law, guideline, rule, regulation, directive or request
or (ii) compliance by any Affected Party with any law, guideline, rule,
regulation, directive or request from any central bank or other governmental
authority or agency (whether or not having the force of law), including,
without limitation, compliance by an Affected Party with any request or
directive regarding capital adequacy, has or would have the effect of reducing
the rate of return on the capital of any Affected Party as a consequence of
its obligations hereunder or arising in connection herewith to a level below
that which any such Affected Party could have achieved but for such
introduction, change or compliance (taking into consideration the policies of
such Affected Party with respect to capital adequacy) by an amount deemed by
such Affected Party to be material, then from time to time, within ten days
after demand by such Affected Party (which demand shall be accompanied by a
statement setting forth the basis for such demand), the Seller shall pay
directly to such Affected Party such additional amount or amounts as will
compensate such Affected Party for such reduction.



                                      32
<PAGE>

         (c) If as a result of any event or circumstance similar to those
described in clauses (a) or (b) of this section, any Affected Party is
required to compensate a bank or other financial institution providing
liquidity support, credit enhancement or other similar support to such
Affected Party in connection with this Agreement or the funding or maintenance
of Purchases hereunder, then within ten days after demand by such Affected
Party, the Seller shall pay to such Affected Party such additional amount or
amounts as may be necessary to reimburse such Affected Party for any amounts
paid by it.

         (d) In determining any amount provided for in this section, the
Affected Party may use any reasonable averaging and attribution methods. Any
Affected Party making a claim under this section shall submit to the Seller a
certificate as to such additional or increased cost or reduction, which
certificate shall be conclusive absent demonstrable error.

         (e) If a Purchaser shall notify the Deal Agent that a Eurodollar
Disruption Event as described in clause (a) of the definition of "Eurodollar
Disruption Event" has occurred, the Deal Agent shall in turn so notify the
Seller, whereupon all Capital in respect of which Yield accrues at the
Adjusted Eurodollar Rate shall immediately be converted into Capital in
respect of which Yield accrues at the Base Rate.

                  Section 2.15      Taxes.

         (a) All payments made by an Obligor in respect of a Contract and all
payments made by the Seller or the Servicer under this Agreement will be made
free and clear of and without deduction or withholding for or on account of
any Taxes, unless such withholding or deduction is required by law. In such
event, the Obligor, Seller, or Servicer (as the case may be) shall pay to the
appropriate taxing authority any such Taxes required to be deducted or
withheld and the amount payable to each Purchaser or the Deal Agent (as the
case may be) will be increased (such increase, the "Additional Amount") such
that every net payment made under this Agreement after deduction or
withholding for or on account of any Taxes (including, without limitation, any
Taxes on such increase) is not less than the amount that would have been paid
had no such deduction or withholding been deducted or withheld. The foregoing
obligation to pay Additional Amounts, however, will not apply with respect to
net income or franchise taxes imposed on a Purchaser or the Deal Agent,
respectively, with respect to payments required to be made by the Seller or
Servicer under this Agreement, by a taxing jurisdiction in which such
Purchaser or Deal Agent is organized, conducts business or is paying taxes as
of the Closing Date (as the case may be). If a Purchaser or the Deal Agent
pays any Taxes in respect of which the Seller is obligated to pay Additional
Amounts under this Section 2.14(a), the Seller shall promptly reimburse such
Purchaser or Deal Agent in full.

         (b) The Seller will indemnify each Purchaser and the Deal Agent for
the full amount of Taxes in respect of which the Seller is required to pay
Additional Amounts (including, without limitation, any Taxes imposed by any


                                      33
<PAGE>

jurisdiction on such Additional Amounts) paid by such Purchaser or the Deal
Agent (as the case may be) and any liability (including penalties, interest
and expenses) arising therefrom or with respect thereto; provided, however,
that such Purchaser or the Deal Agent, as appropriate, making a demand for
indemnity payment shall provide the Seller, at its address set forth under its
name on the signature pages hereof, with a certificate from the relevant
taxing authority or from a responsible officer of such Purchaser or the Deal
Agent stating or otherwise evidencing that response such Purchaser or the Deal
Agent has made payment of such Taxes and will provide a copy of or extract
from documentation, if available, furnished by such taxing authority
evidencing assertion or payment of such Taxes. This indemnification shall be
made within ten days from the date the Purchaser or the Deal Agent (as the
case may be) makes written demand therefor.

         (c) Within 30 days after the date of any payment by the Seller of any
Taxes, the Seller will furnish to the Deal Agent, at its address set forth
under its name on the signature pages hereof, appropriate evidence of payment
thereof.

         (d) If a Purchaser is not created or organized under the laws of the
United States or a political subdivision thereof, such Purchaser shall, to the
extent that it may then do so under applicable laws and regulations, deliver
to the Seller with a copy to the Deal Agent (i) within 15 days after the date
hereof, or, if later, the date on which such Purchaser becomes a Purchaser
hereof two (or such other number as may from time to time be prescribed by
applicable laws or regulations) duly completed copies of IRS Form 4224 or Form
1001 (or any successor forms or other certificates or statements which may be
required from time to time by the relevant United States taxing authorities or
applicable laws or regulations), as appropriate, to permit the Seller to make
payments hereunder for the account of such Purchaser, as the case may be,
without deduction or withholding of United States federal income or similar
Taxes and (ii) upon the obsolescence of or after the occurrence of any event
requiring a change in, any form or certificate previously delivered pursuant
to this Section 2.14(d), copies (in such numbers as may from time to time be
prescribed by applicable laws or regulations) of such additional, amended or
successor forms, certificates or statements as may be required under
applicable laws or regulations to permit the Seller to make payments hereunder
for the account of such Purchaser, without deduction or withholding of United
States federal income or similar Taxes.

         (e) For any period with respect to which a Purchaser or the Deal
Agent has failed to provide the Seller with the appropriate form, certificate
or statement described in clause (d) of this section (other than if such
failure is due to a change in law occurring after the date of this Agreement),
the Deal Agent or such Purchaser, as the case may be, shall not be entitled to
indemnification under clauses (a) or (b) of this section with respect to any
Taxes.

         (f) Within 30 days of the written request of the Seller therefor, the
Deal Agent and the Purchaser, as appropriate, shall execute and deliver to the
Seller such certificates, forms or other documents which can be furnished
consistent with the facts and which are reasonably necessary to assist the
Seller in applying for refunds of Taxes remitted hereunder; provided, however,
that the Deal Agent and the Purchaser shall not be required to deliver such


                                      34
<PAGE>

certificates forms or other documents if in their respective sole discretion
it is determined that the deliverance of such certificate, form or other
document would have a material adverse affect on the Deal Agent or Purchaser
and provided further, however, that the Seller shall reimburse the Deal Agent
or Purchaser for any reasonable expenses incurred in the delivery of such
certificate, form or other document.

         (g) If, in connection with an agreement or other document providing
liquidity support, credit enhancement or other similar support to the
Purchasers in connection with this Agreement or the funding or maintenance of
Purchases hereunder, the Purchasers are required to compensate a bank or other
financial institution in respect of Taxes under circumstances similar to those
described in this section then within ten days after demand by the Purchasers,
the Seller shall pay to the Purchasers such additional amount or amounts as
may be necessary to reimburse the Purchasers for any amounts paid by them.

         (h) Without prejudice to the survival of any other agreement of the
Seller hereunder, the agreements and obligations of the Seller contained in
this section shall survive the termination of this Agreement.

                  Section 2.16      Assignment of the Purchase Agreement.

         The Seller hereby represents, warrants and confirms to the Deal Agent
that the Seller has assigned to the Deal Agent, for the ratable benefit of the
Purchasers hereunder, all of the Seller's right and title to and interest in
the Purchase Agreement. The Seller confirms that following a Payout Event the
Deal Agent shall have the sole right to enforce the Seller's rights and
remedies under the Purchase Agreement for the benefit of the Purchasers, but
without any obligation on the part of the Deal Agent, the Purchasers or any of
their respective Affiliates, to perform any of the obligations of the Seller
under the Purchase Agreement. The Seller further confirms and agrees that such
assignment to the Deal Agent shall terminate upon the Collection Date;
provided, however, that the rights of the Deal Agent and the Purchasers
pursuant to such assignment with respect to rights and remedies in connection
with any indemnities and any breach of any representation, warranty or
covenants made by the Originator pursuant to the Purchase Agreement, which
rights and remedies survive the Termination of the Purchase Agreement, shall
be continuing and shall survive any termination of such assignment.

                  Section 2.17      Substitution of Contracts.

         On any day prior to the occurrence of a Restricting Event, the Seller
may, and upon the request of the Deal Agent shall, subject to the conditions
set forth in this Section 2.16, replace any Contract subject to a Warranty
Event or in respect of which the Obligor thereunder has requested the
rewriting and/or restructuring of such Contract with one or more other
Contracts (each, a "Substitute Contract"), provided that no such replacement
shall occur unless each of the following conditions is satisfied as of the
date of such replacement and substitution:



                                      35
<PAGE>

         (a) the Seller has previously recommended to the Deal Agent (with a
copy to the Collateral Custodian) in writing that the Contract to be replaced
should be replaced (each a "Replaced Contract");

         (b) each Substitute Contract is an Eligible Contract on the date of
substitution;

         (c) after giving effect to any such substitution, the aggregate of
all outstanding Capital does not exceed the lesser of the (i) Purchase Limit
and (ii) the Capital Limit;

         (d) the aggregate Discounted Contract Balance (at the applicable Sale
Discount Rate) of such Substitute Contracts shall be equal to or greater than
the aggregate Discounted Contract Balances (at the applicable Sale Discount
Rate as of the date of the inclusion of such Contract in the Asset Pool) of
Contracts being replaced;

         (e) such Substitute Contracts, at the time of substitution by the
Seller, shall have approximately the same weighted average life as the
replaced Contracts;

         (f) all representations and warranties of the Seller contained in
Sections 4.1 and 4.2 shall be true and correct as of the date of substitution
of any such Substitute Contract;

         (g) the substitution of any Substitute Contract does not cause a
Payout Event to occur; and

         (h) the Seller shall deliver to the Deal Agent on the date of such
substitution a certificate of a Responsible Officer certifying that each of
the foregoing is true and correct as of such date.

         In addition, the Seller shall deliver to the Collateral Custodian the
related Contract File as required by Section 3.3. In connection with any such
substitution, the Deal Agent as agent for the Purchasers shall, automatically
and without further action, be deemed to transfer to the Seller, free and
clear of any Lien created pursuant to this Agreement, all of the right, title
and interest of the Deal Agent as Agent for the Purchasers in, to and under
such Replaced Contract, and the Deal Agent as agent for the Purchasers shall
be deemed to represent and warrant that it has the corporate authority and has
taken all necessary corporate action to accomplish such transfer, but without
any other representation and warranty, express or implied. Any right of the
Deal Agent as agent for the Purchasers to substitute any Contract in the Asset
Pool pursuant to this Section 2.16 shall be in addition to, and without
limitation of, any other rights and remedies that the Deal Agent as agent for
the Purchasers or any Purchaser may have to require the Seller or the
Servicer, as applicable, to substitute for, or accept retransfer of, any
Contract pursuant to the terms of this Agreement.



                                      36
<PAGE>

                                  ARTICLE III

                            CONDITIONS OF PURCHASES

                  Section 3.1       Conditions Precedent to Initial Purchase.

         The initial Purchase hereunder is subject to the condition precedent
that the Deal Agent shall have received on or before the date of such purchase
the items listed in Schedule I, each (unless otherwise indicated) dated such
date, in form and substance satisfactory to the Deal Agent and the Purchasers.

                  Section 3.2       Conditions Precedent to All Purchases and
                                    Remittances of Collections.

         Each Purchase (including the Initial Purchase) from the Seller by a
Purchaser, the right of the Servicer to remit Collections to the Seller
pursuant to Section 2.7(b) and each Incremental Purchase (each, a
"Transaction") shall be subject to the further conditions precedent that (a)
with respect to any Purchase (including the Initial Purchase) or Incremental
Purchase, the Servicer shall have delivered to the Deal Agent, on or prior to
the date of such Purchase or Incremental Purchase in form and substance
satisfactory to the Deal Agent, (i) a Purchase Notice (Exhibit A), (ii) a
Purchase Certificate (Exhibit G), and (iii) a Certificate of Assignment
(Exhibit A to the Purchase and Sale Agreement) including Schedule I, thereto
dated within 10 days prior to the date of such Purchase (other than the
Initial Purchase, in which case such items shall be dated within 5 days prior
to the date of such Initial Purchase) or Incremental Purchase and containing
such additional information as may be reasonably requested by the Deal Agent;
(b) on the date of such Transaction the following statements shall be true and
the Seller shall be deemed to have certified that:

                  (i) The representations and warranties contained in Sections
         4.1 and 4.2 are true and correct on and as of such day as though made
         on and as of such date,

                  (ii) No event has occurred and is continuing, or would
         result from such Transaction which constitutes a Payout Event,

                  (iii) On and as of such day, after giving effect to such
         Transaction, the outstanding Capital does not exceed the lesser of
         (x) the Purchase Limit, or (y) the Capital Limit,

                  (iv) On and as of such day, the Seller and the Servicer each
         has performed all of the agreements contained in this Agreement to be
         performed by such person at or prior to such day, and

                  (v) No law or regulation shall prohibit, and no order,
         judgment or decree of any federal, state or local court or
         governmental body, agency or instrumentality shall prohibit or


                                      37
<PAGE>

         enjoin, the making of such Purchase, remittance of Collections or
         Incremental Purchase by the Purchaser in accordance with the
         provisions hereof; and

         (c) on the date of such Transaction, the Deal Agent shall have
received such other approvals, opinions or documents as the Deal Agent may
reasonably require.

                  Section 3.3       Delivery of Contract Files.

         As a condition subsequent to each Purchase or substitution of
Substitute Contracts made hereunder, the Seller shall deliver to the
Collateral Custodian, within 10 calendar days after such Purchase or
substitution, the related Contract Files.

                                  ARTICLE IV

                        REPRESENTATIONS AND WARRANTIES

                  Section 4.1       Representations and Warranties of the
                                    Seller.

         The Seller represents and warrants as follows:

         (a) Organization and Good Standing. The Seller is a corporation duly
organized and validly existing in good standing under the laws of the
Commonwealth of Pennsylvania, and has full corporate power, authority and
legal right to own or lease its properties and conduct its business as such
properties are presently owned or leased and such business is presently
conducted, and to execute, deliver and perform its obligations under this
Agreement and the Purchase Agreement.

         (b) Due Qualification. The Seller is duly qualified to do business
and is in good standing as a corporation, and has obtained or will obtain all
necessary licenses and approvals, in each jurisdiction in which failure to so
qualify or to obtain such licenses and approvals would have a material adverse
effect on its ability to perform its obligations hereunder.

         (c) Due Authorization. The execution and delivery of this Agreement
and the Purchase Agreement and the consummation of the transactions provided
for herein and therein have been duly authorized by the Seller by all
necessary corporate action on the part of the Seller.

         (d) No Conflict. The execution and delivery of this Agreement and the
Purchase Agreement, the performance by the Seller of the transactions
contemplated hereby and thereby and the fulfillment of the terms hereof and
thereof will not conflict with or result in any breach of any of the material
terms and provisions of, and will not constitute (with or without notice or
lapse of time or both) a default under, any indenture, contract, agreement,
mortgage, deed of trust, or other instrument to which the Seller is a party or
by which it or any of its property is bound.



                                      38
<PAGE>

         (e) No Violation. The execution and delivery of this Agreement and
the Purchase Agreement, the performance of the transactions contemplated
hereby and thereby and the fulfillment of the terms hereof and thereof will
not conflict with or violate, in any material respect, any Requirements of Law
applicable to the Seller.

         (f) No Proceedings. There are no proceedings or investigations
pending or, to the best knowledge of the Seller, threatened against the
Seller, before any court, regulatory body, administrative agency, or other
tribunal or governmental instrumentality (i) asserting the invalidity of this
Agreement or the Purchase Agreement, (ii) seeking to prevent the consummation
of any of the transactions contemplated by this Agreement or the Purchase
Agreement or (iii) seeking any determination or ruling that could reasonably
be expected to be adversely determined, and if adversely determined, would
materially and adversely affect the performance by the Seller of its
obligations under this Agreement or the Purchase Agreement.

         (g) All Consents Required. All approvals, authorizations, consents,
orders or other actions of any Person or of any Governmental Authority
required in connection with the execution and delivery by the Seller of this
Agreement and the Purchase Agreement, the performance by the Seller of the
transactions contemplated by this Agreement and the Purchase Agreement, and
the fulfillment of the terms hereof and thereof by the Seller, have been
obtained unless the failure to obtain such shall not materially and adversely
affect the Seller's performance of its obligations thereunder.

         (h) Bulk Sales. The execution, delivery and performance of this
Agreement do not require compliance with any "bulk sales" law by Seller.

         (i) Solvency. The transactions under this Agreement and/or the
Purchase Agreement do not and will not render the Seller not Solvent.

         (j) Selection Procedures; Credit and Collection Policy. No procedures
believed by the Seller to be materially adverse to the interests of VFCC or
the Purchasers were utilized by the Seller in identifying and/or selecting the
Contracts in the Asset Pool. In addition, each Contract shall have been
underwritten in accordance with and satisfy the standards of any Credit and
Collection Policy which has been established by the Seller or the Originator
and is then in effect. Such Credit and Collection Policy or procedure may be
amended from time to time in the Seller's or the Originator's normal course of
business provided that the Seller shall not materially change such credit and
collection policy or procedure without the prior written consent of the Deal
Agent.

         (k) Taxes. The Seller has filed or caused to be filed all Tax returns
which, to its knowledge, are required to be filed. The Seller has paid or made
adequate provisions for the payment of all Taxes and all assessments made
against it or any of its property (other than any amount of Tax the validity
of which is currently being contested in good faith by appropriate proceedings
and with respect to which reserves in accordance with generally accepted


                                      39
<PAGE>

accounting principles have been provided on the books of the Seller), and no
Tax lien has been filed and, to the Seller's knowledge, no claim is being
asserted, with respect to any such Tax, fee or other charge.

         (l) Agreements Enforceable. This Agreement and the Purchase Agreement
constitute the legal, valid and binding obligation of the Seller enforceable
against the Seller in accordance with their respective terms, except as such
enforceability may be limited by Insolvency Laws and except as such
enforceability may be limited by general principles of equity (whether
considered in a suit at law or in equity).

         (m) Exchange Act Compliance. No proceeds of any Purchase or
Incremental Purchase will be used by the Seller to acquire any security in any
transaction which is subject to Section 13 or 14 of the Securities Exchange
Act of 1934, as amended.

         (n) No Liens. Each Asset, together with the Contract related thereto,
shall, at all times, be owned by the Seller free and clear of any Adverse
Claim except as provided herein, and upon each Purchase, remittance of
Collections or Incremental Purchase, the relevant Purchaser shall acquire
(subject to recordation where necessary) a valid and perfected first priority
undivided ownership interest in each Asset then existing or thereafter arising
and Collections with respect thereto, free and clear of any Adverse Claim
except as provided hereunder. No effective financing statement or other
instrument similar in effect covering any Asset or Collections with respect
thereto shall at any time be on file in any recording office except such as
may be filed in favor of the Deal Agent relating to this Agreement.

         (o) Reports Accurate. No Monthly Report (if prepared by the Seller,
or to the extent that information contained therein is supplied by the
Seller), information, exhibit, financial statement, document, book, record or
report furnished or to be furnished by the Seller to the Deal Agent or a
Purchaser in connection with this Agreement is or will be inaccurate in any
material respect as of the date it is or shall be dated or (except as
otherwise disclosed to the Deal Agent or such Purchaser, as the case may be,
at such time) as of the date so furnished, and no such document contains or
will contain any material misstatement of fact or omits or shall omit to state
a material fact or any fact necessary to make the statements contained therein
not misleading.

         (p) Location of Offices. The principal place of business and chief
executive office of the Seller and the office where the Seller keeps all the
Records are located at the address of the Seller referred to in Section 11.2
hereof (or at such other locations as to which the notice and other
requirements specified in Section 5.2(m) shall have been satisfied).

         (q) Lock-Boxes. The names and addresses of all the Lock-Box Banks,
together, with the account numbers of the Lock-Box Accounts of the Seller at
such Lock-Box Banks and the names, addresses and account numbers of all
accounts to which Collections of the Assets outstanding before the initial
Purchase hereunder have been sent, are specified in Schedule II (which shall
be deemed to be amended in respect of terminating or adding any Lock-Box


                                      40
<PAGE>

Account or Lock-Box Bank upon satisfaction of the notice and other
requirements specified in respect thereof).

         (r) Tradenames. Except as described in Schedule III, the Seller has
no trade names, fictitious names, assumed names or "doing business as" names
or other names under which it has done or is doing business.

         (s) Purchase Agreement. The Purchase Agreement is the only agreement
pursuant to which the Seller purchases Assets.

         (t) Value Given. The Seller shall have given reasonably equivalent
value to the Originator in consideration for the transfer to the Seller of the
Assets under the Purchase Agreement, no such transfer shall have been made for
or on account of an antecedent debt owed by the Originator to the Seller, and
no such transfer is or may be voidable or subject to avoidance under any
section of the Bankruptcy Code; no event or circumstance has occurred that
would constitute a Payout Event pursuant to Section 7. 1.

         (u) Special Purpose Entity. The Certificate of Incorporation of the
Seller includes substantially the provisions set forth on Exhibit C hereto,
and the Originator has confirmed in writing to the Seller that, so long as the
Seller is not "insolvent" within the meaning of the Bankruptcy Code, the
Originator will not cause the Seller to file a voluntary petition under the
Bankruptcy Code or any other bankruptcy or insolvency laws. Each of the Seller
and the Originator is aware that in light of the circumstances described in
the preceding sentence and other relevant facts, the filing of a voluntary
petition under the Bankruptcy Code for the purpose of making the assets of the
Seller available to satisfy claims of the creditors of the Originator would
not result in making such assets available to satisfy such creditors under the
Bankruptcy Code.

         (v) Accounting. The Seller accounts for the transfers to it from the
Originator of interests in Assets and Collections under the Purchase Agreement
as sales of such Assets and transfers of Asset Interests as sales of such
Asset Interests in its books, records and financial statements, in each case
consistent with GAAP and with the requirements set forth herein.

         (w) Separate Entity. The Seller is operated as an entity with assets
and liabilities distinct from those of the Originator and any Affiliates
thereof (other than the Seller), and the Seller hereby acknowledges that the
Deal Agent and the Purchasers are entering into the transactions contemplated
by this Agreement in reliance upon the Seller's identity as a separate legal
entity from the Originator and from each such other Affiliate of the
Originator.

         (x) Security Interest. The Seller has granted a security interest (as
defined in the UCC) to the Deal Agent, as agent for the Purchasers, in the
Assets and Collections, which is enforceable in accordance with applicable law
upon execution and delivery of this Agreement. Upon the filing of UCC-1
financing statements naming the Deal Agent as secured party and the Seller as
debtor, the Deal Agent, as agent for the Purchasers, shall have a first


                                      41
<PAGE>

priority perfected security interest in the Assets and Collections (except for
any Permitted Liens). All filings (including, without limitation, such UCC
filings) as are necessary in any Jurisdiction to perfect the interest of the
Deal Agent as agent for the Purchasers, in the Assets and Collections have
been (or prior to the applicable Purchase will be) made.

         (y) Investments. The Seller does not own or hold directly or
indirectly, any capital stock or equity security of, or any equity interest
in, any Person.

         (z) Business. Since its incorporation, the Seller has conducted no
business other than the purchase and receipt of Contracts and related assets
from the Originator under the Purchase Agreement, the sale of Contracts under
this Agreement and such other activities as are incidental to the foregoing.

         (aa) Investment Company Act. The Seller is not an "investment
company" within the meaning of the Investment Company Act of 1940, as amended.

         (bb) Accuracy of Representations and Warranties. Each representation
or warranty by the Seller contained herein or in any certificate or other
document furnished by the Seller pursuant hereto or in connection herewith is
true and correct in all material respects.

         The representations and warranties set forth in this section shall
survive the transfer of the Assets to the Deal Agent as agent for the
Purchasers. Upon discovery by the Seller, the Servicer, any Purchaser, the
Liquidity Agent or the Deal Agent of a breach of any of the foregoing
representations and warranties, the party discovering such breach shall give
prompt written notice to the others.

         Section 4.2 Representations and Warranties of Seller Relating to the
Agreement and the Contracts.

         The Seller hereby represents and warrants to the Deal Agent, each
Purchaser, the Liquidity Agent and each Investor that, as of the Closing Date
and as of each Addition Date:

         (a) Binding, Obligation, Valid Transfer and Security Interest.

                  (i) This Agreement and the Purchase Agreement each
         constitute legal, valid and binding obligations of the Seller,
         enforceable against the Seller in accordance with its terms, except
         as such enforceability may be limited by Insolvency Laws and except
         as such enforceability may be limited by general principles of equity
         (whether considered in a suit at law or in equity).

                  (ii) This Agreement constitutes either (A) a valid transfer
         to the Deal Agent as agent for the Purchasers of all right, title and
         interest of the Seller in, to and under all Assets in the Asset Pool
         to the extent of the Asset Interest, and such transfer will be free
         and clear of any Lien of any Person claiming through or under the
         Seller or its Affiliates, except for Permitted Liens, or (B) a grant


                                      42
<PAGE>

         of a security interest in all Assets in the Asset Pool to the Deal
         Agent as agent for the Purchasers. Upon the filing of the financing
         statements described in Section 6.8(c) and, in the case of Additional
         Contracts on the applicable Addition Date, the Deal Agent as agent
         for the Purchasers shall have a first priority perfected security
         interest in all Assets in the Asset Pool, subject only to Permitted
         Liens. Neither the Seller nor any Person claiming through or under
         Seller shall have any claim to or interest in the Collection Account
         and, if this Agreement constitutes the grant of a security interest
         in such property, except for the interest of Seller in such property
         as a debtor for purposes of the UCC.

         (b) Eligibility of Contracts. As of the Closing Date, (i) Schedule I
to this Agreement and the information contained in the Purchase Certificate
delivered pursuant to Section 2.2(b) is an accurate and complete listing in
all material respects of all the Existing Contracts in the Asset Pool as of
the Closing Date and the information contained therein with respect to the
identity of such Contracts and the amounts owing thereunder is true and
correct in all material respects as of the related Cut Off Date, (ii) each
such Contract is an Eligible Contract, (iii) each such Contract and the
related Equipment is free and clear of any Lien of any Person (other than
Permitted Liens) and in compliance with all Requirements of Law applicable to
the Seller and (iv) with respect to each such Contract, all consents,
licenses, approvals or authorizations of or registrations or declarations with
any Governmental Authority required to be obtained, effected or given by the
Seller in connection with the transfer of an interest in such Contract and the
related Equipment to the Deal Agent as agent for the Purchasers have been duly
obtained, effected or given and are in full force and effect. On each Addition
Date on which Additional Contracts are added by the Seller to the Asset Pool,
the Seller shall be deemed to represent and warrant that (i) such Additional
Contract referenced on the related Purchase Certificate delivered pursuant to
Section 2.2(b) hereof is an Eligible Contract, (ii) each such Additional
Contract and the related Equipment is free and clear of any Lien of any Person
(other than Permitted Liens) and in compliance with all Requirements of Law
applicable to Seller and/or the Originator, (iii) with respect to each such
Additional Contract, all consents, licenses, approvals, authorizations,
registrations or declarations with any Governmental Authority required to be
obtained, effected or given by the Seller in connection with the addition of
such Contract and the related Equipment to the Asset Pool have been duly
obtained, effected or given and are in full force and effect and (iv) the
representations and warranties set forth in Section 4.2(a) are true and
correct with respect to each Contract transferred on such day as if made on
such day.

         (c) Notice of Breach. The representations and warranties set forth in
this Section 4.2 shall survive the transfer of an interest in the respective
Contracts and related Equipment, or interests therein, to the Deal Agent as
agent for the Purchasers. Upon discovery by the Seller, the Servicer, any
Purchaser, the Deal Agent, the Liquidity Agent of any Investor of a breach of
any of the foregoing representations and warranties, the party discovering
such breach shall give prompt written notice to the others.



                                      43
<PAGE>

                  Section 4. 3      Representations and Warranties of the
                                    Seller Relating to the Purchase Limit and 
                                    Capital Limit.

         The Seller is hereby deemed to represent and warrant that on each day
prior to the Termination Date, the amount of Capital outstanding on such day
shall not exceed the lesser of (x) the Purchase Limit or (y) the Capital
Limit.

                                   ARTICLE V

                        GENERAL COVENANTS OF THE SELLER

                  Section 5.1       General Covenants.

         Until the date on which all Aggregate Unpaids have been indefeasibly
paid in full, the Seller hereby covenants that:

         (a) Compliance with Laws, Preservation of Corporate Existence. The
Seller will comply in all material respects with all applicable laws, rules,
regulations and orders and preserve and maintain its corporate existence,
rights, franchises, qualifications and privileges.

                  Section 5.2       Covenants of Seller.

         The Seller hereby covenants that:

         (a) Contracts Not to be Evidenced by Instruments. The Seller will
take no action to cause any Contract which is not, as of the Closing Date or
the related Addition Date, as the case may be, evidenced by an Instrument, to
be so evidenced except in connection with the enforcement or collection of
such Contract.

         (b) Security Interests. The Seller will not sell, pledge, assign or
transfer to any other Person, or grant, create, incur, assume or suffer to
exist any Lien on any Contract in the Asset Pool or related Equipment, whether
now existing or hereafter transferred hereunder, or any interest therein, and
the Seller will not sell, pledge, assign or suffer to exist any Lien on its
interest, if any, hereunder. The Seller will promptly notify the Deal Agent of
the existence of any Lien on any Contract in the Asset Pool or related
Equipment and the Seller shall defend the right, title and interest of the
Deal Agent as agent for the Purchasers in, to and under the Contracts in the
Asset Pool and the related Equipment, against all claims of third parties,
provided, however, that nothing in this section 5.2(b) shall prevent or be
deemed to prohibit the Seller from suffering to exist Permitted Liens upon any
of the Contracts in the Asset Pool or any related Equipment.

         (c) Delivery of Collections. The Seller agrees to pay to the Servicer
promptly (but in no event later than two Business Days after receipt) all
Collections received by Seller in respect of the Contracts in the Asset Pool.



                                      44
<PAGE>

         (d) Compliance with the Law. Seller hereby agrees to comply in all
material respects with all Requirements of Law applicable to Seller, the
Contracts and the Equipment.

         (e) Activities of Seller. The Seller shall not engage in any business
or activity of any kind, or enter into any transaction or indenture, mortgage,
instrument, agreement, contract, lease or other undertaking, which is not
incidental to the transactions contemplated and authorized by this Agreement
or the Purchase Agreements.

         (f) Indebtedness; Investments. The Seller shall not create, incur,
assume or suffer to exist any Indebtedness or other liability whatsoever,
except (i) obligations incurred under this Agreement, or (ii) liabilities
incident to the maintenance of its corporate existence in good standing.

         (g) Guarantees. The Seller shall not become or remain liable,
directly or indirectly, in connection with any Indebtedness or other liability
of any other Person, whether by guarantee, endorsement (other than
endorsements of negotiable instruments for deposit or collection in the
ordinary course of business), agreement to purchase or repurchase, agreement
to supply or advance funds, or otherwise.

         (h) Investments. The Seller shall not make or suffer to exist any
loans or advances to, or extend any credit to, or make any investments (by way
of transfer of property, contributions to capital, purchase of stock or
securities or evidences of indebtedness, acquisition of the business or
assets, or otherwise) in, any Person except for purchases of Contracts
pursuant to the Purchase Agreements, or for investments in Permitted
Investments in accordance with the terms of this Agreement.

         (i) Merger; Sales. The Seller shall not enter into any transaction of
merger or consolidation, or liquidate or dissolve itself (or suffer any
liquidation or dissolution), or acquire or be acquired by any Person, or
convey, sell, lease or otherwise dispose of all or substantially all of its
property or business, except as provided for in this Agreement.

         (j) Distributions. The Seller shall not declare or pay, directly or
indirectly, any dividend or make any other distribution (whether in cash or
other property) with respect to the profits, assets or capital of the Seller
or any Person's interest therein, or purchase, redeem or otherwise acquire for
value any of its capital stock now or hereafter outstanding, except that so
long as no Payout Event has occurred and is continuing and no Payout Event
would occur as a result thereof or after giving effect thereto and the Seller
would continue to be Solvent as a result thereof and after giving effect
thereto, the Seller may declare and pay cash or stock dividends on its capital
stock.

         (k) Agreements. The Seller shall not become a party to, or permit any
of its properties to be bound by, any indenture, mortgage, instrument,
contract, agreement, lease or other undertaking, except this Agreement and the


                                      45
<PAGE>

Purchase Agreements, or amend or modify the provisions of its Certificate of
Incorporation without the consent of the Deal Agent or issue any power of
attorney except to the Deal Agent or the Servicer.

         (l) Separate Corporate Existence. The Seller shall:

                  (i) Maintain its own deposit account or accounts, separate
         from those of any Affiliate, with commercial banking institutions.
         The funds of the Seller will not be diverted to any other Person or
         for other than corporate uses of the Seller.

                  (ii) Ensure that, to the extent that it shares the same
         officers or other employees as any of its stockholders or Affiliates,
         the salaries of and the expenses related to providing benefits to
         such officers and other employees shall be fairly allocated among
         such entities, and each such entity shall bear its fair share of the
         salary and benefit costs associated with all such common officers and
         employees.

                  (iii) Ensure that, to the extent that it jointly contracts
         with any of its stockholders or Affiliates to do business with
         vendors or service providers or to share overhead expenses, the costs
         incurred in so doing shall be allocated fairly among such entities,
         and each such entity shall bear its fair share of such costs. To the
         extent that the Seller contracts or does business with vendors or
         service providers when the goods and services provided are partially
         for the benefit of any other Person, the costs incurred in so doing
         shall be fairly allocated to or among such entities for whose benefit
         the goods and services are provided, and each such entity shall bear
         its fair share of such costs. All material transactions between
         Seller and any of its Affiliates shall be only on an arm's length
         basis.

                  (iv) Maintain a principal executive and administrative
         office through which its business is conducted separate from those of
         its Affiliates. To the extent that Seller and any of its stockholders
         or Affiliates have offices in the same location, there shall be a
         fair and appropriate allocation of overhead costs among them, and
         each such entity shall bear its fair share of such expenses.

                  (v) Conduct its affairs strictly in accordance with its
         Certificate of Incorporation and observe all necessary, appropriate
         and customary corporate formalities, including, but not limited to,
         holding all regular and special stockholders, and directors' meetings
         appropriate to authorize all corporate action, keeping separate and
         accurate minutes of its meetings, passing all resolutions or consents
         necessary to authorize actions taken or to be taken, and maintaining
         accurate and separate books, records and accounts, including, but not
         limited to, payroll and intercompany transaction accounts.

                  (vi) Take or refrain from taking, as applicable, each of the
         activities specified in the "non-substantive consolidation" opinion
         of Morgan, Lewis & Bockius LLP delivered on the Closing Date, upon
         which the conclusions expressed therein are based.



                                      46
<PAGE>

         (m) Location of Seller, Records; Instruments. The Seller (x) shall
not move outside the Commonwealth of Pennsylvania, the location of its chief
executive office, without 30 days' prior written notice to the Deal Agent and
(y) shall not move, or consent to the Collateral Custodian or Servicer moving,
the Contract Files from the possession of the Collateral Custodian thereof on
the Closing Date, without 30 days' prior written notice to the Deal Agent and
(z) will promptly take all actions required of each relevant jurisdiction in
order to continue the first priority perfected security interest of the Deal
Agent as agent for the Purchasers in all Assets in the Asset Pool. The Seller
will give the Deal Agent prompt notice of a change within the Commonwealth of
Pennsylvania of the location of its chief executive office.

         (n) Accounting of Purchases. Other than for federal, state and local
income tax purposes, the Seller will not account for or treat (whether in
financial statements or otherwise) the transactions contemplated hereby in any
manner other than as the sale, or absolute assignment, of Assets by the Seller
to a Purchaser. The Seller will not account for or treat (whether in financial
statements or otherwise) the transaction contemplated by the Purchase
Agreement in any manner other than as the sale, or absolute assignment, of the
Originator Assets by the Originator to the Seller, as the case may be.

         (o) ERISA Matters. The Seller will not (a) engage or permit any ERISA
Affiliate to engage in any prohibited transaction for which an exemption is
not available or has not previously been obtained from the United States
Department of Labor; (b) permit to exist any accumulated funding deficiency,
as defined in Section 302(a) of ERISA and Section 412(a) of the Code, or
funding deficiency with respect to any Benefit Plan other than a Multiemployer
Plan; (c) fail to make any payments to a Multiemployer Plan that the Seller or
any ERISA Affiliate may be required to make under the agreement relating to
such Multiemployer Plan or any law pertaining thereto; (d) terminate any
Benefit Plan so as to result in any liability; or (e) permit to exist any
occurrence of any reportable event described in Title IV of ERISA.

         (p) Originator Assets. With respect to each Asset acquired by the
Seller, the Seller will (i) acquire such Asset pursuant to and in accordance
with the terms of the Purchase Agreement, (ii) take all action necessary to
perfect, protect and more fully evidence the Seller's ownership of such Asset,
including, without limitation, (A) filing and maintaining, effective financing
statements (Form UCC-1) against the Originator in all necessary or appropriate
filing offices, and filing continuation statements, amendments or assignments
with respect thereto in such filing offices and (B) executing or causing to be
executed such other instruments or notices as may be necessary or appropriate
and (iii) take all additional action that the Deal Agent may reasonably
request to perfect, protect and more fully evidence the respective interests
of the parties to this Agreement in the Assets and interest therein
represented by the Asset Interest.

         (q) Transactions with Affiliates. The Seller will not enter into, or
be a party to, any transaction with any of its Affiliates, except (i) the
transactions permitted or contemplated by this Agreement and the Purchase
Agreement, and (ii) other transactions (including, without limitation, the
lease of office space or computer equipment or software by the Seller to or
from an Affiliate) (A) in the ordinary course of business, (B) pursuant to the


                                      47
<PAGE>

reasonable requirements of the Seller's business, (C) upon fair and reasonable
terms that are no less favorable to the Seller than could be obtained in a
comparable arm's-length transaction with a Person not an Affiliate of the
Seller, and (D) not inconsistent with the factual assumptions set forth in the
opinion letters issued by Morgan, Lewis & Bockius LLP and delivered to the
Deal Agent as a condition to the initial Purchase as such assumptions may be
modified in any subsequent opinion letters delivered to the Deal Agent
hereunder pursuant to Section 3.2(c) or otherwise. It is understood that any
compensation arrangement for officers shall be permitted under clause (ii)(A)
through (C) above if such arrangement has been expressly approved by the board
of directors of the Seller.

         (r) Investments. The Seller will not make any Investments other than
Permitted Investments.

         (s) Change in the Purchase Agreement. The Seller will not amend,
modify, waive or terminate any terms or conditions of the Purchase Agreement,
without the consent of Deal Agent.

         (t) Amendment to Certificate of Incorporation. The Seller will not
amend, modify or otherwise make any change to its Certificate of Incorporation
which would delete or otherwise nullify or circumvent the provisions set forth
on Exhibit C hereto.

         (u) Credit and Collection Policy. The Seller shall not cause or
permit any changes to be made to the Credit and Collection Policy in any
manner that would materially and adversely affect the collectibility of the
Contracts sold hereunder without the prior written consent of the Deal Agent,
which consent shall not be unreasonably withheld.

                  Section 5.3       Release of Lien on Equipment.

         At the same time as (i) any Contract in the Asset Pool expires by its
terms and all amounts in respect thereof have been paid by the related Obligor
and deposited in the Collection Account or (ii) any Contract becomes a Prepaid
Contract and all amounts in respect thereof have been paid by the related
Obligor and deposited in the Collection Account, the Deal Agent as agent for
the Purchasers will, to the extent requested by the Servicer, release its
interest in such Contract; provided, however, that such release will not
constitute a release of their respective interests in the Equipment or the
proceeds of such Contract or Equipment. In connection with any sale of such
Equipment on or after the occurrence of (i) or (ii) above, the Deal Agent as
agent for the Purchasers will after the deposit by the Servicer of the
proceeds of such sale into the Collection Account, at the sole expense of the
Servicer, execute and deliver to the Servicer any assignments, bills of sale,
termination statements and any other releases and instruments as the Servicer
may reasonably request in order to effect the release and transfer of such
Equipment; provided that the Deal Agent as agent for the Purchasers will make
no representation or warranty, express or implied, with respect to any such
Equipment in connection with such sale or transfer and assignment. Nothing in
this section shall diminish the Servicer's obligations pursuant to Section
6.1(c) with respect to the proceeds of any such sale.



                                      48
<PAGE>

                  Section 5.4       Hedging of Contracts.

         On or prior to the Purchase Date, the Seller shall have entered into
the Hedging Agreement with the Hedge Counterparty. On each Purchase Date the
Seller shall assign to the Deal Agent on behalf of VFCC all of the Seller's
rights under the Hedging Agreements relating to the Contracts conveyed on such
Purchase Date. Each Hedging Agreement shall (i) have a scheduled Termination
Date that coincides with the last Scheduled Payment due to occur for the
Contracts conveyed on such Purchase Date; (ii) provide for a notional amount
from time to time equal to one hundred percent (100%) of the aggregate Capital
on such Purchase Date, after giving effect to any increase in the aggregate
Capital to be made on such Purchase Date, (the "Hedged Level"), of the
aggregate amount (discounted to the present value at the "Swap Rate" defined
below) of all remaining Scheduled Payments on the Contracts on such Purchase
Date (the "Hedged Amount"); (iii) provide that the Hedge Counterparty's
payment obligations shall be calculated by reference to the Hedged Amount and
a per annum rate determined by reference to USD-CP-H. 15, as defined in the
1991 ISDA Definitions published by the International Swap Dealers Association,
Inc. and as determined in accordance with the procedures in effect on the date
of this Agreement (the "H.15"), for a period of 30 days, as determined on the
immediately preceding Payment Date; (iv) provide that the Seller's payment
obligations shall be calculated by reference to the Hedged Amount and a per
annum fixed rate agreed to between the Seller and the Hedge Counterparty (the
"Swap Rate"); (v) provide for net payments to be paid on each Payment Date and
any early termination date thereunder (A) on behalf of the Seller, solely out
of funds in the Collection Account and (B) by the Hedge Counterparty for
deposit into the Collection Account, for distribution in accordance with the
Agreement, (vi) provide for early termination at the option of the Required
Investors upon the disposition of the related Contracts and (vii) include
other provisions requested by the Required Investors and be in a form
acceptable to the Required Investors, which form shall be substantially the
same as set forth in Exhibit H hereto. In the event the H.15 is no longer
available, then the rate described in clause (iii) above shall be determined
by reference to such other publication or method of calculation as shall be
reasonably agreed between the Seller and the Purchaser in order to effect an
economically equivalent business deal between such parties. The Servicer will
provide the Deal Agent with written notice confirming the amounts, if any, to
be paid by or to the Hedge Counterparty on each Payment Date and any early
termination date.

                  Section 5.5       Retransfer of Ineligible Contracts.

         In the event of a breach of any representation or warranty set forth
in Section 4.2 with respect to a Contract in the Asset Pool (each such
Contract, an "Ineligible Contract"), no later than the earlier of (i)
knowledge by the Seller of such Contract becoming an Ineligible Contract and
(ii) receipt by the Seller from the Deal Agent or Servicer of written notice
thereof, the Seller shall either (a) accept the retransfer of each such
Ineligible Contract and any related Equipment selected by the Servicer as to
which such breach related, and the Deal Agent as agent for the Purchasers
shall convey to the Seller, without recourse, representation or warranty, all
of its right, title and interest in such Ineligible Contract; or (b) subject
to the satisfaction of the conditions in Section 2.16, substitute for such
Ineligible Contract a Substitute Contract. In any of the foregoing instances,

                                      49
<PAGE>

the Seller shall accept the retransfer of each such Ineligible Contract, and
the ADCB shall be reduced by the Discounted Contract Balance (calculated using
the applicable Blended Discount Rate as of the most recent Determination Date)
of each such Ineligible Contract and, if applicable, increased by the
Discounted Contract Balance of each such Substitute Contract. On and after the
date of retransfer, the Ineligible Contract so retransferred shall not be
included in the Asset Pool and, as applicable, the Substitute Contract shall
be included in the Asset Pool. In consideration of such retransfer, without
substitution, the Seller shall, on the date of retransfer of such Ineligible
Contract, make a deposit to the Collection Account (for allocation pursuant to
Section 2.7 , 2.8 or 2.9, as applicable) in immediately available funds in an
amount equal to the Discounted Contract Balance of such Ineligible Contract
(calculated using the applicable Blended Discount Rate as of the most recent
Determination Date). Upon each retransfer to the Seller of such Ineligible
Contract, the Deal Agent, as agent for the Purchasers, shall automatically and
without further action be deemed to transfer, assign and set-over to the
Seller, without recourse, representation or warranty, all the right, title and
interest of the Deal Agent, as agent for the Purchasers, in, to and under such
Ineligible Contract and all monies due or to become due with respect thereto,
the related Equipment and all proceeds of such Ineligible Contract and
Recoveries and Insurance Proceeds relating thereto and all rights to security
for any such Ineligible Contract, and all proceeds and products of the
foregoing. The Deal Agent, as agent for the Purchasers, shall, at the sole
expense of the Servicer execute such documents and instruments of transfer as
may be prepared by the Servicer on behalf of the Seller and take other such
actions as shall reasonably be requested by the Seller to effect the transfer
of such Ineligible Contract pursuant to this subsection.

                  Section 5.6       Retransfer of Assets.

         In the event of a breach of any representation or warranty set forth
in Section 4.2 hereof which breach could reasonably be expected to have a
material adverse affect on the rights of the Purchasers or the Deal Agent, as
agent of the Purchasers, or on the ability of the Seller to perform its
obligations hereunder, by notice then given in writing to the Seller, the Deal
Agent may direct the Seller to accept the retransfer of all of the Assets and
the Seller shall be obligated to accept retransfer of such Assets on a Payment
Date specified by the Seller (such date, the "Retransfer Date"). The Seller
shall deposit on the Retransfer Date an amount equal to the deposit amount
provided below for such Assets in the Collection Account for distribution to
the Purchasers. The deposit amount (the "Retransfer Amount") for such
retransfer will be equal to the (A) sum of (i) the aggregate outstanding
Capital at the end of the Business Day preceding the Payment Date on which the
retransfer is scheduled to be made, (ii) an amount equal to all amounts
accrued and to accrue with respect to unpaid Program Fees, Commitment Fees and
Yield in respect of such Capital at the applicable Yield Rate through the
maturity date of latest maturing Commercial Paper Notes and (iii) any and all
costs associated with the termination, in whole or in part, of any Hedging
Agreement minus (B) the amount, if any, available in the Collection Account on
such Payment Date. On the Retransfer Date, provided that full Retransfer
Amount has been deposited into the Collection Account, the Assets shall be
transferred to the Seller; and the Deal Agent as agent for the Purchasers
shall, at the sole expense of the Servicer, execute and deliver such
instruments of transfer, in each case without recourse, representation or


                                      50
<PAGE>

warranty, as shall be prepared and reasonably requested by the Servicer on
behalf of the Seller to vest in the Seller, or its designee or assignee, all
right, title and interest of the Deal Agent as agent for the Purchasers in, to
and under the Assets. If the Deal Agent gives a notice directing the Seller to
accept such a retransfer as provided above, the obligation of Seller to accept
a retransfer pursuant to this Section 5.6 shall constitute the sole remedy
respecting a breach of the representations and warranties contained in Section
4.2 available to the Purchasers and the Deal Agent on behalf of the
Purchasers.

                                  ARTICLE VI

                   ADMINISTRATION AND SERVICING OF CONTRACTS


                  Section 6.1       Appointment and Acceptance; Duties.

         (a) Appointment of Initial Servicer and Collateral Custodian.
Fidelity Leasing, Inc. is hereby appointed as Servicer pursuant to this
Agreement. Fidelity Leasing, Inc. accepts the appointment and agrees to act as
the Servicer pursuant to this Agreement. Harris Trust and Savings Bank is
hereby appointed as Collateral Custodian pursuant to this Agreement. Harris
Trust and Savings Bank accepts the appointment and agrees to act as the
Collateral Custodian pursuant to this Agreement.

         (b) General Duties. The Servicer will manage, service, administer,
collect and enforce the Assets in the Asset Pool on behalf of the Purchasers
(the "Servicing Duties") and will have full power and authority to do any and
all things in connection with the performance of the Servicing Duties which it
deems necessary or desirable provided, however, nothing it does may contravene
the provisions of this Agreement. The Servicer will perform the Servicing
Duties with reasonable care, using that degree of skill and attention that a
prudent person engaging in such activities would exercise, but in any event
shall not act with less care than the Servicer exercises with respect to all
comparable contracts that it services for itself or others. The Servicing
Duties will include, without limitation, collection and posting of all
payments, responding to inquiries of Obligors regarding the Assets in the
Asset Pool, investigating delinquencies and making Servicer Advances,
remitting payments to the Deal Agent in a timely manner, furnishing monthly,
quarterly and annual statements with respect to collections and payments in
accordance with the provisions of this Agreement, and using its best efforts
to maintain the perfected first priority security interest of the Deal Agent
as agent for the Purchasers in the Assets. The Servicer will follow customary
standards, policies, and procedures and will have full power and authority,
acting alone, to do any and all things in connection with the performance of
the Servicing Duties that it deems necessary or desirable. If the Servicer
commences a legal proceeding to enforce a Defaulted Contract or commences or
participates in a legal proceeding (including a bankruptcy proceeding)
relating to or involving an Asset in the Asset Pool, the Deal Agent as agent
for the Purchasers will be deemed to have automatically assigned the related
Contract to the Servicer for purposes of commencing or participating in any
such proceeding as a party or claimant, and the Servicer is authorized and


                                      51
<PAGE>

empowered by the Purchasers, pursuant to this Section 6.1(b), to execute and
deliver, on behalf of itself and the Deal Agent as agent for the Purchasers,
any and all instruments of satisfaction or cancellation, or partial or full
release or discharge, and all other notices, demands, claims, complaints,
responses, affidavits or other documents or instruments in connection with any
such proceedings. If in any enforcement suit or legal proceeding it is held
that the Servicer may not enforce a Contract on the ground that it is not a
real party in interest or a holder entitled to enforce the Contract, then the
Deal Agent will, at the Servicer's expense and direction, take steps on behalf
of the Deal Agent as agent for the Purchasers to enforce the Contract,
including bringing suit in the name of the Deal Agent as agent for the
Purchasers.

         (c) Disposition Upon Termination of Contract. Upon the termination of
a Contract included in the Asset Pool as a result of a default by the Obligor
thereunder the Servicer will use commercially reasonable efforts to dispose of
any related Equipment. Without limiting the generality of the foregoing, the
Servicer may dispose of any such Equipment by purchasing such Equipment or by
selling such Equipment to any of its Affiliates for a purchase price equal to
the fair market value thereof, any such sale to be evidenced by a certificate
of a Responsible Officer of the Servicer delivered to the Deal Agent setting
forth the Contract, the Equipment, the sale price of the Equipment and
certifying that such sale price is the fair market value of such Equipment.

         (d) Further Assurances. The Deal Agent will, at the sole expense of
the Servicer, furnish the Servicer with any powers of attorney and other
documents necessary or appropriate to enable the Servicer to carry out its
servicing and administrative duties under this Agreement.

         (e) Custodial Duties. The Collateral Custodian shall take and retain
custody of the Contract Files delivered by the Seller pursuant to Section 3.3
hereof in accordance with the terms and conditions of this Agreement, all for
the benefit of the Purchasers and subject to the Lien thereon in favor of the
Deal Agent as agent for the Purchasers. Within five Business Days of its
receipt of any Contract File, the Collateral Custodian shall review the
related Contract to verify that such Contract has been executed and has no
missing or mutilated pages and to confirm (in reliance on the related contract
number and Lessee name) that such Contract is referenced on the related list
of Contracts. In order to facilitate the foregoing review by the Collateral
Custodian, in connection with each delivery of Contract Files hereunder to the
Collateral Custodian, the Servicer shall provide to the Collateral Custodian
an electronic file (in EXCEL or a comparable format) that contains the related
list of Contracts or which otherwise contains the Contract number and the name
of the Lessee with respect to each related Contract. If, at the conclusion of
such review, the Collateral Custodian shall determine that such Contract is
not executed or in proper form on its face, or that it is not referenced on
such list of Contracts, the Collateral Custodian shall promptly notify the
Seller and the Deal Agent of such determination by providing a written report
to such Persons setting forth, with particularity, the lack of execution of
such Contract, that such Contract has missing or mutilated pages, or the fact
that such Contract was not referenced on the related list of Contracts. In
addition, unless instructed otherwise in writing by the Seller or the Deal
Agent within 10 days of the Collateral Custodian's delivery of such report,
the Collateral Custodian shall return any Contract not referenced on such list


                                      52
<PAGE>

of Contracts to the Seller. Other than the foregoing, the Collateral Custodian
shall not have any responsibility for reviewing any Contract File.

         In taking and retaining custody of the Contract Files, the Collateral
Custodian shall be deemed to be acting as the agent of the Deal Agent as agent
for the Purchasers, provided, however, that the Collateral Custodian makes no
representations as to the existence, perfection or priority of any Lien on the
Contract Files or the instruments therein, and provided, further, that the
Collateral Custodian's duties as agent shall be limited to those expressly
contemplated herein. All Contract Files shall be kept in fireproof vaults or
cabinets at the locations specified on Schedule IV attached hereto, or at such
other office as shall be specified to the Deal Agent by the Collateral
Custodian in a written notice delivered at least 45 days prior to such change.
All Contract Files shall be placed together in a separate file cabinet with an
appropriate identifying label and maintained in such a manner so as to permit
retrieval and access. All Contract Files shall be clearly segregated from any
other documents or instruments maintained by the Collateral Custodian. The
Collateral Custodian shall clearly indicate that such Contract Files are the
sole property of the Seller and that the Seller has granted an interest
therein to the Deal Agent on behalf of the Purchasers. In performing its
duties, the Collateral Custodian shall use the same degree of care and
attention as it employs with respect to similar Contracts which it holds as
Collateral Custodian.

         (f)      Concerning the Collateral Custodian.

                  (i) The Collateral Custodian may conclusively rely on and
         shall be fully protected in acting upon any certificate, instrument,
         opinion, notice, letter, telegram or other document delivered to it
         and which in good faith it reasonably believes to be genuine and
         which has been signed by the proper party or parties. The Collateral
         Custodian may rely conclusively on and shall be fully protected by in
         acting upon (A) the written instructions of any designated officer of
         the Deal Agent or (B) the verbal instructions of the Deal Agent.

                  (ii) The Collateral Custodian may consult counsel
         satisfactory to it and the advice or opinion of such counsel shall be
         full and complete authorization and protection in respect of any
         action taken, suffered or omitted by it hereunder in good faith and
         in accordance with the advice or opinion of such counsel.

                  (iii) The Collateral Custodian shall not be liable for any
         error of judgment, or for any act done or step taken or omitted by
         it, in good faith, or for any mistakes of fact or law, or for
         anything which it may do or refrain from doing in connection herewith
         except in the case of its willful misconduct or grossly negligent
         performance or omission.

                  (iv) The Collateral Custodian makes no warranty or
         representation and shall have no responsibility (except as expressly
         set forth in this Agreement) as to the content, enforceability,
         completeness, validity, sufficiency, value, genuineness, ownership or
         transferability of the Contracts, and will not be required to and


                                      53
<PAGE>

         will not make any representations as to the validity or value (except
         as expressly set forth in this Agreement) of any of the Contracts.
         The Collateral Custodian shall not be obligated to take any legal
         action hereunder which might in its judgment involve any expense or
         liability unless it has been furnished with an indemnity reasonably
         satisfactory to it.

                  (v) The Collateral Custodian shall have no duties or
         responsibilities except such duties and responsibilities as are
         specifically set forth in this Agreement and no covenants or
         obligations shall be implied in this Agreement against the Collateral
         Custodian.

                  (vi) The Collateral Custodian shall not be required to
         expend or risk its own funds in the performance of its duties
         hereunder.

                  (vii) It is expressly agreed and acknowledged that the
         Collateral Custodian is not guaranteeing performance of or assuming
         any liability for the obligations of the other parties hereto or any
         parties to the Contracts.

                  Section 6.2       Collection of Payments.

         (a) Collection Efforts, Modification of Contracts. The Servicer will
make reasonable efforts to collect all payments called for under the terms and
provisions of the Contracts in the Asset Pool as and when the same become due,
and will follow those collection procedures which it follows with respect to
all comparable Contracts that it services for itself or others. The Servicer
may not waive, modify or otherwise vary any provision of a Contract. The
Servicer may in its discretion waive any late payment charge or any other fees
that may be collected in the ordinary course of servicing any Contract in the
Asset Pool.

         (b) Prepaid Contract. The Servicer may not permit a Contract in the
Asset Pool to become a Prepaid Contract (which shall not include a Contract
that becomes a Prepaid Contract due to a Casualty Loss), unless (x) the
Servicer provides an Additional Contract or (y) such prepayment will not
result in the Collection Account receiving an amount (the "Prepayment Amount")
less than the sum of (A) the Discounted Contract Balance on the date of such
prepayment calculated using the applicable Blended Discount Rate in effect on
the date of such payment and (B) any outstanding Servicer Advances thereon.
After a Payout Event has occurred, the Servicer may not permit a Contract in
the Asset Pool to become a Prepaid Contract (which shall not include a
Contract that becomes a Prepaid Contract due to a Casualty Loss), unless the
Servicer collects an amount equal to the sum of the Discounted Contract
Balance plus accrued and unpaid interest and any outstanding Servicer Advances
thereon plus any swap breakage costs associated with the prepayment.

         (c) Acceleration. The Servicer shall accelerate the maturity of all
or any Scheduled Payments under any Contract in the Asset Pool under which a
default under the terms thereof has occurred and is continuing (after the
lapse of any applicable grace period) promptly after such Contract becomes a
Defaulted Contract.



                                      54
<PAGE>

         (d) Taxes and other Amounts. To the extent provided for in any
Contract in the Asset Pool, the Servicer will use its best efforts to collect
all payments with respect to amounts due for taxes, assessments and insurance
premiums relating to such Contracts or the Equipment and remit such amounts to
the appropriate Governmental Authority or insurer on or prior to the date such
payments are due.

         (e) Payments to Lock-Box Account. On or before the Closing Date with
respect to the Existing Contracts and on or before the relevant Addition Date,
with respect to Additional Contracts, the Servicer shall have instructed all
Obligors to make all payments in respect of the Contracts in the Asset Pool to
a Lock-Box or directly to a Lock-Box Account.

         (f) Establishment of the Collection Account. The Servicer shall cause
to be established, on or before the Closing Date, and maintained in the name
of the Deal Agent as agent for the Purchasers, with an office or branch of a
depository institution or trust company organized under the laws of the United
States of America or any one of the States thereof or the District of Columbia
(or any domestic branch of a foreign bank) a segregated corporate trust
account (the "Collection Account"); provided, however, that at all times such
depository institution or trust company shall be a depository institution
organized under the laws of the United States of America or any one of the
States thereof or the District of Columbia (or any domestic branch of a
foreign bank), (i) (A) which has either (1) a long-term unsecured debt rating
of A- or better by S&P and A-3 or better by Moody's or (2) a short-term
unsecured debt rating or certificate of deposit rating of A-1 or better by S&P
or P-1 or better by Moody's, (B) the parent corporation of which has either
(1) a long-term unsecured debt rating of A- or better by S&P and A-3 or better
by Moody's or (2) a short-term unsecured debt rating or certificate of deposit
rating of A-1 or better by S&P and P-1 or better by Moody's or (C) is
otherwise acceptable to the Deal Agent and (ii) whose deposits are insured by
the Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation (any such depository institution or
trust company, a "Qualified Institution").

                  Section 6.3       Servicer Advances.

         For each Monthly Period, if the Servicer determines that any
Scheduled Payment (or portion thereof) which was due and payable pursuant to a
Contract in the Asset Pool during such Monthly Period was not received prior
to the end of such Monthly Period, the Servicer may make an advance in an
amount up to the amount of such delinquent Scheduled Payment (or portion
thereof); in addition, if on any day there are not sufficient funds on deposit
in the Collection Account to pay accrued Yield of any Asset Interest the
Monthly Period of which ends on such day, the Servicer shall make an advance
in the amount necessary to pay such Yield (in either case, any such advance, a
"Servicer Advance"). Notwithstanding the preceding sentence, (i) the Servicer
shall be required to make a Servicer Advance with respect to any Contract if,
and only if, the Servicer determines (such determination to be conclusive and
binding) in good faith that such Servicer Advance will ultimately be
recoverable from future collections on, or the liquidation of, the Asset Pool
and payments under any Hedging Agreement, (ii) the Servicer's obligation to
make a Servicer Advance for any Contract shall cease on the day such Contract


                                      55
<PAGE>

becomes a Defaulted Contract or is charged-off pursuant to the Servicer's
Credit and Collection Policies and (iii) any successor Servicer, including the
Backup Servicer, will not be obligated to make any Servicer Advances. The
Servicer will deposit any Servicer Advances into the Collection Account on or
prior to 11:00 a.m. (Charlotte, North Carolina time) on the related Payment
Date, in immediately available funds.

                  Section 6.4       Realization Upon Defaulted Contract.

         The Servicer will use reasonable efforts to repossess or otherwise
comparably convert the ownership of any Equipment relating to a Defaulted
Contract and will act as sales and processing agent for Equipment which it
repossesses. The Servicer will follow such other practices and procedures as
it deems necessary or advisable and as are customary and usual in its
servicing of contracts and other actions by the Servicer in order to realize
upon such Equipment, which practices and procedures may include reasonable
efforts to enforce all obligations of Obligors and repossessing and selling
such Equipment at public or private sale in circumstances other than those
described in the preceding sentence. Without limiting the generality of the
foregoing, the Servicer may sell any such Equipment to the Servicer or its
Affiliates for a purchase price equal to the then fair market value thereof,
any such sale to be evidenced by a certificate of a Responsible Officer of the
Servicer delivered to the Deal Agent setting forth the Contract, the
Equipment, the sale price of the Equipment and certifying that such sale price
is the fair market value of such Equipment. In any case in which any such
Equipment has suffered damage, the Servicer will not expend funds in
connection with any repair or toward the repossession of such Equipment unless
it reasonably determines that such repair and/or repossession will increase
the Recoveries by an amount greater than the amount of such expenses. The
Servicer will remit to the Collection Account the Recoveries received in
connection with the sale or disposition of Equipment relating to a Defaulted
Contract.

                  Section 6.5       Maintenance of Insurance Policies.

         The Servicer will use its best efforts to ensure that each Obligor
maintains an Insurance Policy with respect to the related Equipment in an
amount at least equal to the sum of the Discounted Contract Balance of the
related Contract and shall ensure that each such Insurance Policy names the
Deal Agent, as agent for the Purchasers, as loss payee and as an insured
thereunder; provided that the Servicer, in accordance with its Credit and
Collection Policy, may allow Obligors to self-insure. Additionally, the
Servicer will require that each Obligor maintain property damage liability
insurance during the term of each Contract in amounts and against risks
customarily insured against by the Obligor on equipment owned by it. If an
Obligor fails to maintain property damage insurance, the Servicer may purchase
and maintain such insurance on behalf of, and at the expense of, the Obligor.
In connection with its activities as Servicer, the Servicer agrees to present,
on behalf of the Deal Agent as agent for the Purchasers, claims to the insurer
under each Insurance Policy and any such liability policy, and to settle,
adjust and compromise such claims, in each case, consistent with the terms of
each Contract. The Servicer's Insurance Policies with respect to the related
Equipment will insure against liability for personal injury and property
damage relating to such Equipment, will name the Deal Agent as agent for the
Purchasers as loss payee and as an insured thereunder and will contain a
breach of warranty clause.



                                      56
<PAGE>

                  Section 6.6       Representations and Warranties of Servicer.

         The Servicer represents and warrants to the Deal Agent, as agent for
the Purchasers, the Purchasers, the Collateral Custodian and Backup Servicer
that, as of the Closing Date and on each Addition Date, insofar as any of the
following affects the Servicer's ability to perform its obligations pursuant
to this Agreement in any material respect:

         (a) Organization and Good Standing. The Servicer is a corporation
duly organized, validly existing and in good standing under the laws of
Pennsylvania with all requisite corporate power and authority to own its
properties and to conduct its business as presently conducted and to enter
into and perform its obligations pursuant to this Agreement.

         (b) Due Qualification. The Servicer is qualified to do business as a
corporation, is in good standing, and has obtained all licenses and approvals
as required under the laws of all jurisdictions in which the ownership or
lease of its property and or the conduct of its business (other than the
performance of its obligations hereunder) requires such qualification,
standing, license or approval, except to the extent that the failure to so
qualify, maintain such standing or be so licensed or approved would not have
an adverse effect on the interests of the Seller or of the Purchasers. The
Servicer is qualified to do business as a corporation, is in good standing,
and has obtained all licenses and approvals as required under the laws of all
states in which the performance of its obligations pursuant to this Agreement
requires such qualification, standing, license or approval and where the
failure to qualify or obtain such license or approval would have material
adverse effect on its ability to perform hereunder.

         (c) Power and Authority. The Servicer has the corporate power and
authority to execute and deliver this Agreement and to carry out its terms.
The Servicer has duly authorized the execution, delivery and performance of
this Agreement by all requisite corporate action. The execution, delivery and
performance of this Agreement does not contravene the Servicer's Certificate
of Incorporation or by-laws.

         (d) No Violation. The consummation of the transactions contemplated
by, and the fulfillment of the terms of, this Agreement by the Servicer (with
or without notice or lapse of time) will not (i) conflict with, result in any
breach of any of the terms or provisions of, or constitute a default under,
the articles of incorporation or by-laws of the Servicer, or any term of any
agreement, indenture, mortgage, deed of trust or other instrument to which the
Servicer is a party or by which it or any of its property is bound, (ii)
result in the creation or imposition of any Lien upon any of its properties
pursuant to the terms of any such indenture, agreement, mortgage, deed of
trust or other instrument, or (iii) violate any law, regulation, order, writ,
judgment, injunction, decree, determination or award of any Governmental
Authority applicable to the Servicer or any of its properties.



                                      57
<PAGE>

         (e) No Consent. No consent, approval, authorization, order,
registration, filing, qualification, license or permit of or with any
Governmental Authority having jurisdiction over the Servicer or any of its
properties is required to be obtained by or with respect to the Servicer in
order for the Servicer to enter into this Agreement or perform its obligations
hereunder.

         (f) Binding Obligation. This Agreement constitutes a legal, valid and
binding obligation of the Servicer, enforceable against the Servicer in
accordance with its terms, except as such enforceability may be limited by (i)
applicable Insolvency Laws and (ii) general principles of equity (whether
considered in a suit at law or in equity).

         (g) No Proceeding. There are no proceedings or investigations pending
or threatened against the Servicer, before any Governmental Authority (i)
asserting the invalidity of this Agreement, (ii) seeking to prevent the
consummation of any of the transactions contemplated by this Agreement or
(iii) seeking any determination or ruling that might (in the reasonable
judgment of the Servicer) materially and adversely affect the performance by
the Servicer of its obligations under, or the validity or enforceability of,
this Agreement.

         (h) Reports Accurate. No Servicer Certificate, information, exhibit,
financial statement, document, book, record or report furnished or to be
furnished by the Servicer to the Deal Agent or a Purchaser in connection with
this Agreement is or will be inaccurate in any material respect as of the date
it is or shall be dated or (except as otherwise disclosed to the Deal Agent or
such Purchaser, as the case may be, at such time) as of the date so furnished,
and no such document contains or will contain any material misstatement of
fact or omits or shall omit to state a material fact or any fact necessary to
make the statements contained therein not misleading.

         Section 6.7       Representations and Warranties of Backup Servicer
                           and Collateral Custodian.

         Each of the Backup Servicer and the Collateral Custodian represents
and warrants to the Deal Agent, as agent for the Purchasers, and the
Purchasers that, as of the Closing Date and on each Addition Date, insofar as
any of the following affects the Backup Servicer's or the Collateral
Custodian's, as the case may be, ability to perform its obligations pursuant
to this Agreement in any material respect:

         (a) Organization and Good Standing. Harris Trust and Savings Bank is
an Illinois banking corporation duly organized, validly existing and in good
standing under the laws of the State of Illinois with all requisite corporate
power and authority to own its properties and to conduct its business as
presently conducted and to enter into and perform its obligations pursuant to
this Agreement.

         (b) Power and Authority. Each of the Backup Servicer and the
Collateral Custodian has the corporate power and authority to execute and
deliver this Agreement and to carry out its terms. Each of the Backup Servicer


                                      58
<PAGE>

and the Collateral Custodian has duly authorized the execution, delivery and
performance of this Agreement by all requisite corporate action.

         (c) No Violation. The consummation of the transactions contemplated
by, and the fulfillment of the terms of, this Agreement by the Backup Servicer
and the Collateral Custodian will not (i) conflict with, result in any breach
of any of the terms or provisions of, or constitute a default under, the
articles of incorporation or bylaws of the Backup Servicer or the Collateral
Custodian, or any term of any material agreement, indenture, mortgage, deed of
trust or other instrument to which the Backup Servicer or the Collateral
Custodian is a party or by which it or any of its property is bound, (ii)
result in the creation or imposition of any Lien upon any of its properties
pursuant to the terms of any such indenture, agreement, mortgage, deed of
trust or other instrument, or (iii) violate any law, regulation, order, writ,
judgment, injunction, decree, determination or award of any Governmental
Authority applicable to Harris Trust and Savings Bank or any of its properties
that might (in the reasonable judgment of the Backup Servicer or the
Collateral Custodian, as the case may be) materially and adversely affect the
performance by the Backup Servicer or the Collateral Custodian of its
obligations under, or the validity or enforceability of, this Agreement.

         (d) No Consent. No consent, approval, authorization, order,
registration, filing, qualification, license or permit (collectively, the
"Consents") of or with any Governmental Authority having jurisdiction over the
Backup Servicer or the Collateral Custodian or any of its respective
properties is required to be obtained by or with respect to the Backup
Servicer or the Collateral Custodian in order for the Backup Servicer or the
Collateral Custodian, as the case may be, to enter into this Agreement or
perform its obligations hereunder (except with respect to performance only,
such Consents as the Backup Servicer or the Collateral Custodian, as the case
may be, may need to obtain prior to the commencement of its performance of its
duties hereunder in the certain jurisdictions outside of Illinois, provided
that in lieu of obtaining for itself the requisite Consents, the Backup
Servicer or the Collateral Custodian, as the case may be, may and shall be
permitted to delegate the performance of its duties to parties having the
requisite Consents in such jurisdictions; provided, however, in the case of
such delegation of performance the Backup Servicer or the Collateral
Custodian, as the case may be, shall not be relieved of their responsibility
under this Agreement with respect to such duties).

         (e) Binding Obligation. This Agreement constitutes a legal, valid and
binding obligation of Harris Trust and Savings Bank, enforceable against the
Backup Servicer and the Collateral Custodian in accordance with its terms,
except as such enforceability may be limited by (i) applicable Insolvency Laws
and (ii) general principles of equity (whether considered in a suit at law or
in equity).

         (f) No Proceeding. There are no proceedings or investigations pending
or, to the best of its knowledge, threatened, against the Backup Servicer or
the Collateral Custodian, before any Governmental Authority (i) asserting the
invalidity of this Agreement, (ii) seeking to prevent the consummation of any
of the transactions contemplated by this Agreement or (iii) seeking any
determination or ruling that might (in the reasonable judgment of the Backup


                                      59
<PAGE>

Servicer or the Collateral Custodian, as the case may be) materially and
adversely affect the performance by the Backup Servicer or the Collateral
Custodian of its obligations under, or the validity or enforceability of, this
Agreement.



                  Section 6.8       Covenants of Servicer.

         The Servicer hereby covenants that:

         (a) Compliance with Law. The Servicer will comply with all laws and
regulations of any Governmental Authority applicable to the Servicer or the
Contracts in the Asset Pool and related Equipment and Contract Files or any
part thereof.

         (b) Obligations with Respect to Contracts; Modifications. The
Servicer will duly fulfill and comply with all obligations on the part of the
Seller to be fulfilled or complied with under or in connection with each
Contract in the Asset Pool and will do nothing to impair the rights of the
Deal Agent as agent for the Purchasers or of the Purchasers in, to and under
the Assets. The Servicer will perform such obligations under the Contracts in
the Asset Pool and will not change or modify the Contracts.

         (c) Preservation of Security Interest. The Servicer will execute and
file such financing and continuation statements and any other documents which
may be required by any law or regulation of any Governmental Authority to
preserve and protect fully the interest of the Deal Agent as agent for the
Purchasers in, to and under the Assets.

         (d) No Bankruptcy Petition. Prior to the date that is one year and
one day after the payment in full of all amounts owing in respect of all
outstanding commercial paper issued by VFCC, the Servicer will not institute
against the Seller or VFCC, or join any other Person in instituting against
the Seller or VFCC, any bankruptcy, reorganization, arrangement, insolvency or
liquidation proceedings or other similar proceedings under the laws of the
United States or any state of the United States. This Section 6.9(d) will
survive the termination of this Agreement.

                  Section 6.9       Covenants of Backup Servicer and Collateral
                                    Custodian.

         Each of the Backup Servicer and the Collateral Custodian hereby
covenants that:

         (a) Contract Files. The Collateral Custodian will not dispose of any
documents constituting the Contract Files in any manner which is inconsistent
with the performance of its obligations as the Collateral Custodian pursuant
to this Agreement and will not dispose of any Contract except as contemplated
by this Agreement.



                                      60
<PAGE>

         (b) Compliance with Law. Each of the Backup Servicer and the
Collateral Custodian will comply with all laws and regulations of any
Governmental Authority applicable to the Backup Servicer and the Collateral
Custodian.

         (c) No Bankruptcy Petition. Prior to the date that is one year and
one day after the payment in full of all amounts owing in respect of all
outstanding commercial paper issued by VFCC, neither the Backup Servicer nor
the Collateral Custodian will institute against the Seller or VFCC, or join
any other Person in instituting against the Seller or VFCC, any bankruptcy,
reorganization, arrangement, insolvency or liquidation proceedings or other
similar proceedings under the laws of the United States or any state of the
United States.
This Section 6.9(d) will survive the termination of this Agreement.

         (d) Location of Contract Files. The Contract Files shall remain at
all times in the possession of the Collateral Custodian at the address set
forth herein unless notice of a different address is given in accordance with
the terms hereof.

         (e) No Changes in Backup Servicer and Collateral Custodian Fee. The
Backup Servicer and Collateral Custodian will not make any changes to the fees
set forth in the Backup Servicer and Collateral Custodian Fee Letter without
the prior written approval of the Deal Agent.

                  Section 6.10      Servicing Compensation.

         As compensation for its servicing activities hereunder and
reimbursement for its expenses, the Servicer shall be entitled to receive a
servicing fee (the "Servicing Fee") in respect of each Monthly Period (or
portion thereof) equal to one-twelfth of the product of (A) the Servicing Fee
Rate and (B) the ADCB as on the most recent Determination Date, such Servicing
Fee to be payable monthly in arrears on each Payment Date to the extent of
funds available therefor pursuant to the provisions of Section 2.7, 2.8 or
2.9, as applicable.

                  Section 6.11      Custodial Compensation.

         As compensation for its custodial activities hereunder and
reimbursement for its expenses, the Collateral Custodian shall be entitled to
receive a custodial fee (the "Custodial Fee") as provided in the Backup
Servicer and Collateral Custodian Fee Letter.

                  Section 6.12      Payment of Certain Expenses by Servicer.

         The Servicer will be required to pay all expenses incurred by it in
connection with its activities under this Agreement, including fees and
disbursements of independent accountants, Taxes imposed on the Servicer,
expenses incurred in connection with payments and reports pursuant to this
Agreement, and all other fees and expenses not expressly stated under this
Agreement for the account of the Seller, but excluding Liquidation Expenses
incurred as a result of activities contemplated by Section 6.4. The Servicer


                                      61
<PAGE>

will be required to pay all reasonable fees and expenses owing to any bank or
trust company in connection with the maintenance of the Collection Account and
the Lock-Box Account. The Servicer shall be required to pay such expenses for
its own account and shall not be entitled to any payment therefor other than
the Servicing Fee.

                  Section 6.13      Reports.

         (a) Monthly Report. With respect to each Determination Date and the
related Monthly Period, the Servicer will provide to the Seller, the Deal
Agent and the Backup Servicer, on the related Reporting Date, a monthly
statement (a "Monthly Report"), signed by a Responsible Officer of the
Servicer and substantially in the form of Exhibit E.

         (b) Servicer's Certificate. Together with each Monthly Report, the
Servicer shall submit to the Purchaser a certificate (a "Servicer's
Certificate"), signed by a Responsible Officer of the Servicer and
substantially in the form of Exhibit F.

         (c) Financial Statements. The Servicer will submit to the Purchaser
and the Backup Servicer, within 45 days of the end of each of its fiscal
quarters, commencing February 15, 1998 unaudited financial statements
(including an analysis of delinquencies and losses for each fiscal quarter) as
of the end of each such fiscal quarter. The Servicer will submit to the
Purchaser, within 90 days of the end of each of its fiscal years, commencing
December 31, 1997 audited financial statements (including an analysis of
delinquencies and losses for each fiscal year describing the causes thereof
and sufficient to determine whether a Payout Event has occurred or is
reasonably likely to occur and otherwise reasonably satisfactory to the Deal
Agent) as of the end of each such fiscal year.

                  Section 6.14      Annual Statement as to Compliance.

         The Servicer will provide to the Deal Agent and the Backup Servicer,
on or prior to December 31 of each year, commencing December 31, 1997, an
annual report signed by a Responsible Officer of the Servicer certifying that
(a) a review of the activities of the Servicer, and the Servicer's performance
pursuant to this Agreement, for the period ending on the last day of the
immediately preceding fiscal year has been made under such Person's
supervision and (b) the Servicer has performed or has caused to be performed
in all material respects all of its obligations under this Agreement
throughout such year and no Servicer Default has occurred and is continuing
(or if a Servicer Default has so occurred and is continuing, specifying each
such event, the nature and status thereof and the steps necessary to remedy
such event, and, if a Servicer Default occurred during such year and no notice
thereof has been given to the Deal Agent, specifying such Servicer Default and
the steps taken to remedy such event).

                  Section 6.15      Annual Independent Public Accountant's
                                    Servicing Reports.

         The Servicer will cause a firm of nationally recognized independent
public accountants (who may also render other services to the Servicer) to
furnish to the Deal Agent and the Backup Servicer, on or prior to September 30


                                      62
<PAGE>

of each year, commencing September 30, 1998, (i) a report relating to the
previous fiscal year to the effect that (A) such firm has reviewed certain
documents and records relating to the servicing of the Contracts in the Asset
Pool, and (B) based on such examination, such firm is of the opinion that the
Monthly Reports for such year were prepared in compliance with this Agreement,
except for such exceptions as it believes to be immaterial and such other
exceptions as will be set forth in such firm's report and (ii) a report
covering the preceding fiscal year to the effect that such accountants have
applied certain agreed-upon procedures to certain documents and records
relating to the servicing of Contracts under this Agreement, compared the
information contained in the Servicer's Certificates delivered during the
period covered by such report with such documents and records and that no
matters came to the attention of such accountants that caused them to believe
that such servicing was not conducted in compliance with this Article VI of
this Agreement, except for such exceptions as such accountants shall believe
to be immaterial and such other exceptions as shall be set forth in such
statement. In the event such firm requires the Backup Servicer to agree to the
procedures performed by such firm, the Servicer shall direct the Backup
Servicer in writing to so agree; it being understood and agreed that the
Backup Servicer will deliver such letter of agreement in conclusive reliance
upon the direction of the Servicer, and the Backup Servicer makes no
independent inquiry or investigation as to, and shall have no obligation or
liability in respect of, the sufficiency, validity or correctness of such
procedures.

                  Section 6.16      Adjustments.

         If (i) the Servicer makes a deposit into the Collection Account in
respect of a Collection of a Contract in the Asset Pool and such Collection
was received by the Servicer in the form of a check which is not honored for
any reason or (ii) the Servicer makes a mistake with respect to the amount of
any Collection and deposits an amount that is less than or more than the
actual amount of such Collection, the Servicer shall appropriately adjust the
amount subsequently deposited into the Collection Account to reflect such
dishonored check or mistake. Any Scheduled Payment in respect of which a
dishonored check is received shall be deemed not to have been paid.

                  Section 6.17      Merger or Consolidation of the Servicer.

         The Servicer shall not consolidate with or merge into any other
Person or convey or transfer its properties and assets substantially as an
entirety to any Person, unless the Servicer is the surviving entity and
unless:

                  (i) the Servicer has delivered to the Deal Agent and the
         Backup Servicer an Officer's Certificate and an Opinion of Counsel
         each stating that any consolidation, merger, conveyance or transfer
         and such supplemental agreement comply with this Section 6.17 and
         that all conditions precedent herein provided for relating to such
         transaction have been complied with and, in the case of the Opinion
         of Counsel, that such supplemental agreement is legal, valid and
         binding with respect to the Servicer and such other matters as the
         Deal Agent may reasonably request;



                                      63
<PAGE>

                  (ii) the Servicer shall have delivered notice of such
         consolidation, merger, conveyance or transfer to the Deal Agent; and

                  (iii) after giving effect thereto, no Payout Event or event
         which with notice or lapse of time would constitute a Payout Event
         shall have occurred.

                  Section 6.18      Limitation on Liability of the Servicer
                                    and Others.

         Except as provided herein, neither the Servicer nor any of the
directors or officers or employees or agents of the Servicer shall be under
any liability to the Deal Agent, the Purchasers or any other Person for any
action taken or for refraining from the taking of any action pursuant to this
Agreement whether arising from express or implied duties under this Agreement;
provided, however, that this provision shall not protect the Servicer or any
such Person against any liability which would otherwise be imposed by reason
of its willful misfeasance, bad faith or gross negligence in the performance
of duties or by reason of its willful misconduct hereunder.

                  Section 6.19      Indemnification of the Seller, the Backup
                                    Servicer, the Collateral Custodian, the
                                    Deal Agent and the Purchasers.

         The Servicer shall indemnify and hold harmless the Seller, the Backup
Servicer, the Collateral Custodian, the Deal Agent, the Liquidity Agent and
each Purchaser and their respective officers, directors, employees and agents
(collectively, the "Indemnified Persons") from and against any loss,
liability, expense, damage or injury suffered or sustained by any Indemnified
Person by reason of any acts, omissions or alleged acts or omissions of the
Servicer, including, but not limited to any judgment, award, settlement,
reasonable attorneys' fees and other costs or expenses incurred in connection
with the defense of any actual or threatened action, proceeding or claim, but
excluding allocations of overhead expenses of any such Indemnified Party or
other non-monetary damages of any such Indemnified Party. Notwithstanding the
foregoing, the Servicer shall not indemnify an Indemnified Person if such
loss, liability, expense, damage or injury results or arises (i) as a result
of fraud, gross negligence or breach of fiduciary duty by such Indemnified
Person; and (ii) under any Tax law, including without limitation any federal,
state or local income or franchise taxes or any other Tax imposed on or
measured by income (or any interest or penalties with respect thereto or
arising from a failure to comply therewith) required to be paid by the Seller,
the Backup Servicer, the Collateral Custodian, the Deal Agent, the Liquidity
Agent or the Purchasers in connection herewith to any taxing authority. The
provisions of this indemnity shall run directly to and be enforceable by an
injured party subject to the limitations hereof. If the Servicer has made any
indemnity payment pursuant to this Section 8.1 and such payment fully
indemnified the recipient thereof and the recipient thereafter collects any
payments from others in respect of such Indemnified Amounts, the recipient
shall repay to the Servicer an amount equal to the amount it has collected
from others in respect of such indemnified amounts.



                                      64
<PAGE>

         If for any reason the indemnification provided above in this Section
6.19 is unavailable to the Indemnified Person or is insufficient to hold an
Indemnified Person harmless, then Servicer shall contribute to the amount paid
or payable by such Indemnified Person as a result of such loss, claim, damage
or liability in such proportion as is appropriate to reflect not only the
relative benefits received by such Indemnified Person on the one hand and
Servicer on the other hand but also the relative fault of such Indemnified
Person as well as any other relevant equitable considerations.

         The parties hereto agree that the provisions of this Section 6.19
shall not be interpreted to provide recourse to the Seller against loss by
reason of the bankruptcy or insolvency (or other credit condition) of, or
default by, related Obligor on, any Pool Asset.

         Any indemnification pursuant to this Section shall not be payable
from the Assets.

         The obligations of the Servicer under this Section 6.19 shall survive
the resignation or removal of the Deal Agent, the Liquidity Agent, the Backup
Servicer or the Collateral Custodian and the termination of this Agreement.

                  Section 6.20      The Servicer Not to Resign.

         The Servicer shall not resign from the obligations and duties hereby
imposed on it except upon the Servicer's determination that (i) the
performance of its duties hereunder is or becomes impermissible under
applicable law and (ii) there is no reasonable action which the Servicer could
take to make the performance of its duties hereunder permissible under
applicable law. Any such determination permitting the resignation of the
Servicer shall be evidenced as to clause (i) above by an Opinion of Counsel to
such effect delivered to the Deal Agent and the Backup Servicer. No such
resignation shall become effective until a Successor Servicer shall have
assumed the responsibilities and obligations of the Servicer in accordance
with Section 6.25.

                  Section 6.21      Access to Certain Documentation and
                                    Information Regarding the Contracts.

         The Collateral Custodian shall provide to the Deal Agent access to
the Contract Files and all other documentation regarding the Contracts in the
Asset Pool and the related Equipment in such cases where the Deal Agent is
required in connection with the enforcement of the rights or interests of the
Purchasers, or by applicable statutes or regulations to review such
documentation, such access being afforded without charge but only (i) upon two
business days prior written request, (ii) during normal business hours and
(iii) subject to the Servicer's and Collateral Custodian's normal security and
confidentiality procedures. Prior to the Closing Date and periodically
thereafter at the discretion of the Deal Agent, the Deal Agent may review the
Servicer's collection and administration of the Contracts in order to assess
compliance by the Servicer with the Servicer's written policies and
procedures, as well as with this Agreement and may conduct an audit of the
Contracts and Contract Files in conjunction with such a review. Such review
shall be reasonable in scope and shall be completed in a reasonable period of
time.



                                      65
<PAGE>

                  Section 6.22      Backup Servicer.

         (a) On or before the date on which the initial Purchase occurs, until
the receipt by the Servicer of a Termination Notice, the Backup Servicer shall
perform, on behalf of the Deal Agent and the Purchaser, the following duties
and obligations:

                  (i) On or before the Closing Date, the Backup Servicer shall
         accept from the Servicer delivery of the information required to be
         set forth in the Monthly Reports in hard copy and on computer tape;
         provided, however, the computer tape is in an MS-DOS, PC readable
         ASCII format or format to be agreed upon by the Backup Servicer and
         the Servicer on or prior to closing.

                  (ii) Not later than 12:00 noon New York time two Business
         Days prior to each Reporting Date, the Backup Servicer shall accept
         delivery of tape from the Servicer, which shall include but not be
         limited to the following information: the name, number and name of
         the related Lessee for each Contract, the collection status, the
         contract status, the principal balance and the ADCB (the "Tape").

         The Servicer shall provide, or cause the Subservicer to provide, the
Tape on each Reporting Date as described above.

         (b) On or before the date on which the initial Purchase occurs, and
until the receipt by the Servicer of a Termination Notice, the Backup Servicer
shall perform, on behalf of the Purchaser and the Deal Agent, the following
duties and obligations:

                  (i) Prior to the related Payment Date, the Backup Servicer
         shall review the Monthly Report to ensure that it is complete on its
         face and that the following items in such Monthly Report have been
         accurately calculated, if applicable, and reported: (A) the ADCB, (B)
         the Backup Servicing Fee, (C) the Average ADCB, (D) the accounts that
         are 30-60 days past due, (E) the accounts that are 61-90 days past
         due, (E) the accounts that are 90+ days past due, (F) the accounts
         that are Defaulted Contracts, (G) the Delinquency Ratio and (H) the
         Default Ratio. The Backup Servicer shall notify the Deal Agent and
         the Servicer of any disagreements with the Monthly Report based on
         such review not later than the Business Day preceding such Payment
         Date to such Persons.

                  (ii) If the Servicer disagrees with the report provided
         under paragraph (i) above by the Backup Servicer or if the Servicer
         or any subservicer has not reconciled such discrepancy, the Backup
         Servicer agrees to confer with the Servicer to resolve such
         disagreement on or prior to the next succeeding Determination Date
         and shall settle such discrepancy with the Servicer if possible, and
         notify the Deal Agent of the resolution thereof. The Servicer hereby
         agrees to cooperate at its own expense, with the Backup Servicer in
         reconciling any discrepancies herein. If within 20 days after the
         delivery of the report provided under paragraph (i) above by the


                                      66
<PAGE>

         Backup Servicer, such discrepancy is not resolved, the Backup
         Servicer shall promptly notify the Deal Agent of the continued
         existence of such discrepancy. Following receipt of such notice by
         the Deal Agent, the Servicer shall deliver to the Deal Agent, the
         Purchasers, and the Backup Servicer no later than the related Payment
         Date a certificate describing the nature and amount of such
         discrepancies and the actions the Servicer proposes to take with
         respect thereto.

         With respect to the foregoing, the Backup Servicer, in the
performance of its duties and obligations hereunder, is entitled to rely
conclusively, and shall be fully protected in so relying, on the contents of
each Tape, including, but not limited to, the completeness and accuracy
thereof, provided by the Servicer.

         (c) After the receipt of an effective Termination Notice by the
Servicer in accordance with this Agreement, all authority, power, rights and
responsibilities of the Servicer, under this Agreement, whether with respect
to the Contracts or otherwise shall pass to and be vested in the Backup
Servicer, subject to and in accordance with the provisions of Section 6.25, as
long as the Backup Servicer is not prohibited by an applicable provision of
law from fulfilling the same, as evidenced by an Opinion of Counsel.

         (d) Any Person (i) into which the Backup Servicer may be merged or
consolidated, (ii) which may result from any merger or consolidation to which
the Backup Servicer shall be a party, or (iii) which may succeed to the
properties and assets of the Backup Servicer substantially as a whole, which
Person in any of the foregoing cases executes an agreement of assumption to
perform every obligation of the Backup Servicer hereunder, shall be the
successor to the Backup Servicer under this Agreement without further act on
the part of any of the parties to this Agreement.

         (e) As compensation for its back-up servicing obligations hereunder,
the Backup Servicer shall be entitled to receive the Backup Servicing Fee in
respect of each Monthly Period (or portion thereof) until the first to occur
of the date on which the Backup Servicer becomes a Successor Servicer, resigns
or is removed as Backup Servicer or termination of this Agreement.

         (f) The Backup Servicer may resign at any time by not less than 120
days notice to the Deal Agent, the Liquidity Agent, the Servicer, the Seller
and the Originator. In addition, the Backup Servicer may be removed without
cause by the Deal Agent by notice then given in writing to the Servicer, the
Seller and the Backup Servicer. In the event of any such resignation or
removal, the Backup Servicer may be replaced by (i) the Servicer, acting with
the consent of the Deal Agent or (ii) if no such replacement is appointed
within 30 days following such removal or resignation, by the Deal Agent.

         (g) The Backup Servicer undertakes to perform only such duties and
obligations as are specifically set forth in this Agreement, it being
expressly understood by all parties hereto that there are no implied duties or
obligations of the Backup Servicer hereunder. Without limiting the generality
of the foregoing, the Backup Servicer, except as expressly set forth herein,


                                      67
<PAGE>

shall have no obligation to supervise, verify, monitor or administer the
performance of the Servicer. The Backup Servicer may act through its agents,
attorneys and custodians in performing any of its duties and obligations under
this Agreement, it being understood by the parties hereto that the Backup
Servicer will be responsible for any misconduct or negligence on the part of
such agents, attorneys or custodians acting on the routine and ordinary
day-to-day operations for and on behalf of the Backup Servicer. Neither the
Backup Servicer nor any of its officers, directors, employees or agents shall
be liable, directly or indirectly, for any damages or expenses arising out of
the services performed under this Agreement other than damages or expenses
which result from the gross negligence or willful misconduct of it or them or
the failure to perform materially in accordance with this Agreement.

         (h) The Backup Servicer shall not be liable for any obligation of the
Servicer contained in this Agreement or for any errors of the Servicer
contained in any computer tape, certificate or other data or document
delivered to the Backup Servicer hereunder or on which the Backup Servicer
must rely in order to perform its obligations hereunder, and the Seller,
Purchaser, Deal Agent, Liquidity Agent, Collateral Custodian and Backup
Servicer, shall look only to the Servicer to perform such obligations. The
Backup Servicer, and the Collateral Custodian shall have no responsibility and
shall not be in default hereunder or incur any liability for any failure,
error, malfunction or any delay in carrying out any of their respective duties
under this Agreement if such failure or delay results from the Backup Servicer
acting in accordance with information prepared or supplied by a Person other
than the Backup Servicer or the failure of any such other Person to prepare or
provide such information. The Backup Servicer shall have no responsibility,
shall not be in default and shall incur no liability for (i) any act or
failure to act of any third party, including the Servicer (ii) any inaccuracy
or omission in a notice or communication received by the Backup Servicer from
any third party, (iii) the invalidity or unenforceability of any Asset or
Contract under applicable law, (iv) the breach or inaccuracy of any
representation or warranty made with respect to any Asset, Contract or any
item of Equipment, or (v) the acts or omissions of any successor Backup
Servicer.

                  Section 6.23      Identification of Records.

         The Servicer shall clearly and unambiguously identify each Contract
in the Asset Pool and the related Equipment in its computer or other records
to reflect that such Contracts and Equipment have been transferred to and are
owned by the Seller and that an interest therein has been transferred by the
Seller pursuant to this Agreement.

                  Section 6.24      Servicer Defaults.

         If any one of the following events (a "Servicer Default") shall occur
and be continuing:

         (a) any failure by the Servicer to make any payment, transfer or
deposit or to give instructions or notice to the Deal Agent as required by
this Agreement including, without limitation, while Fidelity is Servicer, any
payment required to be made under the Backup Servicer and Collateral Custodian
Fee Letter, or to deliver any required Monthly Report or other Required


                                      68
<PAGE>

Reports hereunder on or before the date occurring two Business Days after the
date such payment, transfer, deposit, instruction of notice or report is
required to be made or given, as the case may be, under the terms of this
Agreement;

         (b) any failure on the part of the Servicer duly to observe or
perform in any material respect any other covenants or agreements of the
Servicer set forth in this Agreement or the Purchase Agreement which has a
material adverse effect on the Purchasers, which continues unremedied for a
period of 30 days after the first to occur of (i) the date on which written
notice of such failure requiring the same to be remedied shall have been given
to the Servicer by the Deal Agent and (ii) the date on which the Servicer
becomes aware thereof;

         (c) any representation, warranty or certification made by the
Servicer in this Agreement or in any certificate delivered pursuant to this
Agreement shall prove to have been incorrect when made, which has a material
adverse effect on the Purchasers and which continues to be unremedied for a
period of 30 days after the first to occur of (i) the date on which written
notice of such incorrectness requiring the same to be remedied shall have been
given to the Servicer by the Deal Agent and (ii) the date on which the
Servicer becomes aware thereof;

         (d) an Insolvency Event shall occur with respect to the Servicer;

         (e) any material delegation of the Servicer's duties which is not
permitted by Section 7.1;

         (f) any financial or Asset information reasonably requested by the
Deal Agent or the Purchaser as provided herein is not reasonably provided as
requested;

         (g) the rendering against the Servicer of a final judgment, decree or
order for the payment of money in excess of U.S. $1,000,000 and the
continuance of such judgment, decree or order unsatisfied and in effect for
any period of 61 consecutive days without a stay of execution;

         (h) the failure of the Servicer to make any payment due with respect
to aggregate recourse debt or other obligations with an aggregate principal
amount exceeding U.S. $1,000,000 or the occurrence of any event or condition
which would permit acceleration of such recourse debt or other obligations if
such event or condition has not been waived;

         (i) any change in the management of the Servicer relating to the
positions of President, CEO, Chairman of the Board and Executive Vice
President; or

         (j) any change in the control of the Servicer which takes the form of
either a merger or consolidation in which the Servicer is not the surviving
entity.

Notwithstanding anything herein to the contrary, so long as any such Servicer
Default shall not have been remedied, the Deal Agent, by written notice to the
Servicer (with a copy to the Backup Servicer) (a "Termination Notice"), may
terminate all of the rights and obligations of the Servicer as Servicer under
this Agreement.



                                      69
<PAGE>

                  Section 6.25      Appointment of Successor Servicer.

         (a) On and after the receipt by the Servicer of a Termination Notice
pursuant to Section 6.24, the Servicer shall continue to perform all servicing
functions under this Agreement until the date specified in the Termination
Notice or otherwise specified by the Deal Agent in writing or, if no such date
is specified in such Termination Notice or otherwise specified by the Deal
Agent, until a date mutually agreed upon by the Servicer and the Deal Agent.
The Deal Agent may at the time described in the immediately preceding sentence
in its sole discretion, appoint the Backup Servicer as the Servicer hereunder,
and the Backup Servicer shall on such date assume all obligations of the
Servicer hereunder, and all authority and power of the Servicer under this
Agreement shall pass to and be vested in the Backup Servicer; provided,
however, that the Successor Servicer shall not (i) be responsible or liable
for any past actions or omissions of the outgoing Servicer or (ii) be
obligated to make Servicer Advances. In the event that the Deal Agent does not
so appoint the Backup Servicer, there is no Backup Servicer or the Backup
Servicer is unwilling or unable to assume such obligations on such date, the
Deal Agent shall as promptly as possible appoint a successor servicer (the
Backup Servicer or any such other successor, the "Successor Servicer"), and
such Successor Servicer shall accept its appointment by a written assumption
in a form acceptable to the Deal Agent. If the Deal Agent within 60 days of
receipt of a Termination Notice is unable to obtain any bids from Eligible
Servicers and the Servicer delivers an Officer's Certificate to the effect
that it cannot in good faith cure the Servicer Default which gave rise to a
transfer of servicing, then the Deal Agent shall offer the Seller the right to
accept retransfer of all the Assets and the Seller may accept re-transfer of
all the Assets, provided, however, that if the long-term unsecured debt
obligations of the Seller are not rated at the time of such purchase at least
investment grade by each rating agency providing a rating in respect of such
long-term unsecured debt obligations, no such re-transfer shall occur unless
the Seller shall deliver an Opinion of Counsel reasonably acceptable to the
Deal Agent that such re-transfer would not constitute a fraudulent conveyance
of the Seller. The amount to be paid and deposited in respect of such
re-transfer shall be equal to the sum of the Capital outstanding plus all
Yield that has accrued thereon and that will accrue thereon. In the event that
a Successor Servicer has not been appointed and has not accepted its
appointment at the time when the Servicer ceases to act as Servicer, the Deal
Agent shall petition a court of competent Jurisdiction to appoint any
established financial institution having a net worth of not less than U.S.
$50,000,000 and whose regular business includes the servicing of Contracts as
the Successor Servicer hereunder.

         (b) Upon its appointment, the Backup Servicer (subject to Section
6.25(a)) or the Successor Servicer, as applicable, shall be the successor in
all respects to the Servicer with respect to servicing functions under this
Agreement and shall be subject to all the responsibilities, duties and
liabilities relating thereto placed on the Servicer by the terms and
provisions hereof, and all references in this Agreement to the Servicer shall
be deemed to refer to the Backup Servicer or the Successor Servicer, as
applicable.



                                      70
<PAGE>

         (c) All authority and power granted to the Servicer under this
Agreement shall automatically cease and terminate upon termination of this
Agreement and shall pass to and be vested in the Seller and, without
limitation, the Seller is hereby authorized and empowered to execute and
deliver, on behalf of the Servicer, as attorney-in-fact or otherwise, all
documents and other instruments, and to do and accomplish all other acts or
things necessary or appropriate to effect the purposes of such transfer of
servicing rights. The Servicer agrees to cooperate with the Seller in
effecting the termination of the responsibilities and rights of the Servicer
to conduct servicing on the Contracts in the Asset Pool.

         (d) Upon the Backup Servicer receiving notice that it is required to
serve as the Servicer hereunder pursuant to the foregoing provisions of this
Section 6.25, the Backup Servicer will promptly begin the transition to its
role as Servicer.

         (e) The Backup Servicer shall be entitled to receive its reasonable
costs incurred in transitioning to Servicer.

                  Section 6.26      Notification.

         Upon the Servicer becoming aware of the occurrence of any Servicer
Default, the Servicer shall promptly give written notice thereof to the Deal
Agent and the Backup Servicer.

                  Section 6.27      Protection of Right, Title and Interest
                                    to Assets.

         (a) The Servicer shall cause this Agreement, all amendments hereto
and/or all financing statements and continuation statements and any other
necessary documents covering the right, title and interest of the Deal Agent
as agent for the Purchaser and of the Purchasers to the Assets to be promptly
recorded, registered and filed, and at all times to be kept recorded,
registered and filed, all in such manner and in such places as may be required
by law fully to preserve and protect the right, title and interest of the Deal
Agent as agent for the Purchasers hereunder to all property comprising the
Assets. The Servicer shall deliver to the Deal Agent file-stamped copies of,
or filing receipts for, any document recorded, registered or filed as provided
above, as soon as available following such recording, registration or filing.
The Seller shall cooperate fully with the Servicer in connection with the
obligations set forth above and will execute any and all documents reasonably
required to fulfill the intent of this subsection 6.27(a).

         (b) The Servicer will give the Deal Agent at least 30 days' prior
written notice of any relocation of any office from which it services
Contracts in the Asset Pool or keeps the Contract Files or of its principal
executive office and whether, as a result of such relocation, the applicable
provisions of the UCC or any other applicable law governing the perfection of
interests in property would require the filing of any amendment of any
previously filed financing or continuation statement or of any new financing
statement and shall file such financing statements or amendments as may be
necessary to continue the perfection of the security interest of the Deal
Agent as agent for the Purchasers in the Contracts in the Asset Pool and the
proceeds thereof. The Servicer will at all times maintain each office from
which it services Contracts in the Asset Pool within the United States of
America.



                                      71
<PAGE>

                  Section 6.28      Release of Contract Files.

         The Seller may, with the prior written consent of the Deal Agent
(such consent not to be unreasonably withheld), require that the Collateral
Custodian release each Contract File (a) delivered to the Collateral Custodian
in error, (b) for which a Substitute Contract has been substituted in
accordance with Section 2.16, (c) as to which the lien on the related
Equipment has been so released pursuant to Section 5.3, (d) which has been
retransferred to the Seller pursuant to Section 5.5 or 5.6, or (e) which is
required to be redelivered to the Seller in connection with the termination of
this Agreement, in each case by submitting to the Collateral Custodian and the
Deal Agent a written request in the form of Exhibit H hereto (signed by both
the Seller and the Deal Agent) specifying the Contracts to be so released and
reciting that the conditions to such release have been met (and specifying the
section or sections of this Agreement being relied upon for such release). The
Collateral Custodian shall upon its receipt of each such request for release
executed by the Seller and the Deal Agent promptly, but in any event within 5
Business Days, release the Contract Files so requested to the Seller.

                                  ARTICLE VII

                         PAYOUT AND RESTRICTING EVENTS

                  Section 7.1       Payout Events.

         If any of the following events ("Payout Events") shall occur:

         (a) as of any Reporting Date, the Delinquency Ratio for the preceding
Determination Date exceeds 3.0%;

         (b) as of any Reporting Date, the Default Ratio for the preceding
Determination Date exceeds 2.75%;

         (c) the passage of 60 days following receipt by the Purchaser of a
written notification of the Seller's intent to terminate the revolving period;

         (d) a Restricting Event has occurred.

                  Section 7.2       Restricting Events.

         If any of the following events ("Restricting Events") shall occur:

         (a) as of any Reporting Date, the Delinquency Ratio for the preceding
Determination Date exceeds 4.0%;



                                      72
<PAGE>

         (b) as of any Reporting Date, the Default Ratio for the preceding
Determination Date exceeds 3.25%;

         (c) the Termination Date shall have occurred;

         (d) the level of Capital exceeds the Capital Limit and the Seller
does not, within one Business Day, contribute Eligible Contracts and/or cash
collateral sufficient to cause the Capital to comply with the Capital Limit;

         (e) the Seller is not in compliance with the Portfolio Concentration
Criteria, and such noncompliance is not cured within 5 Business Days;

         (f) a Servicer Default occurs and is continuing;

         (g) (i) failure on the part of the Seller to make any payment or
         deposit required by the terms of this Agreement on the day such
         payment or deposit is required to be made or

                  (ii) failure on the part of the Seller to observe or perform
         any of its covenants or agreements set forth in this Agreement, which
         failure has a material adverse effect on the interests of the Deal
         Agent, any Purchaser, the Liquidity Agent or any Investor and which
         continues unremedied for a period of 30 days or more after written
         notice to Seller; provided, that only a five Business Day cure period
         shall apply in the case of a failure by the Seller to observe its
         covenants not to grant a security interest or otherwise intentionally
         create a Lien on the Contracts;

         (h) any representation or warranty made by the Seller in this
Agreement or any information required to be given by the Seller to the Deal
Agent to identify Contracts pursuant to this Agreement, shall prove to have
been incorrect in any material respect when made or delivered and which
continues to be incorrect in any material respect for a period of 30 days
after written notice or actual knowledge thereof;

         (i) the occurrence of an Insolvency Event relating to the Originator,
the Seller or the Servicer;

         (j) the Seller shall become an "investment company" within the
meaning of the Investment Company Act of 1940, as amended (the "40 Act") or
the arrangements contemplated by this Agreement shall require registration as
an `investment company" within the meaning of the 40 Act;

         (k) a regulatory, tax or accounting body has ordered that the
activities of the Seller or any Affiliate of the Seller, contemplated hereby
be terminated or, as a result of any other event or circumstance, the
activities of the Seller contemplated hereby may reasonably be expected to
cause the Seller or any of its respective Affiliates to suffer materially
adverse regulatory, accounting or tax consequences; or



                                      73
<PAGE>

         (l) on any day, less than 100% of the Capital is subject to Hedging
Agreements.

then, and in any such event, the Termination Date shall be deemed to have
occurred automatically upon the occurrence of such event. Upon any such
occurrence, the Deal Agent and the Purchasers shall have, in addition to all
other rights and remedies under this Agreement or otherwise, all other rights
and remedies provided under the UCC of the applicable jurisdiction and other
applicable laws, which rights shall be cumulative.


                                 ARTICLE VIII

                                INDEMNIFICATION

                  Section 8.1       Indemnities by the Seller.

         Without limiting any other rights which the Deal Agent, the Backup
Servicer, the Collateral Custodian, the Liquidity Agent, the Purchasers or any
of their respective Affiliates may have hereunder or under applicable law, the
Seller hereby agrees to indemnify the Deal Agent, the Backup Servicer, the
Collateral Custodian, the Liquidity Agent, the Purchasers, and each of their
respective Affiliates and officers, directors, employees and agents thereof
from and against any and all damages, losses, claims, liabilities and related
costs and expenses, including reasonable attorneys' fees and disbursements
(all of the foregoing being collectively referred to as "Indemnified Amounts")
awarded against or incurred by, but excluding allocations of overhead expenses
of any such Indemnified Party or other non-monetary damages of any such
Indemnified Party any of them arising out of or as a result of this Agreement
or the ownership of the Asset Interest or in respect of any Asset or any
Contract, excluding, however, (a) Indemnified Amounts to the extent resulting
from negligence or willful misconduct on the part of the Deal Agent, the
Backup Servicer, the Collateral Custodian, the Liquidity Agent, such Purchaser
or such Affiliate and (b) recourse (except with respect to payment and
performance of obligations provided for in this Agreement) for Defaulted
Contracts. If the Seller has made any indemnity payment pursuant to this
Section 8.1 and such payment fully indemnified the recipient thereof and the
recipient thereafter collects any payments from others in respect of such
Indemnified Amounts then, the recipient shall repay to the Seller an amount
equal to the amount it has collected from others in respect of such
indemnified amounts. Without limiting the foregoing, the Seller shall
indemnify the Deal Agent, the Backup Servicer, the Collateral Custodian, the
Liquidity Agent, the Purchasers and each of their respective Affiliates and
officers, directors, employees and agents thereof for Indemnified Amounts
relating to or resulting from:

                  (i) any Purchased Asset treated as or represented by the
         Seller to be an Eligible Contract which is not at the applicable time
         an Eligible Contract;



                                      74
<PAGE>

                  (ii) reliance on any representation or warranty made or
         deemed made by the Seller, the Servicer (if the Originator or one of
         its Affiliates) or any of their respective officers under or in
         connection with this Agreement, which shall have been false or
         incorrect in any material respect when made or deemed made or
         delivered;

                  (iii) the failure by the Seller or the Servicer (if the
         Originator or one of its Affiliates) to comply with any term,
         provision or covenant contained in this Agreement or any agreement
         executed in connection with this Agreement, or with any applicable
         law, rule or regulation with respect to any Asset, the related
         Contract, or the nonconformity of any Asset, the related Contract
         with any such applicable law, rule or regulation;

                  (iv) the failure to vest and maintain vested in the relevant
         Purchaser or to transfer to such Purchaser, an undivided ownership
         interest in the Assets, together with all Collections, free and clear
         of any Adverse Claim whether existing at the time of any Purchase or
         at any time thereafter;

                  (v) the failure to maintain, as of the close of business on
         each Business Day prior to the Termination Date, an amount of Capital
         outstanding which is less than or equal to the lesser of (x) the
         Purchase Limit on such Business Day, or (y) the Capital Limit on such
         Business Day;

                  (vi) the failure to file, or any delay in filing, financing
         statements or other similar instruments or documents under the UCC of
         any applicable jurisdiction or other applicable laws with respect to
         any Assets which are, or are purported to be, Pool Assets, whether at
         the time of any Purchase or at any subsequent time;

                  (vii) any dispute, claim, offset or defense (other than the
         discharge in bankruptcy of the Obligor) of the Obligor to the payment
         of any Asset which is, or is purported to be, a Purchased Asset
         (including, without limitation, a defense based on such Asset or the
         related Contract not being a legal, valid and binding obligation of
         such Obligor enforceable against it in accordance with its terms), or
         any other claim resulting from the sale of the merchandise or
         services related to such Asset or the furnishing or failure to
         furnish such merchandise or services;

                  (viii) any failure of the Seller or the Servicer (if the
         Originator or one of its Affiliates) to perform its duties or
         obligations in accordance with the provisions of this Agreement or
         any failure by the Originator, the Seller or any Affiliate thereof to
         perform its respective duties under the Contracts;

                  (ix) any products liability claim or personal injury or
         property damage suit or other similar or related claim or action of
         whatever sort arising out of or in connection with merchandise or
         services which are the subject of any Asset or Contract;



                                      75
<PAGE>

                  (x) the failure by Seller to pay when due any Taxes for
         which the Seller is liable, including without limitation, sales,
         excise or personal property taxes payable in connection with the Pool
         Assets;

                  (xi) any repayment by the Deal Agent, the Liquidity Agent or
         a Purchaser of any amount previously distributed in reduction of
         Capital or payment of Yield or any other amount due hereunder, in
         each case which amount the Deal Agent, the Liquidity Agent or a
         Purchaser believes in good faith is required to be repaid;

                  (xii) the commingling of Collections of Pool Assets at any
         time with other funds;

                  (xiii) any investigation, litigation or proceeding related
         to this Agreement or the use of proceeds of Purchases or
         reinvestments or the ownership of the Asset Interest or in respect of
         any Asset or Contract;

                  (xiv) any failure by the Seller to give reasonably
         equivalent value to the Originator in consideration for the transfer
         by the Originator to the Seller of any Assets or any attempt by any
         Person to void or otherwise avoid any such transfer under any
         statutory provision or common law or equitable action, including,
         without limitation, any provision of the Bankruptcy Code; or

                  (xv) the failure of the Seller, the Originator or any of
         their respective agents or representatives to remit to the Servicer
         or the Deal Agent, Collections of Pool Assets remitted to the Seller
         or any such agent or representative.

Any amounts subject to the indemnification provisions of this Section 8.1
shall be paid by the Seller solely pursuant to the provisions of Sections 2.7,
2.8 and 2.9 hereof as the case may be to the Deal Agent within two Business
Days following the Deal Agent's demand therefor.

         If for any reason the indemnification provided above in this Section
8.1 is unavailable to the Indemnified Person or is insufficient to hold an
Indemnified Person harmless, then Servicer shall contribute to the amount paid
or payable by such Indemnified Person as a result of such loss, claim, damage
or liability in such proportion as is appropriate to reflect not only the
relative benefits received by such Indemnified Person on the one hand and the
Seller on the other hand but also the relative fault of such Indemnified
Person as well as any other relevant equitable considerations.

         The parties hereto agree that the provisions of Section 8.1 shall not
be interpreted to provide recourse to the Seller against loss by reason of the
bankruptcy or insolvency (or other credit condition) of, or default by,
related Obligor on, any Pool Asset.



                                      76
<PAGE>

                                  ARTICLE IX

                    THE DEAL AGENT AND THE LIQUIDITY AGENT

                  Section 9.1       Authorization and Action.

         (a) Each Purchaser hereby designates and appoints the Deal Agent as
Deal Agent hereunder, and authorizes the Deal Agent to take such actions as
agent on its behalf and to exercise such powers as are delegated to the Deal
Agent by the terms of this Agreement together with such powers as are
reasonably incidental thereto. The Deal Agent shall not have any duties or
responsibilities, except those expressly set forth herein, or any fiduciary
relationship with any Purchaser, and no implied covenants, functions,
responsibilities, duties, obligations or liabilities on the part of the Deal
Agent shall be read into this Agreement or otherwise exist for the Deal Agent.
In performing its functions and duties hereunder, the Deal Agent shall act
solely as agent for the Purchasers and does not assume nor shall be deemed to
have assumed any obligation or relationship of trust or agency with or for the
Seller or any of its successors or assigns. The Deal Agent shall not be
required to take any action which exposes the Deal Agent to personal liability
or which is contrary to this Agreement or applicable law. The appointment and
authority of the Deal Agent hereunder shall terminate at the indefeasible
payment in full of the Aggregate Unpaids.

         (b) Each Investor hereby designates and appoints FUNB as Liquidity
Agent hereunder, and authorizes the Liquidity Agent to take such actions as
agent on its behalf and to exercise such powers as are delegated to the
Liquidity Agent by the terms of this Agreement together with such powers as
are reasonably incidental thereto. The Liquidity Agent shall not have any
duties or responsibilities, except those expressly set forth herein, or any
fiduciary relationship with any Investor, and no implied covenants, functions,
responsibilities, duties, obligations or liabilities on the part of the
Liquidity Agent shall be read into this Agreement or otherwise exist for the
Liquidity Agent. In performing its functions and duties hereunder, the
Liquidity Agent shall act solely as agent for the Investors and does not
assume nor shall be deemed to have assumed any obligation or relationship of
trust or agency with or for the Seller or any of its successors or assigns.
The Liquidity Agent shall not be required to take any action which exposes the
Liquidity Agent to personal liability or which is contrary to this Agreement
or applicable law. The appointment and authority of the Liquidity Agent
hereunder shall terminate at the indefeasible payment in full of the Aggregate
Unpaids.

                  Section 9.2       Delegation of Duties.

         (a) The Deal Agent may execute any of its duties under this Agreement
by or through agents or attorneys-in-fact and shall be entitled to advice of
counsel concerning all matters pertaining to such duties. The Deal Agent shall
not be responsible for the negligence or misconduct of any agents or
attorneys-in-fact selected by it with reasonable care.



                                      77
<PAGE>

         (b) The Liquidity Agent may execute any of its duties under this
Agreement by or through agents or attorneys-in-fact and shall be entitled to
advice of counsel concerning all matters pertaining to such duties. The
Liquidity Agent shall not be responsible for the negligence or misconduct of
any agents or attorneys-in-fact selected by it with reasonable care.

                  Section 9.3       Exculpatory Provisions.

         (a) Neither the Deal Agent nor any of its directors, officers, agents
or employees shall be (i) liable for any action lawfully taken or omitted to
be taken by it or them under or in connection with this Agreement (except for
its, their or such Person's own gross negligence or willful misconduct or, in
the case of the Deal Agent, the breach of its obligations expressly set forth
in this Agreement), or (ii) responsible in any manner to any of the Purchasers
for any recitals, statements, representations or warranties made by the Seller
contained in this Agreement or in any certificate, report, statement or other
document referred to or provided for in, or received under or in connection
with, this Agreement for the value, validity, effectiveness, genuineness,
enforceability or sufficiency of this Agreement or any other document
furnished in connection herewith, or for any failure of the Seller to perform
its obligations hereunder, or for the satisfaction of any condition specified
in Article III. The Deal Agent shall not be under any obligation to any
Purchaser to ascertain or to inquire as to the observance or performance of
any of the agreements or covenants contained in, or conditions of, this
Agreement, or to inspect the properties, books or records of the Seller. The
Deal Agent shall not be deemed to have knowledge of any Payout Event unless
the Deal Agent has received notice from the Seller or a Purchaser.

         (b) Neither the Liquidity Agent nor any of its directors, officers,
agents or employees shall be (i) liable for any action lawfully taken or
omitted to be taken by it or them under or in connection with this Agreement
(except for its, their or such Person's own gross negligence or willful
misconduct or, in the case of the Liquidity Agent, the breach of its
obligations expressly set forth in this Agreement), or (ii) responsible in any
manner to the Deal Agent or any of the Purchasers for any recitals,
statements, representations or warranties made by the Seller contained in this
Agreement or in any certificate, report, statement or other document referred
to or provided for in, or received under or in connection with, this Agreement
or for the value, validity, effectiveness, genuineness, enforceability or
sufficiency of this Agreement or any other document furnished in connection
herewith, or for any failure of the Seller to perform its obligations
hereunder, or for the satisfaction of any condition specified in Article III.
The Liquidity Agent shall not be under any obligation to the Deal Agent or any
Purchaser to ascertain or to inquire as to the observance or performance of
any of the agreements or covenants contained in, or conditions of, this
Agreement, or to inspect the properties, books or records of the Seller. The
Liquidity Agent shall not be deemed to have knowledge of any Payout Event
unless the Liquidity Agent has received notice from the Seller, the Deal Agent
or a Purchaser.



                                      78
<PAGE>

                  Section 9.4       Reliance.

         (a) The Deal Agent shall in all cases be entitled to rely, and shall
be fully protected in relying, upon any document or conversation believed by
it to be genuine and correct and to have been signed, sent or made by the
proper Person or Persons and upon advice and statements of legal counsel
(including, without limitation, counsel to the Seller), independent
accountants and other experts selected by the Deal Agent. The Deal Agent shall
in all cases be fully justified in failing or refusing to take any action
under this Agreement or any other document furnished in connection herewith
unless it shall first receive such advice or concurrence of VFCC or the
Required Investors or all of the Purchasers, as applicable, as it deems
appropriate or it shall first be indemnified to its satisfaction by the
Purchasers, provided that unless and until the Deal Agent shall have received
such advice, the Deal Agent may take or refrain from taking any action, as the
Deal Agent shall deem advisable and in the best interests of the Purchasers.
The Deal Agent shall in all cases be fully protected in acting, or in
refraining from acting, in accordance with a request of VFCC or the Required
Investors or all of the Purchasers, as applicable, and such request and any
action taken or failure to act pursuant thereto shall be binding upon all the
Purchasers.

         (b) The Liquidity Agent shall in all cases be entitled to rely, and
shall be fully protected in relying, upon any document or conversation
believed by it to be genuine and correct and to have been signed, sent or made
by the proper Person or Persons and upon advice and statements of legal
counsel (including, without limitation, counsel to the Seller), independent
accountants and other experts selected by the Liquidity Agent. The Liquidity
Agent shall in all cases be fully justified in failing or refusing to take any
action under this Agreement or any other document furnished in connection
herewith unless it shall first receive such advice or concurrence of Required
Investors as it deems appropriate or it shall first be indemnified to its
satisfaction by the Investors, provided that unless and until the Liquidity
Agent shall have received such advice, the Liquidity Agent may take or refrain
from taking any action, as the Liquidity Agent shall deem advisable and in the
best interests of the Investors. The Liquidity Agent shall in all cases be
fully protected in acting, or in refraining from acting, in accordance with a
request of the Required Investors and such request and any action taken or
failure to act pursuant thereto shall be binding upon all the Investors.

                  Section 9.5       Non-Reliance on Deal Agent, Liquidity
                                    Agent and Other Purchasers.

         Each Purchaser expressly acknowledges that neither the Deal Agent,
the Liquidity Agent nor any of their respective officers, directors,
employees, agents, attorneys-in-fact or affiliates has made any
representations or warranties to it and that no act by the Deal Agent or the
Liquidity Agent hereafter taken, including, without limitation, any review of
the affairs of the Seller, shall be deemed to constitute any representation or
warranty by the Deal Agent or the Liquidity Agent. Each Purchaser represents
and warrants to the Deal Agent and to the Liquidity Agent that it has and
will, independently and without reliance upon the Deal Agent, the Liquidity
Agent or any other Purchaser and based on such documents and information as it


                                      79
<PAGE>

has deemed appropriate, made its own appraisal of and investigation into the
business, operations, property, prospects, financial and other conditions and
creditworthiness of the Seller and made its own decision to enter into this
Agreement.

                  Section 9.6       Reimbursement and Indemnification.

         The Investors agree to reimburse and indemnify VFCC, the Deal Agent,
the Liquidity Agent and each of their respective officers, directors,
employees, representatives and agents ratably according to their pro rata
shares, to the extent not paid or reimbursed by the Seller (i) for any amounts
for which VFCC, the Liquidity Agent, acting in its capacity as Liquidity
Agent, or the Deal Agent, acting in its capacity as Deal Agent, is entitled to
reimbursement by the Seller hereunder and (ii) for any other expenses incurred
by VFCC, the Liquidity Agent, acting in its capacity as Liquidity Agent, or
the Deal Agent, in its capacity as Deal Agent and acting on behalf of the
Purchasers, in connection with the administration and enforcement of this
Agreement.

                  Section 9.7       Deal Agent and Liquidity Agent in their 
                                    Individual Capacities.

         The Deal Agent, the Liquidity Agent and each of their respective
Affiliates may make loans to, accept deposits from and generally engage in any
kind of business with the Seller or any Affiliate of the Seller as though the
Deal Agent or the Liquidity Agent, as the case may be, were not the Deal Agent
or the Liquidity Agent, as the case may be, hereunder. With respect to the
acquisition of Asset Interests pursuant to this Agreement, the Deal Agent, the
Liquidity Agent and each of their respective Affiliates shall have the same
rights and powers under this Agreement as any Purchaser and may exercise the
same as though it were not the Deal Agent or the Liquidity Agent, as the case
may be, and the terms "Investor," "Purchaser," "Investors" and "Purchasers"
shall include the Deal Agent or the Liquidity Agent, as the case may be, in
its individual capacity.

                  Section 9.8       Successor Deal Agent or Liquidity Agent.

         (a) The Deal Agent may, upon 5 days' notice to the Seller and the
Purchasers, and the Deal Agent will, upon the direction of all of the
Purchasers (other than the Deal Agent, in its individual capacity) resign as
Deal Agent. If the Deal Agent shall resign, then the Required Investors during
such 5-day period shall appoint from among the Purchasers a successor agent.
If for any reason no successor Deal Agent is appointed by the Required
Investors during such 5-day period, then effective upon the expiration of such
5-day period, the Purchasers shall perform all of the duties of the Deal Agent
hereunder and the Seller shall make all payments in respect of the Aggregate
Unpaids or under any fee letter delivered by the Originator to the Deal Agent
and the Purchasers directly to the applicable Purchaser and for all purposes
shall deal directly with the Purchasers. After any retiring Deal Agent's
resignation hereunder as Deal Agent, the provisions of this Article VIII and
Article IX shall inure to its benefit as to any actions taken or omitted to be
taken by it while it was Deal Agent under this Agreement.



                                      80
<PAGE>

         (b) The Liquidity Agent may, upon 5 days' notice to the Seller, the
Deal Agent and the Investors, and the Liquidity Agent will, upon the direction
of all of the Investors (other than the Liquidity Agent, in its individual
capacity) resign as Liquidity Agent. If the Liquidity Agent shall resign, then
the Required Investors during such 5-day period shall appoint from among the
Investors a successor Liquidity Agent. If for any reason no successor
Liquidity Agent is appointed by the Required Investors during such 5-day
period, then effective upon the expiration of such 5-day period, the Investors
shall perform all of the duties of the Liquidity Agent hereunder and all
payments in respect of the Aggregate Unpaids. After any retiring Liquidity
Agent's resignation hereunder as Liquidity Agent, the provisions of this
Article VIII and Article IX shall inure to its benefit as to any actions taken
or omitted to be taken by it while it was Liquidity Agent under this
Agreement.


                                   ARTICLE X

                          ASSIGNMENTS; PARTICIPATIONS

                  Section 10.1      Assignments and Participations.

         (a) Each Investor may upon at least 30 days' notice to VFCC, the Deal
Agent, the Liquidity Agent and S&P and Moody's, assign to one or more banks or
other entities all or a portion of its rights and obligations under this
Agreement; provided, however, that (i) each such assignment shall be of a
constant, and not a varying percentage of all of the assigning Investor's
rights and obligations under this Agreement, (ii) the amount of the Commitment
of the assigning Investor being assigned pursuant to each such assignment
(determined as of the date of the Assignment and Acceptance with respect to
such assignment) shall in no event be less than the lesser of (A) $15,000,000
or an integral multiple of $1,000,000 in excess of that amount and (B) the
full amount of the assigning Investor's Commitment, (iii) each such assignment
shall be to an Eligible Assignee, (iv) the parties to each such assignment
shall execute and deliver to the Deal Agent, for its acceptance and recording
in the Register, an Assignment and Acceptance, together with a processing and
recordation fee of $3,500 or such lesser amount as shall be approved by the
Deal Agent, (v) the parties to each such assignment shall have agreed to
reimburse the Deal Agent, the Liquidity Agent and VFCC for all fees, costs and
expenses (including, without limitation, the reasonable fees and out-of-pocket
expenses of counsel for each of the Deal Agent, the Liquidity Agent and VFCC)
incurred by the Deal Agent, the Liquidity Agent and VFCC, respectively, in
connection with such assignment and (vi) there shall be no increased costs,
expenses or taxes incurred by the Deal Agent, the Liquidity Agent or VFCC upon
such assignment or participation, and provided further that upon the effective
date of such assignment the provisions of Section 3.03(f) of the
Administration Agreement shall be satisfied. Upon such execution, delivery and
acceptance by the Deal Agent and the Liquidity Agent and the recording by the
Deal Agent, from and after the effective date specified in each Assignment and
Acceptance, which effective date shall be the date of acceptance thereof by
the Deal Agent and the Liquidity Agent, unless a later date is specified
therein, (i) the assignee thereunder shall be a party hereto and, to the
extent that rights and obligations hereunder have been assigned to it pursuant


                                      81
<PAGE>

to such Assignment and Acceptance, have the rights and obligations of an
Investor hereunder and (ii) the Investor assignor thereunder shall, to the
extent that rights and obligations hereunder have been assigned by it pursuant
to such Assignment and Acceptance, relinquish its rights and be released from
its obligations under this Agreement (and, in the case of an Assignment and
Acceptance covering all or the remaining portion of an assigning Investor's
rights and obligations under this Agreement, such Investor shall cease to be a
party hereto).

         (b) By executing and delivering an Assignment and Acceptance, the
Investor assignor thereunder and the assignee thereunder confirm to and agree
with each other and the other parties hereto as follows: (i) other than as
provided in such Assignment and Acceptance, such assigning Investor makes no
representation or warranty and assumes no responsibility with respect to any
statements, warranties or representations made in or in connection with this
Agreement or the execution, legality, validity, enforceability, genuineness,
sufficiency or value of this Agreement or any other instrument or document
furnished pursuant hereto; (ii) such assigning Investor makes no
representation or warranty and assumes no responsibility with respect to the
financial condition of VFCC or the performance or observance by VFCC of any of
its obligations under this Agreement or any other instrument or document
furnished pursuant hereto; (iii) such assignee confirms that it has received a
copy of this Agreement, together with copies of such financial statements and
other documents and information as it has deemed appropriate to make its own
credit analysis and decision to enter into such Assignment and Acceptance;
(iv) such assignee will, independently and without reliance upon the Deal
Agent or the Liquidity Agent, such assigning Investor or any other Investor
and based on such documents and information as it shall deem appropriate at
the time, continue to make its own credit decisions in taking or not taking
action under this Agreement; (v) such assigning Investor and such assignee
confirm that such assignee is an Eligible Assignee; (vi) such assignee
appoints and authorizes each of the Deal Agent and the Liquidity Agent to take
such action as agent on its behalf and to exercise such powers under this
Agreement as are delegated to such agent by the terms hereof, together with
such powers as are reasonably incidental thereto; and (vii) such assignee
agrees that it will perform in accordance with their terms all of the
obligations which by the terms of this Agreement are required to be performed
by it as an Investor.

         (c) The Deal Agent shall maintain at its address referred to herein a
copy of each Assignment and Acceptance delivered to and accepted by it and a
register for the recordation of the names and addresses of the Investors and
the Commitment of, and the Capital of, each Asset interest owned by each
investor from time to time (the "Register"). The entries in the Register shall
be conclusive and binding for all purposes, absent manifest error, and VFCC,
the Seller and the Investors may treat each Person whose name is recorded in
the Register as an Investor hereunder for all purposes of this Agreement. The
Register shall be available for inspection by VFCC, the Liquidity Agent or any
Investor at any reasonable time and from time to time upon reasonable prior
notice.

         (d) Subject to the provisions of Section 10.1(a), upon its receipt of
an Assignment and Acceptance executed by an assigning Investor and an
assignee, the Deal Agent and the Liquidity Agent shall each, if such
Assignment and Acceptance has been completed and is in substantially the form


                                      82
<PAGE>

of Exhibit D hereto, accept such Assignment and Acceptance, and the Deal Agent
shall then (i) record the information contained therein in the Register and
(ii) give prompt notice thereof to VFCC.

         (e) Each Investor may sell participations to one or more banks or
other entities in or to all or a portion of its rights and obligations under
this Agreement (including, without limitation, all or a portion of its
Commitment and each Asset Interest owned by it); provided, however, that (i)
such Investor's obligations under this Agreement (including, without
limitation, its Commitment hereunder) shall remain unchanged, (ii) such
Investor shall remain solely responsible to the other parties hereto for the
performance of such obligations and (iii) the Deal Agent and the other
Investors shall continue to deal solely and directly with such Investor in
connection with such Investor's rights and obligations under this Agreement,
and provided further that the Deal Agent shall have confirmed that upon the
effective date of such participation the provisions of Section 3.03(f) of the
Administration Agreement shall be satisfied. Notwithstanding anything herein
to the contrary, each participant shall have the rights of an Investor
(including any right to receive payment) under Sections 2.12 and 2.13;
provided, however, that no participant shall be entitled to receive payment
under either such Section in excess of the amount that would have been payable
under such Section by the Seller to the Investor granting its participation
had such participation not been granted, and no Investor granting a
participation shall be entitled to receive payment under either such Section
in an amount which exceeds the sum of (i) the amount to which such Investor is
entitled under such Section with respect to any portion of any Asset Interest
owned by such Investor which is not subject to any participation plus (ii) the
aggregate amount to which its participants are entitled under such Sections
with respect to the amounts of their respective participations. With respect
to any participation described in this Section 10.1, the participant's rights
as set forth in the agreement between such participant and the applicable
Investor to agree to or to restrict such Investor's ability to agree to any
modification, waiver or release of any of the terms of this Agreement or to
exercise or refrain from exercising any powers or rights which such Investor
may have under or in respect of this Agreement shall be limited to the right
to consent to any of the matters set forth in Section 11.1 of this Agreement.

         (f) Each Investor may, in connection with any assignment or
participation or proposed assignment or participation pursuant to this Section
10.1, disclose to the assignee or participant or proposed assignee or
participant any information relating to the Seller or VFCC furnished to such
Investor by or on behalf of the Seller or VFCC.

         (g) In the event (i) an Investor ceases to qualify as an Eligible
Assignee, or (ii) an Investor makes demand for compensation pursuant to
Section 2.12 or Section 2.13, VFCC may, and, upon the direction of the Seller
and prior to the occurrence of a Restricting Event, shall, in any such case,
notwithstanding any provision to the contrary herein, replace such Investor
with an Eligible Assignee by giving three Business Days' prior written notice
to such Investor. In the event of the replacement of an Investor, such
Investor agrees (i) to assign all of its rights and obligations hereunder to
an Eligible Assignee selected by VFCC upon payment to such Investor of the
amount of such Investor's Asset Interests together with any accrued and unpaid


                                      83
<PAGE>

Yield thereon, all accrued and unpaid commitment fees owing to such Investor
and all other amounts owing to such Investor hereunder and (ii) to execute and
deliver an Assignment and Acceptance and such other documents evidencing such
assignment as shall be necessary or reasonably requested by VFCC or the Deal
Agent. In the event that any Investor ceases to qualify as an Eligible
Assignee, such affected Investor agrees (1) to give the Deal Agent, the Seller
and VFCC prompt written notice thereof and (2) subject to the following
proviso, to reimburse the Deal Agent, the Liquidity Agent, the Seller, VFCC
and the relevant assignee for all fees, costs and expenses (including, without
limitation, the reasonable fees and out-of-pocket expenses of counsel for each
of the Deal Agent, the Liquidity Agent, the Seller and VFCC and such assignee)
incurred by the Deal Agent, the Liquidity Agent, the Seller, VFCC and such
assignee, respectively, in connection with any assignment made pursuant to
this Section 10.1(g) by such affected Investor; provided, however, that such
affected Investor's liability for such costs, fees and expenses shall be
limited to the amount of any up-front fees paid to such affected Investor at
the time that it became a party to this Agreement.

         (h) Nothing herein shall prohibit any Investor from pledging or
assigning as collateral any of its rights under this Agreement to any Federal
Reserve Bank in accordance with applicable law and any such pledge or
collateral assignment may be made without compliance with Section 10.1(a) or
Section 10.1(b).

         (i) In the event any Investor causes increased costs, expenses or
taxes to be incurred by the Deal Agent, Liquidity Agreement or VFCC in
connection with the assignment or participation of such Investor's rights and
obligations under this Agreement to an Eligible Assignee then such Investor
agrees that it will make reasonable efforts to assign such increased costs,
expenses or taxes to such Eligible Assignee in accordance with the provisions
of this Agreement.

                                  ARTICLE XI

                                 MISCELLANEOUS

                  Section 11.1      Amendments and Waivers.

         (a) Except as provided in this Section 11.1, no amendment, waiver or
other modification of any provision of this Agreement shall be effective
without the written agreement of the Seller, the Deal Agent and the Required
Investors; provided, however, that no such amendment, waiver or modification
affecting the rights or obligations of any Hedge Counterparty, the Backup
Servicer or the Collateral Custodian shall be effective as against the Backup
Servicer and/or the Collateral Custodian, as the case may be, without the
written agreement of such Persons. Any waiver or consent shall be effective
only in the specific instance and for the specific purpose for which given.



                                      84
<PAGE>

         (b) No amendment, waiver or other modification of this Agreement
shall:

                  (i) without the consent of each affected Purchaser, (A)
         extend the Commitment Termination Date or the date of any payment or
         deposit of Collections by the Seller or the Servicer, (B) reduce the
         rate or extend the time of payment of Yield (or any component
         thereof), (C) reduce any fee payable to the Deal Agent for the
         benefit of the Purchasers, (D) except pursuant to Article X hereof,
         change the amount of the Capital of any Purchaser, an Investor's pro
         rata share or an Investor's Commitment, (E) amend, modify or waive
         any provision of the definition of Required Investors or this Section
         11.1(b), (F) consent to or permit the assignment or transfer by the
         Seller of any of its rights and obligations under this Agreement or
         (G) amend or modify any defined term (or any defined term used
         directly or indirectly in such defined term) used in clauses (A)
         through (E) above in a manner which would circumvent the intention of
         the restrictions set forth in such clauses; or

                  (ii) without the written consent of the Deal Agent, amend,
         modify or waive any provision of this Agreement if the effect thereof
         is to affect the rights or duties of such Agent.

         (c) Notwithstanding the foregoing provisions of this Section 11.1,
without the consent of the Investors, the Deal Agent may, with the consent of
the Seller amend this Agreement solely to add additional Persons as Investors
hereunder. Any modification or waiver shall apply to each of the Purchasers
equally and shall be binding upon the Seller, the Purchasers and the Deal
Agent.

                  Section 11.2      Notices, Etc.

         All notices and other communications provided for hereunder shall,
unless otherwise stated herein, be in writing (including telex communication
and communication by facsimile copy) and mailed, telexed, transmitted or
delivered, as to each party hereto, at its address set forth under its name on
the signature pages hereof or specified in such party's Assignment and
Acceptance or at such other address as shall be designated by such party in a
written notice to the other parties hereto. All such notices and
communications shall be effective, upon receipt, or in the case of (a) notice
by mail, five days after being deposited in the United States mail, first
class postage prepaid, (b) notice by telex, when telexed against receipt of
answer back, or (c) notice by facsimile copy, when verbal communication of
receipt is obtained, except that notices and communications pursuant to
Article 11 shall not be effective until received with respect to any notice
sent by mail or telex.

                  Section 11.3      Ratable Payments.

         If any Purchaser, whether by setoff or otherwise, has payment made to
it with respect to any portion of the Aggregate Unpaids owing to such
Purchaser (other than payments received pursuant to Section 8.1 in a greater
proportion than that received by any other Purchaser), such Purchaser agrees,


                                      85
<PAGE>

promptly upon demand, to purchase for cash without recourse or warranty a
portion of the Aggregate Unpaids held by the other Purchasers so that after
such purchase each Purchaser will hold its ratable proportion of the Aggregate
Unpaids; provided, however, that if all or any portion of such excess amount
is thereafter recovered from such Purchaser, such purchase shall be rescinded
and the purchase price restored to the extent of such recovery, but without
interest.

                  Section 11.4      No Waiver, Rights and Remedies.

         No failure on the part of the Deal Agent, the Collateral Custodian,
the Backup Servicer or a Purchaser to exercise, and no delay in exercising,
any right or remedy hereunder shall operate as a waiver thereof; nor shall any
single or partial exercise of any right or remedy hereunder preclude any other
or further exercise thereof or the exercise of any other right. The rights and
remedies herein provided are cumulative and not exclusive of any rights and
remedies provided by law.

                  Section 11.5      Binding Effect.

         This Agreement shall be binding upon and inure to the benefit of the
Seller, the Deal Agent, the Backup Servicer, the Collateral Custodian, the
Purchasers and their respective successors and permitted assigns.

                  Section 11.6      Term of this Agreement.

         This Agreement, including, without limitation, the Seller's
obligation to observe its covenants set forth in Article V, and the Servicer's
obligation to observe its covenants set forth in Article VI, shall remain in
full force and effect until the Collection Date; provided, however, that the
rights and remedies with respect to any breach of any representation and
warranty made or deemed made by the Seller pursuant to Articles III and IV and
the indemnification and payment provisions of Article VIII and Article IX and
the provisions of Section 11.9 and Section 11.10 shall be continuing and shall
survive any termination of this Agreement.

         Section 11.7      GOVERNING LAW; CONSENT TO JURISDICTION; WAIVER OF
                           OBJECTION TO VENUE.

         THIS AGREEMENT SHALL BE GOVERNED BY, AND CONSTRUED IN ACCORDANCE
WITH, THE LAWS OF THE STATE OF NEW YORK. EACH OF THE PURCHASERS, THE SELLER,
THE LIQUIDITY AGENT AND THE DEAL AGENT HEREBY AGREES TO THE NON-EXCLUSIVE
JURISDICTION OF ANY FEDERAL COURT LOCATED WITHIN THE STATE OF NEW YORK. EACH
OF THE PARTIES HERETO HEREBY WAIVES ANY OBJECTION BASED ON FORUM NON
CONVENIENS, AND ANY OBJECTION TO VENUE OF ANY ACTION INSTITUTED HEREUNDER IN
ANY OF THE AFOREMENTIONED COURTS AND CONSENTS TO THE GRANTING OF SUCH LEGAL OR
EQUITABLE RELIEF AS IS DEEMED APPROPRIATE BY SUCH COURT.



                                      86
<PAGE>

                  Section 11.8      WAIVER OF JURY TRIAL.

         TO THE EXTENT PERMITTED BY APPLICABLE LAW, EACH OF THE PURCHASERS,
THE SELLER AND THE DEAL AGENT WAIVES ANY RIGHT TO HAVE A JURY PARTICIPATE IN
RESOLVING ANY DISPUTE, WHETHER SOUNDING IN CONTRACT, TORT, OR OTHERWISE
BETWEEN THE PARTIES HERETO ARISING OUT OF, CONNECTED WITH, RELATED TO, OR
INCIDENTAL TO THE RELATIONSHIP BETWEEN ANY OF THEM IN CONNECTION WITH THIS
AGREEMENT OR THE TRANSACTIONS CONTEMPLATED HEREBY. INSTEAD, ANY SUCH DISPUTE
RESOLVED IN COURT WILL BE RESOLVED IN A BENCH TRIAL WITHOUT A JURY.

                  Section 11.9      Costs, Expenses and Taxes.

         (a) In addition to the rights of indemnification granted to the Deal
Agent, the Liquidity Agent, the Backup Servicer, the Collateral Custodian, the
Purchasers and its or their Affiliates and officers, directors, employees and
agents thereof under Article VIII hereof, the Seller agrees to pay on demand
all costs and expenses of the Deal Agent, the Liquidity Agent, the Backup
Servicer, the Collateral Custodian and the Purchasers incurred in connection
with the preparation, execution, delivery, administration (including periodic
auditing), amendment or modification of, or any waiver or consent issued in
connection with, this Agreement and the other documents to be delivered
hereunder or in connection herewith, including, without limitation, the
reasonable fees and out-of-pocket expenses of counsel for the Deal Agent, the
Liquidity Agent, the Backup Servicer, the Collateral Custodian and the
Purchasers with respect thereto and with respect to advising the Deal Agent,
the Liquidity Agent, the Backup Servicer, the Collateral Custodian and the
Purchasers as to their respective rights and remedies under this Agreement and
the other documents to be delivered hereunder or in connection herewith, and
all costs and expenses, if any (including reasonable counsel fees and
expenses), incurred by the Deal Agent, the Liquidity Agent, the Backup
Servicer, the Collateral Custodian or the Purchasers in connection with the
enforcement of this Agreement and the other documents to be delivered
hereunder or in connection herewith.

         (b) The Seller shall pay on demand any and all stamp, sales, excise
and other taxes and fees payable or determined to be payable in connection
with the execution, delivery, filing and recording of this Agreement, the
other documents to be delivered hereunder or any agreement or other document
providing liquidity support, credit enhancement or other similar support to
the Purchaser in connection with this Agreement or the funding or maintenance
of Purchases hereunder.

         (c) The Seller shall pay on demand all other costs, expenses and
Taxes (excluding income taxes) incurred by any Issuer or any shareholder of
such Issuer ("Other Costs"), including, without limitation, all costs and
expenses incurred by the Deal Agent in connection with periodic audits of the


                                      87
<PAGE>

Seller's or the Servicer's books and records and the cost of rating such
Issuer's commercial paper with respect to financing its purchase of Asset
Interests hereunder by independent financial rating agencies.

                  Section 11.10     No Proceedings.

         Each of the Seller, the Deal Agent, the Liquidity Agent, the
Servicer, the Backup Servicer, the Collateral Custodian and the Purchasers
hereby agrees that it will not institute against, or join any other Person in
instituting against VFCC any proceedings of the type referred to in Section
6.8(d) and 6.9(c) so long as any commercial paper issued by VFCC shall be
outstanding and there shall not have elapsed one year and one day since the
last day on which any such commercial paper shall have been outstanding.

                  Section 11.11     Recourse Against Certain Parties.

         No recourse under or with respect to any obligation, covenant or
agreement (including, without limitation, the payment of any fees or any other
obligations) of any Purchaser as contained in this Agreement or any other
agreement, instrument or document entered into by it pursuant hereto or in
connection herewith shall be had against any administrator of such Purchaser
or any incorporator, affiliate, stockholder, officer, employee or director of
such Purchaser or of any such administrator, as such, by the enforcement of
any assessment or by any legal or equitable proceeding, by virtue of any
statute or otherwise; it being expressly agreed and understood that the
agreements of such Purchaser contained in this Agreement and all of the other
agreements, instruments and documents entered into by it pursuant hereto or in
connection herewith are, in each case, solely the corporate obligations of
such Purchaser, and that no personal liability whatsoever shall attach to or
be incurred by any administrator of such Purchaser or any incorporator,
stockholder, affiliate, officer, employee or director of such Purchaser or of
any such administrator, as such, or any other of them, under or by reason of
any of the obligations, covenants or agreements of such Purchaser contained in
this Agreement or in any other such instruments, documents or agreements, or
which are implied therefrom, and that any and all personal liability of every
such administrator of such Purchaser and each incorporator, stockholder,
affiliate, officer, employee or director of such Purchaser or of any such
administrator, or any of them, for breaches by such Purchaser of any such
obligations, covenants or agreements, which liability may arise either at
common law or at equity, by statute or constitution, or otherwise, is hereby
expressly waived as a condition of and in consideration for the execution of
this Agreement. The provisions of this Section 11.11 shall survive the
termination of this Agreement.

         Section 11.12        Protection of Ownership Interests of the
                              Purchasers; Intent of Parties; Security
                              Interest; Third Party Beneficiary.

         (a) The Seller agrees that from time to time, at its expense, it will
promptly execute and deliver all instruments and documents, and take all
actions, that may reasonably be necessary or desirable, or that the Deal Agent
may reasonably request, to perfect, protect or more fully evidence the Asset


                                      88
<PAGE>

Interests and the undivided ownership interest in the Assets in the Asset Pool
represented by such Asset Interests, or to enable the Deal Agent or the
Purchasers to exercise and enforce their rights and remedies hereunder.

         (b) If the Seller or the Servicer fails to perform any of its
obligations hereunder after five Business Days' notice from the Deal Agent,
the Deal Agent or any Purchaser may (but shall not be required to) perform, or
cause performance of, such obligation; and the Deal Agent's or such
Purchaser's costs and expenses incurred in connection therewith shall be
payable by the Seller (if the Servicer that fails to so perform is the Seller
or an Affiliate thereof) as provided in Article VIII, as applicable. The
Seller irrevocably authorizes the Deal Agent and appoints the Deal Agent as
its attorney-in-fact to act on behalf of the Seller (i) to execute on behalf
of the Seller as debtor and to file financing statements necessary or
desirable in the Deal Agent's sole discretion to perfect and to maintain the
perfection and priority of the interest of the Purchasers in the Assets and
(ii) to file a carbon, photographic or other reproduction of this Agreement or
any financing statement with respect to the Assets as a financing statement in
such offices as the Deal Agent in its sole discretion deems necessary or
desirable to perfect and to maintain the perfection and priority of the
interests of the Purchasers in the Assets. This appointment is coupled with an
interest and is irrevocable.

         (c) The parties hereto intend that the conveyance of Asset Interests
by the Seller to the Purchasers shall be treated as sales for all purposes.
If, despite such intention, a determination is made that such transactions
shall not be treated as sales, then the parties hereto intend that this
Agreement constitutes a security agreement and the transactions effected
hereby constitute secured loans by the Purchasers to the Seller under
applicable law. For such purpose, the Seller hereby transfers, conveys,
assigns and grants to the Deal Agent, for the benefit of the Purchasers and
the Hedge Counterparties, a continuing security interest in all Assets, all
Collections and the proceeds of the foregoing to secure the repayment of all
Capital, all payments at any time due or accrued in respect of the Yield on
any Asset Interest and all other payments at any time due (whether accrued or
due) by the Seller hereunder (including without limit any amount owing under
Article VIII hereof), under any Hedging Agreement (including, without
limitation, payments in respect of the termination of any such Hedging
Agreement) or under any fee letter to the Deal Agent and each Purchaser.

         (d) Each of the parties hereto agree that the Hedge Counterparties
shall be third party beneficiaries hereunder with respect to the rights
specifically granted to such Hedge Counterparties, including, without
limitation, the priorities set forth in Section 2.7, 2.8 and 2.9.

                  Section 11.13     Confidentiality

         (a) Each of the Deal Agent, the Purchasers, the Liquidity Agent, the
Servicer, the Collateral Custodian, the Backup Servicer and the Seller shall
maintain and shall cause each of its employees and officers to maintain the
confidentiality of the Agreement and all information with respect to the other
parties, including all information regarding the business of the Seller and
the Servicer hereto and their respective businesses obtained by it or them in


                                      89
<PAGE>

connection with the structuring, negotiating and execution of the transactions
contemplated herein, except that each such party and its officers and
employees may (i) disclose such information to its external accountants,
attorneys, investors, potential investors and the agents of such Persons
("Excepted Persons"), provided, however, that each Excepted Person shall, as a
condition to any such disclosure, agree for the benefit of the Deal Agent, the
Seller and the Investors that such information shall be used solely in
connection with such Excepted Person's evaluation of, or relationship with,
the Seller and its affiliates, (ii) disclose the existence of the Agreement,
but not the financial terms thereof and (iii) disclose such information as is
required by an applicable law or an order of an judicial or administrative
proceeding. It is understood that the financial terms that may not be
disclosed except in compliance with this Section 11.13(a) include, without
limitation, all fees and other pricing terms, and all Payout Events,
Restricting Events, Servicer Defaults, and priority of payment provisions

         (b) Anything herein to the contrary notwithstanding, the Seller
hereby consents to the disclosure of any nonpublic information with respect to
it (i) to the Deal Agent, the Liquidity Agent, the Collateral Custodian, the
Backup Servicer or the Purchasers by each other, (ii) by the Deal Agent or the
Purchasers to any prospective or actual assignee or participant of any of them
or (iii) by the Deal Agent, the Liquidity Agent or a Purchaser to any Rating
Agency, Commercial Paper dealer or provider of a surety, guaranty or credit or
liquidity enhancement to a Purchaser and to any officers, directors,
employees, outside accountants and attorneys of any of the foregoing, provided
each such Person is informed of the confidential nature of such information.
In addition, the Purchasers, the Liquidity Agent and the Deal Agent may
disclose any such nonpublic information as required pursuant to any law, rule,
regulation, direction, request or order of any judicial, administrative or
regulatory authority or proceedings (whether or not having the force or effect
of law).

         (c) Notwithstanding anything herein to the contrary, the foregoing
shall not be construed to prohibit (i) disclosure of any and all information
that is or becomes publicly known, (ii) disclosure of any and all information
(A) if required to do so by any applicable statute, law, rule or regulation,
(B) to any government agency or regulatory body having or claiming authority
to regulate or oversee any respects of the Collateral Custodian's or Backup
Servicer's business or that of their affiliates, (C) pursuant to any subpoena,
civil investigative demand or similar demand or request of any court,
regulatory authority, arbitrator or arbitration to which the Collateral
Custodian or Backup Servicer or an affiliate or an officer, director, employer
or shareholder thereof is a party, (D) in any preliminary or final offering
circular, registration statement or contract or other document pertaining to
the transactions contemplated herein approved in advance by the Seller or
Servicer or (E) to any affiliate, independent or internal auditor, agent,
employee or attorney of the Collateral Custodian or Backup Servicer having a
need to know the same, provided that the Collateral Custodian or Backup
Servicer advises such recipient of the confidential nature of the information
being disclosed, or (iii) any other disclosure authorized by the Seller or
Servicer.



                                      90
<PAGE>

                  Section 11.14     Execution in Counterparts; Severability;
                                    Integration.

         This Agreement may be executed in any number of counterparts and by
different parties hereto in separate counterparts, each of which when so
executed shall be deemed to be an original and all of which when taken
together shall constitute one and the same agreement. In case any provision in
or obligation under this Agreement shall be invalid, illegal or unenforceable
in any jurisdiction, the validity, legality and enforceability of the
remaining provisions or obligations, or of such provision or obligation in any
other jurisdiction, shall not in any way be affected or impaired thereby. This
Agreement contains the final and complete integration of all prior expressions
by the parties hereto with respect to the subject matter hereof and shall
constitute the entire agreement among the parties hereto with respect to the
subject matter hereof, superseding all prior oral or written understandings
other than any fee letter delivered by the Originator to the Deal Agent and
the Purchasers.





                                      91
<PAGE>



         IN WITNESS WHEREOF, the parties have caused this Agreement to be
executed by their respective officers thereunto duly authorized, as of the
date first above written.

THE SELLER:                       SW LEASING PORTFOLIO IV, INC.


                                  By______________________________
                                    Title:


THE SERVICER:                     FIDELITY LEASING, INC.

                                  By______________________________
                                    Title:


THE INVESTORS:                    FIRST UNION NATIONAL BANK

                                  By______________________________
                                    Title:

                                  Commitment:  $50,000,000

                                  First Union National Bank
                                  One First Union Center, TW-6
                                  Charlotte, North Carolina 28288
                                  Attention:  Mr. Bill A. Shirley
                                  Facsimile No.:  (704) 374-3254
                                  Confirmation No:  (704) 374-4001

VFCC:                             VARIABLE FUNDING CAPITAL
                                  CORPORATION

                                  By First Union Capital Markets Corp., as
                                       attorney-in-fact

                                  By______________________________
                                    Title:

                                  Variable Funding Capital Corporation
                                  c/o First Union Capital Markets Corp.
                                  One First Union Center, TW-6
                                  Attention:  Mr. Darrell Baber
                                  Facsimile No.:  (704) 383-6036
                                  Confirmation No.:  (704) 383-9343




                                      92
<PAGE>

                  With a copy to:

                                  Lord Securities Corp.

                                  Attention:
                                  Facsimile No.:  (____) __________
                                  Confirmation No.:  (____) __________


THE DEAL AGENT:                   FIRST UNION CAPITAL MARKETS
                                  CORP.

                                  By
                                    Title:________________________



                                  First Union Capital Markets Corp.
                                  One First Union Center, TW-6
                                  Charlotte, North Carolina 28288
                                  Attention:  Mr. Darrell Baber
                                  Facsimile No.:  (704) 383-6036
                                  Telephone No.:  (704) 383-9343


THE LIQUIDITY AGENT:              FIRST UNION NATIONAL BANK

                                  By______________________________
                                    Title:

                                  First Union National Bank
                                  One First Union Center, TW-6
                                  Charlotte, North Carolina 28288
                                  Attention:  Mr. Bill A. Shirley
                                  Facsimile No.:  (704) 374-3254
                                  Telephone No.:  (704) 374-4001




                                      93
<PAGE>

THE COLLATERAL CUSTODIAN:  HARRIS TRUST AND SAVINGS BANK

                                  By______________________________
                                    Title:

                                    Harris Trust and Savings Bank
                                    311 West Monroe Street, 12th Floor
                                    Chicago, Illinois 60606
                                    Attention:  Indenture Trust Administrator
                                    Facsimile:  (312) 461-3525
                                    Telephone:  (312) 461-2532

THE BACKUP SERVICER:              HARRIS TRUST AND SAVINGS BANK

                                     By___________________________
                                        Title:

                                       Harris Trust and Savings Bank
                                       311 West Monroe Street, 12th Floor
                                       Chicago, Illinois 60606
                                       Attention:  Indenture Trust Administrator
                                       Facsimile:  (312) 461-3525
                                       Telephone:  (312) 461-2532



                                      94
<PAGE>


FIDELITY LEASING, INC.:           FIDELITY LEASING, INC.

                                  By______________________________
                                    Title:









                                      95



<PAGE>

                                                                EXECUTION COPY



==============================================================================



                        SW LEASING PORTFOLIO IV, INC.,

                                   as Buyer



                                      and



                            FIDELITY LEASING, INC.,

                                   as Seller






==============================================================================


                          PURCHASE AND SALE AGREEMENT

                         Dated as of December 18, 1997


==============================================================================


<PAGE>





                               TABLE OF CONTENTS


<TABLE>
<S>                                                                                                            <C>
ARTICLE I  GENERAL................................................................................................1
         Section 1.1 Certain Defined Terms........................................................................1
         Section 1.2 Other Definitional Provisions................................................................3
ARTICLE II  SALE AND CONVEYANCE...................................................................................3
         Section 2.1 Sale.........................................................................................3
         Section 2.2 Subsequent Contracts.........................................................................5
ARTICLE III  PURCHASE PRICE AND PAYMENT; MONTHLY REPORT...........................................................6
         Section 3.1 Purchase Price...............................................................................6
         Section 3.2 Payment of Purchase Price....................................................................6
ARTICLE IV  REPRESENTATIONS AND WARRANTIES........................................................................7
         Section 4.1 Seller's Representations and Warranties......................................................7
         Section 4.2 Seller's Representations and Warranties Regarding the Agreement and the Contracts...........11
         Section 4.3 Representations and Warranties of the Buyer.................................................12
ARTICLE V  COVENANTS.............................................................................................13
         Section 5.1 Seller Covenants............................................................................13
ARTICLE VI  REPURCHASE OBLIGATION................................................................................15
         Section 6.1 Retransfer of Ineligible Contracts..........................................................15
         Section 6.2 Retransfer of Purchased Assets..............................................................16
         Section 6.3 Adjustments.................................................................................17
         Section 6.4 Substitution of Contracts...................................................................17
ARTICLE VII  CONDITIONS PRECEDENT................................................................................18
         Section 7.1 Conditions to the Buyer's Obligations Regarding Contracts...................................18
ARTICLE VIII  TERM AND TERMINATION...............................................................................19
         Section 8.1 Termination.................................................................................19
ARTICLE IX  MISCELLANEOUS PROVISIONS.............................................................................19
         Section 9.1 Amendment...................................................................................19
         Section 9.2 Governing Law...............................................................................19
         Section 9.3 Notices.....................................................................................19
         Section 9.4 Severability of Provisions..................................................................20
         Section 9.5 Assignment..................................................................................20
         Section 9.6 Further Assurances..........................................................................21
         Section 9.7 No Waiver; Cumulative Remedies..............................................................21
         Section 9.8 Counterparts................................................................................22
         Section 9.9 Binding Effect; Third-Party Beneficiaries...................................................22
         Section 9.10 Merger and Integration.....................................................................22
         Section 9.11 Headings...................................................................................22
         Section 9.12 Schedules and Exhibits.....................................................................22
         Section 9.13 No Proceedings.............................................................................22
         Section 9.14 Merger or Consolidation of, or Assumption of the Obligations of, the Seller................22
         Section 9.15 Costs, Expenses and Taxes..................................................................23
         Section 9.16  Recourse Against Certain Parties..........................................................24
</TABLE>

Schedule I       List of Contracts
Schedule II      Tradenames, Fictitious Names and "Doing Business As" Names

Exhibit A        Form of Assignment
Exhibit B        Form of Seller Funding Note

                                     -i-
<PAGE>

                          PURCHASE AND SALE AGREEMENT


         PURCHASE AND SALE AGREEMENT, dated as of December 18, 1997 by and
between FIDELITY LEASING, INC., a Pennsylvania corporation (the "Seller"), and
SW LEASING PORTFOLIO IV, INC., a Pennsylvania corporation (the "Buyer").

                             W I T N E S S E T H :

         WHEREAS, the Buyer desires to purchase from the Seller and the Seller
desires to sell to the Buyer certain contracts originated or purchased by the
Seller in its normal course of business, together with, among other things the
related rights of payment thereunder and the interest of the Seller in the
related equipment and other interests securing the payments to be made under
such contracts.

         NOW, THEREFORE, it is hereby agreed by and between the Buyer and the
Seller as follows:


                                   ARTICLE I

                                    GENERAL

                  Section 1.1       Certain Defined Terms.

         Certain capitalized terms used throughout this Agreement are defined
above or in this Section 1.1. In addition, capitalized terms used but not
defined herein have the meanings given to such terms in the Receivables
Purchase Agreement.

Agreement: Shall mean this Purchase and Sale Agreement, as the same shall be
amended, supplemented, restated or replaced from time to time.

Excess Amount: Shall have the meaning specified in Section 3.2 hereof

Purchase: Any purchase made hereunder pursuant to Section 2.1.

Purchase Date: Any day on which any Purchased Asset is acquired by the Buyer
pursuant to the terms of this Agreement.

Purchase Price: Shall have the meaning specified in Section 3.1 hereof.

Purchased Assets: The interests and property purchased pursuant to Sections
2.1(a) and (b).

Purchased Contracts: The Contracts listed on Schedule I hereto.


<PAGE>

Receivables Purchase Agreement: The Receivables Purchase Agreement dated as of
December 18, 1997 by and among the Buyer, as seller thereunder, Fidelity
Leasing, Inc., as servicer, the investors named therein, Variable Funding
Capital Corporation, as a purchaser, Harris Trust and Savings Bank, as
collateral custodian and backup servicer, First Union Capital Markets Corp.,
as deal agent and First Union National Bank, as liquidity agent, as the same
may be amended, supplemented, restated or replaced from time to time.

Required Lease Cancellation Payment: Shall have the meaning set forth in
Section 6.3(b) hereof.

Residual Value: With respect to any Purchased Contract, the residual value of
any unit of equipment related to such Contract, as agreed to between the
Purchaser and the Seller on the date such Contract becomes a Purchased
Contract; provided, however, such residual value shall not be less than zero;
such Residual Value to be set forth on Schedule I hereto.

Residual Value Adjustment Amount: With respect to any Purchased Contract, the
excess of (a) Residual Value of such Purchased Contract over (b) net proceeds
from the sale, re-lease or other disposition of the equipment related to such
Purchased Contract upon the expiration, or earlier termination, of the term of
such Purchased Contract.

Sale Papers:  Shall have the meaning set forth in Section 4.1(a) hereof.

Seller Note: The promissory note, in the form of Exhibit B hereto, issued to
the Seller by the Purchaser pursuant to Section 3.2(a) hereof, which note
shall have a principal balance at all times equal to the Seller Note Principal
Balance and shall bear interest at a rate per annum equal to the Seller Note
Interest Rate.

Seller Note Interest Rate:  On any day, the rate per annum equal to 9.0%.

Seller Note Maturity Date: The day that is one year and one day following the
date on which the Aggregate Unpaids have been indefeasibly paid in full in
cash.

Seller Note Principal Balance: On any day an amount equal to (i) the sum of
(a) the Excess Amount on the Closing Date, (b) the aggregate of the Excess
Amounts on each Subsequent Purchase Date and (c) the aggregate of the Residual
Values, minus (ii) the sum of (a) the aggregate Residual Value Adjustment
Amount and (b) all other amounts from time to time received by the Seller in
reduction of the Seller Note Principal Balance; provided, however, that the
Seller Note Principal Balance shall never be less than zero.

Servicer: Initially Fidelity Leasing , Inc., in its capacity as the Servicer
under the Receivables Purchase Agreement, and its permitted successors and
assigns, and thereafter any Person appointed as successor as provided therein
to service the Assets thereunder.

Subsequent Contract List: The list of Contracts to be sold by the Seller to
the Buyer on a Subsequent Purchase Date.



                                     -2-
<PAGE>

Subsequent Contracts: On any Subsequent Purchase Date, the Contracts sold by
the Seller to the Buyer on such date as listed on the Subsequent Contact List.

Subsequent Purchase Date: Each Purchase Date other than the Closing Date.

Substitution Date: Any date on which the Seller transfers a Substitute
Contract to the Buyer.

                  Section 1.2       Other Definitional Provisions.

         The words "hereof," "herein" and "hereunder" and words of similar
import when used in this Agreement or any Sale Paper shall refer to this
Agreement as a whole and not to any particular provision of this Agreement;
and Section, Subsection, Schedule and Exhibit references contained in this
Agreement are references to Sections, Subsections, Schedules and Exhibits in
or to this Agreement unless otherwise specified. In the event that any term or
provision contained herein shall conflict with or be inconsistent with any
term or provision contained in the Receivables Purchase Agreement, the terms
and provisions contained herein shall govern with respect to this Agreement.


                                  ARTICLE II

                              SALE AND CONVEYANCE

                  Section 2.1       Sale.

         (a) On the Closing Date, the Seller hereby sells, transfers, assigns,
sets over and otherwise conveys to the Buyer as of the Closing Date, and the
Buyer hereby purchases from the Seller, without recourse, all right, title and
interest of the Seller in, to and under the following property, whether now
existing or hereafter created or acquired:

                           (i) the Contracts that are owned by the Seller on
         the Closing Date and that are listed on the Contract List, together
         with all Collections and all monies due or to become due in payment
         of such Contracts after the related Cut Off Date, and any payments in
         respect of a Casualty Loss or Early Termination, but excluding any
         Scheduled Payments due on or prior to the related Cut Off Date and
         any Excluded Amounts;

                           (ii) the Equipment related to such Contracts,
         including all proceeds from any sale or other disposition of such
         Equipment;

                           (iii)    the Contract Files;

                           (iv) all payments made or to be made in the future
         specifically with respect to such Contracts or the Obligor thereunder
         under any guarantee or similar credit enhancement with respect to
         such Contracts;



                                     -3-
<PAGE>

                           (v) all Insurance Proceeds with respect to each
         such Contract; and

                           (vii) all income and proceeds of the foregoing.

         (b) On each Subsequent Purchase Date, the Seller will sell, transfer,
assign and set over and otherwise convey to the Buyer and the Buyer will
purchase from the Seller, without recourse, all right, title and interest of
the Seller in, to and under the following property, whether now existing or
hereafter created or acquired:

                           (i) the Subsequent Contracts identified on the
         Subsequent Contract List delivered by the Seller to the Buyer two
         Business Days before the applicable Subsequent Purchase Date,
         together with all Collections and all monies due or to become due in
         payment of such Contracts after the related Cut Off Date, and any
         payments in respect of a casualty or early termination, but excluding
         any Scheduled Payments due on or prior to the related Cut Off Date
         and any Excluded Amounts;

                           (ii) the Equipment related to such Contracts,
         including all proceeds from any sale or other disposition of such
         Equipment;

                           (iii)    the Contract Files;

                           (iv) all payments made or to be made in the future
         specifically with respect to such Contracts or the Obligor thereunder
         under any guarantee or similar credit enhancement with respect to
         such Contracts;

                           (v) all Insurance Proceeds with respect to each
         such Contract; and

                           (vii) all income and proceeds of the foregoing.


The foregoing sale, transfer, assignment, set-over and conveyance does not
constitute and is not intended to result in a creation or an assumption by the
Buyer of any obligation of the Seller or any other Person in connection with
the Contracts or under any agreement or instrument relating thereto including,
without limitation, any obligation to any Obligors.

         (c) In connection with the sale of the Purchased Assets, the Seller
agrees (i) to record and file, at its own expense, any financing statements
(and continuation statements with respect to such financing statements when
applicable) with respect to the Purchased Assets, meeting the requirements of
applicable state law in such manner and in such jurisdictions as are necessary
to perfect, and maintain the perfection of, the sale of the Purchased Assets
from the Seller to the Buyer on and after the Closing Date, (ii) that such
financing statements shall name the Seller, as seller, and the Buyer, as
purchaser, of the Purchased Assets and (iii) to deliver a file-stamped copy of
such financing statements or other evidence of such filings (excluding
continuation statements, which shall be delivered as filed) to the Buyer on or
prior to the Closing Date, in the case of the Original Contracts and (if any
additional filing is necessary) on or prior to the related Subsequent Purchase
Date, in the case of Subsequent Contracts.



                                     -4-
<PAGE>

         (d) In connection with the sale of the Purchased Assets, the Seller
further agrees that it will, at its own expense, indicate clearly and
unambiguously in its computer files, on or prior to the Closing Date in the
case of the Original Contracts and on or prior to the related Subsequent
Purchase Date in the case of each Subsequent Contract, that such Contracts
have been sold to the Buyer pursuant to this Agreement. The Seller further
agrees to deliver to the Buyer (i) on the Closing Date, a computer file or
microfiche list containing a true and complete list of all Original Contracts,
identified by account number and Outstanding Balance as of the Cut Off Date
and (ii) on any Subsequent Purchase Date with respect to Subsequent Contracts,
a computer file or microfiche list containing a true and complete list of all
Subsequent Contracts transferred on such date identified by account number and
Outstanding Balance as of the related Additional Cut Off Date. Such file or
list shall be marked as Schedule I to this Agreement, shall be delivered to
the Buyer as confidential and proprietary, and is hereby incorporated into and
made a part of this Agreement.

         (e) It is the intention of the parties hereto that the conveyance of
the Contracts and the other Purchased Assets by the Seller to the Buyer as
provided in this Section 2.1 be, and be construed as, an absolute sale,
without recourse, of the Contracts and the other Purchased Assets by the
Seller to the Buyer. Furthermore, it is not intended that such conveyance be
deemed a pledge of the Contracts and the other Purchased Assets by the Seller
to the Buyer to secure a debt or other obligation of the Seller. If, however,
notwithstanding the intention of the parties, the conveyance provided for in
this Section 2.1 is determined to be a transfer for security, then this
Agreement shall also be deemed to be a "security agreement" within the meaning
of Article 9 of the UCC and the Seller hereby grants to the Buyer a "security
interest" within the meaning of Article 9 of the UCC in all of the Seller's
right, title and interest in and to the Contracts and the other Purchased
Assets, now existing and hereafter created, to secure a loan in an amount
equal to the aggregate Purchase Price and each of the Seller's other payment
obligations under this Agreement.

                  Section 2.2       Subsequent Contracts.

         (a) The Seller shall on or prior to any Subsequent Purchase Date with
respect to any Contracts execute and deliver to the Buyer a written assignment
from Seller to the Buyer substantially the form of Exhibit A hereto. From and
after such Subsequent Purchase Date, such Subsequent Contracts shall be deemed
to be Contracts hereunder.

         (a) Covenants of the Seller In Connection With Additions. On or
before any Subsequent Purchase Date with respect to any Contracts acquired by
the Buyer as described in subsection 2.1(b), the Seller shall:

                  (i) clearly indicate in its files that such Contracts have
been sold to the Buyer and deliver to the Buyer a computer file or microfiche
list which the Seller shall represent to contain a true and complete list of
such Subsequent Contracts, identified by account number as of the related Cut
Off Date, which computer file or microfiche list shall be as of such date
incorporated into and made apart of this Agreement;



                                     -5-
<PAGE>

                  (ii) provide the Buyer with an Officer's Certificate
certifying as follows: (A) each such Contract was, as of the related
Subsequent Purchase Date, an Eligible Contract, (B) no selection procedures
believed by the Seller to be materially adverse to the interest of the Buyer
were utilized in selecting such Contracts from the available Eligible
Contracts in the Seller's portfolio, (C) such Contracts and all proceeds
thereof will be conveyed to the Buyer free and clear of any Lien of any Person
claiming through or under the Seller or any of its Affiliates, except for
Liens permitted hereunder and (D) as of the related Subsequent Purchase Date,
(x) no Insolvency Event with respect to the Seller has occurred, (y) the Buyer
is not insolvent and (z) the sale of such Contracts to the Buyer has not been
made in contemplation of the occurrence of any Insolvency Event with respect
to the Seller, and (E) as of the related Subsequent Purchase Date, no
Restricting Event with respect to the Seller has occurred;

                  (iii) record and file financing statements with respect to
such Contracts meeting the requirements of applicable state law in such manner
and in such jurisdictions as are necessary to perfect the sale of such
Contracts by the Seller to the Buyer.


                                  ARTICLE III

                  PURCHASE PRICE AND PAYMENT; MONTHLY REPORT

                  Section 3.1       Purchase Price.

         The purchase price for each Contract sold to the Buyer by the Seller
under this Agreement (the "Purchase Price") shall be a dollar amount equal to
the sum of a Residual Value and (b) Discounted Contract Balance determined as
of the related Cut Off Date.

                  Section 3.2       Payment of Purchase Price.

         (a) Each Purchase Price payment shall be paid on the date of such
Purchase by the Purchaser to the Seller in the manner provided below:

         (i) in cash, in an amount equal to the lesser of (A) the amount (such
    amount being referred to herein as the "Available Funds") of funds
    available to the Purchaser on the date of such Purchase pursuant to the
    terms of the Receivables Purchase Agreement and (B) the aggregate Purchase
    Price of such Contracts; and

         (ii) to the extent that the aggregate Purchase Price of Contracts to
    be sold to the Buyer on any day exceeds (such excess being hereinafter
    referred to as the "Excess Amount") the amount of the cash payment in
    (i)(A) above, such excess shall be paid (A) on the Closing Date, by the
    issuance to the Seller of the Seller Note in a principal amount equal to
    the Excess Amount as of the Closing Date and (B) on each Subsequent
    Purchase Date, by increasing the principal balance of the Seller Note by
    an amount equal to the Excess Amount for such Purchase Date.



                                     -6-
<PAGE>

         (b) Unless otherwise specified herein, all payments of the Purchase
Price of any Contract sold hereunder shall be made not later than 3:00 p.m.
(New York City time) on the date specified therefor in lawful money of the
United States of America in same day funds by depositing such amounts in the
bank account designated in writing by the Seller to the Purchaser.

         (c) The Seller Note shall bear interest at a rate per annum equal,
from time to time, to the Seller Note Interest Rate.


                                  ARTICLE IV

                        REPRESENTATIONS AND WARRANTIES

                  Section 4.1       Seller's Representations and Warranties.

         The Seller hereby represents and warrants to the Buyer, as of the
Closing Date and each Subsequent Purchase Date, that:

         (a) Organization and Good Standing. The Seller is a corporation duly
organized and validly existing in good standing under the laws of the
jurisdiction of its formation and has full corporate power, authority and
legal right to own its properties and conduct its business as such properties
are presently owned and as such business is presently conducted and to
execute, deliver and perform its obligations under this Agreement and each
other document or instrument to be delivered by the Seller hereunder
(collectively, the "Sale Papers").

         (b) Due Qualification. The Seller is duly qualified to do business
and is in good standing as a foreign corporation (or is exempt from such
requirements), and has obtained all necessary licenses and approvals, in each
jurisdiction in which failure to so qualify or to obtain such licenses and
approvals would have a material adverse effect on its ability to perform its
obligations hereunder or under the Sale Papers.

         (c) Due Authorization. The execution and delivery of this Agreement
and each of the Sale Papers, and the consummation of the transactions provided
for herein and therein have been duly authorized by the Seller by all
necessary corporate action on the part of the Seller.

         (d) No Conflict. The execution and delivery of this Agreement and
each of the Sale Papers, the performance of the transactions contemplated
hereby and thereby and the fulfillment of the terms hereof and thereof, will
not conflict with, result in any breach of any of the material terms and
provisions of, or constitute (with or without notice or lapse of time or both)
a material default under, any material indenture, contract, agreement,
mortgage, deed of trust, or other instrument to which the Seller is a party or
by which it or any of its property is bound.



                                     -7-
<PAGE>

         (e) No Violation. The execution and delivery of this Agreement and
each of the Sale Papers, the performance of the transactions contemplated
hereby and thereby and the fulfillment of the terms hereof and thereof
(including, without limitation, the sale of Purchased Assets by the Seller or
remittance of Collections in accordance with the provisions of this
Agreement), will not conflict with or violate, in any material respect, any
Requirements of Law applicable to the Seller.

         (f) No Proceedings. There are no proceedings or investigations
pending or, to the best knowledge of the Seller, threatened against the Seller
before any court, regulatory body, administrative agency, or other tribunal or
governmental instrumentality (i) asserting the invalidity of this Agreement or
any of the Sale Papers, (ii) seeking to prevent the consummation of any of the
transactions contemplated by this Agreement or any of the Sale Papers, or
(iii) seeking any determination or ruling that could reasonably be expected to
be adversely determined, and if adversely determined, would materially and
adversely affect the performance by the Seller of its obligations under this
Agreement or any of the Sale Papers.

         (g) All Consents Required. All approvals, authorizations, consents,
orders or other actions of any Person or of any Governmental Authority
required in connection with the execution and delivery of this Agreement and
the Sale Papers, the performance of the transactions contemplated by this
Agreement and the Sale Papers and the fulfillment of or terms hereof and
thereof, have been obtained.

         (h) Bulk Sales. The execution, delivery and performance of this
Agreement do not require compliance with any "bulk sales" law by the Seller.

         (i) Solvency. The transactions contemplated under this Agreement and
the Sale Papers do not and will not render the Seller insolvent.

         (j) Selection Procedures. No selection procedures believed by the
Seller to be materially adverse to the interests of the Buyer were utilized by
the Seller in selecting the Contracts to be sold, assigned, transferred,
set-over and otherwise conveyed hereunder.

         (k) Use of Proceeds. No proceeds of the sale of any Contract
hereunder received by the Seller will be used by the Seller to purchase or
carry any margin security.

         (l) Not an Investment Company. The Seller is not an "investment
company" within the meaning of the Investment Company Act of 1940, as amended,
or is exempt from all provisions of such Act.

         (m) Other Names. The legal name of the Seller is as set forth in this
Agreement and within the preceding five years the Seller has not used, and the
Seller currently does not use, any tradenames, fictitious names, assumed names
or "doing business as" names other than those set forth on Schedule II hereto.



                                     -8-
<PAGE>

         (n) Taxes. The Seller has filed or caused to be filed all tax returns
which, to its knowledge, are required to be filed and has paid all taxes shown
to be due and payable on such returns or on any assessments made against it or
any of its property and all other taxes, fees or other charges imposed on it
or any of its property by any Governmental Authority (other than any amount of
tax due the validity of which is currently being contested in good faith by
appropriate proceedings and with respect to which reserves in accordance with
generally accepted accounting principles have been provided on the books of
the Seller); no tax lien has been filed and, to the Seller's knowledge, no
claim is being asserted, with respect to any such tax, fee or other charge.

         (o) Place of Business. The principal executive offices of the Seller
are in Ambler, Pennsylvania and the offices where the Seller keeps its records
concerning the Contracts are in Ambler, Pennsylvania.

         (p) No Liens. Each Purchased Asset, together with the Contract
related thereto, shall, at all times, be owned by the Seller free and clear of
any Lien except as provided herein, and upon the sale, transfer or assignment
hereunder, the Buyer shall acquire a valid and perfected first priority
undivided ownership interest in each Purchased Asset then existing or
thereafter arising and in the Collections with respect thereto, free and clear
of any Lien except as provided herein. No effective financing statement or
other instrument similar in effect covering any Purchased Asset or the
Collections with respect thereto shall at any time be on file in any recording
office except such as may be filed in favor of the Buyer relating to this
Agreement.

         (q) Special Purpose Entity. The Seller agrees that, for a period of
one year and one day after the Aggregate Unpaids have been paid in full, the
Seller will not cause the Buyer to file a voluntary petition or institute,
cause to be instituted or join in any involuntary petition or proceeding under
the Bankruptcy Code or any other bankruptcy or insolvency laws. Each of the
Buyer and the Seller is aware that in light of the circumstances described in
the preceding sentence and other relevant facts, the filing of a voluntary
petition under the Bankruptcy Code for the purpose of making the assets of the
Buyer available to satisfy claims of the creditors of the Seller would not
result in making such assets available to satisfy such creditors under the
Bankruptcy Code.

         (r) Security Interest. The Seller has granted a security interest (as
defined in the UCC) to the Buyer in the Purchased Assets and Collections,
which is enforceable in accordance with the UCC upon execution and delivery of
this Agreement. Upon the filing of UCC-1 financing statements naming the Buyer
as secured party and the Seller as debtor, the Buyer shall have a first
priority perfected security interest in the Purchased Assets and Collections.
All filings (including, without limitation, such UCC filings) as are necessary
in any jurisdiction to perfect the interest of the Buyer in the Purchased
Assets and Collections have been (or prior to the applicable purchase
hereunder will be) made; provided, however, that filings as to related
Equipment have been (or prior to the applicable purchase hereunder will be)
made solely in the Filing Locations and such Equipment filings have been (or
prior to the applicable purchase hereunder will be) made by filing in each
such Filing Location one financing statement listing all Equipment, without
the necessity of making individual filings for each item of Equipment.



                                     -9-
<PAGE>

         (s) Accounting. The Seller will account for the transfers by it to
the Buyer of interests in Purchased Assets and Collections under this
Agreement as sales of such Purchased Assets in its books, records and
financial statements, in each case consistent with GAAP, as applicable, and
with the requirements set forth herein.

         (t) Separate Entity. The Buyer is operated as an entity with assets
and liabilities distinct from those of the Seller and any Affiliates thereof,
and the Seller hereby acknowledges that the Deal Agent and the Purchasers
under the Receivables Purchase Agreement are entering into the transactions
contemplated by the Receivables Purchase Agreement in reliance upon the
Buyer's identity as a separate legal entity from the Seller and from each such
Affiliate of the Seller.

         (u) Value Given. The cash payments received by the Seller in respect
of the Purchase Price of each Contract sold hereunder constitutes reasonably
equivalent value in consideration for the transfer to the Buyer of such
Contract under this Agreement, such transfer was not made for or on account of
an antecedent debt owed by the Seller to the Buyer, and such transfer was not
and is not voidable or subject to avoidance under any section of the
Bankruptcy Code.

         (v) Reports Accurate. No report (if prepared by the Seller, or to the
extent that information contained therein is supplied by the Seller),
information, exhibit, financial statement, document, book, record or report
furnished or to be furnished by the Seller to the Buyer in connection with
this Agreement is or will be inaccurate in any material respect as of the date
it is or shall be dated or (except as otherwise disclosed to the Buyer at such
time) as of the date so furnished, and no such document contains or will
contain any material misstatement of fact or omits or shall omit to state a
material fact or any fact necessary to make the statements contained therein
not misleading.

         (w) Exchange Act Compliance. No proceeds of the sale of any Purchased
Assets will be used by the Seller to acquire any security in any transaction
which is subject to Section 13 or 14 of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934,
as amended.

         (x) Accuracy of Representations and Warranties. Each representation
or warranty by the Seller contained herein or in any certificate or other
document furnished by the Seller pursuant hereto or in connection herewith is
true and correct in all material respects.

         The representations and warranties set forth in this Section 4.1
shall survive the sale, transfer and assignment of the Purchased Assets to the
Buyer. Upon discovery by the Seller or the Buyer of a breach of any of the
foregoing representations and warranties, the party discovering such breach
shall give prompt written notice thereof to the other and to the Deal Agent
immediately upon obtaining knowledge of such breach.



                                     -10-
<PAGE>

                  Section 4.2       Seller's Representations and Warranties
                                    Regarding the Agreement and the Contracts.

         The Seller hereby represents and warrants to the Buyer, as of the
Closing Date and each Subsequent Purchase Date that:

         (a) Binding Obligation; Valid Transfer and Security Interest.

                  (i) This Agreement and each of the Sale Papers constitutes a
legal, valid and binding obligation of the Seller, enforceable against the
Seller in accordance with its terms, except as such enforceability may be
limited by Insolvency Laws and except as such enforceability may be limited by
general principles of equity (whether considered in a suit at law or in
equity) or by an implied covenant of good faith and fair dealing.

                  (ii) This Agreement constitutes a valid transfer to the
Buyer of all right, title and interest of the Seller in, to and under the
Purchased Assets, and such transfer will be free and clear of any Lien of any
Person claiming through or under the Seller or its Affiliates, except for
Permitted Liens. Upon the filing of the financing statements described in
Section 4.1(r) and, in the case of Subsequent Contracts on the applicable
Subsequent Purchase Date, the Buyer shall have a first priority perfected
security interest in such property, subject only to Permitted Liens.

         (b) Eligibility of Contracts. As of the Cut Off Date, (i) the
Contract List and the computer file or microfiche or written list delivered in
connection therewith is an accurate and complete listing in all material
respects of all the Contracts transferred hereunder as of the Cut Off Date and
the information contained therein with respect to the identity of such
Contracts and the amounts owing thereunder is true and correct in all material
respects as of the Cut Off Date, (ii) each such Contract is an Eligible
Contract, (iii) each such Contract and the Seller's interest in the related
Equipment and Applicable Security, as appropriate, has been transferred to the
Buyer free and clear of any Lien of any Person (other than Permitted Liens)
and in compliance, in all material respects, with all Requirements of Law
applicable to the Seller and (iv) with respect to each such Contract, all
material consents, licenses, approvals or authorizations of or registrations
or declarations with any Governmental Authority required to be obtained,
effected or given by the Seller in connection with the transfer of such
Contract and the related Equipment to the Buyer have been duly obtained,
effected or given and are in full force and effect. On each Subsequent
Purchase Date on which Subsequent Contracts are transferred by the Seller to
the Buyer, the Seller shall be deemed to represent and warrant to the Buyer
that (I) each Subsequent Contract transferred on such day is an Eligible
Contract, (II) each such Subsequent Contract and the Seller's interest in the
related Equipment, as appropriate, has been transferred to the Buyer free and
clear of any Lien of any Person (other than Permitted Liens) and in
compliance, in all material respects, with all Requirements of Law applicable
to the Seller or the originator thereof, (III) with respect to each such
Subsequent Contract, all material consents, licenses, approvals or
authorizations of or registrations or declarations with any Governmental
Authority required to be obtained, effected or given by the Seller in
connection with the transfer of such Contract and the related Equipment to the
Buyer have been duly obtained, effected or given and are in full force and
effect and (IV) the representations and warranties set forth in Section 4.2(b)
clauses (i) through (iv), inclusive, are true and correct with respect to each
Contract transferred on such day as if made on such day.



                                     -11-
<PAGE>

         (c) Notice of Breach. The representations and warranties set forth in
this Section 4.2 shall survive the transfer and assignment of the respective
Contracts and Related Equipment, or interests therein, to the Buyer. Upon
discovery by the Seller or the Buyer of a breach of any of the foregoing
representations and warranties, the party discovering such breach shall give
written notice thereof to the other and to the Deal Agent under the
Receivables Purchase Agreement immediately upon obtaining knowledge of such
breach.

                  Section 4.3       Representations and Warranties of the Buyer.

         The Buyer hereby represents and warrants to the Seller, as of the
Closing Date and each Subsequent Purchase Date, that:

         (a) Organization and Good Standing. The Buyer is a corporation duly
organized and validly existing in good standing under the laws of the State of
Delaware, and has full corporate power, authority and legal right to own its
properties and conduct its business as such properties are presently owned and
such business is presently conducted, and to execute, deliver and perform its
obligations under this Agreement and each of the Sale Papers.

         (b) Due Qualification. The Buyer is duly qualified to do business and
is in good standing as a foreign corporation (or is exempt from such
requirements), and has obtained or will obtain all necessary licenses and
approvals, in each jurisdiction in which failure to so qualify or to obtain
such licenses and approvals would have a material adverse effect on its
ability to perform its obligations hereunder or under the Sale Papers.

         (c) Due Authorization. The execution and delivery of this Agreement
and each of the Sale Papers and the consummation of the transactions provided
for herein or therein have been duly authorized by the Buyer by all necessary
corporate action on the part of the Buyer.

         (d) No Conflicts. The execution and delivery of this Agreement and
each of the Sale Papers, the performance of the transactions contemplated
hereby or thereby and the fulfillment of the terms hereof and thereof will not
conflict with, result in any breach of any of the material terms and
provisions of, or constitute (with or without notice or lapse of time or both)
a material default under, any material indenture, contract, agreement,
mortgage, deed of trust, or other instrument to which the Buyer is a party or
by which it or any of its property is bound.

         (e) No Violation. The execution and delivery of this Agreement and
each of the Sale Papers, the performance of the transactions contemplated
hereby and thereby, and the fulfillment of the terms hereof and thereof
(including, without limitation, the purchase of Purchased Assets by the Buyer
in accordance with the provisions of this Agreement) will not conflict with or
violate, in any material respect, any Requirements of Law applicable to the
Buyer.



                                     -12-
<PAGE>

         (f) No Proceedings. There are no proceedings or investigations
pending or, to the best knowledge of the Buyer, threatened against the Buyer,
before any court, regulatory body, administrative agency, or other tribunal or
governmental instrumentality (i) asserting the invalidity of this Agreement or
any of the Sale Papers, (ii) seeking to prevent the consummation of any of the
transactions contemplated by this Agreement or any of the Sale Papers, or
(iii) seeking any determination or ruling that could reasonably be expected to
be adversely determined, and if adversely determined, would materially and
adversely affect the performance by the Buyer of its obligations under this
Agreement or any of the Sale Papers.


                                   ARTICLE V

                                   COVENANTS

                  Section 5.1       Seller Covenants.

         The Seller hereby covenants with respect to each Contract, that:

         (a) Compliance with Laws; Preservation of Corporate Existence. The
Seller will comply in all material respects with all applicable laws, rules,
regulations and orders and preserve and maintain its corporate existence,
rights, franchises, qualifications and privileges.

         (b) Contracts Not to be Evidenced by Promissory Notes. Except to the
extent the provisions of Section 6.4 are satisfied, the Seller will take no
action to cause any Contract which is not, as of the Closing Date or the
related Subsequent Purchase Date, as the case may be, evidenced by an
Instrument, to be so evidenced except in connection with the enforcement or
collection of such Contract.

         (c) Security Interests. Except for the transfers hereunder, the
Seller will not sell, pledge, assign or transfer to any other Person, or
grant, create, incur, assume or suffer to exist any Lien on any Contract
transferred hereunder or related Equipment, whether now existing or hereafter
transferred hereunder, or any interest therein, and Seller will not sell,
pledge, assign or suffer to exist any Lien on its interest, if any, hereunder,
other than Liens arising by operation of law in the ordinary course of
business for sums not due and which are released or extinguished within
fifteen (15) days (or such longer period as the Buyer may approve in its sole
discretion) of the Seller becoming aware thereof. The Seller will immediately
notify the Buyer of the existence of any Lien on any Contract transferred
hereunder or related Equipment; and the Seller shall defend the right, title
and interest of the Buyer in, to and under the Contracts transferred hereunder
and the related Equipment, against all claims of third parties; provided,
however, that nothing in this Section 5.1(c) shall prevent or be deemed to
prohibit the Seller from suffering to exist Permitted Liens upon any of the
Contracts transferred hereunder or any related Equipment.

         (d) Delivery of Collections. The Seller agrees to pay to the Buyer
promptly (but in no event later than two Business Days after receipt) all
Collections received by the Seller in respect of the Contracts transferred
hereunder.



                                     -13-
<PAGE>

         (e) Compliance with Law. The Seller hereby agrees to comply in all
material respects with all Requirements of Law applicable to the Seller, the
Contracts and the Equipment.

         (f) Activities of the Seller. The Seller shall not engage in any
business or activity of any kind with the Buyer, or enter into any transaction
or indenture, mortgage, instrument, agreement, contract, lease or other
undertaking with the Buyer, which is not directly related to the transactions
contemplated and authorized by this Agreement, the Receivables Purchase
Agreement and the Certificate of Incorporation of the Buyer.

         (g) Guarantees. The Seller shall not become or remain liable,
directly or contingently, in connection with any Indebtedness or other
liability of the Buyer, whether by guarantee, endorsement (other than
endorsements of negotiable instruments for deposit or collection in the
ordinary course of business), agreement to purchase or repurchase, agreement
to supply or advance funds, or otherwise.

         (h) Merger; Sales. The Seller shall not enter into any transaction of
merger or consolidation, or liquidate or dissolve itself (or suffer any
liquidation or dissolution), or acquire or be acquired by any Person, or
convey, sell, lease or otherwise dispose of all or substantially all of its
property or business, except as provided for in this Agreement.

         (i) Location of Seller, Records; Instruments. The Seller (x) shall
not move outside the Commonwealth of Pennsylvania, the location of its chief
executive office, without 30 days' prior written notice to the Buyer and the
Deal Agent and (y) shall not move the location of the Contract Files from the
locations thereof on the Closing Date, without 30 days' prior written notice
to the Buyer and the Deal Agent and (z) will promptly take all actions
required (including, but not limited to, all filings and other acts necessary
or advisable under the UCC, if applicable, of each relevant jurisdiction in
order to continue the first priority perfected security interest of the Buyer
in all Contracts transferred hereunder. The Seller will give the Buyer and the
Deal Agent prompt notice of a change within the Commonwealth of Pennsylvania
of the location of its chief executive office.

         (j) Accounting of Purchases. The Seller will not account for or treat
(whether in financial statements or otherwise) the transactions contemplated
hereby in any manner other than the sale of Purchased Assets by the Seller to
the Buyer.

         (k) ERISA Matters. The Seller will not (a) engage in any prohibited
transaction for which an exemption is not available or has not previously been
obtained from the United States Department of Labor; (b) permit to exist any
accumulated funding deficiency, as defined in Section 302(a) of ERISA and
Section 412(a) of the Code, or funding deficiency with respect to any Benefit
Plan other than a Multiemployer Plan; (c) fail to make any payments to an
Multiemployer Plan that the Seller may be required to make under the agreement
relating to such Multiemployer Plan or any law pertaining thereto; (d)
terminate any Benefit Plan so as to result in any liability; or (e) permit to
exist any occurrence of any reportable event described in Title IV of ERISA
which represents a material risk of a liability of the Seller under ERISA or
the Code.



                                     -14-
<PAGE>

         (l) Nature of Business. The Seller will engage in no business with
the Buyer other than the sale and transfer of Purchased Assets hereunder and
the other transactions permitted or contemplated by this Agreement.

         (m) Change in the Purchase and Sale Agreement. The Seller will not
amend, modify, waive or terminate any terms or conditions of this Agreement
except as provided herein.


                                  ARTICLE VI

                             REPURCHASE OBLIGATION

                  Section 6.1       Retransfer of Ineligible Contracts.

         In the event of a breach of any representation or warranty set forth
in Section 4.2 with respect to a Contract transferred hereunder (each such
Contract, an "Ineligible Contract"), no later than 30 days after the earlier
of (i) knowledge of such breach on the part of the Seller and (ii) receipt by
the Seller of written notice thereof given by the Buyer, the Seller shall
accept a retransfer of each such Contract (and any related Equipment or
Applicable Security) selected by the Buyer to which such breach relates at
such time as there is a breach of any such representation or warranty on the
terms and conditions set forth below; provided, however, that no such
retransfer shall be required to be made with respect to such Ineligible
Contract (and such Contract shall cease to be an Ineligible Contract) if, on
or before the expiration of such 30-day period, the representations and
warranties in Section 4.2 with respect to such Contract shall be made true and
correct in all material respects with respect to such Contract as if such
Contract had been transferred to the Buyer on such day. Notwithstanding
anything contained in this Section 6.1 to the contrary, in the event of breach
of any representation and warranty set forth in Section 4.2, with respect to
each Original Contract or Subsequent Contract and the related Equipment having
been conveyed to the Buyer free and clear of any Lien of any Person claiming
through or under the Seller and its Affiliates (other than Permitted Liens)
and in compliance in all material respects, with all Requirements of Law
applicable to the Seller, immediately upon the earlier to occur of the
discovery of such breach by the Seller or receipt by the Seller of written
notice of such breach given by the Buyer, the Seller shall repurchase and the
Buyer shall convey, free and clear of any Lien created pursuant to this
Agreement, all of its right, title and interest in such Ineligible Contract,
and the Buyer shall, in connection with such conveyance and without further
action, be deemed to represent and warrant that it has the corporate authority
and has taken all necessary corporate action to accomplish such conveyance,
but without any other representation or warranty, express or implied. In any
of the foregoing instances, the Seller shall accept a retransfer of each such
Ineligible Contract, and there shall be deducted from the ADCB of the Asset
Pool the Discounted Contract Balance (calculated using the Blended Discount
Rate as of the most recent Determination Date) of each such Ineligible
Contract. On and after the date of such retransfer, each Ineligible Contract
so retransferred shall not be included in the pool of Purchased Assets. In
consideration of such retransfer the Seller shall, on the date of retransfer
of such Ineligible Contract, make a deposit in the Collection Account (for


                                     -15-
<PAGE>

allocation pursuant to Section 2.7, 2.8 or 2.9 of the Receivables Purchase
Agreement, as applicable,) in immediately available funds in an amount equal
to the Discounted Contract Balance, plus interest thereon from the most recent
Payment Date to and including the date of repurchase at a rate per annum equal
to the weighted average of the Yield Rates. Upon each retransfer to the Seller
of such Ineligible Contract, the Buyer shall automatically and without further
action be deemed to transfer, assign and set-over to the Seller, free and
clear of any Lien created pursuant to this Agreement, all the right, title and
interest of the Buyer in, to and under such Contract and all monies due or to
become due with respect thereto, the related Equipment and all proceeds of
such Contract and Liquidation Proceeds and Insurance Proceeds relating thereto
and all rights to security for any such Contract, and all proceeds and
products of the foregoing, and the Buyer shall, in connection with such
transfer, assignment and set-over and without further action, be deemed to
represent and warrant that it has the corporate authority and has taken all
necessary corporate action to accomplish such transfer, assignment and
set-over, but without any other representation or warranty, express or
implied.. The Buyer shall, at the sole expense of the Seller, execute such
documents and instruments of transfer as may be prepared by the Seller and
take such other actions as shall reasonably be requested by the Seller to
effect the transfer of such Ineligible Contract pursuant to this Section 6.1.

                  Section 6.2       Retransfer of Purchased Assets.

         In the event of a breach of any of the representations and warranties
set forth in Section 4.2 hereof affecting the Contracts, which breach could
reasonably be expected to have a material adverse affect on the rights of the
Purchasers under the Receivables Purchase Agreement or the Deal Agent as agent
for the Purchasers under the Receivables Purchase Agreement under the
Receivables Purchase Agreement or on the ability of the Buyer to perform its
obligations under the Receivables Purchase Agreement, the Buyer, by notice
then given in writing to the Seller may direct the Seller to accept retransfer
of all of the Contracts purchased from the Seller and the Seller shall be
obligated to accept retransfer of such Contracts on a Payment Date specified
by the Seller (such date, the "Retransfer Date") after such notice on the
terms and conditions set forth below; provided, however, that no such
retransfer shall be required to be made if, on or before expiration of such
applicable period, the representations and warranties contained in Section 4.2
shall then be true and correct in all material respects. The Seller shall
deposit on the Retransfer Date an amount equal to the deposit amount provided
in the next sentence for such Contracts in the Collection Account for
distribution to the Purchasers under the Receivables Purchase Agreement. The
deposit amount for such retransfer will be equal to (x) the sum of (i) the
outstanding Capital at the end of the Business Day preceding the Payment Date
on which the retransfer is scheduled to be made and (ii) an amount equal to
all accrued, and to accrue, but unpaid Yield on such Capital at the applicable
Yield Rate through the latest maturing Fixed Period minus (y) the amount, if
any, available in the Collection Account on such Payment Date. On the
Retransfer Date, provided that such amount has been deposited in full into the
Collection Account, the Contracts transferred hereunder (or security interests
therein) and all monies due or to become due with respect thereto, the related
Equipment (or security interests therein) and all proceeds thereof, all rights
to security for any such Contracts, and all proceeds and products of the
foregoing, shall be transferred to the Seller, and the Buyer shall, at the
sole expense of the Seller, execute and deliver such instruments of transfer,


                                     -16-
<PAGE>

in each case without recourse, representation or warranty, as shall be
prepared and reasonably requested by the Seller to vest in the Seller, or its
designee or assignee, all right, title and interest of the Buyer in, to and
under the Contracts transferred hereunder, all monies due or to become due
with respect thereto, the related Equipment and all proceeds thereof and
Insurance Proceeds relating thereto.

                  Section 6.3       Adjustments.

         The Seller hereby agrees that, with respect to each Contract
transferred hereunder which provides for any payment constituting a
Prepayment, which amount is less than an amount equal to the aggregate
remaining Scheduled Payments related to such Contract, the Seller shall
indemnify the Buyer in an amount equal to the amount equal to the aggregate
remaining Scheduled Payments related to such Contract.

                  Section 6.4       Substitution of Contracts.

         On any day prior to the occurrence of the Termination Date, the Buyer
may, in its sole discretion, by written notice to the Seller, request that any
Contract be replaced by one or more other Contracts (each, a "Substitute
Contract"), provided that no such replacement shall occur unless each of the
following conditions is satisfied as of the date of such replacement and
substitution:

         (a) the Seller has previously recommended to the Buyer in writing
that the Contract to be replaced should be replaced (each, a "Replaced
Contract");

         (b) each Substitute Contract is an Eligible Contract on the date of
such substitution;

         (c) after giving effect to any such substitution, the aggregate of
all outstanding Capital does not exceed the lesser of (A) the Purchase Limit
and (B) the Capital Limit;

         (d) such Substitute Contracts, at the time of substitution by the
Seller, shall have approximately the same weighted average life as the
remaining Scheduled Payments of Assets in the Asset Pool and shall not
materially exceed the last Scheduled Payment of any Asset in the Asset Pool;

         (e) all representations and warranties of the Seller contained in
Section 5.1 and 5.2 shall be true and correct as of the date of substitution
of any such Substitute Contract;

         (f) the substitution of any Substitute Contract does not cause a
Payout Event to occur under the Receivables Purchase Agreement; and

         (g) the Seller shall deliver to the Deal Agent on the date of such
substitution a certificate of a Responsible Officer certifying that each of
the foregoing is true and correct as of such date.



                                     -17-
<PAGE>

         In connection with any such substitution, the Buyer shall,
automatically and without further action, be deemed to transfer to the Seller,
free and clear of any Lien created pursuant to this Agreement, all of the
right, title and interest of the Buyer in, to and under such Replaced
Contract, and the Buyer shall be deemed to represent and warrant that it has
the corporate authority and has taken all necessary corporate action to
accomplish such transfer, but without any other representation or warranty,
express or implied. Any right of the Buyer to substitute any Contract pursuant
to this Section 6.5 shall be in addition to, and without limitation of, any
other rights or remedies that the Buyer may have to require the Seller to
substitute for, or accept retransfer of, any Contract pursuant to the terms of
this Agreement.


                                  ARTICLE VII

                             CONDITIONS PRECEDENT

                  Section 7.1       Conditions to the Buyer's Obligations
                                    Regarding Contracts.

         The obligations of the Buyer to purchase Purchased Assets from the
Seller on the Closing Date and on any Subsequent Purchase Date shall be
subject to the satisfaction of the following conditions:

         (a) all representations and warranties of the Seller contained in
Sections 4.1 and 4.2 shall be true and correct on and as of such day as though
made on and as of such date;

         (b) on and as of such day, the Seller shall have performed all
obligations required to be performed by it on or prior to such day pursuant to
the provisions of this Agreement;

         (c) no event has occurred and is continuing, or would result from
such purchase which constitutes a Payout Event under the Receivables Purchase
Agreement;

         (d) no law or regulation shall prohibit, and no order, judgment or
decree of any federal, state or local court or governmental body, agency or
instrumentality shall prohibit or enjoin, the making of any such purchase by
the Buyer in accordance with the provisions hereof; and

         (e) all corporate and legal proceedings and all instruments in
connection with the transactions contemplated by this Agreement shall be
satisfactory in form and substance to the Buyer, and the Buyer shall have
received from the Seller copies of all documents (including, without
limitation, records of corporate proceedings, approvals and opinions) relevant
to the transactions herein contemplated as the Buyer may reasonably have
requested.




                                     -18-
<PAGE>

                                 ARTICLE VIII

                             TERM AND TERMINATION

                  Section 8.1       Termination.

         This Agreement shall commence as of the date of execution and
delivery hereof and shall continue in full force and effect until the
occurrence of the Collection Date pursuant to the Receivables Purchase
Agreement; provided, however, that the termination of this Agreement pursuant
to this Section 8.1 shall not discharge any Person from obligations incurred
prior to any such termination of this Agreement, including, without
limitation, any obligations to repurchase Contracts sold prior to such
termination pursuant to Section 6.1 or 6.2 hereof, or to make the payments
required under Section 6.3 hereof.

                                  ARTICLE IX

                           MISCELLANEOUS PROVISIONS

                  Section 9.1       Amendment.

         This Agreement and any other Sale Papers and the rights and
obligations of the parties hereunder may not be amended, waived or changed
orally, but only by an instrument in writing signed by the Buyer and the
Seller, with the prior written consent of the Deal Agent. The Buyer shall
provide not less than 10 Business Days prior written notice of any such
amendment to the Deal Agent.

                  Section 9.2       Governing Law.

         THIS AGREEMENT SHALL BE GOVERNED BY, AND CONSTRUED IN ACCORDANCE
WITH, THE LAWS OF THE STATE OF NEW YORK. EACH OF THE PARTIES HERETO HEREBY
AGREES TO THE JURISDICTION OF ANY FEDERAL COURT LOCATED WITHIN THE STATE OF
NEW YORK. EACH OF THE PARTIES HERETO HEREBY WAIVES ANY OBJECTION BASED ON
FORUM NON CONVENIENS, AND ANY OBJECTION TO VENUE OF ANY ACTION INSTITUTED
HEREUNDER IN ANY OF THE AFOREMENTIONED COURTS AND CONSENTS TO THE GRANTING OF
SUCH LEGAL OR EQUITABLE RELIEF AS IS DEEMED APPROPRIATE BY SUCH COURT.

                  Section 9.3       Notices.

         All demands, notices and communications hereunder shall be in writing
and shall be deemed to have been duly given if personally delivered at or
mailed by registered mail, return receipt requested, to:



                                     -19-
<PAGE>

         (a)      in the case of the Buyer, to:

                  SW Leasing Portfolio IV, Inc.
                  3000 Mellon Bank Center
                  1735 Market Street
                  Philadelphia, Pennsylvania  19103
                  Attn:  President
                  Facsimile No.:  (215) 575-7640
                  Confirmation No.:  (215) 575-0500

         (b)      in the case of the Seller, to:

                  Fidelity Leasing, Inc.
                  Seven East Skippack Pike
                  Ambler, PA  19002

                  Attn:  David H. English
                  Facsimile No.:  (215) 619-2830
                  Confirmation No.:  (215) 643-6300

         (c)      in the case of the Deal Agent, to:

                  First Union Capital Markets Corp.
                  One First Union Center, TW-6
                  Charlotte, North Carolina  28288
                  Attn:  Conduit Administrator
                  Facsimile No.:  (704) 383-6036
                  Confirmation No.:  (704) 383-9343

or, as to each party, at such other address as shall be designated by such
party in a written notice to each other party.

                  Section 9.4       Severability of Provisions.

         If any one or more of the covenants, agreements, provisions or terms
of this Agreement or any of the Sale Papers shall for any reason whatsoever be
held invalid, then such covenants, agreements, provisions, or terms shall be
deemed severable from the remaining covenants, agreements, provisions, or
terms of this Agreement and the Sale Papers and shall in no way affect the
validity or enforceability of the other provisions of this Agreement or any of
the Sale Papers.

                  Section 9.5       Assignment.

         (a) Notwithstanding anything to the contrary contained herein, this
Agreement may not be assigned by the Buyer or the Seller except as permitted
by this Section 9.5 or by the Receivables Purchase Agreement. Simultaneously


                                     -20-
<PAGE>

with the execution and delivery of this Agreement, the Buyer shall assign all
of its right, title and interest herein (to the extent of the aggregate Asset
Interests) to the Deal Agent as agent for the Purchasers under the Receivables
Purchase Agreement as provided in the Receivables Purchase Agreement, to which
assignment the Seller hereby expressly consents. The Seller agrees to perform
its obligations hereunder for the benefit of the Deal Agent as agent for the
Purchasers under the Receivables Purchase Agreement and the Deal Agent, as
agent for the Purchasers under the Receivables Purchase Agreement under the
Receivables Purchase Agreement shall be a third party beneficiary hereof. The
Deal Agent as agent for the Purchasers under the Receivables Purchase
Agreement may enforce the provisions of this Agreement, exercise the rights of
the Buyer and enforce the obligations of the Seller hereunder as provided in
of the Receivables Purchase Agreement. This Agreement may not be assigned by
the Seller except in connection with a merger or consolidation of the Seller
with or into, or disposition of the Seller's properties and assets to, another
Person, provided, however, that any such merger, consolidation or disposition
shall satisfy the requirements of Section 9.14, upon not less than 10 Business
Days' prior written notice to the Buyer and the Deal Agent.

         (b) In connection with any permitted assignment of this Agreement by
the Seller, the Seller shall deliver to the Buyer and the Deal Agent an
Officer's Certificate that such assignment complies with this Section 9.5, and
shall cause such assignee to execute an agreement supplemental hereto, in form
and substance satisfactory to the Seller, pursuant to which such assignee
shall expressly assume and agree to the performance of every covenant and
obligation of the Seller hereunder, to provide for the delivery of an Opinion
of Counsel that such supplemental agreement is legal, valid and binding with
respect to such assignee, and to take such other actions and execute such
other instruments as may reasonably be required to effectuate such assignment.

                  Section 9.6       Further Assurances.

         the Buyer and the Seller agree to do and perform, from time to time,
any and all acts and to execute any and all further instruments required or
reasonably requested by the other party more fully to effect the purposes of
this Agreement and the Sale Papers, including, without limitation, the
execution of any financing statements, continuation statements, termination
statements, releases or equivalent documents relating to the Contracts for
filing under the provisions of the UCC or other laws of any applicable
jurisdiction.

                  Section 9.7       No Waiver; Cumulative Remedies.

         No failure to exercise and no delay in exercising, on the part of the
Buyer or the Seller, any right, remedy, power or privilege hereunder, shall
operate as a waiver thereof; nor shall any single or partial exercise of any
right, remedy, power or privilege hereunder preclude any other or further
exercise thereof or the exercise of any other right, remedy, power or
privilege. The rights, remedies, powers and privileges herein provided are
cumulative and not exhaustive of any rights, remedies, powers and privilege
provided by law.



                                     -21-
<PAGE>

                  Section 9.8       Counterparts.

         This Agreement may be executed in two or more counterparts including
telefax transmission thereof (and by different parties on separate
counterparts), each of which shall be an original, but all of which together
shall constitute one and the same instrument.

                  Section 9.9       Binding Effect; Third-Party Beneficiaries.

         This Agreement shall inure to the benefit of and the obligations
thereunder shall be binding upon the parties hereto and their respective
successors and permitted assigns. Any permitted assigns shall be third-party
beneficiaries of this Agreement.

                  Section 9.10      Merger and Integration.

         Except as specifically stated otherwise herein, this Agreement sets
forth the entire understanding of the parties relating to the subject matter
hereof, there are no other agreements between the parties for transactions
relating to or similar to the transactions contemplated by this Agreement, and
all prior understandings, written or oral, are superseded by this Agreement.
This Agreement may not be modified, amended, waived or supplemented except as
provided herein.

                  Section 9.11      Headings.

         The headings herein are for purposes of reference only and shall not
otherwise affect the meaning or interpretation of any provision hereof.

                  Section 9.12      Schedules and Exhibits.

         The schedules and exhibits attached hereto and referred to herein
shall constitute a part of this Agreement and are incorporated into this
Agreement for all purposes.

                  Section 9.13      No Proceedings.

         The Seller hereby covenants and agrees that, prior to the date which
is one year and one day after the payment in full of the Note, it will not
institute against or join any other Person in instituting against the Buyer
any bankruptcy, reorganization, arrangement, insolvency or liquidation
proceedings or other similar proceeding under the laws of the United States or
any State of the United States.

                  Section 9.14      Merger or Consolidation of, or Assumption
                                    of the Obligations of, the Seller.

         The Seller shall not consolidate with or merge into any other
corporation or convey or transfer its properties and assets substantially as
an entirety to any Person, unless:



                                     -22-
<PAGE>

                  (i) the Person formed by such consolidation or into which
         the Seller is merged or the Person which acquires by conveyance or
         transfer the properties and assets of the Seller substantially as an
         entirety shall be, if the Seller is not the surviving entity,
         organized and existing under the laws of the United States of America
         or any State or the District of Columbia and shall expressly assume,
         by an agreement supplemental hereto, executed and delivered to the
         Buyer in form satisfactory to the Buyer, the performance of every
         covenant and obligation of the Seller hereunder (to the extent that
         any right, covenant or obligation of the Seller, as applicable
         hereunder, is inapplicable to the successor entity, such successor
         entity shall be subject to such covenant or obligation, or benefit
         from such right, as would apply, to the extent practicable, to such
         successor entity);

                  (ii) the Seller shall have delivered to the Buyer and the
         Deal Agent an Officer's Certificate that such consolidation, merger,
         conveyance or transfer and such supplemental agreement comply with
         this Section 9.14 and that all conditions precedent herein provided
         for relating to such transaction have been complied with and an
         Opinion of Counsel that such supplemental agreement is legal, valid
         and binding with respect to the successor entity and that the entity
         surviving such consolidation, conveyance or transfer is organized and
         existing under the laws of the United States of America or any State
         or the District of Columbia. The Deal Agent shall receive prompt
         written notice of such merger or consolidation of the Seller; and

                  (iii) after giving effect thereto, no Event of Termination
         under the Receivables Purchase Agreement or an event which with
         notice or lapse of time or both would constitute such an Event of
         Termination thereunder shall have occurred.

                  Section 9.15      Costs, Expenses and Taxes.

         (a) The Seller agrees to pay on demand all costs and expenses of the
Buyer incurred in connection with the preparation, execution, delivery,
administration (including periodic auditing), amendment or modification of, or
any waiver or consent issued in connection with, this Agreement and the other
documents to be delivered hereunder or in connection herewith, including,
without limitation, the reasonable fees and out-of-pocket expenses of counsel
for the Buyer with respect thereto and with respect to advising the Buyer as
to its rights and remedies under this Agreement and the other documents to be
delivered hereunder or in connection herewith, and all costs and out-of-pocket
expenses, if any (including reasonable counsel fees and expenses), incurred by
the Buyer in connection with the enforcement of this Agreement and the other
documents to be delivered hereunder or in connection herewith.

         (b) The Seller shall pay on demand any and all stamp, sales, excise
and other taxes and fees payable or determined to be payable in connection
with the execution, delivery, filing and recording of this Agreement or any
agreement or other document delivered in connection with this Agreement



                                     -23-
<PAGE>

         (c) The Seller shall pay on demand any and all damages, losses,
claims, liabilities, fees and related costs and expenses, including attorney's
fees and expenses, incurred by or awarded against the Buyer or any of its
Affiliates (each, an "Indemnified Party") arising out of or as a result of the
transactions contemplated under this Agreement and owed by such Indemnified
Party to any other Person; provided, that the Seller shall not be liable to
pay any portion of any such damages, losses, claims or liabilities resulting
from the gross negligence or willful misconduct of an Indemnified Party or the
breach of a Requirement of Law by an Indemnified Party.

                  Section 9.16      Recourse Against Certain Parties.

         (a) No recourse under or with respect to any obligation, covenant or
agreement (including, without limitation, the payment of any fees or any other
obligations) of the Seller as contained in this Agreement or any other
agreement, instrument or document entered into by it pursuant hereto or in
connection herewith shall be had against any administrator of the Seller or
any incorporator, officer, employee or director of the Seller or of any such
administrator, as such, by the enforcement of any assessment or by any legal
or equitable proceeding, by virtue of any statute or otherwise; it being
expressly agreed and understood that the agreements of the Seller contained in
this Agreement and all of the other agreements, instruments and documents
entered into by it pursuant hereto or in connection herewith are, in each
case, solely the corporate obligations of the Seller, and that no personal
liability whatsoever shall attach to or be incurred by any administrator of
the Seller or any incorporator, officer, employee or director of the Seller or
of any such administrator, as such, or any other them, under or by reason of
any of the obligations, covenants or agreements of the Seller contained in
this Agreement or in any other such instruments, documents or agreements, or
which are implied therefrom, and that any and all personal liability of every
such administrator of the Seller and each incorporator, officer, employee or
director of the Seller or of any such administrator, or any of them, for
breaches by the Seller of any such obligations, covenants or agreements, which
liability may arise either at common law or at equity, by statute or
constitution, or otherwise, is hereby expressly waived as a condition of and
in consideration for the execution of this Agreement. The provisions of this
Section 9.16(a) shall survive the termination of this Agreement.

         (b) No recourse under or with respect to any obligation, covenant or
agreement (including, without limitation, the payment of any fees or any other
obligations) of the Buyer as contained in this Agreement or any other
agreement, instrument or document entered into by it pursuant hereto or in
connection herewith shall be had against any administrator of the Buyer or any
incorporator, officer, employee or director of the Buyer or of any such
administrator, as such, by the enforcement of any assessment or by any legal
or equitable proceeding, by virtue of any statute or otherwise; it being
expressly agreed and understood that the agreements of the Buyer contained in
this Agreement and all of the other agreements, instruments and documents
entered into by it pursuant hereto or in connection herewith are, in each
case, solely the corporate obligations of the Buyer, and that no personal
liability whatsoever shall attach to or be incurred by any administrator of
the Buyer or any incorporator, officer, employee or director of the Buyer or
of any such administrator, as such, or any other them, under or by reason of
any of the obligations, covenants or agreements of the Buyer contained in this


                                     -24-
<PAGE>

Agreement or in any other such instruments, documents or agreements, or which
are implied therefrom, and that any and all personal liability of every such
administrator of the Buyer and each incorporator, officer, employee or
director of the Buyer or of any such administrator, or any of them, for
breaches by the Buyer of any such obligations, covenants or agreements, which
liability may arise either at common law or at equity, by statute or
constitution, or otherwise, is hereby expressly waived as a condition of and
in consideration for the execution of this Agreement. The provisions of this
Section 9.16 (b) shall survive the termination of this Agreement.

                            [Signatures to Follow]






                                     -25-
<PAGE>

     IN WITNESS WHEREOF, the Buyer and the Seller have caused this Agreement
to be duly executed by their respective officers as of the day and year first
above written.


                            SW LEASING PORTFOLIO IV, INC.


                            By:______________________________________
                                Name:________________________________
                                Title:_______________________________



                            FIDELITY LEASING, INC.


                            By:______________________________________
                                Name:________________________________
                                Title:_______________________________





<PAGE>


                                                                  Exhibit 23.1

                       E.E. Templeton & Associates, Inc.
                             407 1/2 Second Street
                             Marietta, Ohio 45750
                                 614-373-5046



February 23, 1998


Resource Energy, Inc.
Attention:  Mr. Jeffrey C. Simmons
2876 S. Arlington Road
Akron, Ohio  44312

Gentlemen:

We hereby consent to the use of our audit report dated October 23, 1997, on
reserves and revenue as of October 1, 1997, from certain properties owned by
Resource Energy, Inc., as a wholly-owned subsidiary of Resource America, Inc.,
on Form S-3 for the fiscal year ending September 30, 1997.


Very Truly Yours,

/s/ E.E. Templeton & Associates, Inc.

E.E. Templeton & Associates, Inc.







<PAGE>
                                                                  Exhibit 23.2

                         Consent of Grant Thornton LLP



We have issued our reports dated November 6, 1997 accompanying the
consolidated financial statements and schedules of Resource America, Inc. and
subsidiaries included in the Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended
September 30, 1997 which are incorporated by reference in this Registration
Statement. We have also issued our reports dated November 6, 1997 except for
the earnings per share disclosures in footnote 2 accompanying the consolidated
financial statements for the years ended September 30, 1997 and 1996 and for
each of the three years in the period ended September 30, 1997, which
financial statements are included in the Registration Statement. We consent to
the incorporation by reference in the Registration Statement of the
aforementioned reports and to the use of our name as it appears under the
caption "Experts."




/s/ Grant Thornton LLP
- -------------------------------
Cleveland, Ohio
March 4, 1998



© 2022 IncJournal is not affiliated with or endorsed by the U.S. Securities and Exchange Commission